diff options
| author | Steve Lee <me@xiangyangli.com> | 2017-12-13 03:29:05 +0800 |
|---|---|---|
| committer | Steve Lee <me@xiangyangli.com> | 2017-12-13 03:29:05 +0800 |
| commit | 6a57744994be173666c9de1fb0a16ed888b562a8 (patch) | |
| tree | 7f6f3de249ffaa59d704a294656f77f14742ce10 /.emacs.d/elpa/org-20171120/org | |
| parent | 516df54c4bfd63fda22b49dd05f7cb7a09ab45ec (diff) | |
| download | dotfiles-6a57744994be173666c9de1fb0a16ed888b562a8.tar.xz dotfiles-6a57744994be173666c9de1fb0a16ed888b562a8.zip | |
add .emacs.d
Diffstat (limited to '.emacs.d/elpa/org-20171120/org')
| -rw-r--r-- | .emacs.d/elpa/org-20171120/org | 22446 |
1 files changed, 22446 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/.emacs.d/elpa/org-20171120/org b/.emacs.d/elpa/org-20171120/org new file mode 100644 index 0000000..a56da2d --- /dev/null +++ b/.emacs.d/elpa/org-20171120/org @@ -0,0 +1,22446 @@ +This is org, produced by makeinfo version 4.13 from org.texi. + +This manual is for Org version 9.1.3 (release_9.1.3-2-g322612). + + Copyright (C) 2004-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this + document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, + Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software + Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover Texts + being "A GNU Manual," and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) + below. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled + "GNU Free Documentation License." + + (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: "You have the freedom to copy and + modify this GNU manual." + +INFO-DIR-SECTION Emacs editing modes +START-INFO-DIR-ENTRY +* Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer +END-INFO-DIR-ENTRY + + +File: org, Node: Top, Next: Introduction, Prev: (dir), Up: (dir) + +Org Mode Manual +*************** + +This manual is for Org version 9.1.3 (release_9.1.3-2-g322612). + + Copyright (C) 2004-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this + document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, + Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software + Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover Texts + being "A GNU Manual," and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) + below. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled + "GNU Free Documentation License." + + (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: "You have the freedom to copy and + modify this GNU manual." + +* Menu: + +* Introduction:: Getting started +* Document structure:: A tree works like your brain +* Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting +* Hyperlinks:: Notes in context +* TODO items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item +* Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags +* Properties and columns:: Storing information about an entry +* Dates and times:: Making items useful for planning +* Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects +* Agenda views:: Collecting information into views +* Markup:: Prepare text for rich export +* Exporting:: Sharing and publishing notes +* Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files +* Working with source code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks +* Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere +* Hacking:: How to hack your way around +* MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device +* History and acknowledgments:: How Org came into being +* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation. +* Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features +* Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described +* Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions +* Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual + + --- The Detailed Node Listing --- + +Introduction + +* Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does +* Installation:: Installing Org +* Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers +* Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc. +* Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual + +Document structure + +* Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode +* Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines +* Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified +* Motion:: Jumping to other headlines +* Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines +* Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context +* Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry +* Drawers:: Tucking stuff away +* Blocks:: Folding blocks +* Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax +* Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org +* Org syntax:: Formal description of Org's syntax + +Visibility cycling + +* Global and local cycling:: Cycling through various visibility states +* Initial visibility:: Setting the initial visibility state +* Catching invisible edits:: Preventing mistakes when editing invisible parts + +Tables + +* Built-in table editor:: Simple tables +* Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings +* Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines +* Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode +* The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities +* Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables + +The spreadsheet + +* References:: How to refer to another field or range +* Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff +* Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp +* Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values +* Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields +* Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column +* Lookup functions:: Lookup functions for searching tables +* Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas +* Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields +* Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc + +Hyperlinks + +* Link format:: How links in Org are formatted +* Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file +* External links:: URL-like links to the world +* Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following +* Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code? +* Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links +* Search options:: Linking to a specific location +* Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough + +Internal links + +* Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text + +TODO items + +* TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries +* TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments +* Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress +* Priorities:: Some things are more important than others +* Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces +* Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists + +Extended use of TODO keywords + +* Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps +* TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest +* Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way +* Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state +* Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements +* Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states +* TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others + +Progress logging + +* Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE? +* Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change? +* Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been? + +Tags + +* Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline +* Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline +* Tag hierarchy:: Create a hierarchy of tags +* Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags + +Properties and columns + +* Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out +* Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features +* Property searches:: Matching property values +* Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree +* Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing +* Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers + +Column view + +* Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property +* Using column view:: How to create and use column view +* Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view + +Defining columns + +* Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid? +* Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column + +Dates and times + +* Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry +* Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps +* Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work +* Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task +* Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance +* Timers:: Notes with a running timer + +Creating timestamps + +* The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time +* Custom time format:: Making dates look different + +Deadlines and scheduling + +* Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items +* Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again + +Clocking work time + +* Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock +* The clock table:: Detailed reports +* Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle + +Capture - Refile - Archive + +* Capture:: Capturing new stuff +* Attachments:: Add files to tasks +* RSS feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds +* Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org +* Refile and copy:: Moving/copying a tree from one place to another +* Archiving:: What to do with finished projects + +Capture + +* Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored +* Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture +* Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types + +Capture templates + +* Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry +* Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context +* Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context + +Protocols for external access + +* `store-link' protocol:: Store a link, push URL to kill-ring. +* `capture' protocol:: Fill a buffer with external information. +* `open-source' protocol:: Edit published contents. + +Archiving + +* Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file +* Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file + +Agenda views + +* Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information +* Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views +* Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box? +* Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display +* Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees +* Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views +* Exporting agenda views:: Writing a view to a file +* Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries + +The built-in agenda views + +* Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks +* Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items +* Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search +* Search view:: Find entries by searching for text +* Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review + +Presentation and sorting + +* Categories:: Not all tasks are equal +* Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time +* Sorting agenda items:: The order of things +* Filtering/limiting agenda items:: Dynamically narrow the agenda + +Custom agenda views + +* Storing searches:: Type once, use often +* Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer +* Setting options:: Changing the rules + +Markup for rich export + +* Paragraphs:: The basic unit of text +* Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc. +* Horizontal rules:: Make a line +* Images and tables:: Images, tables and caption mechanism +* Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting +* Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols +* Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text +* Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents + +Embedded LaTeX + +* LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy +* Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like? +* CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas + +Exporting + +* The export dispatcher:: The main interface +* Export settings:: Common export settings +* Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents +* Include files:: Include additional files into a document +* Macro replacement:: Use macros to create templates +* Comment lines:: What will not be exported +* ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding +* Beamer export:: Exporting as a Beamer presentation +* HTML export:: Exporting to HTML +* LaTeX export:: Exporting to LaTeX, and processing to PDF +* Markdown export:: Exporting to Markdown +* OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text +* Org export:: Exporting to Org +* Texinfo export:: Exporting to Texinfo +* iCalendar export:: Exporting to iCalendar +* Other built-in back-ends:: Exporting to a man page +* Advanced configuration:: Fine-tuning the export output +* Export in foreign buffers:: Author tables and lists in Org syntax + +Beamer export + +* Beamer export commands:: For creating Beamer documents. +* Beamer specific export settings:: For customizing Beamer export. +* Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer:: For composing Beamer slides. +* Beamer specific syntax:: For using in Org documents. +* Editing support:: For using helper functions. +* A Beamer example:: A complete presentation. + +HTML export + +* HTML Export commands:: Invoking HTML export +* HTML Specific export settings:: Settings for HTML export +* HTML doctypes:: Exporting various (X)HTML flavors +* HTML preamble and postamble:: Inserting preamble and postamble +* Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org files +* Links in HTML export:: Interpreting and formatting links +* Tables in HTML export:: Formatting and modifying tables +* Images in HTML export:: Inserting figures with HTML output +* Math formatting in HTML export:: Handling math equations +* Text areas in HTML export:: Showing an alternate approach, an example +* CSS support:: Styling HTML output +* JavaScript support:: Folding scripting in the web browser + +LaTeX export + +* LaTeX export commands:: For producing LaTeX and PDF documents. +* LaTeX specific export settings:: Unique to this LaTeX back-end. +* LaTeX header and sectioning:: For file structure. +* Quoting LaTeX code:: Directly in the Org document. +* Tables in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to tables. +* Images in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to images. +* Plain lists in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to lists. +* Source blocks in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to source code blocks. +* Example blocks in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to example blocks. +* Special blocks in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to special blocks. +* Horizontal rules in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to horizontal rules. + +OpenDocument Text export + +* Pre-requisites for ODT export:: Required packages. +* ODT export commands:: Invoking export. +* ODT specific export settings:: Configuration options. +* Extending ODT export:: Producing `.doc', `.pdf' files. +* Applying custom styles:: Styling the output. +* Links in ODT export:: Handling and formatting links. +* Tables in ODT export:: Org table conversions. +* Images in ODT export:: Inserting images. +* Math formatting in ODT export:: Formatting LaTeX fragments. +* Labels and captions in ODT export:: Rendering objects. +* Literal examples in ODT export:: For source code and example blocks. +* Advanced topics in ODT export:: For power users. + +Math formatting in ODT export + +* Working with LaTeX math snippets:: Embedding in LaTeX format. +* Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: Embedding in native format. + +Advanced topics in ODT export + +* Configuring a document converter:: Registering a document converter. +* Working with OpenDocument style files:: Exploring internals. +* Creating one-off styles:: Customizing styles, highlighting. +* Customizing tables in ODT export:: Defining table templates. +* Validating OpenDocument XML:: Debugging corrupted OpenDocument files. + +Texinfo export + +* Texinfo export commands:: Invoking commands. +* Texinfo specific export settings:: Setting the environment. +* Texinfo file header:: Generating the header. +* Texinfo title and copyright page:: Creating preamble pages. +* Info directory file:: Installing a manual in Info file hierarchy. +* Headings and sectioning structure:: Building document structure. +* Indices:: Creating indices. +* Quoting Texinfo code:: Incorporating literal Texinfo code. +* Plain lists in Texinfo export:: List attributes. +* Tables in Texinfo export:: Table attributes. +* Images in Texinfo export:: Image attributes. +* Special blocks in Texinfo export:: Special block attributes. +* A Texinfo example:: Processing Org to Texinfo. + +Publishing + +* Configuration:: Defining projects +* Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server +* Sample configuration:: Example projects +* Triggering publication:: Publication commands + +Configuration + +* Project alist:: The central configuration variable +* Sources and destinations:: From here to there +* Selecting files:: What files are part of the project? +* Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing +* Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/LaTeX export +* Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing? +* Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages +* Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages + +Sample configuration + +* Simple example:: One-component publishing +* Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example + +Working with source code + +* Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described +* Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing +* Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results +* Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files +* Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer +* Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks +* Languages:: List of supported code block languages +* Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality +* Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled +* Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode +* Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks +* Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line + +Header arguments + +* Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments +* Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments + +Using header arguments + +* System-wide header arguments:: Set globally, language-specific +* Language-specific header arguments:: Set in the Org file's headers +* Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set in the Org file +* Language-specific mode properties:: +* Code block specific header arguments:: The most commonly used method +* Arguments in function calls:: The most specific level, takes highest priority + +Specific header arguments + +* var:: Pass arguments to `src' code blocks +* results:: Specify results type; how to collect +* file:: Specify a path for output file +* file-desc:: Specify a description for file results +* file-ext:: Specify an extension for file output +* output-dir:: Specify a directory for output file +* dir:: Specify the default directory for code block execution +* exports:: Specify exporting code, results, both, none +* tangle:: Toggle tangling; or specify file name +* mkdirp:: Toggle for parent directory creation for target files during tangling +* comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled code files +* padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled code files +* no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb expansion during tangling +* session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation +* noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references +* noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target +* noweb-sep:: String to separate noweb references +* cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks +* sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org +* hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables +* colnames:: Handle column names in tables +* rownames:: Handle row names in tables +* shebang:: Make tangled files executable +* tangle-mode:: Set permission of tangled files +* eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks +* wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results +* post:: Post processing of results of code block evaluation +* prologue:: Text to prepend to body of code block +* epilogue:: Text to append to body of code block + +Miscellaneous + +* Completion:: M-TAB guesses completions +* Easy templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements +* Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline +* Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code +* Customization:: Adapting Org to changing tastes +* In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS +* The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c +* Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline +* TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty +* Interaction:: With other Emacs packages +* org-crypt:: Encrypting Org files + +Interaction with other packages + +* Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with +* Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts + +Hacking + +* Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals +* Add-on packages:: Available extensions +* Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types +* Adding export back-ends:: How to write new export back-ends +* Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands +* Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for LaTeX and other programs +* Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks +* Special agenda views:: Customized views +* Speeding up your agendas:: Tips on how to speed up your agendas +* Extracting agenda information:: Post-processing of agenda information +* Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties +* Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries + +Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax + +* Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables +* A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial +* Translator functions:: Copy and modify +* Radio lists:: Sending and receiving lists + +MobileOrg + +* Setting up the staging area:: For the mobile device +* Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas +* Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items + + +File: org, Node: Introduction, Next: Document structure, Prev: Top, Up: Top + +1 Introduction +************** + +* Menu: + +* Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does +* Installation:: Installing Org +* Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers +* Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc. +* Conventions:: Typesetting conventions in the manual + + +File: org, Node: Summary, Next: Installation, Up: Introduction + +1.1 Summary +=========== + +Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and project +planning with a fast and effective plain-text system. It also is an +authoring system with unique support for literate programming and +reproducible research. + + Org is implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible +to keep the content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling +and structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily +created with a built-in table editor. Plain text URL-like links +connect to websites, emails, Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any +files related to the projects. + + Org develops organizational tasks around notes files that contain +lists or information about projects as plain text. Project planning +and task management makes use of metadata which is part of an outline +node. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries +and create dynamic agenda views that also integrate the Emacs calendar +and diary. Org can be used to implement many different project +planning schemes, such as David Allen's GTD system. + + Org files can serve as a single source authoring system with export +to many different formats such as HTML, LaTeX, Open Document, and +Markdown. New export backends can be derived from existing ones, or +defined from scratch. + + Org files can include source code blocks, which makes Org uniquely +suited for authoring technical documents with code examples. Org +source code blocks are fully functional; they can be evaluated in place +and their results can be captured in the file. This makes it possible +to create a single file reproducible research compendium. + + Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should feel +like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not +imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when needed. +Org is a toolbox. Many users actually run only a (very personal) +fraction of Org's capabilities, and know that there is more whenever +they need it. + + All of this is achieved with strictly plain text files, the most +portable and future-proof file format. Org runs in Emacs. Emacs is +one of the most widely ported programs, so that Org mode is available +on every major platform. + + There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest +version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked +questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc. This page is located at +`http://orgmode.org'. + + An earlier version (7.3) of this manual is available as a paperback +book from Network Theory Ltd. +(http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/) + + +File: org, Node: Installation, Next: Activation, Prev: Summary, Up: Introduction + +1.2 Installation +================ + +Org is part of recent distributions of GNU Emacs, so you normally don't +need to install it. If, for one reason or another, you want to install +Org on top of this pre-packaged version, there are three ways to do it: + + * By using Emacs package system. + + * By downloading Org as an archive. + + * By using Org's git repository. + + We strongly recommend to stick to a single installation method. + +Using Emacs packaging system +............................ + +Recent Emacs distributions include a packaging system which lets you +install Elisp libraries. You can install Org with `M-x package-install +RET org'. + +Important: you need to do this in a session where no `.org' file has +been visited, i.e., where no Org built-in function have been loaded. +Otherwise autoload Org functions will mess up the installation. + + Then, to make sure your Org configuration is taken into account, +initialize the package system with `(package-initialize)' in your Emacs +init file before setting any Org option. If you want to use Org's +package repository, check out the Org ELPA page +(http://orgmode.org/elpa.html). + +Downloading Org as an archive +............................. + +You can download Org latest release from Org's website +(http://orgmode.org/). In this case, make sure you set the load-path +correctly in your Emacs init file: + + (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp") + + The downloaded archive contains contributed libraries that are not +included in Emacs. If you want to use them, add the `contrib' +directory to your load-path: + + (add-to-list 'load-path "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" t) + + Optionally, you can compile the files and/or install them in your +system. Run `make help' to list compilation and installation options. + +Using Org's git repository +.......................... + +You can clone Org's repository and install Org like this: + + $ cd ~/src/ + $ git clone git://orgmode.org/org-mode.git + $ make autoloads + + Note that in this case, `make autoloads' is mandatory: it defines +Org's version in `org-version.el' and Org's autoloads in +`org-loaddefs.el'. + + Remember to add the correct load-path as described in the method +above. + + You can also compile with `make', generate the documentation with +`make doc', create a local configuration with `make config' and install +Org with `make install'. Please run `make help' to get the list of +compilation/installation options. + + For more detailed explanations on Org's build system, please check +the Org Build System page on Worg +(http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-build-system.html). + + +File: org, Node: Activation, Next: Feedback, Prev: Installation, Up: Introduction + +1.3 Activation +============== + +Org mode buffers need font-lock to be turned on: this is the default in +Emacs(1). + + There are compatibility issues between Org mode and some other Elisp +packages, please take the time to check the list (*note Conflicts::). + + The four Org commands `org-store-link', `org-capture', `org-agenda', +and `org-iswitchb' should be accessible through global keys (i.e., +anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers). Here are suggested +bindings for these keys, please modify the keys to your own liking. + (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link) + (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda) + (global-set-key "\C-cc" 'org-capture) + (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb) + + Files with the `.org' extension use Org mode by default. To turn on +Org mode in a file that does not have the extension `.org', make the +first line of a file look like this: + + MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*- + +which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what the file's +name is. See also the variable `org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file'. + + Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is active. To +make use of this, you need to have `transient-mark-mode' turned on, +which is the default. If you do not like `transient-mark-mode', you +can create an active region by using the mouse to select a region, or +pressing `C-<SPC>' twice before moving the cursor. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) If you don't use font-lock globally, turn it on in Org buffer +with `(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)' + + +File: org, Node: Feedback, Next: Conventions, Prev: Activation, Up: Introduction + +1.4 Feedback +============ + +If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or +ideas about it, please mail to the Org mailing list +<emacs-orgmode@gnu.org>. You can subscribe to the list on this web +page (https://lists.gnu.org/mailman/listinfo/emacs-orgmode). If you +are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the +list after a moderator has approved it(1). + + For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the +latest version of Org available--if you are running an outdated +version, it is quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If +the bug persists, prepare a report and provide as much information as +possible, including the version information of Emacs (`M-x +emacs-version <RET>') and Org (`M-x org-version RET'), as well as the +Org related setup in the Emacs init file. The easiest way to do this +is to use the command + M-x org-submit-bug-report RET + which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so +that you only need to add your description. If you are not sending the +Email from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your +Email program. + + Sometimes you might face a problem due to an error in your Emacs or +Org mode setup. Before reporting a bug, it is very helpful to start +Emacs with minimal customizations and reproduce the problem. Doing so +often helps you determine if the problem is with your customization or +with Org mode itself. You can start a typical minimal session with a +command like the example below. + + $ emacs -Q -l /path/to/minimal-org.el + + However if you are using Org mode as distributed with Emacs, a +minimal setup is not necessary. In that case it is sufficient to start +Emacs as `emacs -Q'. The `minimal-org.el' setup file can have contents +as shown below. + + ;;; Minimal setup to load latest 'org-mode' + + ;; activate debugging + (setq debug-on-error t + debug-on-signal nil + debug-on-quit nil) + + ;; add latest org-mode to load path + (add-to-list 'load-path "/path/to/org-mode/lisp") + (add-to-list 'load-path "/path/to/org-mode/contrib/lisp" t) + + If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how +to create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear +information about: + + 1. What exactly did you do? + + 2. What did you expect to happen? + + 3. What happened instead? + Thank you for helping to improve this program. + +How to create a useful backtrace +................................ + +If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't +understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by +providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a _backtrace_. +This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the +error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace: + + 1. Reload uncompiled versions of all Org mode Lisp files. The + backtrace contains much more information if it is produced with + uncompiled code. To do this, use + C-u M-x org-reload RET + or select `Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled' from the + menu. + + 2. Go to the `Options' menu and select `Enter Debugger on Error'. + + 3. Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to + document the steps you take. + + 4. When you hit the error, a `*Backtrace*' buffer will appear on the + screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using `C-x C-w') + and attach it to your bug report. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Please consider subscribing to the mailing list, in order to +minimize the work the mailing list moderators have to do. + + +File: org, Node: Conventions, Prev: Feedback, Up: Introduction + +1.5 Typesetting conventions used in this manual +=============================================== + +TODO keywords, tags, properties, etc. +..................................... + +Org mainly uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags and +property names. In this manual we use the following conventions: + +`TODO' +`WAITING' + TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are + user-defined. + +`boss' +`ARCHIVE' + User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with + special meaning are written with all capitals. + +`Release' +`PRIORITY' + User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with + special meaning are written with all capitals. + + Moreover, Org uses option keywords (like `#+TITLE' to set the title) +and environment keywords (like `#+BEGIN_EXPORT html' to start a `HTML' +environment). They are written in uppercase in the manual to enhance +its readability, but you can use lowercase in your Org file. + +Key bindings and commands +......................... + +The manual suggests a few global key bindings, in particular `C-c a' for +`org-agenda' and `C-c c' for `org-capture'. These are only +suggestions, but the rest of the manual assumes that these key bindings +are in place in order to list commands by key access. + + Also, the manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands +for accessing a functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for +different functions, depending on context. The command that is bound +to such keys has a generic name, like `org-metaright'. In the manual +we will, wherever possible, give the function that is internally called +by the generic command. For example, in the chapter on document +structure, `M-<right>' will be listed to call `org-do-demote', while in +the chapter on tables, it will be listed to call +`org-table-move-column-right'. If you prefer, you can compile the +manual without the command names by unsetting the flag `cmdnames' in +`org.texi'. + + +File: org, Node: Document structure, Next: Tables, Prev: Introduction, Up: Top + +2 Document structure +******************** + +Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to edit the +structure of the document. + +* Menu: + +* Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode +* Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines +* Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified +* Motion:: Jumping to other headlines +* Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines +* Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context +* Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry +* Drawers:: Tucking stuff away +* Blocks:: Folding blocks +* Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax +* Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org +* Org syntax:: Formal description of Org's syntax + + +File: org, Node: Outlines, Next: Headlines, Up: Document structure + +2.1 Outlines +============ + +Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a document +to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least for me) is +the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview of this +structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the document +to show only the general document structure and the parts currently +being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of outlines by +compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single command, +`org-cycle', which is bound to the <TAB> key. + + +File: org, Node: Headlines, Next: Visibility cycling, Prev: Outlines, Up: Document structure + +2.2 Headlines +============= + +Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org +start with one or more stars, on the left margin(1) (2). For example: + + * Top level headline + ** Second level + *** 3rd level + some text + *** 3rd level + more text + + * Another top level headline + +Note that a headline named after `org-footnote-section', which defaults +to `Footnotes', is considered as special. A subtree with this headline +will be silently ignored by exporting functions. + + Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an +outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline +starters. *note Clean view::, describes a setup to realize this. + + An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and +will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at +least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding +the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the +variable `org-cycle-separator-lines' to modify this behavior. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) See the variables `org-special-ctrl-a/e', `org-special-ctrl-k', +and `org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree' to configure special behavior of `C-a', +`C-e', and `C-k' in headlines. + + (2) Clocking only works with headings indented less than 30 stars. + + +File: org, Node: Visibility cycling, Next: Motion, Prev: Headlines, Up: Document structure + +2.3 Visibility cycling +====================== + +* Menu: + +* Global and local cycling:: Cycling through various visibility states +* Initial visibility:: Setting the initial visibility state +* Catching invisible edits:: Preventing mistakes when editing invisible parts + + +File: org, Node: Global and local cycling, Next: Initial visibility, Up: Visibility cycling + +2.3.1 Global and local cycling +------------------------------ + +Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer. Org +uses just two commands, bound to <TAB> and `S-<TAB>' to change the +visibility in the buffer. + +`<TAB>' (`org-cycle') + _Subtree cycling_: Rotate current subtree among the states + + ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --. + '-----------------------------------' + + The cursor must be on a headline for this to work(1). + +`S-<TAB>' (`org-global-cycle') +C-u <TAB> + _Global cycling_: Rotate the entire buffer among the states + + ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --. + '--------------------------------------' + + When `S-<TAB>' is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the + CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that + inside tables, `S-<TAB>' jumps to the previous field. + + You can run global cycling using <TAB> only if point is at the very + beginning of the buffer, but not on a headline, and + `org-cycle-global-at-bob' is set to a non-`nil' value. + +`C-u C-u <TAB>' (`org-set-startup-visibility') + Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer (*note Initial + visibility::). + +`C-u C-u C-u <TAB>' (`outline-show-all') + Show all, including drawers. + +`C-c C-r' (`org-reveal') + Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the + following heading and the hierarchy above. Useful for working + near a location that has been exposed by a sparse tree command + (*note Sparse trees::) or an agenda command (*note Agenda + commands::). With a prefix argument show, on each level, all + sibling headings. With a double prefix argument, also show the + entire subtree of the parent. + +`C-c C-k' (`outline-show-branches') + Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one + subtree. + +`C-c <TAB>' (`outline-show-children') + Expose all direct children of the subtree. With a numeric prefix + argument N, expose all children down to level N. + +`C-c C-x b' (`org-tree-to-indirect-buffer') + Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer(2). With a numeric + prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N + is negative then go up that many levels. With a `C-u' prefix, do + not remove the previously used indirect buffer. + +`C-c C-x v' (`org-copy-visible') + Copy the visible text in the region into the kill ring. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) see, however, the option `org-cycle-emulate-tab'. + + (2) The indirect buffer (*note Indirect Buffers: (emacs)Indirect +Buffers.) will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the +current tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the +original buffer, but without affecting visibility in that buffer. + + +File: org, Node: Initial visibility, Next: Catching invisible edits, Prev: Global and local cycling, Up: Visibility cycling + +2.3.2 Initial visibility +------------------------ + +When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to +OVERVIEW, i.e., only the top level headlines are visible(1). This can +be configured through the variable `org-startup-folded', or on a +per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the +buffer: + + #+STARTUP: overview + #+STARTUP: content + #+STARTUP: showall + #+STARTUP: showeverything + +Furthermore, any entries with a `VISIBILITY' property (*note Properties +and columns::) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed +values for this property are `folded', `children', `content', and `all'. + +`C-u C-u <TAB>' (`org-set-startup-visibility') + Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e., + whatever is requested by startup options and `VISIBILITY' + properties in individual entries. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) When `org-agenda-inhibit-startup' is non-`nil', Org will not +honor the default visibility state when first opening a file for the +agenda (*note Speeding up your agendas::). + + +File: org, Node: Catching invisible edits, Prev: Initial visibility, Up: Visibility cycling + +2.3.3 Catching invisible edits +------------------------------ + +Sometimes you may inadvertently edit an invisible part of the buffer +and be confused on what has been edited and how to undo the mistake. +Setting `org-catch-invisible-edits' to non-`nil' will help prevent +this. See the docstring of this option on how Org should catch +invisible edits and process them. + + +File: org, Node: Motion, Next: Structure editing, Prev: Visibility cycling, Up: Document structure + +2.4 Motion +========== + +The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer. + +`C-c C-n' (`org-next-visible-heading') + Next heading. + +`C-c C-p' (`org-previous-visible-heading') + Previous heading. + +`C-c C-f' (`org-forward-same-level') + Next heading same level. + +`C-c C-b' (`org-backward-same-level') + Previous heading same level. + +`C-c C-u' (`outline-up-heading') + Backward to higher level heading. + +`C-c C-j' (`org-goto') + Jump to a different place without changing the current outline + visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, + where you can use the following keys to find your destination: + <TAB> Cycle visibility. + <down> / <up> Next/previous visible headline. + <RET> Select this location. + / Do a Sparse-tree search + The following keys work if you turn off `org-goto-auto-isearch' + n / p Next/previous visible headline. + f / b Next/previous headline same level. + u One level up. + 0-9 Digit argument. + q Quit + See also the option `org-goto-interface'. + + +File: org, Node: Structure editing, Next: Sparse trees, Prev: Motion, Up: Document structure + +2.5 Structure editing +===================== + +`M-<RET>' (`org-meta-return') + Insert a new heading, item or row. + + If the command is used at the _beginning_ of a line, and if there + is a heading or a plain list item (*note Plain lists::) at point, + the new heading/item is created _before_ the current line. When + used at the beginning of a regular line of text, turn that line + into a heading. + + When this command is used in the middle of a line, the line is + split and the rest of the line becomes the new item or headline. + If you do not want the line to be split, customize + `org-M-RET-may-split-line'. + + Calling the command with a `C-u' prefix unconditionally inserts a + new heading at the end of the current subtree, thus preserving its + contents. With a double `C-u C-u' prefix, the new heading is + created at the end of the parent subtree instead. + +`C-<RET>' (`org-insert-heading-respect-content') + Insert a new heading at the end of the current subtree. + +`M-S-<RET>' (`org-insert-todo-heading') + Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See + also the variable `org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change'. + +`C-S-<RET>' (`org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content') + Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like + `C-<RET>', the new headline will be inserted after the current + subtree. + +`<TAB>' (`org-cycle') + In a new entry with no text yet, the first <TAB> demotes the entry + to become a child of the previous one. The next <TAB> makes it a + parent, and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another <TAB>, + and you are back to the initial level. + +`M-<left>' (`org-do-promote') + Promote current heading by one level. + +`M-<right>' (`org-do-demote') + Demote current heading by one level. + +`M-S-<left>' (`org-promote-subtree') + Promote the current subtree by one level. + +`M-S-<right>' (`org-demote-subtree') + Demote the current subtree by one level. + +`M-<up>' (`org-move-subtree-up') + Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same level). + +`M-<down>' (`org-move-subtree-down') + Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level). + +`M-h' (`org-mark-element') + Mark the element at point. Hitting repeatedly will mark + subsequent elements of the one just marked. E.g., hitting <M-h> + on a paragraph will mark it, hitting <M-h> immediately again will + mark the next one. + +`C-c @' (`org-mark-subtree') + Mark the subtree at point. Hitting repeatedly will mark + subsequent subtrees of the same level than the marked subtree. + +`C-c C-x C-w' (`org-cut-subtree') + Kill subtree, i.e., remove it from buffer but save in kill ring. + With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees. + +`C-c C-x M-w' (`org-copy-subtree') + Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy + the N sequential subtrees. + +`C-c C-x C-y' (`org-paste-subtree') + Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the + subtree to make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. + The yank level can also be specified with a numeric prefix + argument, or by yanking after a headline marker like `****'. + +`C-y' (`org-yank') + Depending on the options `org-yank-adjusted-subtrees' and + `org-yank-folded-subtrees', Org's internal `yank' command will + paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command + as `C-c C-x C-y'. With the default settings, no level adjustment + will take place, but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing + so would swallow text previously visible. Any prefix argument to + this command will force a normal `yank' to be executed, with the + prefix passed along. A good way to force a normal yank is `C-u + C-y'. If you use `yank-pop' after a yank, it will yank previous + kill items plainly, without adjustment and folding. + +`C-c C-x c' (`org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift') + Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You + will be prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can + also specify if any timestamps in the entry should be shifted. + This can be useful, for example, to create a number of tasks + related to a series of lectures to prepare. For more details, see + the docstring of the command `org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift'. + +`C-c C-w' (`org-refile') + Refile entry or region to a different location. *Note Refile and + copy::. + +`C-c ^' (`org-sort') + Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all + entries in the region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of + the current headline are sorted. The command prompts for the + sorting method, which can be alphabetically, numerically, by time + (first timestamp with active preferred, creation time, scheduled + time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword (in the + sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the + value of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You + can also supply your own function to extract the sorting key. + With a `C-u' prefix, sorting will be case-sensitive. + +`C-x n s' (`org-narrow-to-subtree') + Narrow buffer to current subtree. + +`C-x n b' (`org-narrow-to-block') + Narrow buffer to current block. + +`C-x n w' (`widen') + Widen buffer to remove narrowing. + +`C-c *' (`org-toggle-heading') + Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it + becomes a subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into + a normal line by removing the stars. If there is an active + region, turn all lines in the region into headlines. If the first + line in the region was an item, turn only the item lines into + headlines. Finally, if the first line is a headline, remove the + stars from all headlines in the region. + + When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and +demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of +headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a +line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line +just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is +inside a table (*note Tables::), the Meta-Cursor keys have different +functionality. + + +File: org, Node: Sparse trees, Next: Plain lists, Prev: Structure editing, Up: Document structure + +2.6 Sparse trees +================ + +An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct _sparse +trees_ for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire +document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is +made visible along with the headline structure above it(1). Just try +it out and you will see immediately how it works. + + Org mode contains several commands for creating such trees, all these +commands can be accessed through a dispatcher: + +`C-c /' (`org-sparse-tree') + This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating + command. + +`C-c / r' or `C-c / /' (`org-occur') + Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If + the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the + match is in the body of an entry, headline and body are made + visible. In order to provide minimal context, also the full + hierarchy of headlines above the match is shown, as well as the + headline following the match. Each match is also highlighted; the + highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an editing + command(2), or by pressing `C-c C-c'. When called with a `C-u' + prefix argument, previous highlights are kept, so several calls to + this command can be stacked. + +`M-g n' or `M-g M-n' (`next-error') + Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer. + +`M-g p' or `M-g M-p' (`previous-error') + Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer. + +For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can +use the option `org-agenda-custom-commands' to define fast keyboard +access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be +accessible through the agenda dispatcher (*note Agenda dispatcher::). +For example: + + (setq org-agenda-custom-commands + '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME"))) + +will define the key `C-c a f' as a shortcut for creating a sparse tree +matching the string `FIXME'. + + The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO +keywords, tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this +manual. + + To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command +`ps-print-buffer-with-faces' which does not print invisible parts of the +document. Or you can use `C-c C-e C-v' to export only the visible part +of the document and print the resulting file. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) See also the variable `org-show-context-detail' to decide how +much context is shown around each match. + + (2) This depends on the option `org-remove-highlights-with-change' + + +File: org, Node: Plain lists, Next: Drawers, Prev: Sparse trees, Up: Document structure + +2.7 Plain lists +=============== + +Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide +additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of +checkboxes (*note Checkboxes::). Org supports editing such lists, and +every exporter (*note Exporting::) can parse and format them. + + Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists. + * _Unordered_ list items start with `-', `+', or `*'(1) as bullets. + + * _Ordered_ list items start with a numeral followed by either a + period or a right parenthesis(2), such as `1.' or `1)'(3). If you + want a list to start with a different value (e.g., 20), start the + text of the item with `[@20]'(4). Those constructs can be used in + any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering. + + * _Description_ list items are unordered list items, and contain the + separator ` :: ' to distinguish the description _term_ from the + description. + + Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on +the first line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number +`10.', then the 2-digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the +other numbers in the list. An item ends before the next line that is +less or equally indented than its bullet/number. + + A list ends whenever every item has ended, which means before any +line less or equally indented than items at top level. It also ends +before two blank lines. In that case, all items are closed. Here is +an example: + + ** Lord of the Rings + My favorite scenes are (in this order) + 1. The attack of the Rohirrim + 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king + + this was already my favorite scene in the book + + I really like Miranda Otto. + 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas + - on DVD only + He makes a really funny face when it happens. + But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole. + Important actors in this film are: + - Elijah Wood :: He plays Frodo + - Sean Astin :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember + him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in The Goonies. + + Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to +deal with them correctly, and by exporting them properly (*note +Exporting::). Since indentation is what governs the structure of these +lists, many structural constructs like `#+BEGIN_...' blocks can be +indented to signal that they belong to a particular item. + + If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that +used for the current list-level) improves readability, customize the +variable `org-list-demote-modify-bullet'. To get a greater difference +of indentation between items and their sub-items, customize +`org-list-indent-offset'. + + The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first +line of an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them +imply the application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. +If some of these actions get in your way, configure +`org-list-automatic-rules' to disable them individually. + +`<TAB>' (`org-cycle') + Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this + works only if the cursor is on a plain list item. For more + details, see the variable `org-cycle-include-plain-lists'. If + this variable is set to `integrate', plain list items will be + treated like low-level headlines. The level of an item is then + given by the indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always + subordinate to real headlines, however; the hierarchies remain + completely separated. In a new item with no text yet, the first + <TAB> demotes the item to become a child of the previous one. + Subsequent <TAB>s move the item to meaningful levels in the list + and eventually get it back to its initial position. + +`M-<RET>' (`org-insert-heading') + Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a + new heading (*note Structure editing::). If this command is used + in the middle of an item, that item is _split_ in two, and the + second part becomes the new item(5). If this command is executed + _before item's body_, the new item is created _before_ the current + one. + +`M-S-<RET>' + Insert a new item with a checkbox (*note Checkboxes::). + +`S-up' +`S-down' + Jump to the previous/next item in the current list(6), but only if + `org-support-shift-select' is off. If not, you can still use + paragraph jumping commands like `C-<up>' and `C-<down>' to quite + similar effect. + +`M-up' +`M-down' + Move the item including subitems up/down(7) (swap with + previous/next item of same indentation). If the list is ordered, + renumbering is automatic. + +`M-left' +`M-right' + Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children + alone. + +`M-S-<left>' +`M-S-<right>' + Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems. + Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. + When these commands are executed several times in direct + succession, the initially selected region is used, even if the new + indentation would imply a different hierarchy. To use the new + hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor motion or so. + + As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a + list will move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by + configuring `org-list-automatic-rules'. The global indentation of + a list has no influence on the text _after_ the list. + +`C-c C-c' + If there is a checkbox (*note Checkboxes::) in the item line, + toggle the state of the checkbox. In any case, verify bullets and + indentation consistency in the whole list. + +`C-c -' + Cycle the entire list level through the different + itemize/enumerate bullets (`-', `+', `*', `1.', `1)') or a subset + of them, depending on `org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator', + the type of list, and its indentation. With a numeric prefix + argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an + active region when calling this, all selected lines are converted + to list items. With a prefix argument, selected text is changed + into a single item. If the first line already was a list item, any + item marker will be removed from the list. Finally, even without + an active region, a normal line will be converted into a list item. + +`C-c *' + Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a + subheading at its location). *Note Structure editing::, for a + detailed explanation. + +`C-c C-*' + Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading. + Checkboxes (*note Checkboxes::) will become TODO (resp. DONE) + keywords when unchecked (resp. checked). + +`S-left/right' + This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the + bullet or anywhere in an item line, details depending on + `org-support-shift-select'. + +`C-c ^' + Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method: + numerically, alphabetically, by time, by checked status for check + lists, or by a custom function. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) When using `*' as a bullet, lines must be indented or they will +be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading +stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a +star may be hard to distinguish from true headlines. In short: even +though `*' is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list +items. + + (2) You can filter out any of them by configuring +`org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator'. + + (3) You can also get `a.', `A.', `a)' and `A)' by configuring +`org-list-allow-alphabetical'. To minimize confusion with normal text, +those are limited to one character only. Beyond that limit, bullets +will automatically fallback to numbers. + + (4) If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie must be put +_before_ the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical lists, you +can also use counters like `[@b]'. + + (5) If you do not want the item to be split, customize the variable +`org-M-RET-may-split-line'. + + (6) If you want to cycle around items that way, you may customize +`org-list-use-circular-motion'. + + (7) See `org-list-use-circular-motion' for a cyclic behavior. + + +File: org, Node: Drawers, Next: Blocks, Prev: Plain lists, Up: Document structure + +2.8 Drawers +=========== + +Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you +normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has _drawers_. They +can contain anything but a headline and another drawer. Drawers look +like this: + + ** This is a headline + Still outside the drawer + :DRAWERNAME: + This is inside the drawer. + :END: + After the drawer. + + You can interactively insert drawers at point by calling +`org-insert-drawer', which is bound to <C-c C-x d>. With an active +region, this command will put the region inside the drawer. With a +prefix argument, this command calls `org-insert-property-drawer' and add +a property drawer right below the current headline. Completion over +drawer keywords is also possible using `M-<TAB>'(1). + + Visibility cycling (*note Visibility cycling::) on the headline will +hide and show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single +line. In order to look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor +to the drawer line and press <TAB> there. Org mode uses the +`PROPERTIES' drawer for storing properties (*note Properties and +columns::), and you can also arrange for state change notes (*note +Tracking TODO state changes::) and clock times (*note Clocking work +time::) to be stored in a drawer `LOGBOOK'. If you want to store a +quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use + +`C-c C-z' + Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer. + + You can select the name of the drawers which should be exported with +`org-export-with-drawers'. In that case, drawer contents will appear in +export output. Property drawers are not affected by this variable: +configure `org-export-with-properties' instead. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Many desktops intercept `M-<TAB>' to switch windows. Use +`C-M-i' or `<ESC> <TAB>' instead for completion (*note Completion::). + + +File: org, Node: Blocks, Next: Footnotes, Prev: Drawers, Up: Document structure + +2.9 Blocks +========== + +Org mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including +source code examples (*note Literal examples::) to capturing time +logging information (*note Clocking work time::). These blocks can be +folded and unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also +get all blocks folded at startup by configuring the option +`org-hide-block-startup' or on a per-file basis by using + + #+STARTUP: hideblocks + #+STARTUP: nohideblocks + + +File: org, Node: Footnotes, Next: Orgstruct mode, Prev: Blocks, Up: Document structure + +2.10 Footnotes +============== + +Org mode supports the creation of footnotes. + + A footnote is started by a footnote marker in square brackets in +column 0, no indentation allowed. It ends at the next footnote +definition, headline, or after two consecutive empty lines. The +footnote reference is simply the marker in square brackets, inside +text. Markers always start with `fn:'. For example: + + The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to. + ... + [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org + + Org mode extends the number-based syntax to _named_ footnotes and +optional inline definition. Here are the valid references: + +`[fn:name]' + A named footnote reference, where `name' is a unique label word, + or, for simplicity of automatic creation, a number. + +`[fn::This is the inline definition of this footnote]' + A LaTeX-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given + directly at the reference point. + +`[fn:name:a definition]' + An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name + for the note. Since Org allows multiple references to the same + note, you can then use `[fn:name]' to create additional references. + + Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create +names yourself. This is handled by the variable +`org-footnote-auto-label' and its corresponding `#+STARTUP' keywords. +See the docstring of that variable for details. + +The following command handles footnotes: + +`C-c C-x f' + The footnote action command. + + When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the + definition. When it is at a definition, jump to the (first) + reference. + + Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the option + `org-footnote-define-inline'(1), the definition will be placed + right into the text as part of the reference, or separately into + the location determined by the option `org-footnote-section'. + + When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of + additional options is offered: + s Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing, + Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular + sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will + also move entries according to `org-footnote-section'. Automatic + sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the + option `org-footnote-auto-adjust'. + r Renumber the simple `fn:N' footnotes. Automatic renumbering + after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the option + `org-footnote-auto-adjust'. + S Short for first `r', then `s' action. + n Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including + inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them + in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. + d Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references + to it. + Depending on the variable `org-footnote-auto-adjust'(2), + renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each + insertion or deletion. + +`C-c C-c' + If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. + If it is a the definition, jump back to the reference. When + called at a footnote location with a prefix argument, offer the + same menu as `C-c C-x f'. + +`C-c C-o or mouse-1/2' + Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding + definition/reference, and you can use the usual commands to follow + these links. + +`C-c '' + +`C-c '' + Edit the footnote definition corresponding to the reference at + point in a separate window. The window can be closed by pressing + `C-c ''. + + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) The corresponding in-buffer setting is: `#+STARTUP: fninline' or +`#+STARTUP: nofninline' + + (2) the corresponding in-buffer options are `fnadjust' and +`nofnadjust'. + + +File: org, Node: Orgstruct mode, Next: Org syntax, Prev: Footnotes, Up: Document structure + +2.11 The Orgstruct minor mode +============================= + +If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list +formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes +like Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode `orgstruct-mode' +makes this possible. Toggle the mode with `M-x orgstruct-mode RET', or +turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, with one of: + + (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct) + (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++) + + When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to +Org like a headline or the first line of a list item, most structure +editing commands will work, even if the same keys normally have +different functionality in the major mode you are using. If the cursor +is not in one of those special lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in +the shadows. + + When you use `orgstruct++-mode', Org will also export indentation and +autofill settings into that mode, and detect item context after the +first line of an item. + + You can also use Org structure editing to fold and unfold headlines +in _any_ file, provided you defined `orgstruct-heading-prefix-regexp': +the regular expression must match the local prefix to use before Org's +headlines. For example, if you set this variable to `";; "' in Emacs +Lisp files, you will be able to fold and unfold headlines in Emacs Lisp +commented lines. Some commands like `org-demote' are disabled when the +prefix is set, but folding/unfolding will work correctly. + + +File: org, Node: Org syntax, Prev: Orgstruct mode, Up: Document structure + +2.12 Org syntax +=============== + +A reference document providing a formal description of Org's syntax is +available as a draft on Worg +(http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-syntax.html), written and maintained +by Nicolas Goaziou. It defines Org's core internal concepts such as +`headlines', `sections', `affiliated keywords', `(greater) elements' +and `objects'. Each part of an Org file falls into one of the +categories above. + + To explore the abstract structure of an Org buffer, run this in a +buffer: + + M-: (org-element-parse-buffer) RET + + It will output a list containing the buffer's content represented as +an abstract structure. The export engine relies on the information +stored in this list. Most interactive commands (e.g., for structure +editing) also rely on the syntactic meaning of the surrounding context. + + You can check syntax in your documents using `org-lint' command. + + +File: org, Node: Tables, Next: Hyperlinks, Prev: Document structure, Up: Top + +3 Tables +******** + +Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like +calculations are supported using the Emacs `calc' package (*note Calc: +(calc)Top.). + +* Menu: + +* Built-in table editor:: Simple tables +* Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings +* Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines +* Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode +* The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities +* Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables + + +File: org, Node: Built-in table editor, Next: Column width and alignment, Up: Tables + +3.1 The built-in table editor +============================= + +Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with `|' as +the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table. `|' +is also the column separator(1). A table might look like this: + + | Name | Phone | Age | + |-------+-------+-----| + | Peter | 1234 | 17 | + | Anna | 4321 | 25 | + + A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press <TAB> or +<RET> or `C-c C-c' inside the table. <TAB> also moves to the next +field (<RET> to the next row) and creates new table rows at the end of +the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation of the table is +set by the first line. Any line starting with `|-' is considered as a +horizontal separator line and will be expanded on the next re-align to +span the whole table width. So, to create the above table, you would +only type + + |Name|Phone|Age| + |- + +and then press <TAB> to align the table and start filling in fields. +Even faster would be to type `|Name|Phone|Age' followed by `C-c <RET>'. + + When typing text into a field, Org treats <DEL>, <Backspace>, and all +character keys in a special way, so that inserting and deleting avoids +shifting other fields. Also, when typing _immediately after the cursor +was moved into a new field with `<TAB>', `S-<TAB>' or `<RET>'_, the +field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too +unpredictable for you, configure the option +`org-table-auto-blank-field'. + +Creation and conversion +....................... + +`C-c | (`org-table-create-or-convert-from-region')' + Convert the active region to a table. If every line contains at + least one TAB character, the function assumes that the material is + tab separated. If every line contains a comma, comma-separated + values (CSV) are assumed. If not, lines are split at whitespace + into fields. You can use a prefix argument to force a specific + separator: `C-u' forces CSV, `C-u C-u' forces TAB, `C-u C-u C-u' + will prompt for a regular expression to match the separator, and a + numeric argument N indicates that at least N consecutive spaces, + or alternatively a TAB will be the separator. + If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org + table. But it is easier just to start typing, like + `|Name|Phone|Age <RET> |- <TAB>'. + +Re-aligning and field motion +............................ + +`C-c C-c (`org-table-align')' + Re-align the table and don't move to another field. + +`C-c SPC (`org-table-blank-field')' + Blank the field at point. + +`TAB (`org-table-next-field')' + Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if + necessary. + +`S-<TAB> (`org-table-previous-field')' + Re-align, move to previous field. + +`<RET> (`org-table-next-row')' + Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if + necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, <RET> still does + NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table. + +`M-a (`org-table-beginning-of-field')' + Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the + previous field. + +`M-e (`org-table-end-of-field')' + Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field. + +Column and row editing +...................... + +`M-<left> (`org-table-move-column-left')' +`M-<right> (`org-table-move-column-right')' + Move the current column left/right. + +`M-S-<left> (`org-table-delete-column')' + Kill the current column. + +`M-S-<right> (`org-table-insert-column')' + Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position. + +`M-<up> (`org-table-move-row-up')' +`M-<down> (`org-table-move-row-down')' + Move the current row up/down. + +`M-S-<up> (`org-table-kill-row')' + Kill the current row or horizontal line. + +`M-S-<down> (`org-table-insert-row')' + Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, + the line is created below the current one. + +`C-c - (`org-table-insert-hline')' + Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix + argument, the line is created above the current line. + +`C-c <RET> (`org-table-hline-and-move')' + Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor + into the row below that line. + +`C-c ^ (`org-table-sort-lines')' + Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point + indicates the column to be used for sorting, and the range of + lines is the range between the nearest horizontal separator lines, + or the entire table. If point is before the first column, you + will be prompted for the sorting column. If there is an active + region, the mark specifies the first line and the sorting column, + while point should be in the last line to be included into the + sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type + (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). You can sort in normal + or reverse order. You can also supply your own key extraction and + comparison functions. When called with a prefix argument, + alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive. + +Regions +....... + +`C-c C-x M-w (`org-table-copy-region')' + Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. + Point and mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there + is no active region, copy just the current field. The process + ignores horizontal separator lines. + +`C-c C-x C-w (`org-table-cut-region')' + Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and + blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the "cut" operation. + +`C-c C-x C-y (`org-table-paste-rectangle')' + Paste a rectangular region into a table. The upper left corner + ends up in the current field. All involved fields will be + overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table, + the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal + separator lines. + +`M-<RET> (`org-table-wrap-region')' + Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest + to the line below. If there is an active region, and both point + and mark are in the same column, the text in the column is wrapped + to minimum width for the given number of lines. A numeric prefix + argument may be used to change the number of desired lines. If + there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument, the current + field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field + above. + +Calculations +............ + +`C-c + (`org-table-sum')' + Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined + by the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can + be inserted with `C-y'. + +`S-<RET> (`org-table-copy-down')' + When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field + above. When not empty, copy current field down to next row and + move cursor along with it. Depending on the option + `org-table-copy-increment', integer field values will be + incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not be + incremented. Also, a `0' prefix argument temporarily disables the + increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related + modes (*note Conflicts::). + +Miscellaneous +............. + +`C-c ` (`org-table-edit-field')' + Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for + fields that are not fully visible (*note Column width and + alignment::). When called with a `C-u' prefix, just make the full + field visible, so that it can be edited in place. When called + with two `C-u' prefixes, make the editor window follow the cursor + through the table and always show the current field. The follow + mode exits automatically when the cursor leaves the table, or when + you repeat this command with `C-u C-u C-c `'. + +`M-x org-table-import RET' + Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace + separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data + from a database, because these programs generally can write + TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the + file into the buffer and then converting the region to a table. + Any prefix argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it + to determine the separator. + +`C-c | (`org-table-create-or-convert-from-region')' + Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org + buffer, selecting the pasted text with `C-x C-x' and then using the + `C-c |' command (see above under Creation and conversion). + +`M-x org-table-export RET' + Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data + exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The + format used to export the file can be configured in the option + `org-table-export-default-format'. You may also use properties + `TABLE_EXPORT_FILE' and `TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT' to specify the file + name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports + quite general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is + the same as the format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see *note + Translator functions::, for a detailed description. + + If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your +way on lines which you would like to start with `|', you can turn it +off with + + (setq org-enable-table-editor nil) + +Then the only table command that still works is `C-c C-c' to do a +manual re-align. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) To insert a vertical bar into a table field, use `\vert' or, +inside a word `abc\vert{}def'. + + +File: org, Node: Column width and alignment, Next: Column groups, Prev: Built-in table editor, Up: Tables + +3.2 Column width and alignment +============================== + +The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. +And also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the +fraction of number-like versus non-number fields in the column. + + Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, +leading to inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a +table with several columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. +To set the width of a column, one field anywhere in the column may +contain just the string `<N>' where `N' is an integer specifying the +width of the column in characters. The next re-align will then set the +width of this column to this value. + + |---+------------------------------| |---+--------| + | | | | | <6> | + | 1 | one | | 1 | one | + | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two | + | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> | + | 4 | four | | 4 | four | + |---+------------------------------| |---+--------| + +Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string `=>'. Note +that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden. To see the +full text, hold the mouse over the field--a tool-tip window will show +the full content. To edit such a field, use the command `C-c `' (that +is `C-c' followed by the grave accent). This will open a new window +with the full field. Edit it and finish with `C-c C-c'. + + When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the +necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to +be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option +`org-startup-align-all-tables' will realign all tables in a file upon +visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option on +a per-file basis with: + + #+STARTUP: align + #+STARTUP: noalign + + If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich +columns to the right and of string-rich columns to the left, you can +use `<r>', `<c>'(1) or `<l>' in a similar fashion. You may also +combine alignment and field width like this: `<r10>'. + + Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed +automatically when exporting the document. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an effect +when exporting to HTML. + + +File: org, Node: Column groups, Next: Orgtbl mode, Prev: Column width and alignment, Up: Tables + +3.3 Column groups +================= + +When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical lines +because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally +however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups +of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In +order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the +first field contains only `/'. The further fields can either contain +`<' to indicate that this column should start a group, `>' to indicate +the end of a group, or `<>' (no space between `<' and `>') to make a +column a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon +export be marked with vertical lines. Here is an example: + + | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | ~sqrt(n)~ | ~sqrt[4](N)~ | + |---+-----+-----+-----+-----------+--------------| + | / | < | | > | < | > | + | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | + | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 | + | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 | + |---+-----+-----+-----+-----------+--------------| + #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1))) + + It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after +every vertical line you would like to have: + + | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) | + |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------| + | / | < | | | < | | + + +File: org, Node: Orgtbl mode, Next: The spreadsheet, Prev: Column groups, Up: Tables + +3.4 The Orgtbl minor mode +========================= + +If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you might +also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode. The +minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle the +mode with `M-x orgtbl-mode RET'. To turn it on by default, for example +in Message mode, use + + (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl) + + Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain +tables in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is +possible to construct LaTeX tables with the underlying ease and power of +Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see +*note Tables in arbitrary syntax::. + + +File: org, Node: The spreadsheet, Next: Org-Plot, Prev: Orgtbl mode, Up: Tables + +3.5 The spreadsheet +=================== + +The table editor makes use of the Emacs `calc' package to implement +spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to +derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's +implementation is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, +Org knows the concept of a _column formula_ that will be applied to all +non-header fields in a column without having to copy the formula to +each relevant field. There is also a formula debugger, and a formula +editor with features for highlighting fields in the table corresponding +to the references at the point in the formula, moving these references +by arrow keys + +* Menu: + +* References:: How to refer to another field or range +* Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff +* Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp +* Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values +* Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields +* Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column +* Lookup functions:: Lookup functions for searching tables +* Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas +* Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields +* Advanced features:: Field and column names, parameters and automatic recalc + + +File: org, Node: References, Next: Formula syntax for Calc, Up: The spreadsheet + +3.5.1 References +---------------- + +To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must +reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced by +name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find +out what the coordinates of a field are, press `C-c ?' in that field, +or press `C-c }' to toggle the display of a grid. + +Field references +................ + +Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in +any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number +combination like `B3', meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row. However, +Org prefers(1) to use another, more general representation that looks +like this: + @ROW$COLUMN + + Column specifications can be absolute like `$1', `$2',...`$N', or +relative to the current column (i.e., the column of the field which is +being computed) like `$+1' or `$-2'. `$<' and `$>' are immutable +references to the first and last column, respectively, and you can use +`$>>>' to indicate the third column from the right. + + The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal +separator lines (hlines). Like with columns, you can use absolute row +numbers `@1', `@2',...`@N', and row numbers relative to the current row +like `@+3' or `@-1'. `@<' and `@>' are immutable references the first +and last(2) row in the table, respectively. You may also specify the +row relative to one of the hlines: `@I' refers to the first hline, +`@II' to the second, etc. `@-I' refers to the first such line above +the current line, `@+I' to the first such line below the current line. +You can also write `@III+2' which is the second data line after the +third hline in the table. + + `@0' and `$0' refer to the current row and column, respectively, +i.e., to the row/column for the field being computed. Also, if you omit +either the column or the row part of the reference, the current +row/column is implied. + + Org's references with _unsigned_ numbers are fixed references in the +sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two +different fields, the same field will be referenced each time. Org's +references with _signed_ numbers are floating references because the +same reference operator can reference different fields depending on the +field being calculated by the formula. + + Here are a few examples: + + @2$3 2nd row, 3rd column (same as `C2') + $5 column 5 in the current row (same as `E&') + @2 current column, row 2 + @-1$-3 the field one row up, three columns to the left + @-I$2 field just under hline above current row, column 2 + @>$5 field in the last row, in column 5 + +Range references +................ + +You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field +references connected by two dots `..'. If both fields are in the +current row, you may simply use `$2..$7', but if at least one field is +in a different row, you need to use the general `@row$column' format at +least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with `@' in +order to be interpreted correctly). Examples: + + $1..$3 first three fields in the current row + $P..$Q range, using column names (see under Advanced) + $<<<..$>> start in third column, continue to the last but one + @2$1..@4$3 6 fields between these two fields (same as `A2..C4') + @-1$-2..@-1 3 fields in the row above, starting from 2 columns on the left + @I..II between first and second hline, short for `@I..@II' + +Range references return a vector of values that can be fed into Calc +vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally suppressed, so +that the vector contains only the non-empty fields. For other options +with the mode switches `E', `N' and examples *note Formula syntax for +Calc::. + +Field coordinates in formulas +............................. + +One of the very first actions during evaluation of Calc formulas and +Lisp formulas is to substitute `@#' and `$#' in the formula with the +row or column number of the field where the current result will go to. +The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are `org-table-current-dline' +and `org-table-current-column'. Examples: + +`if(@# % 2, $#, string(""))' + Insert column number on odd rows, set field to empty on even rows. + +`$2 = '(identity remote(FOO, @@#$1))' + Copy text or values of each row of column 1 of the table named + `FOO' into column 2 of the current table. + +`@3 = 2 * remote(FOO, @1$$#)' + Insert the doubled value of each column of row 1 of the table named + `FOO' into row 3 of the current table. + +For the second/third example, the table named `FOO' must have at least +as many rows/columns as the current table. Note that this is +inefficient(3) for large number of rows/columns. + +Named references +................ + +`$name' is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or constant. +Constants are defined globally through the option +`org-table-formula-constants', and locally (for the file) through a +line like + + #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6 + +Also properties (*note Properties and columns::) can be used as +constants in table formulas: for a property `:Xyz:' use the name +`$PROP_Xyz', and the property will be searched in the current outline +entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the `constants.el' +package, it will also be used to resolve constants, including natural +constants like `$h' for Planck's constant, and units like `$km' for +kilometers(4). Column names and parameters can be specified in special +table lines. These are described below, see *note Advanced features::. +All names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and +numbers. + +Remote references +................. + +You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different +table, either in the current file or even in a different file. The +syntax is + + remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF) + +where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a +`#+NAME: Name' line before the table. It can also be the ID of an +entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the +first table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference +as described above for example `@3$3' or `$somename', valid in the +referenced table. + + Indirection of NAME-OR-ID: When NAME-OR-ID has the format +`@ROW$COLUMN' it will be substituted with the name or ID found in this +field of the current table. For example `remote($1, @>$2)' => +`remote(year_2013, @>$1)'. The format `B3' is not supported because it +can not be distinguished from a plain table name or ID. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Org will understand references typed by the user as `B4', but it +will not use this syntax when offering a formula for editing. You can +customize this behavior using the option +`org-table-use-standard-references'. + + (2) For backward compatibility you can also use special names like +`$LR5' and `$LR12' to refer in a stable way to the 5th and 12th field +in the last row of the table. However, this syntax is deprecated, it +should not be used for new documents. Use `@>$' instead. + + (3) The computation time scales as O(N^2) because the table named +`FOO' is parsed for each field to be read. + + (4) `constants.el' can supply the values of constants in two +different unit systems, `SI' and `cgs'. Which one is used depends on +the value of the variable `constants-unit-system'. You can use the +`#+STARTUP' options `constSI' and `constcgs' to set this value for the +current buffer. + + +File: org, Node: Formula syntax for Calc, Next: Formula syntax for Lisp, Prev: References, Up: The spreadsheet + +3.5.2 Formula syntax for Calc +----------------------------- + +A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs `Calc' +package. Note that `calc' has the non-standard convention that `/' has +lower precedence than `*', so that `a/b*c' is interpreted as `a/(b*c)'. +Before evaluation by `calc-eval' (*note calc-eval: (calc)Calling Calc +from Your Programs.), variable substitution takes place according to the +rules described above. The range vectors can be directly fed into the +Calc vector functions like `vmean' and `vsum'. + + A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. +This string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during +execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision 12, +angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display +format, however, has been changed to `(float 8)' to keep tables +compact. The default settings can be configured using the option +`org-calc-default-modes'. + +List of modes: + +`p20' + Set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits. + +`n3', `s3', `e2', `f4' + Normal, scientific, engineering or fixed format of the result of + Calc passed back to Org. Calc formatting is unlimited in + precision as long as the Calc calculation precision is greater. + +`D', `R' + Degree and radian angle modes of Calc. + +`F', `S' + Fraction and symbolic modes of Calc. + +`T', `t', `U' + Duration computations in Calc or Lisp, *note Durations and time + values::. + +`E' + If and how to consider empty fields. Without `E' empty fields in + range references are suppressed so that the Calc vector or Lisp + list contains only the non-empty fields. With `E' the empty + fields are kept. For empty fields in ranges or empty field + references the value `nan' (not a number) is used in Calc formulas + and the empty string is used for Lisp formulas. Add `N' to use 0 + instead for both formula types. For the value of a field the mode + `N' has higher precedence than `E'. + +`N' + Interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers. See the + next section to see how this is essential for computations with + Lisp formulas. In Calc formulas it is used only occasionally + because there number strings are already interpreted as numbers + without `N'. + +`L' + Literal, for Lisp formulas only. See the next section. + +Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation and +-display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a +`printf' format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been +passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the +formatting(1). A few examples: + + $1+$2 Sum of first and second field + $1+$2;%.2f Same, format result to two decimals + exp($2)+exp($1) Math functions can be used + $0;%.1f Reformat current cell to 1 decimal + ($3-32)*5/9 Degrees F -> C conversion + $c/$1/$cm Hz -> cm conversion, using `constants.el' + tan($1);Dp3s1 Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1 + sin($1);Dp3%.1e Same, but use printf specifier for display + taylor($3,x=7,2) Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree + + Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations, (*note +Logical Operations: (calc)Logical Operations.). For example + +`if($1 < 20, teen, string(""))' + "teen" if age $1 is less than 20, else the Org table result field + is set to empty with the empty string. + +`if("$1" == "nan" || "$2" == "nan", string(""), $1 + $2); E f-1' + Sum of the first two columns. When at least one of the input + fields is empty the Org table result field is set to empty. `E' + is required to not convert empty fields to 0. `f-1' is an + optional Calc format string similar to `%.1f' but leaves empty + results empty. + +`if(typeof(vmean($1..$7)) == 12, string(""), vmean($1..$7); E' + Mean value of a range unless there is any empty field. Every + field in the range that is empty is replaced by `nan' which lets + `vmean' result in `nan'. Then `typeof == 12' detects the `nan' + from `vmean' and the Org table result field is set to empty. Use + this when the sample set is expected to never have missing values. + +`if("$1..$7" == "[]", string(""), vmean($1..$7))' + Mean value of a range with empty fields skipped. Every field in + the range that is empty is skipped. When all fields in the range + are empty the mean value is not defined and the Org table result + field is set to empty. Use this when the sample set can have a + variable size. + +`vmean($1..$7); EN' + To complete the example before: Mean value of a range with empty + fields counting as samples with value 0. Use this only when + incomplete sample sets should be padded with 0 to the full size. + + You can add your own Calc functions defined in Emacs Lisp with +`defmath' and use them in formula syntax for Calc. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) The `printf' reformatting is limited in precision because the +value passed to it is converted into an `integer' or `double'. The +`integer' is limited in size by truncating the signed value to 32 bits. +The `double' is limited in precision to 64 bits overall which leaves +approximately 16 significant decimal digits. + + +File: org, Node: Formula syntax for Lisp, Next: Durations and time values, Prev: Formula syntax for Calc, Up: The spreadsheet + +3.5.3 Emacs Lisp forms as formulas +---------------------------------- + +It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp. This can be +useful for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's +functionality is not enough. + + If a formula starts with an apostrophe followed by an opening +parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation +should return either a string or a number. Just as with `calc' +formulas, you can specify modes and a printf format after a semicolon. + + With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way field +references are interpolated into the form. By default, a reference +will be interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the +field. If you provide the `N' mode switch, all referenced elements +will be numbers (non-number fields will be zero) and interpolated as +Lisp numbers, without quotes. If you provide the `L' flag, all fields +will be interpolated literally, without quotes. I.e., if you want a +reference to be interpreted as a string by the Lisp form, enclose the +reference operator itself in double-quotes, like `"$3"'. Ranges are +inserted as space-separated fields, so you can embed them in list or +vector syntax. + + Here are a few examples--note how the `N' mode is used when we do +computations in Lisp: + +`'(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))' + Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1. + +`'(+ $1 $2);N' + Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's `$1+$2'. + +`'(apply '+ '($1..$4));N' + Compute the sum of columns 1 to 4, like Calc's `vsum($1..$4)'. + + +File: org, Node: Durations and time values, Next: Field and range formulas, Prev: Formula syntax for Lisp, Up: The spreadsheet + +3.5.4 Durations and time values +------------------------------- + +If you want to compute time values use the `T', `t', or `U' flag, +either in Calc formulas or Elisp formulas: + + | Task 1 | Task 2 | Total | + |---------+----------+----------| + | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59:00 | + | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59 | + | 3:02:20 | -2:07:00 | 0.92 | + #+TBLFM: @2$3=$1+$2;T::@3$3=$1+$2;U::@4$3=$1+$2;t + + Input duration values must be of the form `HH:MM[:SS]', where seconds +are optional. With the `T' flag, computed durations will be displayed +as `HH:MM:SS' (see the first formula above). With the `U' flag, +seconds will be omitted so that the result will be only `HH:MM' (see +second formula above). Zero-padding of the hours field will depend +upon the value of the variable `org-table-duration-hour-zero-padding'. + + With the `t' flag, computed durations will be displayed according to +the value of the option `org-table-duration-custom-format', which +defaults to `'hours' and will display the result as a fraction of hours +(see the third formula in the example above). + + Negative duration values can be manipulated as well, and integers +will be considered as seconds in addition and subtraction. + + +File: org, Node: Field and range formulas, Next: Column formulas, Prev: Durations and time values, Up: The spreadsheet + +3.5.5 Field and range formulas +------------------------------ + +To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the +field, preceded by `:=', for example `:=vsum(@II..III)'. When you press +<TAB> or <RET> or `C-c C-c' with the cursor still in the field, the +formula will be stored as the formula for this field, evaluated, and the +current field will be replaced with the result. + + Formulas are stored in a special line starting with `#+TBLFM:' +directly below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of +the 3rd data line in the table, the formula will look like +`@3$4=$1+$2'. When inserting/deleting/swapping columns and rows with +the appropriate commands, absolute references (but not relative ones) +in stored formulas are modified in order to still reference the same +field. To avoid this, in particular in range references, anchor ranges +at the table borders (using `@<', `@>', `$<', `$>'), or at hlines using +the `@I' notation. Automatic adaptation of field references does of +course not happen if you edit the table structure with normal editing +commands--then you must fix the equations yourself. + + Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the +following command + +`C-u C-c = (`org-table-eval-formula')' + Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts + for a formula with default taken from the `#+TBLFM:' line, applies + it to the current field, and stores it. + + The left-hand side of a formula can also be a special expression in +order to assign the formula to a number of different fields. There is +no keyboard shortcut to enter such range formulas. To add them, use +the formula editor (*note Editing and debugging formulas::) or edit the +`#+TBLFM:' line directly. + +`$2=' + Column formula, valid for the entire column. This is so common + that Org treats these formulas in a special way, see *note Column + formulas::. + +`@3=' + Row formula, applies to all fields in the specified row. `@>=' + means the last row. + +`@1$2..@4$3=' + Range formula, applies to all fields in the given rectangular + range. This can also be used to assign a formula to some but not + all fields in a row. + +`$name=' + Named field, see *note Advanced features::. + + +File: org, Node: Column formulas, Next: Lookup functions, Prev: Field and range formulas, Up: The spreadsheet + +3.5.6 Column formulas +--------------------- + +When you assign a formula to a simple column reference like `$3=', the +same formula will be used in all fields of that column, with the +following very convenient exceptions: (i) If the table contains +horizontal separator hlines with rows above and below, everything +before the first such hline is considered part of the table _header_ +and will not be modified by column formulas. Therefore a header is +mandatory when you use column formulas and want to add hlines to group +rows, like for example to separate a total row at the bottom from the +summand rows above. (ii) Fields that already get a value from a +field/range formula will be left alone by column formulas. These +conditions make column formulas very easy to use. + + To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in +the column, preceded by an equal sign, like `=$1+$2'. When you press +<TAB> or <RET> or `C-c C-c' with the cursor still in the field, the +formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated +and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains +only `=', the previously stored formula for this column is used. For +each column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In +the `#+TBLFM:' line, column formulas will look like `$4=$1+$2'. The +left-hand side of a column formula cannot be the name of column, it +must be the numeric column reference or `$>'. + + Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the +following command: + +`C-c = (`org-table-eval-formula')' + Install a new formula for the current column and replace current + field with the result of the formula. The command prompts for a + formula, with default taken from the `#+TBLFM' line, applies it to + the current field and stores it. With a numeric prefix + argument(e.g., `C-5 C-c =') the command will apply it to that many + consecutive fields in the current column. + + +File: org, Node: Lookup functions, Next: Editing and debugging formulas, Prev: Column formulas, Up: The spreadsheet + +3.5.7 Lookup functions +---------------------- + +Org has three predefined Emacs Lisp functions for lookups in tables. +`(org-lookup-first VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)' + Searches for the first element `S' in list `S-LIST' for which + (PREDICATE VAL S) + is `t'; returns the value from the corresponding position in list + `R-LIST'. The default `PREDICATE' is `equal'. Note that the + parameters `VAL' and `S' are passed to `PREDICATE' in the same + order as the corresponding parameters are in the call to + `org-lookup-first', where `VAL' precedes `S-LIST'. If `R-LIST' is + `nil', the matching element `S' of `S-LIST' is returned. + +`(org-lookup-last VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)' + Similar to `org-lookup-first' above, but searches for the last + element for which `PREDICATE' is `t'. + +`(org-lookup-all VAL S-LIST R-LIST &optional PREDICATE)' + Similar to `org-lookup-first', but searches for all elements for + which `PREDICATE' is `t', and returns all corresponding values. + This function can not be used by itself in a formula, because it + returns a list of values. However, powerful lookups can be built + when this function is combined with other Emacs Lisp functions. + + If the ranges used in these functions contain empty fields, the `E' +mode for the formula should usually be specified: otherwise empty +fields will not be included in `S-LIST' and/or `R-LIST' which can, for +example, result in an incorrect mapping from an element of `S-LIST' to +the corresponding element of `R-LIST'. + + These three functions can be used to implement associative arrays, +count matching cells, rank results, group data etc. For practical +examples see this tutorial on Worg +(http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-lookups.html). + + +File: org, Node: Editing and debugging formulas, Next: Updating the table, Prev: Lookup functions, Up: The spreadsheet + +3.5.8 Editing and debugging formulas +------------------------------------ + +You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the +field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active formulas +of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org converts +references to the standard format (like `B3' or `D&') if possible. If +you prefer to only work with the internal format (like `@3$2' or `$4'), +configure the option `org-table-use-standard-references'. + +`C-c = or C-u C-c = (`org-table-eval-formula')' + Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the + minibuffer. See *note Column formulas::, and *note Field and + range formulas::. + +`C-u C-u C-c = (`org-table-eval-formula')' + Re-insert the active formula (either a field formula, or a column + formula) into the current field, so that you can edit it directly + in the field. The advantage over editing in the minibuffer is + that you can use the command `C-c ?'. + +`C-c ? (`org-table-field-info')' + While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s) + referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula. + +`C-c }' + Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using + overlays (`org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays'). These are + updated each time the table is aligned; you can force it with `C-c + C-c'. + +`C-c {' + Toggle the formula debugger on and off + (`org-table-toggle-formula-debugger'). See below. + +`C-c ' (`org-table-edit-formulas')' + Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where + the formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field + has an active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark + it. While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically + highlight any field or range reference at the cursor position. + You may edit, remove and add formulas, and use the following + commands: + + `C-c C-c or C-x C-s (`org-table-fedit-finish')' + Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. + With `C-u' prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire + table. + + `C-c C-q (`org-table-fedit-abort')' + Exit the formula editor without installing changes. + + `C-c C-r (`org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type')' + Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard + (like `B3') and internal (like `@3$2'). + + `<TAB> (`org-table-fedit-lisp-indent')' + Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line + containing a Lisp formula, format the formula according to + Emacs Lisp rules. Another <TAB> collapses the formula back + again. In the open formula, <TAB> re-indents just like in + Emacs Lisp mode. + + `M-<TAB> (`lisp-complete-symbol')' + Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.(1) + + `S-<up>/<down>/<left>/<right>' + Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference + is `B3' and you press `S-<right>', it will become `C3'. This + also works for relative references and for hline references. + + `M-S-<up> (`org-table-fedit-line-up')' + `M-S-<down> (`org-table-fedit-line-down')' + Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up + and down. + + `M-<up> (`org-table-fedit-scroll-down')' + `M-<down> (`org-table-fedit-scroll-up')' + Scroll the window displaying the table. + + `C-c }' + Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off. + + Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated +with the field, because that is stored in a different line (the +`#+TBLFM' line)--during the next recalculation the field will be filled +again. To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty +reply when prompted for the formula, or to edit the `#+TBLFM' line. + + You may edit the `#+TBLFM' directly and re-apply the changed +equations with `C-c C-c' in that line or with the normal recalculation +commands in the table. + +Using multiple #+TBLFM lines +............................ + +You may apply the formula temporarily. This is useful when you switch +the formula. Place multiple `#+TBLFM' lines right after the table, and +then press `C-c C-c' on the formula to apply. Here is an example: + + | x | y | + |---+---| + | 1 | | + | 2 | | + #+TBLFM: $2=$1*1 + #+TBLFM: $2=$1*2 + +Pressing `C-c C-c' in the line of `#+TBLFM: $2=$1*2' yields: + + | x | y | + |---+---| + | 1 | 2 | + | 2 | 4 | + #+TBLFM: $2=$1*1 + #+TBLFM: $2=$1*2 + +Note: If you recalculate this table (with `C-u C-c *', for example), you +will get the following result of applying only the first `#+TBLFM' line. + + | x | y | + |---+---| + | 1 | 1 | + | 2 | 2 | + #+TBLFM: $2=$1*1 + #+TBLFM: $2=$1*2 + +Debugging formulas +.................. + +When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content +becomes the string `#ERROR'. If you would like see what is going on +during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug, +turn on formula debugging in the `Tbl' menu and repeat the calculation, +for example by pressing `C-u C-u C-c = <RET>' in a field. Detailed +information will be displayed. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Many desktops intercept `M-<TAB>' to switch windows. Use +`C-M-i' or `<ESC> <TAB>' instead for completion (*note Completion::). + + +File: org, Node: Updating the table, Next: Advanced features, Prev: Editing and debugging formulas, Up: The spreadsheet + +3.5.9 Updating the table +------------------------ + +Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be +triggered by a command. See *note Advanced features::, for a way to +make recalculation at least semi-automatic. + + In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use +the following commands: + +`C-c * (`org-table-recalculate')' + Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column + formulas from left to right, and all field/range formulas in the + current row. + +`C-u C-c *' +`C-u C-c C-c' + Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the + first hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the + table header. + +`C-u C-u C-c * or C-u C-u C-c C-c (`org-table-iterate')' + Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur. + This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of + other fields that are computed later in the calculation sequence. + +`M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables RET' + Recompute all tables in the current buffer. + +`M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables RET' + Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge + table-to-table dependencies. + + +File: org, Node: Advanced features, Prev: Updating the table, Up: The spreadsheet + +3.5.10 Advanced features +------------------------ + +If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if +you want to be able to assign names(1) to fields and columns, you need +to reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters. + +`C-# (`org-table-rotate-recalc-marks')' + Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states ` ', + `#', `*', `!', `$'. When there is an active region, change all + marks in the region. + + Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students +and makes use of these features: + + |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| + | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note | + |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| + | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | | + | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 | + | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | | + |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| + | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 | + | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 | + |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| + | | Average | | | | 25.0 | | + | ^ | | | | | at | | + | $ | max=50 | | | | | | + |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------| + #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@-II..@-I);%.1f + +Important: please note that for these special tables, recalculating the +table with `C-u C-c *' will only affect rows that are marked `#' or +`*', and fields that have a formula assigned to the field itself. The +column formulas are not applied in rows with empty first field. + + The marking characters have the following meaning: + +`!' + The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you + may refer to a column as `$Tot' instead of `$6'. + +`^' + This row defines names for the fields _above_ the row. With such + a definition, any formula in the table may use `$m1' to refer to + the value `10'. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it + will be stored as `$name=...'. + +`_' + Similar to `^', but defines names for the fields in the row + _below_. + +`$' + Fields in this row can define _parameters_ for formulas. For + example, if a field in a `$' row contains `max=50', then formulas + in this table can refer to the value 50 using `$max'. Parameters + work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on a + per-table basis. + +`#' + Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing + <TAB> or <RET> or `S-<TAB>' in this row. Also, this row is + selected for a global recalculation with `C-u C-c *'. Unmarked + lines will be left alone by this command. + +`*' + Selects this line for global recalculation with `C-u C-c *', but + not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic + recalculation slows down editing too much. + +` ' + Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with `C-u C-c *'. + All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with `#' or + `*'. + +`/' + Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the + narrowing `<N>' markers or column group markers. + + Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the +fantastic `calc.el' package, here is a table that computes the Taylor +series of degree `n' at location `x' for a couple of functions. + + |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------| + | | Func | n | x | Result | + |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------| + | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x | + | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 | + | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 | + | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 | + | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 | + | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 | + |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------| + #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3 + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Such names must start by an alphabetic character and use only +alphanumeric/underscore characters. + + +File: org, Node: Org-Plot, Prev: The spreadsheet, Up: Tables + +3.6 Org-Plot +============ + +Org-Plot can produce graphs of information stored in org tables, either +graphically or in ASCII-art. + +Graphical plots using `Gnuplot' +------------------------------- + +Org-Plot produces 2D and 3D graphs using `Gnuplot' +`http://www.gnuplot.info/' and `gnuplot-mode' +`http://xafs.org/BruceRavel/GnuplotMode'. To see this in action, ensure +that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed on your system, +then call `C-c " g' or `M-x org-plot/gnuplot <RET>' on the following +table. + + #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]" + | Sede | Max cites | H-index | + |-----------+-----------+---------| + | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 | + | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 | + | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 | + | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 | + | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 | + + Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as +labels. Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance +of plots can be exercised through the `#+PLOT:' lines preceding a +table. See below for a complete list of Org-plot options. The +`#+PLOT:' lines are optional. For more information and examples see +the Org-plot tutorial at +`http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html'. + +Plot Options +............ + +`set' + Specify any `gnuplot' option to be set when graphing. + +`title' + Specify the title of the plot. + +`ind' + Specify which column of the table to use as the `x' axis. + +`deps' + Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by + parentheses and separated by spaces for example `dep:(3 4)' to + graph the third and fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other + columns aside from the `ind' column). + +`type' + Specify whether the plot will be `2d', `3d', or `grid'. + +`with' + Specify a `with' option to be inserted for every col being plotted + (e.g., `lines', `points', `boxes', `impulses', etc...). Defaults + to `lines'. + +`file' + If you want to plot to a file, specify + `"PATH/TO/DESIRED/OUTPUT-FILE"'. + +`labels' + List of labels to be used for the `deps' (defaults to the column + headers if they exist). + +`line' + Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script. + +`map' + When plotting `3d' or `grid' types, set this to `t' to graph a + flat mapping rather than a `3d' slope. + +`timefmt' + Specify format of Org mode timestamps as they will be parsed by + Gnuplot. Defaults to `%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S'. + +`script' + If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place + the file name between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. + Before plotting, every instance of `$datafile' in the specified + script will be replaced with the path to the generated data file. + Note: even if you set this option, you may still want to specify + the plot type, as that can impact the content of the data file. + +ASCII bar plots +--------------- + +While the cursor is on a column, typing `C-c " a' or `M-x +orgtbl-ascii-plot <RET>' create a new column containing an ASCII-art +bars plot. The plot is implemented through a regular column formula. +When the source column changes, the bar plot may be updated by +refreshing the table, for example typing `C-u C-c *'. + + | Sede | Max cites | | + |---------------+-----------+--------------| + | Chile | 257.72 | WWWWWWWWWWWW | + | Leeds | 165.77 | WWWWWWWh | + | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | WWW; | + | Stockholm | 134.19 | WWWWWW: | + | Morelia | 257.56 | WWWWWWWWWWWH | + | Rochefourchat | 0.00 | | + #+TBLFM: $3='(orgtbl-ascii-draw $2 0.0 257.72 12) + + The formula is an elisp call: + (orgtbl-ascii-draw COLUMN MIN MAX WIDTH) + +`COLUMN' + is a reference to the source column. + +`MIN MAX' + are the minimal and maximal values displayed. Sources values + outside this range are displayed as `too small' or `too large'. + +`WIDTH' + is the width in characters of the bar-plot. It defaults to `12'. + + + +File: org, Node: Hyperlinks, Next: TODO items, Prev: Tables, Up: Top + +4 Hyperlinks +************ + +Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to other +files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more. + +* Menu: + +* Link format:: How links in Org are formatted +* Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file +* External links:: URL-like links to the world +* Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following +* Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code? +* Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links +* Search options:: Linking to a specific location +* Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough + + +File: org, Node: Link format, Next: Internal links, Up: Hyperlinks + +4.1 Link format +=============== + +Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as clickable +links. The general link format, however, looks like this: + + [[link][description]] or alternatively [[link]] + +Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org will +change the display so that `description' is displayed instead of +`[[link][description]]' and `link' is displayed instead of `[[link]]'. +Links will be highlighted in the face `org-link', which by default is +an underlined face. You can directly edit the visible part of a link. +Note that this can be either the `link' part (if there is no +description) or the `description' part. To edit also the invisible +`link' part, use `C-c C-l' with the cursor on the link. + + If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of +the displayed text and press <BACKSPACE>, you will remove the +(invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete +and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the +missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the internal +structure of all links, use the menu entry `Org->Hyperlinks->Literal +links'. + + +File: org, Node: Internal links, Next: External links, Prev: Link format, Up: Hyperlinks + +4.2 Internal links +================== + +If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal +in the current file. The most important case is a link like +`[[#my-custom-id]]' which will link to the entry with the `CUSTOM_ID' +property `my-custom-id'. You are responsible yourself to make sure +these custom IDs are unique in a file. + + Links such as `[[My Target]]' or `[[My Target][Find my target]]' +lead to a text search in the current file. + + The link can be followed with `C-c C-o' when the cursor is on the +link, or with a mouse click (*note Handling links::). Links to custom +IDs will point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for +a text link is a dedicated target: the same string in double angular +brackets, like `<<My Target>>'. + + If no dedicated target exists, the link will then try to match the +exact name of an element within the buffer. Naming is done with the +`#+NAME' keyword, which has to be put in the line before the element it +refers to, as in the following example + + #+NAME: My Target + | a | table | + |----+------------| + | of | four cells | + + If none of the above succeeds, Org will search for a headline that +is exactly the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and +tags(1). + + During export, internal links will be used to mark objects and +assign them a number. Marked objects will then be referenced by links +pointing to them. In particular, links without a description will +appear as the number assigned to the marked object(2). In the +following excerpt from an Org buffer + + - one item + - <<target>>another item + Here we refer to item [[target]]. + +The last sentence will appear as `Here we refer to item 2' when +exported. + + In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the link +text. In the above example the search would be for `my target'. + + Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can +return to the previous position with `C-c &'. Using this command +several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded +earlier. + +* Menu: + +* Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) To insert a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can +be used. Just type a star followed by a few optional letters into the +buffer and press `M-<TAB>'. All headlines in the current buffer will +be offered as completions. + + (2) When targeting a `#+NAME' keyword, `#+CAPTION' keyword is +mandatory in order to get proper numbering (*note Images and tables::). + + +File: org, Node: Radio targets, Up: Internal links + +4.2.1 Radio targets +------------------- + +Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names in +normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the +text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are +enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target `<<<My +Target>>>' causes each occurrence of `my target' in normal text to +become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically for +radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To update +the target list during editing, press `C-c C-c' with the cursor on or +at a target. + + +File: org, Node: External links, Next: Handling links, Prev: Internal links, Up: Hyperlinks + +4.3 External links +================== + +Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages, BBDB +database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their logs. +External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short +identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after +the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type. + + http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik on the web + doi:10.1000/182 DOI for an electronic resource + file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg file, absolute path + /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg same as above + file:papers/last.pdf file, relative path + ./papers/last.pdf same as above + file:/ssh:myself@some.where:papers/last.pdf file, path on remote machine + /ssh:myself@some.where:papers/last.pdf same as above + file:sometextfile::NNN file, jump to line number + file:projects.org another Org file + file:projects.org::some words text search in Org file(1) + file:projects.org::*task title heading search in Org file(2) + docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN open in doc-view mode at page + id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 Link to heading by ID + news:comp.emacs Usenet link + mailto:adent@galaxy.net Mail link + mhe:folder MH-E folder link + mhe:folder#id MH-E message link + rmail:folder RMAIL folder link + rmail:folder#id RMAIL message link + gnus:group Gnus group link + gnus:group#id Gnus article link + bbdb:R.*Stallman BBDB link (with regexp) + irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob IRC link + info:org#External links Info node or index link + shell:ls *.org A shell command + elisp:org-agenda Interactive Elisp command + elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") Elisp form to evaluate + + On top of these built-in link types, some are available through the +`contrib/' directory (*note Installation::). For example, these links +to VM or Wanderlust messages are available when you load the +corresponding libraries from the `contrib/' directory: + + vm:folder VM folder link + vm:folder#id VM message link + vm://myself@some.where.org/folder#id VM on remote machine + vm-imap:account:folder VM IMAP folder link + vm-imap:account:folder#id VM IMAP message link + wl:folder WANDERLUST folder link + wl:folder#id WANDERLUST message link + + For customizing Org to add new link types *note Adding hyperlink +types::. + + A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a +descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (*note Link +format::), for example: + + [[https://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]] + +If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML +export (*note HTML export::) will inline the image as a clickable +button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an +image, that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file. + + Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them +as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in +`bbdb:Richard Stallman'), or if you need to remove ambiguities about +the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) The actual behavior of the search will depend on the value of +the option `org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline'. If its value +is `nil', then a fuzzy text search will be done. If it is `t', then +only the exact headline will be matched, ignoring spaces and cookies. +If the value is `query-to-create', then an exact headline will be +searched; if it is not found, then the user will be queried to create +it. + + (2) Headline searches always match the exact headline, ignoring +spaces and cookies. If the headline is not found and the value of the +option `org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline' is `query-to-create', +then the user will be queried to create it. + + +File: org, Node: Handling links, Next: Using links outside Org, Prev: External links, Up: Hyperlinks + +4.4 Handling links +================== + +Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to insert +it into an Org file, and to follow the link. + +`C-c l (`org-store-link')' + Store a link to the current location. This is a _global_ command + (you must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in + any buffer to create a link. The link will be stored for later + insertion into an Org buffer (see below). What kind of link will + be created depends on the current buffer: + + Org mode buffers + For Org files, if there is a `<<target>>' at the cursor, the link + points to the target. Otherwise it points to the current + headline, which will also be the description(1). + + If the headline has a `CUSTOM_ID' property, a link to this custom + ID will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the + value of `org-id-link-to-org-use-id'), a globally unique `ID' + property will be created and/or used to construct a link(2). So + using this command in Org buffers will potentially create two + links: a human-readable from the custom ID, and one that is + globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from file to + file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which + one to use. + + Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus + Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will + point to the current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the + group. The description is constructed from the author and the + subject. + + Web browsers: Eww, W3 and W3M + Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as + description. + + Contacts: BBDB + Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry. + + Chat: IRC + For IRC links, if you set the option `org-irc-link-to-logs' to `t', + a `file:/' style link to the relevant point in the logs for the + current conversation is created. Otherwise an `irc:/' style link + to the user/channel/server under the point will be stored. + + Other files + For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a + search string (*note Search options::) pointing to the contents of + the current line. If there is an active region, the selected + words will form the basis of the search string. If the + automatically created link is not working correctly or accurately + enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string + and to do the search for particular file types--see *note Custom + searches::. The key binding `C-c l' is only a suggestion--see + *note Installation::. + + Agenda view + When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to + the entry referenced by the current line. + +`C-c C-l (`org-insert-link')' + Insert a link(3). This prompts for a link to be inserted into the + buffer. You can just type a link, using text for an internal + link, or one of the link type prefixes mentioned in the examples + above. The link will be inserted into the buffer(4), along with a + descriptive text. If some text was selected when this command is + called, the selected text becomes the default description. + + Inserting stored links + All links stored during the current session are part of the + history for this prompt, so you can access them with <up> and + <down> (or `M-p/n'). + + Completion support + Completion with <TAB> will help you to insert valid link prefixes + like `https:', including the prefixes defined through link + abbreviations (*note Link abbreviations::). If you press <RET> + after inserting only the PREFIX, Org will offer specific + completion support for some link types(5) For example, if you + type `file <RET>', file name completion (alternative access: `C-u + C-c C-l', see below) will be offered, and after `bbdb <RET>' you + can complete contact names. + +`C-u C-c C-l' + When `C-c C-l' is called with a `C-u' prefix argument, a link to a + file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to + select the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted + relative to the directory of the current Org file, if the linked + file is in the current directory or in a sub-directory of it, or + if the path is written relative to the current directory using + `../'. Otherwise an absolute path is used, if possible with `~/' + for your home directory. You can force an absolute path with two + `C-u' prefixes. + +`C-c C-l (with cursor on existing link)' + When the cursor is on an existing link, `C-c C-l' allows you to + edit the link and description parts of the link. + +`C-c C-o (`org-open-at-point')' + Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using + `browse-url-at-point'), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for + the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. + When the cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the + corresponding search. When the cursor is on a TAG list in a + headline, it creates the corresponding TAGS view. If the cursor + is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that date. + Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in `file:' links + with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text + files. Classification of files is based on file extension only. + See option `org-file-apps'. If you want to override the default + application and visit the file with Emacs, use a `C-u' prefix. If + you want to avoid opening in Emacs, use a `C-u C-u' prefix. + If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links + in the headline and entry text. If you want to setup the frame + configuration for following links, customize + `org-link-frame-setup'. + +`<RET>' + When `org-return-follows-link' is set, `<RET>' will also follow + the link at point. + +`mouse-2' +`mouse-1' + On links, `mouse-1' and `mouse-2' will open the link just as `C-c + C-o' would. + +`mouse-3' + Like `mouse-2', but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and + internal links to be displayed in another window(6). + +`C-c C-x C-v (`org-toggle-inline-images')' + Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will + only inline images that have no description part in the link, + i.e., images that will also be inlined during export. When called + with a prefix argument, also display images that do have a link + description. You can ask for inline images to be displayed at + startup by configuring the variable + `org-startup-with-inline-images'(7). + +`C-c % (`org-mark-ring-push')' + Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return + easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically. + +`C-c & (`org-mark-ring-goto')' + Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the + commands following internal links, and by `C-c %'. Using this + command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of + previously recorded positions. + +`C-c C-x C-n (`org-next-link')' +`C-c C-x C-p (`org-previous-link')' + Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the + limit of the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. + The key bindings for this are really too long; you might want to + bind this also to `C-n' and `C-p' + (add-hook 'org-load-hook + (lambda () + (define-key org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link) + (define-key org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link))) + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) If the headline contains a timestamp, it will be removed from +the link and result in a wrong link--you should avoid putting timestamp +in the headline. + + (2) The library `org-id.el' must first be loaded, either through +`org-customize' by enabling `org-id' in `org-modules', or by adding +`(require 'org-id)' in your Emacs init file. + + (3) Note that you don't have to use this command to insert a link. +Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them straight +into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically +enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional +descriptive text. + + (4) After insertion of a stored link, the link will be removed from +the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use a +triple `C-u' prefix argument to `C-c C-l', or configure the option +`org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion'. + + (5) This works if a completion function is defined in the +`:complete' property of a link in `org-link-parameters'. + + (6) See the option `org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer' + + (7) with corresponding `#+STARTUP' keywords `inlineimages' and +`noinlineimages' + + +File: org, Node: Using links outside Org, Next: Link abbreviations, Prev: Handling links, Up: Hyperlinks + +4.5 Using links outside Org +=========================== + +You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in Org, +but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two global +commands, like this (please select suitable global keys yourself): + + (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global) + (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global) + + +File: org, Node: Link abbreviations, Next: Search options, Prev: Using links outside Org, Up: Hyperlinks + +4.6 Link abbreviations +====================== + +Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are +needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An +abbreviated link looks like this + + [[linkword:tag][description]] + +where the tag is optional. The linkword must be a word, starting with +a letter, followed by letters, numbers, `-', and `_'. Abbreviations +are resolved according to the information in the variable +`org-link-abbrev-alist' that relates the linkwords to replacement text. +Here is an example: + + (setq org-link-abbrev-alist + '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=") + ("url-to-ja" . "http://translate.google.fr/translate?sl=en&tl=ja&u=%h") + ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=") + ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s") + ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1") + ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST"))) + + If the replacement text contains the string `%s', it will be +replaced with the tag. Using `%h' instead of `%s' will url-encode the +tag (see the example above, where we need to encode the URL parameter.) +Using `%(my-function)' will pass the tag to a custom function, and +replace it by the resulting string. + + If the replacement text doesn't contain any specifier, the tag will +simply be appended in order to create the link. + + Instead of a string, you may also specify a function that will be +called with the tag as the only argument to create the link. + + With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with +`[[bugzilla:129]]', search the web for `OrgMode' with +`[[google:OrgMode]]', show the map location of the Free Software +Foundation `[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]' or of Carsten office +`[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]' and find out +what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with +`[[ads:Dominik,C]]'. + + If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you +can define them in the file with + + #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id= + #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s + +In-buffer completion (*note Completion::) can be used after `[' to +complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function that +implements special (e.g., completion) support for inserting such a link +with `C-c C-l'. Such a function should not accept any arguments, and +return the full link with prefix. You can add a completion function to +a link like this: + + (org-link-set-parameters ``type'' :complete #'some-function) + + +File: org, Node: Search options, Next: Custom searches, Prev: Link abbreviations, Up: Hyperlinks + +4.7 Search options in file links +================================ + +File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a +particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a +line number or a search option after a double(1) colon. For example, +when the command `C-c l' creates a link (*note Handling links::) to a +file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search string that +can be used to find this line back later when following the link with +`C-c C-o'. + + Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file +link, together with an explanation: + + [[file:~/code/main.c::255]] + [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]] + [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]] + [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]] + [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]] + +`255' + Jump to line 255. + +`My Target' + Search for a link target `<<My Target>>', or do a text search for + `my target', similar to the search in internal links, see *note + Internal links::. In HTML export (*note HTML export::), such a + file link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named + anchor in the linked file. + +`*My Target' + In an Org file, restrict search to headlines. + +`#my-custom-id' + Link to a heading with a `CUSTOM_ID' property + +`/regexp/' + Do a regular expression search for `regexp'. This uses the Emacs + command `occur' to list all matches in a separate window. If the + target file is in Org mode, `org-occur' is used to create a sparse + tree with the matches. + + As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used +to search the current file. For example, `[[file:::find me]]' does a +search for `find me' in the current file, just as `[[find me]]' would. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) For backward compatibility, line numbers can also follow a +single colon. + + +File: org, Node: Custom searches, Prev: Search options, Up: Hyperlinks + +4.8 Custom Searches +=================== + +The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the +actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all +cases. For example, BibTeX database files have many entries like +`year="1993"' which would not result in good search strings, because +the only unique identification for a BibTeX entry is the citation key. + + If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to +set the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the +search for the string in the file. Using `add-hook', these functions +need to be added to the hook variables +`org-create-file-search-functions' and +`org-execute-file-search-functions'. See the docstring for these +variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism for +BibTeX database files, and you can use the corresponding code as an +implementation example. See the file `org-bibtex.el'. + + +File: org, Node: TODO items, Next: Tags, Prev: Hyperlinks, Up: Top + +5 TODO items +************ + +Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents(1). +Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the notes file, because +TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org mode, simply +mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way, +information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the +TODO item emerged is always present. + + Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them +throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing +methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do. + +* Menu: + +* TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries +* TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments +* Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress +* Priorities:: Some things are more important than others +* Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces +* Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Of course, you can make a document that contains only long lists +of TODO items, but this is not required. + + +File: org, Node: TODO basics, Next: TODO extensions, Up: TODO items + +5.1 Basic TODO functionality +============================ + +Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word `TODO', +for example: + + *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune + +The most important commands to work with TODO entries are: + +`C-c C-t (`org-todo')' + Rotate the TODO state of the current item among + + ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --. + '--------------------------------' + + If TODO keywords have fast access keys (see *note Fast access to + TODO states::), you will be prompted for a TODO keyword through + the fast selection interface; this is the default behavior when + `org-use-fast-todo-selection' is non-`nil'. + + The same rotation can also be done "remotely" from agenda buffers + with the `t' command key (*note Agenda commands::). + +`C-u C-c C-t' + When TODO keywords have no selection keys, select a specific + keyword using completion; otherwise force cycling through TODO + states with no prompt. When `org-use-fast-todo-selection' is set + to `prefix', use the fast selection interface. + +`S-<right> / S-<left>' + Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. + Useful mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (*note + TODO extensions::). See also *note Conflicts::, for a discussion + of the interaction with `shift-selection-mode'. See also the + variable `org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change'. + +`C-c / t (`org-show-todo-tree')' + View TODO items in a _sparse tree_ (*note Sparse trees::). Folds + the entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) + and the headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or + by using `C-c / T'), search for a specific TODO. You will be + prompted for the keyword, and you can also give a list of keywords + like `KWD1|KWD2|...' to list entries that match any one of these + keywords. With a numeric prefix argument N, show the tree for the + Nth keyword in the option `org-todo-keywords'. With two prefix + arguments, find all TODO states, both un-done and done. + +`C-c a t (`org-todo-list')' + Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE + states) from all agenda files (*note Agenda views::) into a single + buffer. The new buffer will be in `agenda-mode', which provides + commands to examine and manipulate the TODO entries from the new + buffer (*note Agenda commands::). *Note Global TODO list::, for + more information. + +`S-M-<RET> (`org-insert-todo-heading')' + Insert a new TODO entry below the current one. + +Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring +of the option `org-todo-state-tags-triggers' for details. + + +File: org, Node: TODO extensions, Next: Progress logging, Prev: TODO basics, Up: TODO items + +5.2 Extended use of TODO keywords +================================= + +By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and +DONE. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways +with _TODO keywords_ (stored in `org-todo-keywords'). With special +setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different files. + + Note that tags are another way to classify headlines in general and +TODO items in particular (*note Tags::). + +* Menu: + +* Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps +* TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest +* Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way +* Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state +* Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements +* Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states +* TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others + + +File: org, Node: Workflow states, Next: TODO types, Up: TODO extensions + +5.2.1 TODO keywords as workflow states +-------------------------------------- + +You can use TODO keywords to indicate different _sequential_ states in +the process of working on an item, for example(1): + + (setq org-todo-keywords + '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED"))) + + The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that _need +action_) from the DONE states (which need _no further action_). If you +don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE +state. With this setup, the command `C-c C-t' will cycle an entry from +TODO to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. +You may also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific +state. For example `C-3 C-c C-t' will change the state immediately to +VERIFY. Or you can use `S-<left>' to go backward through the sequence. +If you define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion (*note +Completion::) or even a special one-key selection scheme (*note Fast +access to TODO states::) to insert these words into the buffer. +Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see *note +Tracking TODO state changes::, for more information. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Changing this variable only becomes effective after restarting +Org mode in a buffer. + + +File: org, Node: TODO types, Next: Multiple sets in one file, Prev: Workflow states, Up: TODO extensions + +5.2.2 TODO keywords as types +---------------------------- + +The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different +_types_ of action items. For example, you might want to indicate that +items are for "work" or "home". Or, when you work with several people +on a single project, you might want to assign action items directly to +persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would be set up +like this: + + (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE"))) + + In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but +rather different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a +task to a person, and later to mark it DONE. Org mode supports this +style by adapting the workings of the command `C-c C-t'(1). When used +several times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in +order to first select the right type for a task. But when you return +to the item after some time and execute `C-c C-t' again, it will switch +from any name directly to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to +quickly select a specific name. You can also review the items of a +specific TODO type in a sparse tree by using a numeric prefix to `C-c / +t'. For example, to see all things Lucy has to do, you would use `C-3 +C-c / t'. To collect Lucy's items from all agenda files into a single +buffer, you would use the numeric prefix argument as well when creating +the global TODO list: `C-3 C-c a t'. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) This is also true for the `t' command in the agenda buffers. + + +File: org, Node: Multiple sets in one file, Next: Fast access to TODO states, Prev: TODO types, Up: TODO extensions + +5.2.3 Multiple keyword sets in one file +--------------------------------------- + +Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in +parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic `TODO'/`DONE', +but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a separate state indicating +that an item has been canceled (so it is not DONE, but also does not +require action). Your setup would then look like this: + + (setq org-todo-keywords + '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE") + (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED") + (sequence "|" "CANCELED"))) + + The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep +track of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this +setup, `C-c C-t' only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from +`DONE' to (nothing) to `TODO', and from `FIXED' to (nothing) to +`REPORT'. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially select the +correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a keyword or +using completion, you may also apply the following commands: + +`C-u C-u C-c C-t' +`C-S-<right>' +`C-S-<left>' + These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above + example, `C-u C-u C-c C-t' or `C-S-<right>' would jump from `TODO' + or `DONE' to `REPORT', and any of the words in the second row to + `CANCELED'. Note that the `C-S-' key binding conflict with + `shift-selection-mode' (*note Conflicts::). + +`S-<right>' +`S-<left>' + `S-<left>' and `S-<right>' and walk through _all_ keywords from + all sets, so for example `S-<right>' would switch from `DONE' to + `REPORT' in the example above. See also *note Conflicts::, for a + discussion of the interaction with `shift-selection-mode'. + + +File: org, Node: Fast access to TODO states, Next: Per-file keywords, Prev: Multiple sets in one file, Up: TODO extensions + +5.2.4 Fast access to TODO states +-------------------------------- + +If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state +instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for +single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the +selection character after each keyword, in parentheses(1). For example: + + (setq org-todo-keywords + '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)") + (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)") + (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)"))) + + If you then press `C-c C-t' followed by the selection key, the entry +will be switched to this state. `SPC' can be used to remove any TODO +keyword from an entry.(2) + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) All characters are allowed except `@^!', which have a special +meaning here. + + (2) Check also the option `org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo', it +allows you to change the TODO state through the tags interface (*note +Setting tags::), in case you like to mingle the two concepts. Note +that this means you need to come up with unique keys across both sets +of keywords. + + +File: org, Node: Per-file keywords, Next: Faces for TODO keywords, Prev: Fast access to TODO states, Up: TODO extensions + +5.2.5 Setting up keywords for individual files +---------------------------------------------- + +It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in +different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special +lines to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that +file only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed +above, you need one of the following lines anywhere in the file: + + #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED + (you may also write `#+SEQ_TODO' to be explicit about the +interpretation, but it means the same as `#+TODO'), or + #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE + + A setup for using several sets in parallel would be: + + #+TODO: TODO | DONE + #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED + #+TODO: | CANCELED + +To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type `#+' into the +buffer and then use `M-<TAB>' completion. + + Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last +keyword if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE +(although you may use a different word). After changing one of these +lines, use `C-c C-c' with the cursor still in the line to make the +changes known to Org mode(1). + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Org mode parses these lines only when Org mode is activated +after visiting a file. `C-c C-c' with the cursor in a line starting +with `#+' is simply restarting Org mode for the current buffer. + + +File: org, Node: Faces for TODO keywords, Next: TODO dependencies, Prev: Per-file keywords, Up: TODO extensions + +5.2.6 Faces for TODO keywords +----------------------------- + +Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: `org-todo' for +keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and +`org-done' for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If you +are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use special +faces for some of them. This can be done using the option +`org-todo-keyword-faces'. For example: + + (setq org-todo-keyword-faces + '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow") + ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold)))) + + While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED +_should_ work, this does not always seem to be the case. If necessary, +define a special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a +color. The option `org-faces-easy-properties' determines if that color +is interpreted as a foreground or a background color. + + +File: org, Node: TODO dependencies, Prev: Faces for TODO keywords, Up: TODO extensions + +5.2.7 TODO dependencies +----------------------- + +The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to +define TODO dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be +marked DONE until all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked +as DONE. And sometimes there is a logical sequence to a number of +(sub)tasks, so that one task cannot be acted upon before all siblings +above it are done. If you customize the option +`org-enforce-todo-dependencies', Org will block entries from changing +state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE. Furthermore, +if an entry has a property `ORDERED', each of its children will be +blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an example: + + * TODO Blocked until (two) is done + ** DONE one + ** TODO two + + * Parent + :PROPERTIES: + :ORDERED: t + :END: + ** TODO a + ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a) + ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b) + + You can ensure an entry is never blocked by using the `NOBLOCKING' +property: + + * This entry is never blocked + :PROPERTIES: + :NOBLOCKING: t + :END: + +`C-c C-x o (`org-toggle-ordered-property')' + Toggle the `ORDERED' property of the current entry. A property is + used for this behavior because this should be local to the current + entry, not inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to + track the value of this property with a tag for better visibility, + customize the option `org-track-ordered-property-with-tag'. + +`C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t' + Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking. + + If you set the option `org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks', TODO entries +that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a +dimmed font or even made invisible in agenda views (*note Agenda +views::). + + You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes +(*note Checkboxes::). If you set the option +`org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies', an entry that has unchecked +checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE. + + If you need more complex dependency structures, for example +dependencies between entries in different trees or files, check out the +contributed module `org-depend.el'. + + +File: org, Node: Progress logging, Next: Priorities, Prev: TODO extensions, Up: TODO items + +5.3 Progress logging +==================== + +Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when +you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of +a TODO item. This system is highly configurable; settings can be on a +per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For +information on how to clock working time for a task, see *note Clocking +work time::. + +* Menu: + +* Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE? +* Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change? +* Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been? + + +File: org, Node: Closing items, Next: Tracking TODO state changes, Up: Progress logging + +5.3.1 Closing items +------------------- + +The most basic logging is to keep track of _when_ a certain TODO item +was finished. This is achieved with(1) + + (setq org-log-done 'time) + +Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any +of the DONE states, a line `CLOSED: [timestamp]' will be inserted just +after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item +through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you +turn the entry back to a non-TODO state (by pressing <C-c C-t SPC> for +example), that line will also be removed, unless you set +`org-closed-keep-when-no-todo' to non-`nil'. If you want to record a +note along with the timestamp, use(2) + + (setq org-log-done 'note) + +You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below +the entry with a `Closing Note' heading. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) The corresponding in-buffer setting is: `#+STARTUP: logdone' + + (2) The corresponding in-buffer setting is: `#+STARTUP: lognotedone'. + + +File: org, Node: Tracking TODO state changes, Next: Tracking your habits, Prev: Closing items, Up: Progress logging + +5.3.2 Tracking TODO state changes +--------------------------------- + +When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (*note Workflow +states::), you might want to keep track of when a state change occurred +and maybe take a note about this change. You can either record just a +timestamp, or a time-stamped note for a change. These records will be +inserted after the headline as an itemized list, newest first(1). When +taking a lot of notes, you might want to get the notes out of the way +into a drawer (*note Drawers::). Customize `org-log-into-drawer' to +get this behavior--the recommended drawer for this is called +`LOGBOOK'(2). You can also overrule the setting of this variable for a +subtree by setting a `LOG_INTO_DRAWER' property. + + Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org +mode expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is +achieved by adding special markers `!' (for a timestamp) or `@' (for a +note with timestamp) in parentheses after each keyword. For example, +with the setting + + (setq org-todo-keywords + '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@)"))) + + To record a timestamp without a note for TODO keywords configured +with `@', just type `C-c C-c' to enter a blank note when prompted. + +You not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also +request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to DONE(3), and +that a note is recorded when switching to WAIT or CANCELED. The +setting for WAIT is even more special: the `!' after the slash means +that in addition to the note taken when entering the state, a timestamp +should be recorded when leaving the WAIT state, if and only if the +target state does not configure logging for entering it. So it has no +effect when switching from WAIT to DONE, because DONE is configured to +record a timestamp only. But when switching from WAIT back to TODO, +the `/!' in the WAIT setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO +has no logging configured. + + You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences +local to a buffer: + #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@) + + In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a +single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty +LOGGING property resets all logging settings to `nil'. You may then +turn on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like +`lognotedone' or `logrepeat', as well as adding state specific settings +like `TODO(!)'. For example + + * TODO Log each state with only a time + :PROPERTIES: + :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!) + :END: + * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating + :PROPERTIES: + :LOGGING: WAIT(@) logrepeat + :END: + * TODO No logging at all + :PROPERTIES: + :LOGGING: nil + :END: + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) See the option `org-log-states-order-reversed' + + (2) Note that the `LOGBOOK' drawer is unfolded when pressing <SPC> +in the agenda to show an entry--use <C-u SPC> to keep it folded here + + (3) It is possible that Org mode will record two timestamps when you +are using both `org-log-done' and state change logging. However, it +will never prompt for two notes--if you have configured both, the state +change recording note will take precedence and cancel the `Closing +Note'. + + +File: org, Node: Tracking your habits, Prev: Tracking TODO state changes, Up: Progress logging + +5.3.3 Tracking your habits +-------------------------- + +Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of +TODOs, called "habits". A habit has the following properties: + + 1. You have enabled the `habits' module by customizing `org-modules'. + + 2. The habit is a TODO item, with a TODO keyword representing an open + state. + + 3. The property `STYLE' is set to the value `habit'. + + 4. The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a `.+' style repeat + interval. A `++' style may be appropriate for habits with time + constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a `+' style for an + unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports. + + 5. The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by + using the syntax `.+2d/3d', which says that you want to do the + task at least every three days, but at most every two days. + + 6. You must also have state logging for the `DONE' state enabled + (*note Tracking TODO state changes::), in order for historical + data to be represented in the consistency graph. If it is not + enabled it is not an error, but the consistency graphs will be + largely meaningless. + + To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, +here's an actual habit with some history: + + ** TODO Shave + SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d> + :PROPERTIES: + :STYLE: habit + :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36] + :END: + - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu] + - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon] + - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat] + - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun] + - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri] + - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue] + - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri] + - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat] + - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed] + - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat] + + What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given +by the `SCHEDULED' date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. +If today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct +17, after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on +Oct 19, after four days have elapsed. + + What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along +with a consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting +that task done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task +was done over the past three weeks, with colors for each day. The +colors used are: + +`Blue' + If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day. + +`Green' + If the task could have been done on that day. + +`Yellow' + If the task was going to be overdue the next day. + +`Red' + If the task was overdue on that day. + + In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an +asterisk if the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation +mark to show where the current day falls in the graph. + + There are several configuration variables that can be used to change +the way habits are displayed in the agenda. + +`org-habit-graph-column' + The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. + This will overwrite any text in that column, so it is a good idea + to keep your habits' titles brief and to the point. + +`org-habit-preceding-days' + The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in + consistency graphs. + +`org-habit-following-days' + The number of days after today that will appear in consistency + graphs. + +`org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today' + If non-`nil', only show habits in today's agenda view. This is + set to true by default. + + Lastly, pressing `K' in the agenda buffer will cause habits to +temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press `K' again +to bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you +have habits which should only be done in certain contexts, for example. + + +File: org, Node: Priorities, Next: Breaking down tasks, Prev: Progress logging, Up: TODO items + +5.4 Priorities +============== + +If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items +that it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be +done by placing a _priority cookie_ into the headline of a TODO item, +like this + + *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune + +By default, Org mode supports three priorities: `A', `B', and `C'. `A' +is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is treated just +like priority `B'. Priorities make a difference only for sorting in +the agenda (*note Weekly/daily agenda::); outside the agenda, they have +no inherent meaning to Org mode. The cookies can be highlighted with +special faces by customizing `org-priority-faces'. + + Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to +be TODO items. + +`C-c ,' + Set the priority of the current headline (`org-priority'). The + command prompts for a priority character `A', `B' or `C'. When + you press <SPC> instead, the priority cookie is removed from the + headline. The priorities can also be changed "remotely" from the + agenda buffer with the `,' command (*note Agenda commands::). + +`S-<up> (`org-priority-up')' +`S-<down> (`org-priority-down')' + Increase/decrease priority of current headline(1). Note that + these keys are also used to modify timestamps (*note Creating + timestamps::). See also *note Conflicts::, for a discussion of + the interaction with `shift-selection-mode'. + + You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the options +`org-highest-priority', `org-lowest-priority', and +`org-default-priority'. For an individual buffer, you may set these +values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that the +highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest priority): + + #+PRIORITIES: A C B + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) See also the option `org-priority-start-cycle-with-default'. + + +File: org, Node: Breaking down tasks, Next: Checkboxes, Prev: Priorities, Up: TODO items + +5.5 Breaking tasks down into subtasks +===================================== + +It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable +subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO +item, with detailed subtasks on the tree(1). To keep the overview over +the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert either +`[/]' or `[%]' anywhere in the headline. These cookies will be updated +each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing `C-c +C-c' on the cookie. For example: + + * Organize Party [33%] + ** TODO Call people [1/2] + *** TODO Peter + *** DONE Sarah + ** TODO Buy food + ** DONE Talk to neighbor + + If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the +meaning of the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property +`COOKIE_DATA' to either `checkbox' or `todo' to resolve this issue. + + If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO +entries in the subtree (not just direct children), configure +`org-hierarchical-todo-statistics'. To do this for a single subtree, +include the word `recursive' into the value of the `COOKIE_DATA' +property. + + * Parent capturing statistics [2/20] + :PROPERTIES: + :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive + :END: + + If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE when +all children are done, you can use the following setup: + + (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done) + "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise." + (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging + (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO")))) + + (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo) + + Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a +hierarchy of) a large number of subtasks (*note Checkboxes::). + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) To keep subtasks out of the global TODO list, see the +`org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels'. + + +File: org, Node: Checkboxes, Prev: Breaking down tasks, Up: TODO items + +5.6 Checkboxes +============== + +Every item in a plain list(1) (*note Plain lists::) can be made into a +checkbox by starting it with the string `[ ]'. This feature is similar +to TODO items (*note TODO items::), but is more lightweight. +Checkboxes are not included in the global TODO list, so they are often +great to split a task into a number of simple steps. Or you can use +them in a shopping list. To toggle a checkbox, use `C-c C-c', or use +the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's `org-mouse.el'). + + Here is an example of a checkbox list. + + * TODO Organize party [2/4] + - [-] call people [1/3] + - [ ] Peter + - [X] Sarah + - [ ] Sam + - [X] order food + - [ ] think about what music to play + - [X] talk to the neighbors + + Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children +that are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make +the parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are +checked. + + The `[2/4]' and `[1/3]' in the first and second line are cookies +indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked +off, and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an +idea on how many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded +entry. The cookies can be placed into a headline or into (the first +line of) a plain list item. Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct +children structurally below the headline/item on which the cookie +appears(2). You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either +`[/]' or `[%]'. With `[/]' you get an `n out of m' result, as in the +examples above. With `[%]' you get information about the percentage of +checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be `[50%]' and +`[33%]', respectively). In a headline, a cookie can count either +checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it will +display whatever was changed last. Set the property `COOKIE_DATA' to +either `checkbox' or `todo' to resolve this issue. + + If the current outline node has an `ORDERED' property, checkboxes +must be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try +to check off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it. + +The following commands work with checkboxes: + +`C-c C-c (`org-toggle-checkbox')' + Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at + point. With a single prefix argument, add an empty checkbox or + remove the current one(3). With a double prefix argument, set it + to `[-]', which is considered to be an intermediate state. + +`C-c C-x C-b (`org-toggle-checkbox')' + Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at + point. With double prefix argument, set it to `[-]', which is + considered to be an intermediate state. + - If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in + the region and set all remaining boxes to the same status as + the first. With a prefix arg, add or remove the checkbox for + all items in the region. + + - If the cursor is in a headline, toggle the state of the first + checkbox in the region between this headline and the next--so + _not_ the entire subtree--and propagate this new state to all + other checkboxes in the same area. + + - If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at + point. + +`M-S-<RET> (`org-insert-todo-heading')' + Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if the cursor + is already in a plain list item (*note Plain lists::). + +`C-c C-x o (`org-toggle-ordered-property')' + Toggle the `ORDERED' property of the entry, to toggle if + checkboxes must be checked off in sequence. A property is used + for this behavior because this should be local to the current + entry, not inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to + track the value of this property with a tag for better visibility, + customize `org-track-ordered-property-with-tag'. + +`C-c # (`org-update-statistics-cookies')' + Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When + called with a `C-u' prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox + statistic cookies are updated automatically if you toggle + checkboxes with `C-c C-c' and make new ones with `M-S-<RET>'. + TODO statistics cookies update when changing TODO states. If you + delete boxes/entries or add/change them by hand, use this command + to get things back into sync. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) With the exception of description lists. But you can allow it +by modifying `org-list-automatic-rules' accordingly. + + (2) Set the option `org-checkbox-hierarchical-statistics' if you +want such cookies to count all checkboxes below the cookie, not just +those belonging to direct children. + + (3) `C-u C-c C-c' before the _first_ bullet in a list with no +checkbox will add checkboxes to the rest of the list. + + +File: org, Node: Tags, Next: Properties and columns, Prev: TODO items, Up: Top + +6 Tags +****** + +An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating +information is to assign tags to headlines. Org mode has extensive +support for tags. + + Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of +the headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, `_', +and `@'. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g., +`:work:'. Several tags can be specified, as in `:work:urgent:'. Tags +will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline. +You may specify special faces for specific tags using the option +`org-tag-faces', in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords +(*note Faces for TODO keywords::). + +* Menu: + +* Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline +* Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline +* Tag hierarchy:: Create a hierarchy of tags +* Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags + + +File: org, Node: Tag inheritance, Next: Setting tags, Up: Tags + +6.1 Tag inheritance +=================== + +Tags make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a +heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as +well. For example, in the list + + * Meeting with the French group :work: + ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes: + *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action: + +the final heading will have the tags `:work:', `:boss:', `:notes:', and +`:action:' even though the final heading is not explicitly marked with +all those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in a file +should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical +level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this(1): + + #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret: + +To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, use +`org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance'. To turn it off entirely, use +`org-use-tag-inheritance'. + + When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance +is turned on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple +match form) match as well(2). The list of matches may then become very +long. If you only want to see the first tags match in a subtree, +configure `org-tags-match-list-sublevels' (not recommended). + + Tag inheritance is relevant when the agenda search tries to match a +tag, either in the `tags' or `tags-todo' agenda types. In other agenda +types, `org-use-tag-inheritance' has no effect. Still, you may want to +have your tags correctly set in the agenda, so that tag filtering works +fine, with inherited tags. Set `org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance' to +control this: the default value includes all agenda types, but setting +this to `nil' can really speed up agenda generation. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) As with all these in-buffer settings, pressing `C-c C-c' +activates any changes in the line. + + (2) This is only true if the search does not involve more complex +tests including properties (*note Property searches::). + + +File: org, Node: Setting tags, Next: Tag hierarchy, Prev: Tag inheritance, Up: Tags + +6.2 Setting tags +================ + +Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline. +After a colon, `M-<TAB>' offers completion on tags. There is also a +special command for inserting tags: + +`C-c C-q (`org-set-tags-command')' + Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either + offer completion or a special single-key interface for setting + tags, see below. After pressing <RET>, the tags will be inserted + and aligned to `org-tags-column'. When called with a `C-u' + prefix, all tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that + column, just to make things look nice. TAGS are automatically + realigned after promotion, demotion, and TODO state changes (*note + TODO basics::). + +`C-c C-c (`org-set-tags-command')' + When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as `C-c C-q'. + + Org supports tag insertion based on a _list of tags_. By default +this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags currently +used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list of tags +with the variable `org-tag-alist'. Finally you can set the default +tags for a given file with lines like + + #+TAGS: @work @home @tennisclub + #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat + + If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the +variable `org-tag-alist', but would like to use a dynamic tag list in a +specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file: + + #+TAGS: + + If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in +every file, in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS +option lines, then you may specify a list of tags with the variable +`org-tag-persistent-alist'. You may turn this off on a per-file basis +by adding a STARTUP option line to that file: + + #+STARTUP: noptag + + By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion +facilities for entering tags. However, it also implements another, +quicker, tag selection method called _fast tag selection_. This allows +you to select and deselect tags with just a single key press. For this +to work well you should assign unique, case-sensitive, letters to most +of your commonly used tags. You can do this globally by configuring +the variable `org-tag-alist' in your Emacs init file. For example, you +may find the need to tag many items in different files with `:@home:'. +In this case you can set something like: + + (setq org-tag-alist '(("@work" . ?w) ("@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l))) + +If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you +can instead set the TAGS option line as: + + #+TAGS: @work(w) @home(h) @tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p) + +The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash window. If +you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert `\n' into the +tag list + + #+TAGS: @work(w) @home(h) @tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p) + +or write them in two lines: + + #+TAGS: @work(w) @home(h) @tennisclub(t) + #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p) + +You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using +braces, as in: + + #+TAGS: { @work(w) @home(h) @tennisclub(t) } laptop(l) pc(p) + +you indicate that at most one of `@work', `@home', and `@tennisclub' +should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed. + +Don't forget to press `C-c C-c' with the cursor in one of these lines +to activate any changes. + +To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable `org-tag-alist', +you must use the dummy tags `:startgroup' and `:endgroup' instead of +the braces. Similarly, you can use `:newline' to indicate a line +break. The previous example would be set globally by the following +configuration: + + (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil) + ("@work" . ?w) ("@home" . ?h) + ("@tennisclub" . ?t) + (:endgroup . nil) + ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p))) + + If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing `C-c C-c' will +automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited +tags, the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags +with corresponding keys(1). + + Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list +of tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually +exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group. + + In this interface, you can also use the following special keys: + +`<TAB>' + Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the + predefined list. You will be able to complete on all tags present + in the buffer. You can also add several tags: just separate them + with a comma. + +`<SPC>' + Clear all tags for this line. + +`<RET>' + Accept the modified set. + +`C-g' + Abort without installing changes. + +`q' + If `q' is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like `C-g'. + +`!' + Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an + exception) assign several tags from such a group. + +`C-c' + Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below). If you are + using expert mode, the first `C-c' will display the selection + window. + +This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With +the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set `@home', +`laptop' and `pc' tags with just the following keys: `C-c C-c <SPC> h l +p <RET>'. Switching from `@home' to `@work' would be done with `C-c +C-c w <RET>' or alternatively with `C-c C-c C-c w'. Adding the +non-predefined tag `Sarah' could be done with `C-c C-c <TAB> S a r a h +<RET> <RET>'. + + If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to +modify your list of tags, set `org-fast-tag-selection-single-key'. +Then you no longer have to press <RET> to exit fast tag selection--it +will immediately exit after the first change. If you then occasionally +need more keys, press `C-c' to turn off auto-exit for the current tag +selection process (in effect: start selection with `C-c C-c C-c' +instead of `C-c C-c'). If you set the variable to the value `expert', +the special window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it +comes up only when you press an extra `C-c'. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which have no +configured keys. + + +File: org, Node: Tag hierarchy, Next: Tag searches, Prev: Setting tags, Up: Tags + +6.3 Tag hierarchy +================= + +Tags can be defined in hierarchies. A tag can be defined as a _group +tag_ for a set of other tags. The group tag can be seen as the "broader +term" for its set of tags. Defining multiple _group tags_ and nesting +them creates a tag hierarchy. + + One use-case is to create a taxonomy of terms (tags) that can be +used to classify nodes in a document or set of documents. + + When you search for a group tag, it will return matches for all +members in the group and its subgroups. In an agenda view, filtering +by a group tag will display or hide headlines tagged with at least one +of the members of the group or any of its subgroups. This makes tag +searches and filters even more flexible. + + You can set group tags by using brackets and inserting a colon +between the group tag and its related tags--beware that all whitespaces +are mandatory so that Org can parse this line correctly: + + #+TAGS: [ GTD : Control Persp ] + + In this example, `GTD' is the _group tag_ and it is related to two +other tags: `Control', `Persp'. Defining `Control' and `Persp' as +group tags creates an hierarchy of tags: + + #+TAGS: [ Control : Context Task ] + #+TAGS: [ Persp : Vision Goal AOF Project ] + + That can conceptually be seen as a hierarchy of tags: + + - GTD + - Persp + - Vision + - Goal + - AOF + - Project + - Control + - Context + - Task + + You can use the `:startgrouptag', `:grouptags' and `:endgrouptag' +keyword directly when setting `org-tag-alist' directly: + + (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgrouptag) + ("GTD") + (:grouptags) + ("Control") + ("Persp") + (:endgrouptag) + (:startgrouptag) + ("Control") + (:grouptags) + ("Context") + ("Task") + (:endgrouptag))) + + The tags in a group can be mutually exclusive if using the same +group syntax as is used for grouping mutually exclusive tags together; +using curly brackets. + + #+TAGS: { Context : @Home @Work @Call } + + When setting `org-tag-alist' you can use `:startgroup' & `:endgroup' +instead of `:startgrouptag' & `:endgrouptag' to make the tags mutually +exclusive. + + Furthermore, the members of a _group tag_ can also be regular +expressions, creating the possibility of a more dynamic and rule-based +tag structure. The regular expressions in the group must be specified +within { }. Here is an expanded example: + + #+TAGS: [ Vision : {V@.+} ] + #+TAGS: [ Goal : {G@.+} ] + #+TAGS: [ AOF : {AOF@.+} ] + #+TAGS: [ Project : {P@.+} ] + + Searching for the tag `Project' will now list all tags also including +regular expression matches for `P@.+', and similarly for tag searches on +`Vision', `Goal' and `AOF'. For example, this would work well for a +project tagged with a common project-identifier, e.g. `P@2014_OrgTags'. + + If you want to ignore group tags temporarily, toggle group tags +support with `org-toggle-tags-groups', bound to `C-c C-x q'. If you +want to disable tag groups completely, set `org-group-tags' to `nil'. + + +File: org, Node: Tag searches, Prev: Tag hierarchy, Up: Tags + +6.4 Tag searches +================ + +Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related +information into special lists. + +`C-c / m or C-c \ (`org-match-sparse-tree')' + Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a + tags/property/TODO search. With a `C-u' prefix argument, ignore + headlines that are not a TODO line. *Note Matching tags and + properties::. + +`C-c a m (`org-tags-view')' + Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files. *Note + Matching tags and properties::. + +`C-c a M (`org-tags-view')' + Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but + check only TODO items and force checking subitems (see the option + `org-tags-match-list-sublevels'). + + These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic +Boolean logic like `+boss+urgent-project1', to find entries with tags +`boss' and `urgent', but not `project1', or `Kathy|Sally' to find +entries tagged as `Kathy' or `Sally'. The full syntax of the search +string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry +levels and properties. For a complete description with many examples, +see *note Matching tags and properties::. + + +File: org, Node: Properties and columns, Next: Dates and times, Prev: Tags, Up: Top + +7 Properties and columns +************************ + +A property is a key-value pair associated with an entry. Properties +can be set so they are associated with a single entry, with every entry +in a tree, or with every entry in an Org mode file. + + There are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First, +properties are like tags, but with a value. Imagine maintaining a file +where you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. +Instead of using tags like `:release_1:', `:release_2:', you can use a +property, say `:Release:', that in different subtrees has different +values, such as `1.0' or `2.0'. Second, you can use properties to +implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. Imagine +keeping track of your music CDs, where properties could be things such +as the album, artist, date of release, number of tracks, and so on. + + Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view +(*note Column view::). + +* Menu: + +* Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out +* Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features +* Property searches:: Matching property values +* Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree +* Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing +* Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers + + +File: org, Node: Property syntax, Next: Special properties, Up: Properties and columns + +7.1 Property syntax +=================== + +Properties are key-value pairs. When they are associated with a single +entry or with a tree they need to be inserted into a special drawer +(*note Drawers::) with the name `PROPERTIES', which has to be located +right below a headline, and its planning line (*note Deadlines and +scheduling::) when applicable. Each property is specified on a single +line, with the key (surrounded by colons) first, and the value after +it. Keys are case-insensitive. Here is an example: + + * CD collection + ** Classic + *** Goldberg Variations + :PROPERTIES: + :Title: Goldberg Variations + :Composer: J.S. Bach + :Artist: Glen Gould + :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon + :NDisks: 1 + :END: + + Depending on the value of `org-use-property-inheritance', a property +set this way will either be associated with a single entry, or the +subtree defined by the entry, see *note Property inheritance::. + + You may define the allowed values for a particular property `:Xyz:' +by setting a property `:Xyz_ALL:'. This special property is +_inherited_, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to the +entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the +corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing +errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine +publishers and the number of disks in a box like this: + + * CD collection + :PROPERTIES: + :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4 + :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI + :END: + + If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a +file, use a line like + #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4 + + Contrary to properties set from a special drawer, you have to +refresh the buffer with `C-c C-c' to activate this change. + + If you want to add to the value of an existing property, append a +`+' to the property name. The following results in the property `var' +having the value "foo=1 bar=2". + #+PROPERTY: var foo=1 + #+PROPERTY: var+ bar=2 + + It is also possible to add to the values of inherited properties. +The following results in the `genres' property having the value "Classic +Baroque" under the `Goldberg Variations' subtree. + * CD collection + ** Classic + :PROPERTIES: + :GENRES: Classic + :END: + *** Goldberg Variations + :PROPERTIES: + :Title: Goldberg Variations + :Composer: J.S. Bach + :Artist: Glen Gould + :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon + :NDisks: 1 + :GENRES+: Baroque + :END: + Note that a property can only have one entry per Drawer. + + Property values set with the global variable `org-global-properties' +can be inherited by all entries in all Org files. + +The following commands help to work with properties: + +`M-<TAB> (`pcomplete')' + After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All + keys used in the current file will be offered as possible + completions. + +`C-c C-x p (`org-set-property')' + Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If + necessary, the property drawer is created as well. + +`C-u M-x org-insert-drawer RET' + Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will + be inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning + information like deadlines. + +`C-c C-c (`org-property-action')' + With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property + commands. + +`C-c C-c s (`org-set-property')' + Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the + value can be inserted using completion. + +`S-<right> (`org-property-next-allowed-value')' +`S-<left> (`org-property-previous-allowed-value')' + Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value. + +`C-c C-c d (`org-delete-property')' + Remove a property from the current entry. + +`C-c C-c D (`org-delete-property-globally')' + Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file. + +`C-c C-c c (`org-compute-property-at-point')' + Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from + the nearest column format definition. + + +File: org, Node: Special properties, Next: Property searches, Prev: Property syntax, Up: Properties and columns + +7.2 Special properties +====================== + +Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode +features, like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in +the previous chapters. This interface exists so that you can include +these states in a column view (*note Column view::), or to use them in +queries. The following property names are special and should not be +used as keys in the properties drawer: + + ALLTAGS All tags, including inherited ones. + BLOCKED "t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings. + CLOCKSUM The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. `org-clock-sum' + must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer. + CLOCKSUM_T The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree for today. + `org-clock-sum-today' must be run first to compute the + values in the current buffer. + CLOSED When was this entry closed? + DEADLINE The deadline time string, without the angular brackets. + FILE The filename the entry is located in. + ITEM The headline of the entry. + PRIORITY The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter. + SCHEDULED The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets. + TAGS The tags defined directly in the headline. + TIMESTAMP The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry. + TIMESTAMP_IA The first inactive timestamp in the entry. + TODO The TODO keyword of the entry. + + +File: org, Node: Property searches, Next: Property inheritance, Prev: Special properties, Up: Properties and columns + +7.3 Property searches +===================== + +To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on +properties, the same commands are used as for tag searches (*note Tag +searches::). + +`C-c / m or C-c \ (`org-match-sparse-tree')' + Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a `C-u' + prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line. + +`C-c a m (`org-tags-view')' + Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda + files. *Note Matching tags and properties::. + +`C-c a M (`org-tags-view')' + Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but + check only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see the + option `org-tags-match-list-sublevels'). + + The syntax for the search string is described in *note Matching tags +and properties::. + + There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a +single property: + +`C-c / p' + Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first + prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A + sparse tree is created with all entries that define this property + with the given value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, + it is interpreted as a regular expression and matched against the + property values. + + +File: org, Node: Property inheritance, Next: Column view, Prev: Property searches, Up: Properties and columns + +7.4 Property Inheritance +======================== + +The outline structure of Org mode documents lends itself to an +inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain +property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not +turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches +significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance +useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable +`org-use-property-inheritance'. It may be set to `t' to make all +properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties that +should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches inherited +properties. If a property has the value `nil', this is interpreted as +an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance search will +stop at this value and return `nil'. + + Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at +least for the special applications for which they are used: + +`COLUMNS' + The `:COLUMNS:' property defines the format of column view (*note + Column view::). It is inherited in the sense that the level where + a `:COLUMNS:' property is defined is used as the starting point + for a column view table, independently of the location in the + subtree from where columns view is turned on. + +`CATEGORY' + For agenda view, a category set through a `:CATEGORY:' property + applies to the entire subtree. + +`ARCHIVE' + For archiving, the `:ARCHIVE:' property may define the archive + location for the entire subtree (*note Moving subtrees::). + +`LOGGING' + The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a + subtree (*note Tracking TODO state changes::). + + +File: org, Node: Column view, Next: Property API, Prev: Property inheritance, Up: Properties and columns + +7.5 Column view +=============== + +A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is _column +view_. In column view, each outline node is turned into a table row. +Columns in this table provide access to properties of the entries. Org +mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure over the +headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned into a +table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline tree. +For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS view +(`S-<TAB> S-<TAB>', or simply `c' while column view is active), but you +can still open, read, and edit the entry below each headline. Or, you +can switch to column view after executing a sparse tree command and in +this way get a table only for the selected items. Column view also +works in agenda buffers (*note Agenda views::) where queries have +collected selected items, possibly from a number of files. + +* Menu: + +* Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property +* Using column view:: How to create and use column view +* Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view + + +File: org, Node: Defining columns, Next: Using column view, Up: Column view + +7.5.1 Defining columns +---------------------- + +Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is +done by defining a column format line. + +* Menu: + +* Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid? +* Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column + + +File: org, Node: Scope of column definitions, Next: Column attributes, Up: Defining columns + +7.5.1.1 Scope of column definitions +................................... + +To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like + + #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO + + To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a +`:COLUMNS:' property to the top node of that tree, for example: + + ** Top node for columns view + :PROPERTIES: + :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO + :END: + + If a `:COLUMNS:' property is present in an entry, it defines columns +for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the +column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document, +you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all +sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a +deeper part of the tree. + + +File: org, Node: Column attributes, Prev: Scope of column definitions, Up: Defining columns + +7.5.1.2 Column attributes +......................... + +A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general +definition looks like this: + + %[WIDTH]PROPERTY[(TITLE)][{SUMMARY-TYPE}] + +Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are +optional. The individual parts have the following meaning: + + WIDTH An integer specifying the width of the column in characters. + If omitted, the width will be determined automatically. + PROPERTY The property that should be edited in this column. + Special properties representing meta data are allowed here + as well (*note Special properties::) + TITLE The header text for the column. If omitted, the property + name is used. + {SUMMARY-TYPE} The summary type. If specified, the column values for + parent nodes are computed from the children(1). + Supported summary types are: + {+} Sum numbers in this column. + {+;%.1f} Like `+', but format result with `%.1f'. + {$} Currency, short for `+;%.2f'. + {min} Smallest number in column. + {max} Largest number. + {mean} Arithmetic mean of numbers. + {X} Checkbox status, `[X]' if all children are `[X]'. + {X/} Checkbox status, `[n/m]'. + {X%} Checkbox status, `[n%]'. + {:} Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are + hours(2). + {:min} Smallest time value in column. + {:max} Largest time value. + {:mean} Arithmetic mean of time values. + {@min} Minimum age(3) (in + days/hours/mins/seconds). + {@max} Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds). + {@mean} Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds). + {est+} Add `low-high' estimates. + + The `est+' summary type requires further explanation. It is used for +combining estimates, expressed as `low-high' ranges or plain numbers. +For example, instead of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, +you might estimate it as 5-6 days if you're fairly confident you know +how much work is required, or 1-10 days if you don't really know what +needs to be done. Both ranges average at 5.5 days, but the first +represents a more predictable delivery. + + When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and +highs produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, `est+' adds the +statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final +estimate from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of +which was estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition +produces an estimate of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if +everything goes either extremely well or extremely poorly. In +contrast, `est+' estimates the full job more realistically, at 10-15 +days. + + Numbers are right-aligned when a format specifier with an explicit +width like `%5d' or `%5.1f' is used. + + You can also define custom summary types by setting +`org-columns-summary-types', which see. + + Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with +allowed values. + + :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?){X} %Owner %11Status \(4) + %10Time_Estimate{:} %CLOCKSUM %CLOCKSUM_T + :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don + :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" "" + :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]" + +The first column, `%25ITEM', means the first 25 characters of the item +itself, i.e., of the headline. You probably always should start the +column definition with the `ITEM' specifier. The other specifiers +create columns `Owner' with a list of names as allowed values, for +`Status' with four different possible values, and for a checkbox field +`Approved'. When no width is given after the `%' character, the column +will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order to fully display all +values. The `Approved' column does have a modified title (`Approved?', +with a question mark). Summaries will be created for the +`Time_Estimate' column by adding time duration expressions like HH:MM, +and for the `Approved' column, by providing an `[X]' status if all +children have been checked. The `CLOCKSUM' and `CLOCKSUM_T' columns +are special, they lists the sums of CLOCK intervals in the subtree, +either for all clocks or just for today. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) If more than one summary type apply to the +property, the parent values are computed according to +the first of them. + + (2) A time can also be a duration, using effort +modifiers defined in `org-effort-durations', e.g., `3d +1h'. If any value in the column is as such, the +summary will also be an effort duration. + + (3) An age is defined as a duration since a given +time-stamp (*note Timestamps::). It can also be +expressed as days, hours, minutes and seconds, +identified by `d', `h', `m' and `s' suffixes, all +mandatory, e.g., `0d 13h 0m 10s'. + + (4) Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single +line--it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints. + + +File: org, Node: Using column view, Next: Capturing column view, Prev: Defining columns, Up: Column view + +7.5.2 Using column view +----------------------- + +Turning column view on and off +.............................. + +`C-c C-x C-c (`org-columns')' + Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline + in the file, or the function called with the universal prefix + argument, column view is turned on for the entire file, using the + `#+COLUMNS' definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the + outline, this command searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a + `:COLUMNS:' property that defines a format. When one is found, + the column view table is established for the tree starting at the + entry that contains the `:COLUMNS:' property. If no such property + is found, the format is taken from the `#+COLUMNS' line or from the + variable `org-columns-default-format', and column view is + established for the current entry and its subtree. + +`r (`org-columns-redo')' + Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the + buffer. + +`g (`org-columns-redo')' + Same as `r'. + +`q (`org-columns-quit')' + Exit column view. + +Editing values +.............. + +`<left> <right> <up> <down>' + Move through the column view from field to field. + +`S-<left>/<right>' + Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, + you have to have specified allowed values for a property. + +`1..9,0' + Directly select the Nth allowed value, `0' selects the 10th value. + +`n (`org-columns-next-allowed-value')' +`p (`org-columns-previous-allowed-value')' + Same as `S-<left>/<right>' + +`e (`org-columns-edit-value')' + Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will + invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that + property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag + completion or fast selection interface will pop up. + +`C-c C-c (`org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle')' + When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it. + +`v (`org-columns-show-value')' + View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width + of the column is smaller than that of the value. + +`a (`org-columns-edit-allowed')' + Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is + found in the hierarchy, the modified value is stored there. If no + list is found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is + part of the current column view. + +Modifying the table structure +............................. + +`< (`org-columns-narrow')' +`> (`org-columns-widen')' + Make the column narrower/wider by one character. + +`S-M-<right> (`org-columns-new')' + Insert a new column, to the left of the current column. + +`S-M-<left> (`org-columns-delete')' + Delete the current column. + + +File: org, Node: Capturing column view, Prev: Using column view, Up: Column view + +7.5.3 Capturing column view +--------------------------- + +Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be +exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use +a `columnview' dynamic block (*note Dynamic blocks::). The frame of +this block looks like this: + + * The column view + #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label" + + #+END: + +This dynamic block has the following parameters: + +`:id' + This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature + that is often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture + block might be at a different location in the file. To identify + the tree whose view to capture, you can use 4 values: + local use the tree in which the capture block is located + global make a global view, including all headings in the file + "file:PATH-TO-FILE" + run column view at the top of this file + "ID" call column view in the tree that has an `:ID:' + property with the value label. You can use + `M-x org-id-copy RET' to create a globally unique ID for + the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring. + +`:hlines' + When `t', insert an hline after every line. When a number N, + insert an hline before each headline with level `<= N'. + +`:vlines' + When set to `t', force column groups to get vertical lines. + +`:maxlevel' + When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level. + +`:skip-empty-rows' + When set to `t', skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of + the column view is `ITEM'. + +`:indent' + When non-`nil', indent each `ITEM' field according to its level. + + +The following commands insert or update the dynamic block: + +`C-c C-x i (`org-insert-columns-dblock')' + Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be + prompted for the scope or ID of the view. + +`C-c C-c or C-c C-x C-u (`org-dblock-update')' + Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the + `#+BEGIN' line of the dynamic block. + +`C-u C-c C-x C-u (`org-update-all-dblocks')' + Update all dynamic blocks (*note Dynamic blocks::). This is + useful if you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing + blocks or other dynamic blocks in a buffer. + + You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add +plotting instructions in front of the table--these will survive an +update of the block. If there is a `#+TBLFM:' after the table, the +table will actually be recalculated automatically after an update. + + An alternative way to capture and process property values into a +table is provided by Eric Schulte's `org-collector.el' which is a +contributed package(1). It provides a general API to collect +properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp +expressions to process these values before inserting them into a table +or a dynamic block. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are distributed +with the main distribution of Org (visit `http://orgmode.org'). + + +File: org, Node: Property API, Prev: Column view, Up: Properties and columns + +7.6 The Property API +==================== + +There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can +be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement +features based on them. For more information see *note Using the +property API::. + + +File: org, Node: Dates and times, Next: Capture - Refile - Archive, Prev: Properties and columns, Up: Top + +8 Dates and times +***************** + +To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or +a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time +information is called a _timestamp_ in Org mode. This may be a little +confusing because timestamp is often used to indicate when something +was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term is used in +a much wider sense. + +* Menu: + +* Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry +* Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps +* Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work +* Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task +* Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance +* Timers:: Notes with a running timer + + +File: org, Node: Timestamps, Next: Creating timestamps, Up: Dates and times + +8.1 Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling +========================================= + +A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a +range of times) in a special format, either `<2003-09-16 Tue>'(1) or +`<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>' or `<2003-09-16 Tue 12:00-12:30>'(2). A +timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree +entry. Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the +agenda (*note Weekly/daily agenda::). We distinguish: + +PLAIN TIMESTAMP; EVENT; APPOINTMENT + A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is + just like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. + In the agenda display, the headline of an entry associated with a + plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date. + + * Meet Peter at the movies + <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15> + * Discussion on climate change + <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00> + +TIMESTAMP WITH REPEATER INTERVAL + A timestamp may contain a _repeater interval_, indicating that it + applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a + certain interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years + (y). The following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday: + + * Pick up Sam at school + <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w> + +DIARY-STYLE SEXP ENTRIES + For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the + special sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary + package(3). For example with optional time + + * 22:00-23:00 The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month + <%%(diary-float t 4 2)> + +TIME/DATE RANGE + Two timestamps connected by `--' denote a range. The headline + will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any + dates that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an + example: + + ** Meeting in Amsterdam + <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu> + +INACTIVE TIMESTAMP + Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of + angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that + they do _not_ trigger an entry to show up in the agenda. + + * Gillian comes late for the fifth time + [2006-11-01 Wed] + + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) In this simplest form, the day name is optional when you type +the date yourself. However, any dates inserted or modified by Org will +add that day name, for reading convenience. + + (2) This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601 date/time format. To +use an alternative format, see *note Custom time format::. + + (3) When working with the standard diary sexp functions, you need to +be very careful with the order of the arguments. That order depends +evilly on the variable `calendar-date-style' (or, for older Emacs +versions, `european-calendar-style'). For example, to specify a date +December 1, 2005, the call might look like `(diary-date 12 1 2005)' or +`(diary-date 1 12 2005)' or `(diary-date 2005 12 1)', depending on the +settings. This has been the source of much confusion. Org mode users +can resort to special versions of these functions like `org-date' or +`org-anniversary'. These work just like the corresponding `diary-' +functions, but with stable ISO order of arguments (year, month, day) +wherever applicable, independent of the value of `calendar-date-style'. + + +File: org, Node: Creating timestamps, Next: Deadlines and scheduling, Prev: Timestamps, Up: Dates and times + +8.2 Creating timestamps +======================= + +For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific +format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct +format. + +`C-c . (`org-time-stamp')' + Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the + cursor is at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is + used to modify this timestamp instead of inserting a new one. + When this command is used twice in succession, a time range is + inserted. + +`C-c ! (`org-time-stamp-inactive')' + Like `C-c .', but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause + an agenda entry. + +`C-u C-c .' +`C-u C-c !' + Like `C-c .' and `C-c !', but use the alternative format which + contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to + multiples of 5 minutes, see the option + `org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes'. + +`C-c C-c' + Normalize timestamp, insert/fix day name if missing or wrong. + +`C-c < (`org-date-from-calendar')' + Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the + Calendar. + +`C-c > (`org-goto-calendar')' + Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a + timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date + instead. + +`C-c C-o (`org-open-at-point')' + Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at + point (*note Weekly/daily agenda::). + +`S-<left> (`org-timestamp-down-day')' +`S-<right> (`org-timestamp-up-day')' + Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with + shift-selection and related modes (*note Conflicts::). + +`S-<up> (`org-timestamp-up')' +`S-<down> (`org-timestamp-down-down')' + Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can + be on a year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp + contains a time range like `15:30-16:30', modifying the first time + will also shift the second, shifting the time block with constant + length. To change the length, modify the second time. Note that + if the cursor is in a headline and not at a timestamp, these same + keys modify the priority of an item. (*note Priorities::). The + key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and related modes + (*note Conflicts::). + +`C-c C-y (`org-evaluate-time-range')' + Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start + and end. With a prefix argument, insert result after the time + range (in a table: into the following column). + +* Menu: + +* The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time +* Custom time format:: Making dates look different + + +File: org, Node: The date/time prompt, Next: Custom time format, Up: Creating timestamps + +8.2.1 The date/time prompt +-------------------------- + +When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default +date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific +format. But it will in fact accept date/time information in a variety +of formats. Generally, the information should start at the beginning +of the string. Org mode will find whatever information is in there and +derive anything you have not specified from the _default date and +time_. The default is usually the current date and time, but when +modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a +range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in +information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you will want to +enter a date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given +day/month is before today, it will assume that you mean a future +date(1). If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, +the time prompt will show this with `(=>F).' + + For example, let's assume that today is June 13, 2006. Here is how +various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are +in bold. + + 3-2-5 => 2003-02-05 + 2/5/3 => 2003-02-05 + 14 => 2006-06-14 + 12 => 2006-07-12 + 2/5 => 2007-02-05 + Fri => nearest Friday after the default date + sep 15 => 2006-09-15 + feb 15 => 2007-02-15 + sep 12 9 => 2009-09-12 + 12:45 => 2006-06-13 12:45 + 22 sept 0:34 => 2006-09-22 00:34 + w4 => ISO week four of the current year 2006 + 2012 w4 fri => Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012 + 2012-w04-5 => Same as above + + Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the _first_ +thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a letter ([hdwmy]) +to indicate change in hours, days, weeks, months, or years. With a +single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a +double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead +of a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will +be the Nth such day, e.g.: + + +0 => today + . => today + +4d => four days from today + +4 => same as above + +2w => two weeks from today + ++5 => five days from default date + +2tue => second Tuesday from now + -wed => last Wednesday + + The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If +you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure +the variables `parse-time-months' and `parse-time-weekdays'. + + Not all dates can be represented in a given Emacs implementation. +By default Org mode forces dates into the compatibility range 1970-2037 +which works on all Emacs implementations. If you want to use dates +outside of this range, read the docstring of the variable +`org-read-date-force-compatible-dates'. + + You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by +giving a start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use one or two +dash(es) as the separator in the former case and use '+' as the +separator in the latter case, e.g.: + + 11am-1:15pm => 11:00-13:15 + 11am--1:15pm => same as above + 11am+2:15 => same as above + + Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up(2). When +you exit the date prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, +or by pressing <RET>, the date selected in the calendar will be +combined with the information entered at the prompt. You can control +the calendar fully from the minibuffer: + + <RET> Choose date at cursor in calendar. + mouse-1 Select date by clicking on it. + S-<right>/<left> One day forward/backward. + S-<down>/<up> One week forward/backward. + M-S-<right>/<left> One month forward/backward. + > / < Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month. + M-v / C-v Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months. + M-S-<down>/<up> Scroll calendar forward/backward by one year. + + The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure +you they will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty +much any other way of entering a date/time out there. To help you +understand what is going on, the current interpretation of your input +will be displayed live in the minibuffer(3). + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) See the variable `org-read-date-prefer-future'. You may set +that variable to the symbol `time' to even make a time before now shift +the date to tomorrow. + + (2) If you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable +`org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt'. + + (3) If you find this distracting, turn the display off with +`org-read-date-display-live'. + + +File: org, Node: Custom time format, Prev: The date/time prompt, Up: Creating timestamps + +8.2.2 Custom time format +------------------------ + +Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is +defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another +representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by +customizing the options `org-display-custom-times' and +`org-time-stamp-custom-formats'. + +`C-c C-x C-t (`org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays')' + Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times. + +Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time +format does not _replace_ the default format--instead it is put _over_ +the default format using text properties. This has the following +consequences: + * You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before + or after. + + * The `S-<up>/<down>' keys can no longer be used to adjust each + component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of + the stamp, `S-<up>/<down>' will change the stamp by one day, just + like `S-<left>/<right>'. At the end of the stamp, the time will + be changed by one minute. + + * If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, + these will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were. + + * When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only + disappear from the buffer after _all_ (invisible) characters + belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed. + + * If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you + are using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If + the custom format is shorter, things do work as expected. + + +File: org, Node: Deadlines and scheduling, Next: Clocking work time, Prev: Creating timestamps, Up: Dates and times + +8.3 Deadlines and scheduling +============================ + +A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning. +Both the timestamp and the keyword have to be positioned immediately +after the task they refer to. + +DEADLINE + Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not + necessarily) is supposed to be finished on that date. + + On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In + addition, the agenda for _today_ will carry a warning about the + approaching or missed deadline, starting + `org-deadline-warning-days' before the due date, and continuing + until the entry is marked DONE. An example: + + *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide + DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun> + The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]] + + You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific + deadline using the following syntax. Here is an example with a + warning period of 5 days `DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>'. This + warning is deactivated if the task gets scheduled and you set + `org-agenda-skip-deadline-prewarning-if-scheduled' to `t'. + +SCHEDULED + Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the + given date. + + The headline will be listed under the given date(1). In addition, + a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present in + the compilation for _today_, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e., + the task will automatically be forwarded until completed. + + *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve. + SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat> + + If you want to _delay_ the display of this task in the agenda, use + `SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat -2d>': the task is still scheduled on + the 25th but will appear two days later. In case the task + contains a repeater, the delay is considered to affect all + occurrences; if you want the delay to only affect the first + scheduled occurrence of the task, use `--2d' instead. See + `org-scheduled-delay-days' and + `org-agenda-skip-scheduled-delay-if-deadline' for details on how to + control this globally or per agenda. + + Important: Scheduling an item in Org mode should not be understood + in the same way that we understand scheduling a meeting. Setting + a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should mark + this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown + on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding + by Org users. In Org mode, scheduling means setting a date when + you want to start working on an action item. + + You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline +entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the +assumption that the timestamp represents the nearest instance of the +repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like `<%%(diary-float +t 42)>' in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode +does not know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue +early and late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day +where the sexp entry matches. + +* Menu: + +* Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items +* Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) It will still be listed on that date after it has been marked +DONE. If you don't like this, set the variable +`org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done'. + + +File: org, Node: Inserting deadline/schedule, Next: Repeated tasks, Up: Deadlines and scheduling + +8.3.1 Inserting deadlines or schedules +-------------------------------------- + +The following commands allow you to quickly insert a deadline or to +schedule an item: + +`C-c C-d (`org-deadline')' + Insert `DEADLINE' keyword along with a stamp. Any CLOSED + timestamp will be removed. When called with a prefix arg, an + existing deadline will be removed from the entry. Depending on + the variable `org-log-redeadline'(1), a note will be taken when + changing an existing deadline. + +`C-c C-s (`org-schedule')' + Insert `SCHEDULED' keyword along with a stamp. Any CLOSED + timestamp will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, + remove the scheduling date from the entry. Depending on the + variable `org-log-reschedule'(2), a note will be taken when + changing an existing scheduling time. + +`C-c / d (`org-check-deadlines')' + Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, + or which will become due within `org-deadline-warning-days'. With + `C-u' prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric + prefix, check that many days. For example, `C-1 C-c / d' shows + all deadlines due tomorrow. + +`C-c / b (`org-check-before-date')' + Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date. + +`C-c / a (`org-check-after-date')' + Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date. + + Note that `org-schedule' and `org-deadline' supports setting the +date by indicating a relative time: e.g., +1d will set the date to the +next day after today, and -1w will set the date to the previous week +before any current timestamp. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) with corresponding `#+STARTUP' keywords `logredeadline', +`lognoteredeadline', and `nologredeadline' + + (2) with corresponding `#+STARTUP' keywords `logreschedule', +`lognotereschedule', and `nologreschedule' + + +File: org, Node: Repeated tasks, Prev: Inserting deadline/schedule, Up: Deadlines and scheduling + +8.3.2 Repeated tasks +-------------------- + +Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to +organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED, +or plain timestamp. In the following example + ** TODO Pay the rent + DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m> + the `+1m' is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task +has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month +starting from that time. You can use yearly, monthly, weekly, daily +and hourly repeat cookies by using the `y/w/m/d/h' letters. If you +need both a repeater and a special warning period in a deadline entry, +the repeater should come first and the warning period last: `DEADLINE: +<2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>'. + + Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when +they are over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry +as completed once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a +SCHEDULE with the TODO keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries +in the agenda. The problem with this is, however, that then also the +_next_ instance of the repeated entry will not be active. Org mode +deals with this in the following way: When you try to mark such an +entry DONE (using `C-c C-t'), it will shift the base date of the +repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and immediately set the +entry state back to TODO(1). In the example above, setting the state +to DONE would actually switch the date like this: + + ** TODO Pay the rent + DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m> + + To mark a task with a repeater as `DONE', use `C-- 1 C-c C-t' (i.e., +`org-todo' with a numeric prefix argument of -1.) + + A timestamp(2) will be added under the deadline, to keep a record +that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline. + + As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no +longer be visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all +future instances will be visible. + + With the `+1m' cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one +month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this +entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the +task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you +forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call +him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks +like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time after +the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has special +repeaters `++' and `.+'. For example: + + ** TODO Call Father + DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w> + Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week, + but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into + the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called + and marked it done on Saturday. + ** TODO Empty kitchen trash + DEADLINE: <2008-02-08 Fri 20:00 ++1d> + Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one day, and + also by as many days as it takes to get the timestamp into the + future. Since there is a time in the timestamp, the next + deadline in the future will be on today's date if you + complete the task before 20:00. + ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors + DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m> + Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after + today. + + You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific +task. If the repeater is set for the scheduling information only, you +probably want the repeater to be ignored after the deadline. If so, +set the variable `org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-deadline-is-shown' to +`repeated-after-deadline'. However, any scheduling information without +a repeater is no longer relevant once the task is done, and thus, +removed upon repeating the task. If you want both scheduling and +deadline information to repeat after the same interval, set the same +repeater for both timestamps. + + An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies +of a task subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command `C-c +C-x c' was created for this purpose, it is described in *note Structure +editing::. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) In fact, the target state is taken from, in this sequence, the +`REPEAT_TO_STATE' property or the variable `org-todo-repeat-to-state'. +If neither of these is specified, the target state defaults to the +first state of the TODO state sequence. + + (2) You can change this using the option `org-log-repeat', or the +`#+STARTUP' options `logrepeat', `lognoterepeat', and `nologrepeat'. +With `lognoterepeat', you will also be prompted for a note. + + +File: org, Node: Clocking work time, Next: Effort estimates, Prev: Deadlines and scheduling, Up: Dates and times + +8.4 Clocking work time +====================== + +Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a +project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock. +When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the +clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It +also computes the total time spent on each subtree(1) of a project. +And it remembers a history or tasks recently clocked, so that you can +jump quickly between a number of tasks absorbing your time. + + To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use + (setq org-clock-persist 'history) + (org-clock-persistence-insinuate) + When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete +clock(2) will be found (*note Resolving idle time::) and you will be +prompted about what to do with it. + +* Menu: + +* Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock +* The clock table:: Detailed reports +* Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Clocking only works if all headings are indented with less than +30 stars. This is a hardcoded limitation of `lmax' in `org-clock-sum'. + + (2) To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked on +this task while outside Emacs, use `(setq org-clock-persist t)'. + + +File: org, Node: Clocking commands, Next: The clock table, Up: Clocking work time + +8.4.1 Clocking commands +----------------------- + +`C-c C-x C-i (`org-clock-in')' + Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the + CLOCK keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first + clocking of this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped + into a `:LOGBOOK:' drawer (see also the variable + `org-clock-into-drawer'). You can also overrule the setting of + this variable for a subtree by setting a `CLOCK_INTO_DRAWER' or + `LOG_INTO_DRAWER' property. When called with a `C-u' prefix + argument, select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. + With two `C-u C-u' prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark + it as the default task; the default task will then always be + available with letter `d' when selecting a clocking task. With + three `C-u C-u C-u' prefixes, force continuous clocking by + starting the clock when the last clock stopped. + While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in + the mode line, along with the title of the task. The clock time + shown will be all time ever clocked for this task and its + children. If the task has an effort estimate (*note Effort + estimates::), the mode line displays the current clocking time + against it(1) If the task is a repeating one (*note Repeated + tasks::), only the time since the last reset of the task (2) will + be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised + with the `CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL' property. It may have the values + `current' to show only the current clocking instance, `today' to + show all time clocked on this task today (see also the variable + `org-extend-today-until'), `all' to include all time, or `auto' + which is the default(3). + Clicking with `mouse-1' onto the mode line entry will pop up a + menu with clocking options. + +`C-c C-x C-o (`org-clock-out')' + Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the + same location where the clock was last started. It also directly + computes the resulting time and inserts it after the time range as + `=> HH:MM'. See the variable `org-log-note-clock-out' for the + possibility to record an additional note together with the + clock-out timestamp(4). + +`C-c C-x C-x (`org-clock-in-last')' + Reclock the last clocked task. With one `C-u' prefix argument, + select the task from the clock history. With two `C-u' prefixes, + force continuous clocking by starting the clock when the last clock + stopped. + +`C-c C-x C-e (`org-clock-modify-effort-estimate')' + Update the effort estimate for the current clock task. + +`C-c C-c or C-c C-y (`org-evaluate-time-range')' + Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. + This is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If + you change them with `S-<cursor>' keys, the update is automatic. + +`C-S-<up/down> (`org-clock-timestamps-up/down')' + On `CLOCK' log lines, increase/decrease both timestamps so that the + clock duration keeps the same. + +`S-M-<up/down> (`org-timestamp-up/down')' + On `CLOCK' log lines, increase/decrease the timestamp at point and + the one of the previous (or the next clock) timestamp by the same + duration. For example, if you hit `S-M-<up>' to increase a + clocked-out timestamp by five minutes, then the clocked-in + timestamp of the next clock will be increased by five minutes. + +`C-c C-t (`org-todo')' + Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the + clock if it is running in this same item. + +`C-c C-x C-q (`org-clock-cancel')' + Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by + mistake, or if you ended up working on something else. + +`C-c C-x C-j (`org-clock-goto')' + Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a + `C-u' prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently + clocked tasks. + +`C-c C-x C-d (`org-clock-display')' + Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. + This puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total + time recorded under that heading, including the time of any + subheadings. You can use visibility cycling to study the tree, + but the overlays disappear when you change the buffer (see + variable `org-remove-highlights-with-change') or press `C-c C-c'. + + The `l' key may be used the agenda (*note Weekly/daily agenda::) to +show which tasks have been worked on or closed during a day. + + *Important:* note that both `org-clock-out' and `org-clock-in-last' +can have a global key binding and will not modify the window +disposition. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) To add an effort estimate "on the fly", hook a function doing +this to `org-clock-in-prepare-hook'. + + (2) as recorded by the `LAST_REPEAT' property + + (3) See also the variable `org-clock-modeline-total'. + + (4) The corresponding in-buffer setting is: `#+STARTUP: +lognoteclock-out' + + +File: org, Node: The clock table, Next: Resolving idle time, Prev: Clocking commands, Up: Clocking work time + +8.4.2 The clock table +--------------------- + +Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking +information. Such a report is called a _clock table_, because it is +formatted as one or several Org tables. + +`C-c C-x C-r (`org-clock-report')' + Insert a dynamic block (*note Dynamic blocks::) containing a clock + report as an Org mode table into the current file. When the + cursor is at an existing clock table, just update it. When called + with a prefix argument, jump to the first clock report in the + current document and update it. The clock table always includes + also trees with `:ARCHIVE:' tag. + +`C-c C-c or C-c C-x C-u (`org-dblock-update')' + Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the + `#+BEGIN' line of the dynamic block. + +`C-u C-c C-x C-u' + Update all dynamic blocks (*note Dynamic blocks::). This is + useful if you have several clock table blocks in a buffer. + +`S-<left>' +`S-<right> (`org-clocktable-try-shift')' + Shift the current `:block' interval and update the table. The + cursor needs to be in the `#+BEGIN: clocktable' line for this + command. If `:block' is `today', it will be shifted to `today-1' + etc. + + Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted +into the buffer with the `C-c C-x C-r' command: + + #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file + #+END: clocktable + The `BEGIN' line specifies a number of options to define the scope, +structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these +options can be configured in the variable `org-clocktable-defaults'. + +First there are options that determine which clock entries are to be +selected: + :maxlevel Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table. + Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level. + :scope The scope to consider. This can be any of the following: + nil the current buffer or narrowed region + file the full current buffer + subtree the subtree where the clocktable is located + treeN the surrounding level N tree, for example `tree3' + tree the surrounding level 1 tree + agenda all agenda files + ("file"..) scan these files + function the list of files returned by a function of no argument + file-with-archives current file and its archives + agenda-with-archives all agenda files, including archives + :block The time block to consider. This block is specified either + absolutely, or relative to the current time and may be any of + these formats: + 2007-12-31 New year eve 2007 + 2007-12 December 2007 + 2007-W50 ISO-week 50 in 2007 + 2007-Q2 2nd quarter in 2007 + 2007 the year 2007 + today, yesterday, today-N a relative day + thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-N a relative week + thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-N a relative month + thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-N a relative year + untilnow + Use `S-<left>/<right>' keys to shift the time interval. + :tstart A time string specifying when to start considering times. + Relative times like `"<-2w>"' can also be used. See + *note Matching tags and properties:: for relative time syntax. + :tend A time string specifying when to stop considering times. + Relative times like `"<now>"' can also be used. See + *note Matching tags and properties:: for relative time syntax. + :wstart The starting day of the week. The default is 1 for monday. + :mstart The starting day of the month. The default 1 is for the first + day of the month. + :step `week' or `day', to split the table into chunks. + To use this, `:block' or `:tstart', `:tend' are needed. + :stepskip0 Do not show steps that have zero time. + :fileskip0 Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute. + :tags A tags match to select entries that should contribute. See + *note Matching tags and properties:: for the match syntax. + + Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. +These options are interpreted by the function +`org-clocktable-write-default', but you can specify your own function +using the `:formatter' parameter. + :emphasize When `t', emphasize level one and level two items. + :lang Language(1) to use for descriptive cells like "Task". + :link Link the item headlines in the table to their origins. + :narrow An integer to limit the width of the headline column in + the org table. If you write it like `50!', then the + headline will also be shortened in export. + :indent Indent each headline field according to its level. + :tcolumns Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller + than `:maxlevel', lower levels will be lumped into one column. + :level Should a level number column be included? + :sort A cons cell like containing the column to sort and a sorting type. + E.g., `:sort (1 . ?a)' sorts the first column alphabetically. + :compact Abbreviation for `:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1' + All are overwritten except if there is an explicit `:narrow' + :timestamp A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED, + DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order. + :properties List of properties that should be shown in the table. Each + property will get its own column. + :inherit-props When this flag is `t', the values for `:properties' will be inherited. + :formula Content of a `#+TBLFM' line to be added and evaluated. + As a special case, `:formula %' adds a column with % time. + If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula + below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated. + :formatter A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer. + To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current +day, you could write + #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t + #+END: clocktable + and to use a specific time range you could write(2) + #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>" + :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>" + #+END: clocktable + A range starting a week ago and ending right now could be written as + #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<-1w>" :tend "<now>" + #+END: clocktable + A summary of the current subtree with % times would be + #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula % + #+END: clocktable + A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during +last week would be + #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t + #+END: clocktable + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Language terms can be set through the variable +`org-clock-clocktable-language-setup'. + + (2) Note that all parameters must be specified in a single line--the +line is broken here only to fit it into the manual. + + +File: org, Node: Resolving idle time, Prev: The clock table, Up: Clocking work time + +8.4.3 Resolving idle time and continuous clocking +------------------------------------------------- + +Resolving idle time +................... + +If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your +computer--perhaps to take a phone call--you often need to "resolve" the +time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or +applying it to another one. + + By customizing the variable `org-clock-idle-time' to some integer, +such as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your +computer after being idle for that many minutes(1), and ask what you +want to do with the idle time. There will be a question waiting for +you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has passed +(constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a set of +choices to correct the discrepancy: + +`k' + To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press `k'. + Org will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press <RET> to keep + them all, effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep + that many minutes. + +`K' + If you use the shift key and press `K', it will keep however many + minutes you request and then immediately clock out of that task. + If you keep all of the minutes, this is the same as just clocking + out of the current task. + +`s' + To keep none of the minutes, use `s' to subtract all the away time + from the clock, and then check back in from the moment you + returned. + +`S' + To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the + away time, use the shift key and press `S'. Remember that using + shift will always leave you clocked out, no matter which option + you choose. + +`C' + To cancel the clock altogether, use `C'. Note that if instead of + canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock + amount is less than a minute, the clock will still be canceled + rather than clutter up the log with an empty entry. + + What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, +and now want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task +immediately after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have +subtracted time "on the books", so to speak, and will ask if you want +to apply those minutes to the next task you clock in on. + + There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. +Say you were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased +a mouse who scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! +You suddenly lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still +have your recent Org mode changes, including your last clock in. + + If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that +you have a dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last +session. Using that clock's starting time as the beginning of the +unaccounted-for period, Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. +The logic and behavior is identical to dealing with away time due to +idleness; it is just happening due to a recovery event rather than a +set amount of idle time. + + You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for +dangling clocks at any time using `M-x org-resolve-clocks RET' (or `C-c +C-x C-z'). + +Continuous clocking +................... + +You may want to start clocking from the time when you clocked out the +previous task. To enable this systematically, set +`org-clock-continuously' to `t'. Each time you clock in, Org retrieves +the clock-out time of the last clocked entry for this session, and +start the new clock from there. + + If you only want this from time to time, use three universal prefix +arguments with `org-clock-in' and two `C-u C-u' with +`org-clock-in-last'. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) On computers using Mac OS X, idleness is based on actual user +idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For X11, you can install a +utility program `x11idle.c', available in the `contrib/scripts' +directory of the Org git distribution, or install the `xprintidle' +package and set it to the variable `org-clock-x11idle-program-name' if +you are running Debian, to get the same general treatment of idleness. +On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time only. + + +File: org, Node: Effort estimates, Next: Timers, Prev: Clocking work time, Up: Dates and times + +8.5 Effort estimates +==================== + +If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to +produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may +want to assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking +your work, you may later want to compare the planned effort with the +actual working time, a great way to improve planning estimates. Effort +estimates are stored in a special property `EFFORT'. You can set the +effort for an entry with the following commands: + +`C-c C-x e (`org-set-effort')' + Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric + prefix argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). + This command is also accessible from the agenda with the `e' key. + +`C-c C-x C-e (`org-clock-modify-effort-estimate')' + Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked. + + Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column +view (*note Column view::). You should start by setting up discrete +values for effort estimates, and a `COLUMNS' format that displays these +values together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For +a specific buffer you can use + + #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00 + #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort){:} %CLOCKSUM + +or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the +variables `org-global-properties' and `org-columns-default-format'. In +particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global +setup may be advised. + + The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to +column mode, and to use `S-<right>' and `S-<left>' to change the value. +The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy. +In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed. + + If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort +column will summarize the estimated work effort for each day(1), and +you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get an overview of +the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the option +`org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum'. The appointments +on a day that take place over a specified time interval will then also +be added to the load estimate of the day. + + Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is +triggered with the `/' key in the agenda (*note Agenda commands::). If +you have these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses +will narrow down the list to stuff that fits into an available time +slot. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Please note the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat +list (*note Agenda column view::). + + +File: org, Node: Timers, Prev: Effort estimates, Up: Dates and times + +8.6 Taking notes with a timer +============================= + +Org provides two types of timers. There is a relative timer that +counts up, which can be useful when taking notes during, for example, a +meeting or a video viewing. There is also a countdown timer. + + The relative and countdown are started with separate commands. + +`C-c C-x 0 (`org-timer-start')' + Start or reset the relative timer. By default, the timer is set + to 0. When called with a `C-u' prefix, prompt the user for a + starting offset. If there is a timer string at point, this is + taken as the default, providing a convenient way to restart taking + notes after a break in the process. When called with a double + prefix argument `C-u C-u', change all timer strings in the active + region by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings + if the timer was not started at exactly the right moment. + +`C-c C-x ; (`org-timer-set-timer')' + Start a countdown timer. The user is prompted for a duration. + `org-timer-default-timer' sets the default countdown value. Giving + a numeric prefix argument overrides this default value. This + command is available as `;' in agenda buffers. + + Once started, relative and countdown timers are controlled with the +same commands. + +`C-c C-x . (`org-timer')' + Insert the value of the current relative or countdown timer into + the buffer. If no timer is running, the relative timer will be + started. When called with a prefix argument, the relative timer + is restarted. + +`C-c C-x - (`org-timer-item')' + Insert a description list item with the value of the current + relative or countdown timer. With a prefix argument, first reset + the relative timer to 0. + +`M-<RET> (`org-insert-heading')' + Once the timer list is started, you can also use `M-<RET>' to + insert new timer items. + +`C-c C-x , (`org-timer-pause-or-continue')' + Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused. + +`C-c C-x _ (`org-timer-stop')' + Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not + continue the old one. This command also removes the timer from + the mode line. + + +File: org, Node: Capture - Refile - Archive, Next: Agenda views, Prev: Dates and times, Up: Top + +9 Capture - Refile - Archive +**************************** + +An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly +capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with +them. Org does this using a process called capture. It also can store +files related to a task (attachments) in a special directory. Once in +the system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving +completed project trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and +fast. + +* Menu: + +* Capture:: Capturing new stuff +* Attachments:: Add files to tasks +* RSS feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds +* Protocols:: External (e.g., Browser) access to Emacs and Org +* Refile and copy:: Moving/copying a tree from one place to another +* Archiving:: What to do with finished projects + + +File: org, Node: Capture, Next: Attachments, Up: Capture - Refile - Archive + +9.1 Capture +=========== + +Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your +work flow. Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by +John Wiegley excellent `remember.el' package. Up to version 6.36, Org +used a special setup for `remember.el', then replaced it with +`org-remember.el'. As of version 8.0, `org-remember.el' has been +completely replaced by `org-capture.el'. + + If your configuration depends on `org-remember.el', you need to +update it and use the setup described below. To convert your +`org-remember-templates', run the command + M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates RET + and then customize the new variable with `M-x customize-variable +org-capture-templates', check the result, and save the customization. + +* Menu: + +* Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored +* Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture +* Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types + + +File: org, Node: Setting up capture, Next: Using capture, Up: Capture + +9.1.1 Setting up capture +------------------------ + +The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and +defines a global key(1) for capturing new material. + + (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org")) + (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture) + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Please select your own key, `C-c c' is only a suggestion. + + +File: org, Node: Using capture, Next: Capture templates, Prev: Setting up capture, Up: Capture + +9.1.2 Using capture +------------------- + +`C-c c (`org-capture')' + Call the command `org-capture'. Note that this key binding is + global and not active by default: you need to install it. If you + have templates defined *note Capture templates::, it will offer + these templates for selection or use a new Org outline node as the + default template. It will insert the template into the target + file and switch to an indirect buffer narrowed to this new node. + You may then insert the information you want. + +`C-c C-c (`org-capture-finalize')' + Once you have finished entering information into the capture + buffer, `C-c C-c' will return you to the window configuration + before the capture process, so that you can resume your work + without further distraction. When called with a prefix arg, + finalize and then jump to the captured item. + +`C-c C-w (`org-capture-refile')' + Finalize the capture process by refiling (*note Refile and copy::) + the note to a different place. Please realize that this is a + normal refiling command that will be executed--so the cursor + position at the moment you run this command is important. If you + have inserted a tree with a parent and children, first move the + cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument given to this + command will be passed on to the `org-refile' command. + +`C-c C-k (`org-capture-kill')' + Abort the capture process and return to the previous state. + + + You can also call `org-capture' in a special way from the agenda, +using the `k c' key combination. With this access, any timestamps +inserted by the selected capture template will default to the cursor +date in the agenda, rather than to the current date. + + To find the locations of the last stored capture, use `org-capture' +with prefix commands: + +`C-u C-c c' + Visit the target location of a capture template. You get to + select the template in the usual way. + +`C-u C-u C-c c' + Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer. + + You can also jump to the bookmark `org-capture-last-stored', which +will automatically be created unless you set `org-capture-bookmark' to +`nil'. + + To insert the capture at point in an Org buffer, call `org-capture' +with a `C-0' prefix argument. + + +File: org, Node: Capture templates, Prev: Using capture, Up: Capture + +9.1.3 Capture templates +----------------------- + +You can use templates for different types of capture items, and for +different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is +through the customize interface. + +`C-c c C' + Customize the variable `org-capture-templates'. + + Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's +look at an example. Say you would like to use one template to create +general TODO entries, and you want to put these entries under the +heading `Tasks' in your file `~/org/gtd.org'. Also, a date tree in the +file `journal.org' should capture journal entries. A possible +configuration would look like: + + (setq org-capture-templates + '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks") + "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a") + ("j" "Journal" entry (file+olp+datetree "~/org/journal.org") + "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a"))) + +If you then press `C-c c t', Org will prepare the template for you like +this: + * TODO + [[file:LINK TO WHERE YOU INITIATED CAPTURE]] + +During expansion of the template, `%a' has been replaced by a link to +the location from where you called the capture command. This can be +extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill +in the task definition, press `C-c C-c' and Org returns you to the same +place where you started the capture process. + + To define special keys to capture to a particular template without +going through the interactive template selection, you can create your +key binding like this: + + (define-key global-map "\C-cx" + (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture nil "x"))) + +* Menu: + +* Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry +* Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context +* Templates in contexts:: Only show a template in a specific context + + +File: org, Node: Template elements, Next: Template expansion, Up: Capture templates + +9.1.3.1 Template elements +......................... + +Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in +`org-capture-templates' is a list with the following items: + +KEYS + The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters + only, for example `"a"' for a template to be selected with a + single key, or `"bt"' for selection with two keys. When using + several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential in + the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the prefix + key, for example + ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy") + If you do not define a template for the `C' key, this key will be + used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable. + +DESCRIPTION + A short string describing the template, which will be shown during + selection. + +TYPE + The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are: + + `entry' + An Org mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the + child of the target entry or as a top-level entry. The + target file should be an Org mode file. + + `item' + A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the + target location. Again the target file should be an Org file. + + `checkitem' + A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item + by the default template. + + `table-line' + a new line in the first table at the target location. Where + exactly the line will be inserted depends on the properties + `:prepend' and `:table-line-pos' (see below). + + `plain' + Text to be inserted as it is. + +TARGET + Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org + mode files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become + children of this node. Other types will be added to the table or + list in the body of this node. Most target specifications contain + a file name. If that file name is the empty string, it defaults + to `org-default-notes-file'. A file can also be given as a + variable or as a function called with no argument. When an + absolute path is not specified for a target, it is taken as + relative to `org-directory'. + + Valid values are: + + `(file "path/to/file")' + Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file. + + `(id "id of existing org entry")' + Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry. + + `(file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")' + Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the + file. + + `(file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)' + For non-unique headings, the full path is safer. + + `(file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")' + Use a regular expression to position the cursor. + + `(file+olp+datetree "path/to/file" [ "Level 1 heading" ....])' + This target(1) will create a heading in a date tree(2) for + today's date. If the optional outline path is given, the + tree will be built under the node it is pointing to, instead + of at top level. Check out the `:time-prompt' and + `:tree-type' properties below for additional options. + + `(file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)' + A function to find the right location in the file. + + `(clock)' + File to the entry that is currently being clocked. + + `(function function-finding-location)' + Most general way: write your own function which both visits + the file and moves point to the right location. + +TEMPLATE + The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this + empty, an appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise + this is a string with escape codes, which will be replaced + depending on time and context of the capture call. The string + with escapes may be loaded from a template file, using the special + syntax `(file "path/to/template")'. See below for more details. + +PROPERTIES + The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options. + Recognized properties are: + + `:prepend' + Normally new captured information will be appended at the + target location (last child, last table line, last list + item...). Setting this property will change that. + + `:immediate-finish' + When set, do not offer to edit the information, just file it + away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs + information that can be added automatically. + + `:empty-lines' + Set this to the number of lines to insert before and after + the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1. + + `:clock-in' + Start the clock in this item. + + `:clock-keep' + Keep the clock running when filing the captured entry. + + `:clock-resume' + If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that + clock when finished with the capture. Note that + `:clock-keep' has precedence over `:clock-resume'. When + setting both to `t', the current clock will run and the + previous one will not be resumed. + + `:time-prompt' + Prompt for a date/time to be used for date/week trees and + when filling the template. Without this property, capture + uses the current date and time. Even if this property has + not been set, you can force the same behavior by calling + `org-capture' with a `C-1' prefix argument. + + `:tree-type' + When `week', make a week tree instead of the month tree, i.e. + place the headings for each day under a heading with the + current iso week. + + `:unnarrowed' + Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. + Default is to narrow it so that you only see the new material. + + `:table-line-pos' + Specification of the location in the table where the new line + should be inserted. It can be a string, a variable holding a + string or a function returning a string. The string should + look like `"II-3"' meaning that the new line should become + the third line before the second horizontal separator line. + + `:kill-buffer' + If the target file was not yet visited when capture was + invoked, kill the buffer again after capture is completed. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Org used to offer four different targets for date/week tree +capture. Now, Org automatically translates these to use +`file+olp+datetree', applying the `:time-prompt' and `:tree-type' +properties. Please rewrite your date/week-tree targets using +`file+olp+datetree' since the older targets are now deprecated. + + (2) A date tree is an outline structure with years on the highest +level, months or ISO-weeks as sublevels and then dates on the lowest +level. Tags are allowed in the tree structure. + + +File: org, Node: Template expansion, Next: Templates in contexts, Prev: Template elements, Up: Capture templates + +9.1.3.2 Template expansion +.......................... + +In the template itself, special `%'-escapes(1) allow dynamic insertion +of content. The templates are expanded in the order given here: + + %[FILE] Insert the contents of the file given by FILE. + %(SEXP) Evaluate Elisp SEXP and replace with the result. + For convenience, %:keyword (see below) placeholders + within the expression will be expanded prior to this. + The sexp must return a string. + %<...> The result of format-time-string on the ... format specification. + %t Timestamp, date only. + %T Timestamp, with date and time. + %u, %U Like the above, but inactive timestamps. + %i Initial content, the region when capture is called while the + region is active. + The entire text will be indented like `%i' itself. + %a Annotation, normally the link created with `org-store-link'. + %A Like `%a', but prompt for the description part. + %l Like %a, but only insert the literal link. + %c Current kill ring head. + %x Content of the X clipboard. + %k Title of the currently clocked task. + %K Link to the currently clocked task. + %n User name (taken from `user-full-name'). + %f File visited by current buffer when org-capture was called. + %F Full path of the file or directory visited by current buffer. + %:keyword Specific information for certain link types, see below. + %^g Prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file. + %^G Prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files. + %^t Like `%t', but prompt for date. Similarly `%^T', `%^u', `%^U'. + You may define a prompt like `%^{Birthday}t'. + %^C Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use. + %^L Like `%^C', but insert as link. + %^{PROP}p Prompt the user for a value for property PROP. + %^{PROMPT} prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it. + You may specify a default value and a completion table with + %^{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...}. + The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history. + %\1 ... %\N Insert the text entered at the Nth %^{PROMPT}, where `N' is + a number, starting from 1.(2) + %? After completing the template, position cursor here. + +For specific link types, the following keywords will be defined(3): + + Link type | Available keywords + ---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------- + bbdb | %:name %:company + irc | %:server %:port %:nick + vm, vm-imap, wl, mh, mew, rmail, | %:type %:subject %:message-id + gnus, notmuch | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress + | %:to %:toname %:toaddress + | %:date (message date header field) + | %:date-timestamp (date as active timestamp) + | %:date-timestamp-inactive (date as inactive timestamp) + | %:fromto (either "to NAME" or "from NAME")(4) + gnus | %:group, for messages also all email fields + eww, w3, w3m | %:url + info | %:file %:node + calendar | %:date + org-protocol | %:link %:description %:annotation + +To place the cursor after template expansion use: + + %? After completing the template, position cursor here. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) If you need one of these sequences literally, escape the `%' +with a backslash. + + (2) As required in Emacs Lisp, it is necessary to +escape any backslash character in a string with another +backslash. So, in order to use `%\1' placeholder, you +need to write `%\\1' in the template. + + (3) If you define your own link types (*note Adding hyperlink +types::), any property you store with `org-store-link-props' can be +accessed in capture templates in a similar way. + + (4) This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable +`org-from-is-user-regexp'. + + +File: org, Node: Templates in contexts, Prev: Template expansion, Up: Capture templates + +9.1.3.3 Templates in contexts +............................. + +To control whether a capture template should be accessible from a +specific context, you can customize `org-capture-templates-contexts'. +Let's say for example that you have a capture template `"p"' for +storing Gnus emails containing patches. Then you would configure this +option like this: + + (setq org-capture-templates-contexts + '(("p" (in-mode . "message-mode")))) + + You can also tell that the command key `"p"' should refer to another +template. In that case, add this command key like this: + + (setq org-capture-templates-contexts + '(("p" "q" (in-mode . "message-mode")))) + + See the docstring of the variable for more information. + + +File: org, Node: Attachments, Next: RSS feeds, Prev: Capture, Up: Capture - Refile - Archive + +9.2 Attachments +=============== + +It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline +node/task. Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the +subtree of a project. Hyperlinks (*note Hyperlinks::) can establish +associations with files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the +cloud, like emails or source code files belonging to a project. +Another method is attachments, which are files located in a directory +belonging to an outline node. Org uses directories named by the unique +ID of each entry. These directories are located in the `data' +directory which lives in the same directory where your Org file +lives(1). If you initialize this directory with `git init', Org will +automatically commit changes when it sees them. The attachment system +has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley. + + In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a +directory of your choice to an entry. You can also make children +inherit the attachment directory from a parent, so that an entire +subtree uses the same attached directory. + +The following commands deal with attachments: + +`C-c C-a (`org-attach')' + The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. + After these keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must + press an additional key to select a command: + + `a (`org-attach-attach')' + Select a file and move it into the task's attachment + directory. The file will be copied, moved, or linked, + depending on `org-attach-method'. Note that hard links are + not supported on all systems. + + `c/m/l' + Attach a file using the copy/move/link method. Note that + hard links are not supported on all systems. + + `u (`org-attach-url')' + Attach a file from URL + + `n (`org-attach-new')' + Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer. + + `z (`org-attach-sync')' + Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, + in case you added attachments yourself. + + `o (`org-attach-open')' + Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, + prompt for a file name first. Opening will follow the rules + set by `org-file-apps'. For more details, see the + information on following hyperlinks (*note Handling links::). + + `O (`org-attach-open-in-emacs')' + Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs. + + `f (`org-attach-reveal')' + Open the current task's attachment directory. + + `F (`org-attach-reveal-in-emacs')' + Also open the directory, but force using `dired' in Emacs. + + `d (`org-attach-delete-one')' + Select and delete a single attachment. + + `D (`org-attach-delete-all')' + Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open + the directory in `dired' and delete from there. + + `s (`org-attach-set-directory')' + Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. + This works by putting the directory path into the + `ATTACH_DIR' property. + + `i (`org-attach-set-inherit')' + Set the `ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT' property, so that children will + use the same directory for attachments as the parent does. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) If you move entries or Org files from one directory to another, +you may want to configure `org-attach-directory' to contain an absolute +path. + + +File: org, Node: RSS feeds, Next: Protocols, Prev: Attachments, Up: Capture - Refile - Archive + +9.3 RSS feeds +============= + +Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds +and Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new +podcast in a podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based +note-creating service on the web to import tasks into Org. To access +feeds, configure the variable `org-feed-alist'. The docstring of this +variable has detailed information. Here is just an example: + + (setq org-feed-alist + '(("Slashdot" + "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot" + "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries"))) + +will configure that new items from the feed provided by +`rss.slashdot.org' will result in new entries in the file +`~/org/feeds.org' under the heading `Slashdot Entries', whenever the +following command is used: + +`C-c C-x g (`org-feed-update-all')' + +`C-c C-x g' + Collect items from the feeds configured in `org-feed-alist' and + act upon them. + +`C-c C-x G (`org-feed-goto-inbox')' + Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this + feed. + + Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer `FEEDSTATUS' in +which it will store information about the status of items in the feed, +to avoid adding the same item several times. + + For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see +`org-feed.el' and the docstring of `org-feed-alist'. + + +File: org, Node: Protocols, Next: Refile and copy, Prev: RSS feeds, Up: Capture - Refile - Archive + +9.4 Protocols for external access +================================= + +Org protocol is a mean to trigger custom actions in Emacs from external +applications. Any application that supports calling external programs +with an URL as argument may be used with this functionality. For +example, you can configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link +to the current page to Org and create a note from it using capture +(*note Capture::). You can also create a bookmark that tells Emacs to +open the local source file of a remote website you are browsing. + + In order to use Org protocol from an application, you need to +register `org-protocol://' as a valid scheme-handler. External calls +are passed to Emacs through the `emacsclient' command, so you also need +to ensure an Emacs server is running. More precisely, when the +application calls + + emacsclient org-protocol://PROTOCOL?key1=val1&key2=val2 + +Emacs calls the handler associated to `PROTOCOL' with argument `(:key1 +val1 :key2 val2)'. + + Org protocol comes with three predefined protocols, detailed in the +following sections. Configure `org-protocol-protocol-alist' to define +your own. + +* Menu: + +* `store-link' protocol:: Store a link, push URL to kill-ring. +* `capture' protocol:: Fill a buffer with external information. +* `open-source' protocol:: Edit published contents. + + +File: org, Node: `store-link' protocol, Next: `capture' protocol, Up: Protocols + +9.4.1 `store-link' protocol +--------------------------- + +Using `store-link' handler, you can copy links, insertable through `M-x +org-insert-link' or yanking thereafter. More precisely, the command + + emacsclient org-protocol://store-link?url=URL&title=TITLE + +stores the following link: + + [[URL][TITLE]] + + In addition, `URL' is pushed on the kill-ring for yanking. You need +to encode `URL' and `TITLE' if they contain slashes, and probably quote +those for the shell. + + To use this feature from a browser, add a bookmark with an arbitrary +name, e.g., `Org: store-link' and enter this as _Location_: + + javascript:location.href='org-protocol://store-link?url='+ + encodeURIComponent(location.href); + + +File: org, Node: `capture' protocol, Next: `open-source' protocol, Prev: `store-link' protocol, Up: Protocols + +9.4.2 `capture' protocol +------------------------ + +Activating `capture' handler pops up a `Capture' buffer and fills the +capture template associated to the `X' key with them. + + emacsclient org-protocol://capture?template=X?url=URL?title=TITLE?body=BODY + + To use this feature, add a bookmark with an arbitrary name, e.g. +`Org: capture' and enter this as `Location': + + javascript:location.href='org-protocol://template=x'+ + '&url='+encodeURIComponent(window.location.href)+ + '&title='+encodeURIComponent(document.title)+ + '&body='+encodeURIComponent(window.getSelection()); + + The result depends on the capture template used, which is set in the +bookmark itself, as in the example above, or in +`org-protocol-default-template-key'. + + The following template placeholders are available: + + %:link The URL + %:description The webpage title + %:annotation Equivalent to [[%:link][%:description]] + %i The selected text + + +File: org, Node: `open-source' protocol, Prev: `capture' protocol, Up: Protocols + +9.4.3 `open-source' protocol +---------------------------- + +The `open-source' handler is designed to help with editing local sources +when reading a document. To that effect, you can use a bookmark with +the following location: + + javascript:location.href='org-protocol://open-source?&url='+ + encodeURIComponent(location.href) + + The variable `org-protocol-project-alist' maps URLs to local file +names, by stripping URL parameters from the end and replacing the +`:base-url' with `:working-directory' and `:online-suffix' with +`:working-suffix'. For example, assuming you own a local copy of +`http://orgmode.org/worg/' contents at `/home/user/worg', you can set +`org-protocol-project-alist' to the following + + (setq org-protocol-project-alist + '(("Worg" + :base-url "http://orgmode.org/worg/" + :working-directory "/home/user/worg/" + :online-suffix ".html" + :working-suffix ".org"))) + +If you are now browsing +`http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.html' and find a typo +or have an idea about how to enhance the documentation, simply click the +bookmark and start editing. + + However, such mapping may not yield the desired results. Suppose you +maintain an online store located at `http://example.com/'. The local +sources reside in `/home/user/example/'. It is common practice to serve +all products in such a store through one file and rewrite URLs that do +not match an existing file on the server. That way, a request to +`http://example.com/print/posters.html' might be rewritten on the server +to something like +`http://example.com/shop/products.php/posters.html.php'. The +`open-source' handler probably cannot find a file named +`/home/user/example/print/posters.html.php' and fails. + + Such an entry in `org-protocol-project-alist' may hold an additional +property `:rewrites'. This property is a list of cons cells, each of +which maps a regular expression to a path relative to the +`:working-directory'. + + Now map the URL to the path `/home/user/example/products.php' by +adding `:rewrites' rules like this: + + (setq org-protocol-project-alist + '(("example.com" + :base-url "http://example.com/" + :working-directory "/home/user/example/" + :online-suffix ".php" + :working-suffix ".php" + :rewrites (("example.com/print/" . "products.php") + ("example.com/$" . "index.php"))))) + +Since `example.com/$' is used as a regular expression, it maps +`http://example.com/', `https://example.com', `http://www.example.com/' +and similar to `/home/user/example/index.php'. + + The `:rewrites' rules are searched as a last resort if and only if no +existing file name is matched. + + Two functions can help you filling `org-protocol-project-alist' with +valid contents: `org-protocol-create' and +`org-protocol-create-for-org'. The latter is of use if you're editing +an Org file that is part of a publishing project. + + +File: org, Node: Refile and copy, Next: Archiving, Prev: Protocols, Up: Capture - Refile - Archive + +9.5 Refile and copy +=================== + +When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile or to copy +some of the entries into a different list, for example into a project. +Cutting, finding the right location, and then pasting the note is +cumbersome. To simplify this process, you can use the following +special command: + +`C-c M-w (`org-copy')' + Copying works like refiling, except that the original note is not + deleted. + +`C-c C-w (`org-refile')' + Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible + locations for refiling the entry and lets you select one with + completion. The item (or all items in the region) is filed below + the target heading as a subitem. Depending on + `org-reverse-note-order', it will be either the first or last + subitem. + By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are + considered to be targets, but you can have more complex + definitions across a number of files. See the variable + `org-refile-targets' for details. If you would like to select a + location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, + see the variables `org-refile-use-outline-path' and + `org-outline-path-complete-in-steps'. If you would like to be + able to create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, + check the variable `org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes'. When + the variable `org-log-refile'(1) is set, a timestamp or a note + will be recorded when an entry has been refiled. + +`C-u C-c C-w' + Use the refile interface to jump to a heading. + +`C-u C-u C-c C-w (`org-refile-goto-last-stored')' + Jump to the location where `org-refile' last moved a tree to. + +`C-2 C-c C-w' + Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked. + +`C-3 C-c C-w' + Refile and keep the entry in place. Also see `org-refile-keep' to + make this the default behavior, and beware that this may result in + duplicated `ID' properties. + +`C-0 C-c C-w or C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w (`org-refile-cache-clear')' + Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned + on by setting `org-refile-use-cache'. To make the command see new + possible targets, you have to clear the cache with this command. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) with corresponding `#+STARTUP' keywords `logrefile', +`lognoterefile', and `nologrefile' + + +File: org, Node: Archiving, Prev: Refile and copy, Up: Capture - Refile - Archive + +9.6 Archiving +============= + +When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want to +move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the +agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and +global searches like the construction of agenda views fast. + +`C-c C-x C-a (`org-archive-subtree-default')' + Archive the current entry using the command specified in the + variable `org-archive-default-command'. + +* Menu: + +* Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file +* Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file + + +File: org, Node: Moving subtrees, Next: Internal archiving, Up: Archiving + +9.6.1 Moving a tree to the archive file +--------------------------------------- + +The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another +file, the archive file. + +`C-c C-x C-s or short C-c $ (`org-archive-subtree')' + Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location + given by `org-archive-location'. + +`C-u C-c C-x C-s' + Check if any direct children of the current headline could be + moved to the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for + open TODO entries. If none are found, the command offers to move + it to the archive location. If the cursor is _not_ on a headline + when this command is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked. + +`C-u C-u C-c C-x C-s' + As above, but check subtree for timestamps instead of TODO + entries. The command will offer to archive the subtree if it + _does_ contain a timestamp, and that timestamp is in the past. + + The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the +current file, with the name derived by appending `_archive' to the +current file name. You can also choose what heading to file archived +items under, with the possibility to add them to a datetree in a file. +For information and examples on how to specify the file and the heading, +see the documentation string of the variable `org-archive-location'. + + There is also an in-buffer option for setting this variable, for +example: + + #+ARCHIVE: %s_done:: + +If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry +or a (sub)tree, give the entry an `:ARCHIVE:' property with the +location as the value (*note Properties and columns::). + + When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties +that record context information like the file from where the entry +came, its outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable +`org-archive-save-context-info' to adjust the amount of information +added. + + +File: org, Node: Internal archiving, Prev: Moving subtrees, Up: Archiving + +9.6.2 Internal archiving +------------------------ + +If you want to just switch off--for agenda views--certain subtrees +without moving them to a different file, you can use the archive tag. + + A headline that is marked with the `:ARCHIVE:' tag (*note Tags::) +stays at its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following +way: + - It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility + cycling command (*note Visibility cycling::). You can force + cycling archived subtrees with `C-<TAB>', or by setting the option + `org-cycle-open-archived-trees'. Also normal outline commands like + `show-all' will open archived subtrees. + + - During sparse tree construction (*note Sparse trees::), matches in + archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option + `org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees'. + + - During agenda view construction (*note Agenda views::), the + content of archived trees is ignored unless you configure the + option `org-agenda-skip-archived-trees', in which case these trees + will always be included. In the agenda you can press `v a' to get + archives temporarily included. + + - Archived trees are not exported (*note Exporting::), only the + headline is. Configure the details using the variable + `org-export-with-archived-trees'. + + - Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable + `org-columns-skip-archived-trees' is configured to `nil'. + + The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag: + +`C-c C-x a (`org-toggle-archive-tag')' + Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is + set, the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree + below it is hidden. + +`C-u C-c C-x a' + Check if any direct children of the current headline should be + archived. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO + entries. If none are found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE + tag for the child. If the cursor is _not_ on a headline when this + command is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked. + +`C-TAB (`org-force-cycle-archived')' + Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE. + +`C-c C-x A (`org-archive-to-archive-sibling')' + Move the current entry to the _Archive Sibling_. This is a + sibling of the entry with the heading `Archive' and the tag + `ARCHIVE'. The entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this + way retains a lot of its original context, including inherited + tags and approximate position in the outline. + + +File: org, Node: Agenda views, Next: Markup, Prev: Capture - Refile - Archive, Up: Top + +10 Agenda views +*************** + +Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and tagged +headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of files. +To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are +important for a particular date, this information must be collected, +sorted and displayed in an organized way. + + Org can select items based on various criteria and display them in a +separate buffer. Six different view types are provided: + + * an _agenda_ that is like a calendar and shows information for + specific dates, + + * a _TODO list_ that covers all unfinished action items, + + * a _match view_, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, + and TODO state associated with them, + + * a _text search view_ that shows all entries from multiple files + that contain specified keywords, + + * a _stuck projects view_ showing projects that currently don't move + along, and + + * _custom views_ that are special searches and combinations of + different views. + +The extracted information is displayed in a special _agenda buffer_. +This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the +corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to edit +these files remotely. + + By default, the report ignores commented (*note Comment lines::) and +archived (*note Internal archiving::) entries. You can override this +by setting `org-agenda-skip-comment-trees' and +`org-agenda-skip-archived-trees' to `nil'. + + Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether +the window configuration is restored when the agenda exits: +`org-agenda-window-setup' and `org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit'. + +* Menu: + +* Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information +* Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views +* Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box? +* Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display +* Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees +* Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views +* Exporting agenda views:: Writing a view to a file +* Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries + + +File: org, Node: Agenda files, Next: Agenda dispatcher, Up: Agenda views + +10.1 Agenda files +================= + +The information to be shown is normally collected from all _agenda +files_, the files listed in the variable `org-agenda-files'(1). If a +directory is part of this list, all files with the extension `.org' in +this directory will be part of the list. + + Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should +be put into the list(2). You can customize `org-agenda-files', but the +easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands + +`C-c [ (`org-agenda-file-to-front')' + Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to + the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved + to the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the + end. + +`C-c ] (`org-remove-file')' + Remove current file from the list of agenda files. + +`C-' (`org-cycle-agenda-files')' +`C-,' + Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other. + +`M-x org-iswitchb RET' + Command to use an `iswitchb'-like interface to switch to and + between Org buffers. + +The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used to +visit any of them. + + If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in +this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree +in a file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single +agenda command, you may press `<' once or several times in the +dispatcher (*note Agenda dispatcher::). To restrict the agenda scope +for an extended period, use the following commands: + +`C-c C-x < (`org-agenda-set-restriction-lock')' + Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with + a prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in + a file, the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This + restriction remains in effect until removed with `C-c C-x >', or + by typing either `<' or `>' in the agenda dispatcher. If there is + a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes + effect immediately. + +`C-c C-x > (`org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock')' + Remove the permanent restriction created by `C-c C-x <'. + +When working with `speedbar.el', you can use the following commands in +the Speedbar frame: + +`< in the speedbar frame (`org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction')' + Permanently restrict the agenda to the item--either an Org file or + a subtree in such a file--at the cursor in the Speedbar frame. If + there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction + takes effect immediately. + +`> in the speedbar frame (`org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock')' + Lift the restriction. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) If the value of that variable is not a list, but a single file +name, then the list of agenda files will be maintained in that external +file. + + (2) When using the dispatcher, pressing `<' before selecting a +command will actually limit the command to the current file, and ignore +`org-agenda-files' until the next dispatcher command. + + +File: org, Node: Agenda dispatcher, Next: Built-in agenda views, Prev: Agenda files, Up: Agenda views + +10.2 The agenda dispatcher +========================== + +The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a +global key--for example `C-c a' (*note Activation::). In the following +we will assume that `C-c a' is indeed how the dispatcher is accessed +and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After pressing `C-c +a', an additional letter is required to execute a command. The +dispatcher offers the following default commands: + +`a' + Create the calendar-like agenda (*note Weekly/daily agenda::). + +`t / T' + Create a list of all TODO items (*note Global TODO list::). + +`m / M' + Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (*note + Matching tags and properties::). + +`s' + Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of + keywords and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in + the entry. + +`/' + Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and + additionally in the files listed in + `org-agenda-text-search-extra-files'. This uses the Emacs command + `multi-occur'. A prefix argument can be used to specify the + number of context lines for each match, default is 1. + +`# / !' + Create a list of stuck projects (*note Stuck projects::). + +`<' + Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer(1). After + pressing `<', you still need to press the character selecting the + command. + +`< <' + If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda + command to the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current + subtree(2). After pressing `< <', you still need to press the + character selecting the command. + +`*' + Toggle sticky agenda views. By default, Org maintains only a + single agenda buffer and rebuilds it each time you change the + view, to make sure everything is always up to date. If you often + switch between agenda views and the build time bothers you, you + can turn on sticky agenda buffers or make this the default by + customizing the variable `org-agenda-sticky'. With sticky + agendas, the agenda dispatcher will not recreate agenda views from + scratch, it will only switch to the selected one, and you need to + update the agenda by hand with `r' or `g' when needed. You can + toggle sticky agenda view any time with `org-toggle-sticky-agenda'. + + You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through +the dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the +possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several +blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and +a number of special tags matches. *Note Custom agenda views::. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) For backward compatibility, you can also press `1' to restrict +to the current buffer. + + (2) For backward compatibility, you can also press `0' to restrict +to the current region/subtree. + + +File: org, Node: Built-in agenda views, Next: Presentation and sorting, Prev: Agenda dispatcher, Up: Agenda views + +10.3 The built-in agenda views +============================== + +In this section we describe the built-in views. + +* Menu: + +* Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks +* Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items +* Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search +* Search view:: Find entries by searching for text +* Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review + + +File: org, Node: Weekly/daily agenda, Next: Global TODO list, Up: Built-in agenda views + +10.3.1 The weekly/daily agenda +------------------------------ + +The purpose of the weekly/daily _agenda_ is to act like a page of a +paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day. + +`C-c a a (`org-agenda-list')' + Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. + The agenda shows the entries for each day. With a numeric + prefix(1) (like `C-u 2 1 C-c a a') you may set the number of days + to be displayed. + + The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the +variable `org-agenda-span' (or the obsolete `org-agenda-ndays'). This +variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in +the agenda, or to a span name, such as `day', `week', `month' or +`year'. For weekly agendas, the default is to start on the previous +monday (see `org-agenda-start-on-weekday'). You can also set the start +date using a date shift: `(setq org-agenda-start-day "+10d")' will +start the agenda ten days from today in the future. + + Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you +can change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda +buffer. The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in +*note Agenda commands::. + +Calendar/Diary integration +.......................... + +Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The +calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different +countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of +anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments +(weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to +Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with the diary. + + In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's +agenda, you only need to customize the variable + + (setq org-agenda-include-diary t) + +After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary entries +including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the agenda +buffer created by Org mode. <SPC>, <TAB>, and <RET> can be used from +the agenda buffer to jump to the diary file in order to edit existing +diary entries. The `i' command to insert new entries for the current +date works in the agenda buffer, as well as the commands `S', `M', and +`C' to display Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert +to other calendars, respectively. `c' can be used to switch back and +forth between calendar and agenda. + + If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is +faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move +the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp +entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first +creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at +the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example, +the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries will +be made in the agenda: + + * Holidays + :PROPERTIES: + :CATEGORY: Holiday + :END: + %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names + + * Birthdays + :PROPERTIES: + :CATEGORY: Ann + :END: + %%(org-anniversary 1956 5 14)(2) Arthur Dent is %d years old + %%(org-anniversary 1869 10 2) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old + +Anniversaries from BBDB +....................... + +If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you +will very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a +separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB +anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the +following to one of your agenda files: + + * Anniversaries + :PROPERTIES: + :CATEGORY: Anniv + :END: + %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries) + + You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. +Basically, you need to press `C-o anniversary <RET>' with the cursor in +a BBDB record and then add the date in the format `YYYY-MM-DD' or +`MM-DD', followed by a space and the class of the anniversary +(`birthday' or `wedding', or a format string). If you omit the class, +it will default to `birthday'. Here are a few examples, the header for +the file `org-bbdb.el' contains more detailed information. + + 1973-06-22 + 06-22 + 1955-08-02 wedding + 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org mode, %d years ago + + After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an +Emacs session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org +updates its hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will +be very fast--much faster in fact than a long list of +`%%(diary-anniversary)' entries in an Org or Diary file. + + If you would like to see upcoming anniversaries with a bit of +forewarning, you can use the following instead: + + * Anniversaries + :PROPERTIES: + :CATEGORY: Anniv + :END: + %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries-future 3) + + That will give you three days' warning: on the anniversary date +itself and the two days prior. The argument is optional: if omitted, +it defaults to 7. + +Appointment reminders +..................... + +Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add +the appointments of your agenda files, use the command +`org-agenda-to-appt'. This command lets you filter through the list of +your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific category +or matching a regular expression. It also reads a `APPT_WARNTIME' +property which will then override the value of +`appt-message-warning-time' for this appointment. See the docstring +for details. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) For backward compatibility, the universal prefix `C-u' causes +all TODO entries to be listed before the agenda. This feature is +deprecated, use the dedicated TODO list, or a block agenda instead +(*note Block agenda::). + + (2) `org-anniversary' is just like `diary-anniversary', but the +argument order is always according to ISO and therefore independent of +the value of `calendar-date-style'. + + +File: org, Node: Global TODO list, Next: Matching tags and properties, Prev: Weekly/daily agenda, Up: Built-in agenda views + +10.3.2 The global TODO list +--------------------------- + +The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and +collected into a single place. + +`C-c a t (`org-todo-list')' + Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all + agenda files (*note Agenda views::) into a single buffer. By + default, this lists items with a state the is not a DONE state. + The buffer is in `agenda-mode', so there are commands to examine + and manipulate the TODO entries directly from that buffer (*note + Agenda commands::). + +`C-c a T (`org-todo-list')' + Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. + You can also do this by specifying a prefix argument to `C-c a t'. + You are prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several + keywords by separating them with `|' as the boolean OR operator. + With a numeric prefix, the Nth keyword in `org-todo-keywords' is + selected. The `r' key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and + you can give a prefix argument to this command to change the + selected TODO keyword, for example `3 r'. If you often need a + search for a specific keyword, define a custom command for it + (*note Agenda dispatcher::). + Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags + search (*note Tag searches::). + + Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a +TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the TODO +list are described in *note Agenda commands::. + + Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO +keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep +it more compact: + - Some people view a TODO item that has been _scheduled_ for + execution or have a _deadline_ (*note Timestamps::) as no longer + _open_. Configure the variables + `org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled', + `org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines', + `org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp' and/or + `org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date' to exclude such items from the + global TODO list. + + - TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. + In such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO + headline and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure + the variable `org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels' to get this behavior. + + +File: org, Node: Matching tags and properties, Next: Search view, Prev: Global TODO list, Up: Built-in agenda views + +10.3.3 Matching tags and properties +----------------------------------- + +If headlines in the agenda files are marked with _tags_ (*note Tags::), +or have properties (*note Properties and columns::), you can select +headlines based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda +buffer. The match syntax described here also applies when creating +sparse trees with `C-c / m'. + +`C-c a m (`org-tags-view')' + Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. + The command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean + logic expression with tags, like `+work+urgent-withboss' or + `work|home' (*note Tags::). If you often need a specific search, + define a custom command for it (*note Agenda dispatcher::). + +`C-c a M (`org-tags-view')' + Like `C-c a m', but only select headlines that are also TODO items + in a not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable + `org-tags-match-list-sublevels'). To exclude scheduled/deadline + items, see the variable + `org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options'. Matching specific + TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see + *note Tag searches::. + + The commands available in the tags list are described in *note +Agenda commands::. + +Match syntax +............ + +A search string can use Boolean operators `&' for `AND' and `|' for +`OR'. `&' binds more strongly than `|'. Parentheses are not +implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular +expression matching tags, or an expression like `PROPERTY OPERATOR +VALUE' with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each +element may be preceded by `-', to select against it, and `+' is +syntactic sugar for positive selection. The `AND' operator `&' is +optional when `+' or `-' is present. Here are some examples, using +only tags. + +`work' + Select headlines tagged `:work:'. + +`work&boss' + Select headlines tagged `:work:' and `:boss:'. + +`+work-boss' + Select headlines tagged `:work:', but discard those also tagged + `:boss:'. + +`work|laptop' + Selects lines tagged `:work:' or `:laptop:'. + +`work|laptop+night' + Like before, but require the `:laptop:' lines to be tagged also + `:night:'. + + Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed +in curly braces. For example, `work+{^boss.*}' matches headlines that +contain the tag `:work:' and any tag starting with `boss'. + + Group tags (*note Tag hierarchy::) are expanded as regular +expressions. E.g., if `:work:' is a group tag for the group +`:work:lab:conf:', then searching for `work' will search for +`{\(?:work\|lab\|conf\)}' and searching for `-work' will search for all +headlines but those with one of the tags in the group (i.e., +`-{\(?:work\|lab\|conf\)}'). + + You may also test for properties (*note Properties and columns::) at +the same time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, +or special properties that represent other metadata (*note Special +properties::). For example, the "property" `TODO' represents the TODO +keyword of the entry and the "property" `PRIORITY' represents the +PRIORITY keyword of the entry. + + In addition to the properties mentioned above, `LEVEL' represents the +level of an entry. So a search `+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"' lists all +level three headlines that have the tag `boss' and are _not_ marked +with the TODO keyword DONE. In buffers with `org-odd-levels-only' set, +`LEVEL' does not count the number of stars, but `LEVEL=2' will +correspond to 3 stars etc. + + Here are more examples: + +`work+TODO="WAITING"' + Select `:work:'-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO keyword + `WAITING'. + +`work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"' + Waiting tasks both at work and at home. + + When matching properties, a number of different operators can be +used to test the value of a property. Here is a complex example: + + +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \ + +With={Sarah\|Denny}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>" + +The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is +written: + - If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison + is done, and the allowed operators are `<', `=', `>', `<=', `>=', + and `<>'. + + - If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes, a string + comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed. + + - If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes _and_ angular + brackets (like `DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"'), both values are + assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, + and the comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that + will be recognized are `"<now>"' for now (including time), and + `"<today>"', and `"<tomorrow>"' for these days at 00:00 hours, + i.e., without a time specification. Also strings like `"<+5d>"' + or `"<-2m>"' with units `d', `w', `m', and `y' for day, week, + month, and year, respectively, can be used. + + - If the comparison value is enclosed in curly braces, a regexp + match is performed, with `=' meaning that the regexp matches the + property value, and `<>' meaning that it does not match. + + So the search string in the example finds entries tagged `:work:' but +not `:boss:', which also have a priority value `A', a `:Coffee:' +property with the value `unlimited', an `Effort' property that is +numerically smaller than 2, a `:With:' property that is matched by the +regular expression `Sarah\|Denny', and that are scheduled on or after +October 11, 2008. + + You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a +search, but beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See +*note Property inheritance::, for details. + + For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also +a different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate +the tags/property part of the search string (which may include several +terms connected with `|') with a `/' and then specify a Boolean +expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that +for tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive +selection on several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with +boolean AND. However, _negative selection_ combined with AND can be +meaningful. To make sure that only lines are checked that actually +have any TODO keyword (resulting in a speed-up), use `C-c a M', or +equivalently start the TODO part after the slash with `!'. Using `C-c +a M' or `/!' will not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples: + +`work/WAITING' + Same as `work+TODO="WAITING"' + +`work/!-WAITING-NEXT' + Select `:work:'-tagged TODO lines that are neither `WAITING' nor + `NEXT' + +`work/!+WAITING|+NEXT' + Select `:work:'-tagged TODO lines that are either `WAITING' or + `NEXT'. + + +File: org, Node: Search view, Next: Stuck projects, Prev: Matching tags and properties, Up: Built-in agenda views + +10.3.4 Search view +------------------ + +This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries. +It is particularly useful to find notes. + +`C-c a s (`org-search-view')' + This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching + a substring or specific words using a boolean logic. + For example, the search string `computer equipment' will find entries +that contain `computer equipment' as a substring. If the two words are +separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match. +Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using +Boolean logic. The search string `+computer +wifi -ethernet +-{8\.11[bg]}' will search for note entries that contain the keywords +`computer' and `wifi', but not the keyword `ethernet', and which are +also not matched by the regular expression `8\.11[bg]', meaning to +exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first `+' is necessary to turn on +word search, other `+' characters are optional. For more details, see +the docstring of the command `org-search-view'. + + Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also +search the files listed in `org-agenda-text-search-extra-files'. + + +File: org, Node: Stuck projects, Prev: Search view, Up: Built-in agenda views + +10.3.5 Stuck projects +--------------------- + +If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your +work, one of the "duties" you have is a regular review to make sure +that all projects move along. A _stuck_ project is a project that has +no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists Org +mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such projects +and define next actions for them. + +`C-c a # (`org-agenda-list-stuck-projects')' + List projects that are stuck. + +`C-c a !' + Customize the variable `org-stuck-projects' to define what a stuck + project is and how to find it. + + You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will +work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are +level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least +one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION. + + Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify +projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to +indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further +assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT +and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @SHOP indicates shopping and +is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project +contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed +either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects +with a tags/todo match(1) `+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE', and then check for +TODO, NEXT, @SHOP, and IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that +are not stuck. The correct customization for this is + + (setq org-stuck-projects + '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@SHOP") + "\\<IGNORE\\>")) + + Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of +this entry will still be searched for stuck projects. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) *Note Tag searches::. + + +File: org, Node: Presentation and sorting, Next: Agenda commands, Prev: Built-in agenda views, Up: Agenda views + +10.4 Presentation and sorting +============================= + +Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares +the items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line +starts with a _prefix_ that contains the _category_ (*note Categories::) +of the item and other important information. You can customize in which +column tags will be displayed through `org-agenda-tags-column'. You can +also customize the prefix using the option `org-agenda-prefix-format'. +This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline +associated with the item. + +* Menu: + +* Categories:: Not all tasks are equal +* Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time +* Sorting agenda items:: The order of things +* Filtering/limiting agenda items:: Dynamically narrow the agenda + + +File: org, Node: Categories, Next: Time-of-day specifications, Up: Presentation and sorting + +10.4.1 Categories +----------------- + +The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By +default, the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can +also specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this: + + #+CATEGORY: Thesis + +If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a +(sub)tree, give the entry a `:CATEGORY:' property with the special +category you want to apply as the value. + +The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not +longer than 10 characters. + +You can set up icons for category by customizing the +`org-agenda-category-icon-alist' variable. + + +File: org, Node: Time-of-day specifications, Next: Sorting agenda items, Prev: Categories, Up: Presentation and sorting + +10.4.2 Time-of-day specifications +--------------------------------- + +Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The +time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the +agenda, for example as in `<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>'. Time ranges can be +specified with two timestamps, like +`<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>'. + + In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as +plain text (like `12:45' or a `8:30-1pm'). If the agenda integrates +the Emacs diary (*note Weekly/daily agenda::), time specifications in +diary entries are recognized as well. + + For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a +standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in +the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this: + + 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer + 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub + 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem + 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge + + If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the +timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like + + 8:00...... ------------------ + 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer + 10:00...... ------------------ + 12:00...... ------------------ + 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub + 14:00...... ------------------ + 16:00...... ------------------ + 18:00...... ------------------ + 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem + 20:00...... ------------------ + 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge + + The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable +`org-agenda-use-time-grid', and can be configured with +`org-agenda-time-grid'. + + +File: org, Node: Sorting agenda items, Next: Filtering/limiting agenda items, Prev: Time-of-day specifications, Up: Presentation and sorting + +10.4.3 Sorting agenda items +--------------------------- + +Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is +done depends on the type of view. + * For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. + The default order is to first collect all items containing an + explicit time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown + at the beginning of the list, as a _schedule_ for the day. After + that, items remain grouped in categories, in the sequence given by + `org-agenda-files'. Within each category, items are sorted by + priority (*note Priorities::), which is composed of the base + priority (2000 for priority `A', 1000 for `B', and 0 for `C'), + plus additional increments for overdue scheduled or deadline items. + + * For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but + within each category, sorting takes place according to priority + (*note Priorities::). The priority used for sorting derives from + the priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item + is to its due or scheduled date. + + * For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in + the sequence in which they are found in the agenda files. + + Sorting can be customized using the variable +`org-agenda-sorting-strategy', and may also include criteria based on +the estimated effort of an entry (*note Effort estimates::). + + +File: org, Node: Filtering/limiting agenda items, Prev: Sorting agenda items, Up: Presentation and sorting + +10.4.4 Filtering/limiting agenda items +-------------------------------------- + +Agenda built-in or customized commands are statically defined. Agenda +filters and limits provide two ways of dynamically narrowing down the +list of agenda entries: _filters_ and _limits_. Filters only act on the +display of the items, while limits take effect before the list of agenda +entries is built. Filters are more often used interactively, while +limits are mostly useful when defined as local variables within custom +agenda commands. + +Filtering in the agenda +....................... + +`/ (`org-agenda-filter-by-tag')' + Filter the agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort + estimates. The difference between this and a custom agenda + command is that filtering is very fast, so that you can switch + quickly between different filters without having to recreate the + agenda.(1) + + You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; <SPC> will mean + any tag at all. Pressing <TAB> at that prompt will offer use + completion to select a tag (including any tags that do not have a + selection character). The command then hides all entries that do + not contain or inherit this tag. When called with prefix arg, + remove the entries that _do_ have the tag. A second `/' at the + prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries. + Pressing `+' or `-' switches between filtering and excluding the + next tag. + + Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the + variable `org-agenda-auto-exclude-function' is set to a + user-defined function, that function can decide which tags should + be excluded from the agenda automatically. Once this is set, the + `/' command then accepts `RET' as a sub-option key and runs the + auto exclusion logic. For example, let's say you use a `Net' tag + to identify tasks which need network access, an `Errand' tag for + errands in town, and a `Call' tag for making phone calls. You + could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the + Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this: + + (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag) + (and (cond + ((string= tag "Net") + (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil + "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org"))) + ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call")) + (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time)))) + (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21))))) + (concat "-" tag))) + + (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function) + +`[ ] { }' + + in search view + add new search words (`[' and `]') or new regular expressions + (`{' and `}') to the query string. The opening bracket/brace + will add a positive search term prefixed by `+', indicating + that this search term must occur/match in the entry. The + closing bracket/brace will add a negative search term which + must not occur/match in the entry for it to be selected. + +`< (`org-agenda-filter-by-category')' + Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the + item at point. Pressing `<' another time will remove this filter. + When called with a prefix argument exclude the category of the + item at point from the agenda. + + You can add a filter preset in custom agenda commands through the + option `org-agenda-category-filter-preset'. *Note Setting + options::. + +`^ (`org-agenda-filter-by-top-headline')' + Filter the current agenda view and only display the siblings and + the parent headline of the one at point. + +`= (`org-agenda-filter-by-regexp')' + Filter the agenda view by a regular expression: only show agenda + entries matching the regular expression the user entered. When + called with a prefix argument, it will filter _out_ entries + matching the regexp. With two universal prefix arguments, it will + remove all the regexp filters, which can be accumulated. + + You can add a filter preset in custom agenda commands through the + option `org-agenda-regexp-filter-preset'. *Note Setting options::. + +`_ (`org-agenda-filter-by-effort')' + Filter the agenda view with respect to effort estimates. You + first need to set up allowed efforts globally, for example + (setq org-global-properties + '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00"))) + You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one + of `<', `>', and `=', and then the one-digit index of an effort + estimate in your array of allowed values, where `0' means the 10th + value. The filter will then restrict to entries with effort + smaller-or-equal, equal, or larger-or-equal than the selected + value. For application of the operator, entries without a defined + effort will be treated according to the value of + `org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high'. + + When called with a prefix argument, it will remove entries + matching the condition. With two universal prefix arguments, it + will clear effort filters, which can be accumulated. + + You can add a filter preset in custom agenda commands through the + option `org-agenda-effort-filter-preset'. *Note Setting options::. + +`| (`org-agenda-filter-remove-all')' + Remove all filters in the current agenda view. + +Setting limits for the agenda +............................. + +Here is a list of options that you can set, either globally, or locally +in your custom agenda views (*note Custom agenda views::). + +`org-agenda-max-entries' + Limit the number of entries. + +`org-agenda-max-effort' + Limit the duration of accumulated efforts (as minutes). + +`org-agenda-max-todos' + Limit the number of entries with TODO keywords. + +`org-agenda-max-tags' + Limit the number of tagged entries. + + When set to a positive integer, each option will exclude entries +from other categories: for example, `(setq org-agenda-max-effort 100)' +will limit the agenda to 100 minutes of effort and exclude any entry +that has no effort property. If you want to include entries with no +effort property, use a negative value for `org-agenda-max-effort'. + + One useful setup is to use `org-agenda-max-entries' locally in a +custom command. For example, this custom command will display the next +five entries with a `NEXT' TODO keyword. + + (setq org-agenda-custom-commands + '(("n" todo "NEXT" + ((org-agenda-max-entries 5))))) + + Once you mark one of these five entry as `DONE', rebuilding the +agenda will again the next five entries again, including the first +entry that was excluded so far. + + You can also dynamically set temporary limits, which will be lost +when rebuilding the agenda: + +`~ (`org-agenda-limit-interactively')' + This prompts for the type of limit to apply and its value. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Custom commands can preset a filter by binding the variable +`org-agenda-tag-filter-preset' as an option. This filter will then be +applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through refreshes and +more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of the +entire agenda view--in a block agenda, you should only set this in the +global options section, not in the section of an individual block. + + +File: org, Node: Agenda commands, Next: Custom agenda views, Prev: Presentation and sorting, Up: Agenda views + +10.5 Commands in the agenda buffer +================================== + +Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary +file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda +buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the +original entry location, and to edit the Org files "remotely" from the +agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once, +removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge. + + Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For +the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line. + +Motion +...... + +`n (`org-agenda-next-line')' + Next line (same as <down> and `C-n'). + +`p (`org-agenda-previous-line')' + Previous line (same as <up> and `C-p'). + +`N (`org-agenda-next-item')' + Next item: same as next line, but only consider items. + +`P (`org-agenda-previous-item')' + Previous item: same as previous line, but only consider items. + +View/Go to Org file +................... + +`<SPC> or mouse-3 (`org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up')' + Display the original location of the item in another window. With + prefix arg, make sure that drawers stay folded. + +`L (`org-agenda-recenter')' + Display original location and recenter that window. + +`<TAB> or mouse-2 (`org-agenda-goto')' + Go to the original location of the item in another window. + +`<RET> (`org-agenda-switch-to')' + Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows. + +`F (`org-agenda-follow-mode')' + Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through + the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding + location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new + agenda buffers can be set with the variable + `org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode'. + +`C-c C-x b (`org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer')' + Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect + buffer. With a numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and + then take that tree. If N is negative, go up that many levels. + With a `C-u' prefix, do not remove the previously used indirect + buffer. + +`C-c C-o (`org-agenda-open-link')' + Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any + links in the text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there + is only one link, it will be followed without a selection prompt. + +Change display +.............. + +`A' + Interactively select another agenda view and append it to the + current view. + +`o' + Delete other windows. + +`v d or short d (`org-agenda-day-view')' +`v w or short w (`org-agenda-week-view')' +`v t (`org-agenda-fortnight-view')' +`v m (`org-agenda-month-view')' +`v y (`org-agenda-year-view')' +`v SPC (`org-agenda-reset-view')' + Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week + view, this setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda + refreshes. Since month and year views are slow to create, they do + not become the default. A numeric prefix argument may be used to + jump directly to a specific day of the year, ISO week, month, or + year, respectively. For example, `32 d' jumps to February 1st, `9 + w' to ISO week number 9. When setting day, week, or month view, a + year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For example, + `200712 w' will jump to week 12 in 2007. If such a year + specification has only one or two digits, it will be mapped to the + interval 1938-2037. `v <SPC>' will reset to what is set in + `org-agenda-span'. + +`f (`org-agenda-later')' + Go forward in time to display the following + `org-agenda-current-span' days. For example, if the display + covers a week, switch to the following week. With prefix arg, go + forward that many times `org-agenda-current-span' days. + +`b (`org-agenda-earlier')' + Go backward in time to display earlier dates. + +`. (`org-agenda-goto-today')' + Go to today. + +`j (`org-agenda-goto-date')' + Prompt for a date and go there. + +`J (`org-agenda-clock-goto')' + Go to the currently clocked-in task in the agenda buffer. + +`D (`org-agenda-toggle-diary')' + Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See *note Weekly/daily + agenda::. + +`v l or short l (`org-agenda-log-mode')' + Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked + DONE while logging was on (variable `org-log-done') are shown in + the agenda, as are entries that have been clocked on that day. + You can configure the entry types that should be included in log + mode using the variable `org-agenda-log-mode-items'. When called + with a `C-u' prefix, show all possible logbook entries, including + state changes. When called with two prefix arguments `C-u C-u', + show only logging information, nothing else. `v L' is equivalent + to `C-u v l'. + +`v [ or short [ (`org-agenda-manipulate-query-add')' + Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for + weekly/daily agenda. + +`v a (`org-agenda-archives-mode')' +`v A (`org-agenda-archives-mode 'files')' + Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked + `ARCHIVED' are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you + use the capital `A', even all archive files are included. To exit + archives mode, press `v a' again. + +`v R or short R (`org-agenda-clockreport-mode')' + Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly + agenda will always show a table with the clocked times for the + time span and file scope covered by the current agenda view. The + initial setting for this mode in new agenda buffers can be set + with the variable `org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode'. By + using a prefix argument when toggling this mode (i.e., `C-u R'), + the clock table will not show contributions from entries that are + hidden by agenda filtering(1). See also the variable + `org-clock-report-include-clocking-task'. + +`v c' + Show overlapping clock entries, clocking gaps, and other clocking + problems in the current agenda range. You can then visit clocking + lines and fix them manually. See the variable + `org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks' for information on how to + customize the definition of what constituted a clocking problem. + To return to normal agenda display, press `l' to exit Logbook mode. + +`v E or short E (`org-agenda-entry-text-mode')' + Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines + from the Org outline node referenced by an agenda line will be + displayed below the line. The maximum number of lines is given by + the variable `org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines'. Calling this + command with a numeric prefix argument will temporarily modify + that number to the prefix value. + +`G (`org-agenda-toggle-time-grid')' + Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables + `org-agenda-use-time-grid' and `org-agenda-time-grid'. + +`r (`org-agenda-redo')' + Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes + after modification of the timestamps of items with `S-<left>' and + `S-<right>'. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix + argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific + TODO keyword. + +`g (`org-agenda-redo')' + Same as `r'. + +`C-x C-s or short s (`org-save-all-org-buffers')' + Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the + locations of IDs. + +`C-c C-x C-c (`org-agenda-columns')' + Invoke column view (*note Column view::) in the agenda buffer. + The column view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if + there is no entry at point), from the first entry in the agenda + view. So whatever the format for that entry would be in the + original buffer (taken from a property, from a `#+COLUMNS' line, + or from the default variable `org-columns-default-format'), will + be used in the agenda. + +`C-c C-x > (`org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock')' + Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently + restricted to a file or subtree (*note Agenda files::). + +Secondary filtering and query editing +..................................... + + For a detailed description of these commands, *note + Filtering/limiting agenda items::. + +`/ (`org-agenda-filter-by-tag')' + Filter the agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort + estimates. + +`< (`org-agenda-filter-by-category')' + Filter the current agenda view with respect to the category of the + item at point. + +`^ (`org-agenda-filter-by-top-headline')' + Filter the current agenda view and only display the siblings and + the parent headline of the one at point. + +`= (`org-agenda-filter-by-regexp')' + Filter the agenda view by a regular expression. + +`_ (`org-agenda-filter-by-effort')' + Filter the agenda view with respect to effort estimates. + +`| (`org-agenda-filter-remove-all')' + Remove all filters in the current agenda view. + +Remote editing +.............. + +`0--9' + Digit argument. + +`C-_ (`org-agenda-undo')' + Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is + undone both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer. + +`t (`org-agenda-todo')' + Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the + original org file. + +`C-S-<right> (`org-agenda-todo-nextset')' + +`C-S-<left> (`org-agenda-todo-previousset')' + Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords. + +`C-k (`org-agenda-kill')' + Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree + belonging to it in the original Org file. If the text to be + deleted remotely is longer than one line, the kill needs to be + confirmed by the user. See variable `org-agenda-confirm-kill'. + +`C-c C-w (`org-agenda-refile')' + Refile the entry at point. + +`C-c C-x C-a or short a (`org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation')' + Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the + default archiving command set in `org-archive-default-command'. + When using the `a' key, confirmation will be required. + +`C-c C-x a (`org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag')' + Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. + +`C-c C-x A (`org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling')' + Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its _archive + sibling_. + +`C-c C-x C-s or short $ (`org-agenda-archive')' + Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This + means the entry will be moved to the configured archive location, + most likely a different file. + +`T (`org-agenda-show-tags')' + Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if + you have turned off `org-agenda-show-inherited-tags', but still + want to see all tags of a headline occasionally. + +`: (`org-agenda-set-tags')' + Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region + in the agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region. + +`,' + Set the priority for the current item (`org-agenda-priority'). + Org mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with + <SPC>, the priority cookie is removed from the entry. + +`P (`org-agenda-show-priority')' + Display weighted priority of current item. + +`+ or S-<up> (`org-agenda-priority-up')' + Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is + changed in the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. + Use the `r' key for this. + +`- or S-<down> (`org-agenda-priority-down')' + Decrease the priority of the current item. + +`z or C-c C-z (`org-agenda-add-note')' + Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then + filed to the same location where state change notes are put. + Depending on `org-log-into-drawer', this may be inside a drawer. + +`C-c C-a (`org-attach')' + Dispatcher for all command related to attachments. + +`C-c C-s (`org-agenda-schedule')' + Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling + timestamp + +`C-c C-d (`org-agenda-deadline')' + Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline. + +`S-<right> (`org-agenda-do-date-later')' + Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day + into the future. If the date is in the past, the first call to + this command will move it to today. + With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For + example, `3 6 5 S-<right>' will change it by a year. With a `C-u' + prefix, change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat + the command, it will continue to change hours even without the + prefix arg. With a double `C-u C-u' prefix, do the same for + changing minutes. + The stamp is changed in the original Org file, but the change is + not directly reflected in the agenda buffer. Use `r' or `g' to + update the buffer. + +`S-<left> (`org-agenda-do-date-earlier')' + Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day + into the past. + +`> (`org-agenda-date-prompt')' + Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key + `>' has been chosen, because it is the same as `S-.' on my + keyboard. + +`I (`org-agenda-clock-in')' + Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running + already, it is stopped first. + +`O (`org-agenda-clock-out')' + Stop the previously started clock. + +`X (`org-agenda-clock-cancel')' + Cancel the currently running clock. + +`J (`org-agenda-clock-goto')' + Jump to the running clock in another window. + +`k (`org-agenda-capture')' + Like `org-capture', but use the date at point as the default date + for the capture template. See `org-capture-use-agenda-date' to + make this the default behavior of `org-capture'. + +Dragging agenda lines forward/backward +...................................... + +`M-<up> (`org-agenda-drag-line-backward')' + Drag the line at point backward one line(2). With a numeric + prefix argument, drag backward by that many lines. + +`M-<down> (`org-agenda-drag-line-forward')' + Drag the line at point forward one line. With a numeric prefix + argument, drag forward by that many lines. + +Bulk remote editing selected entries +.................................... + +`m (`org-agenda-bulk-mark')' + Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With numeric prefix + argument, mark that many successive entries. + +`* (`org-agenda-bulk-mark-all')' + Mark all visible agenda entries for bulk action. + +`u (`org-agenda-bulk-unmark')' + Unmark entry at point for bulk action. + +`U (`org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks')' + Unmark all marked entries for bulk action. + +`M-m (`org-agenda-bulk-toggle')' + Toggle mark of the entry at point for bulk action. + +`M-* (`org-agenda-bulk-toggle-all')' + Toggle marks of all visible entries for bulk action. + +`% (`org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp')' + Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action. + +`B (`org-agenda-bulk-action')' + Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will + prompt for another key to select the action to be applied. The + prefix arg to `B' will be passed through to the `s' and `d' + commands, to bulk-remove these special timestamps. By default, + marks are removed after the bulk. If you want them to persist, + set `org-agenda-persistent-marks' to `t' or hit `p' at the prompt. + + `*' + Toggle persistent marks. + + `$' + Archive all selected entries. + + `A' + Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive + siblings. + + `t' + Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword + and changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing + blocking and suppressing logging notes (but not timestamps). + + `+' + Add a tag to all selected entries. + + `-' + Remove a tag from all selected entries. + + `s' + Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule + dates by a fixed number of days, use something starting with + double plus at the prompt, for example `++8d' or `++2w'. + + `d' + Set deadline to a specific date. + + `r' + Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The + entries will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (`g') to + bring them back. + + `S' + Reschedule randomly into the coming N days. N will be + prompted for. With prefix arg (`C-u B S'), scatter only + across weekdays. + + `f' + Apply a function(3) to marked entries. For example, the + function below sets the CATEGORY property of the entries to + web. + + (defun set-category () + (interactive "P") + (let* ((marker (or (org-get-at-bol 'org-hd-marker) + (org-agenda-error))) + (buffer (marker-buffer marker))) + (with-current-buffer buffer + (save-excursion + (save-restriction + (widen) + (goto-char marker) + (org-back-to-heading t) + (org-set-property "CATEGORY" "web")))))) + +Calendar commands +................. + +`c (`org-agenda-goto-calendar')' + Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor. + +`c (`org-calendar-goto-agenda')' + When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the + date at the cursor. + +`i (`org-agenda-diary-entry')' + Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor + and (for block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to + the Emacs diary file(4), in a way similar to the `i' command in + the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where + you can add the entry. + + If you configure `org-agenda-diary-file' to point to an Org mode + file, Org will create entries (in Org mode syntax) in that file + instead. Most entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree + that will later make it easy to archive appointments from previous + months/years. The tree will be built under an entry with a + `DATE_TREE' property, or else with years as top-level entries. + Emacs will prompt you for the entry text--if you specify it, the + entry will be created in `org-agenda-diary-file' without further + interaction. If you directly press <RET> at the prompt without + typing text, the target file will be shown in another window for + you to finish the entry there. See also the `k r' command. + +`M (`org-agenda-phases-of-moon')' + Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current + date. + +`S (`org-agenda-sunrise-sunset')' + Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be + set with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs + calendar. + +`C (`org-agenda-convert-date')' + Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic + calendars. + +`H (`org-agenda-holidays')' + Show holidays for three months around the cursor date. + +`M-x org-icalendar-combine-agenda-files RET' + Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda + files. This is a globally available command, and also available + in the agenda menu. + +Exporting to a file +................... + +`C-x C-w (`org-agenda-write')' + Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of + the selected file name, the view will be exported as HTML (`.html' + or `.htm'), Postscript (`.ps'), PDF (`.pdf'), Org (`.org') and + plain text (any other extension). When exporting to Org, only the + body of original headlines are exported, not subtrees or inherited + tags. When called with a `C-u' prefix argument, immediately open + the newly created file. Use the variable + `org-agenda-exporter-settings' to set options for `ps-print' and + for `htmlize' to be used during export. + +Quit and Exit +............. + +`q (`org-agenda-quit')' + Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer. + +`x (`org-agenda-exit')' + Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by + Emacs for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the + user to visit Org files will not be removed. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Only tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is +ignored. + + (2) Moving agenda lines does not persist after an agenda refresh and +does not modify the contributing `.org' files + + (3) You can also create persistent custom functions through +`org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions'. + + (4) This file is parsed for the agenda when +`org-agenda-include-diary' is set. + + +File: org, Node: Custom agenda views, Next: Exporting agenda views, Prev: Agenda commands, Up: Agenda views + +10.6 Custom agenda views +======================== + +Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access +frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite +agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the +dispatcher (*note Agenda dispatcher::), just like the default commands. + +* Menu: + +* Storing searches:: Type once, use often +* Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer +* Setting options:: Changing the rules + + +File: org, Node: Storing searches, Next: Block agenda, Up: Custom agenda views + +10.6.1 Storing searches +----------------------- + +The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard +shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda +buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current +buffer). + + Custom commands are configured in the variable +`org-agenda-custom-commands'. You can customize this variable, for +example by pressing `C-c a C'. You can also directly set it with Emacs +Lisp in the Emacs init file. The following example contains all valid +agenda views: + + (setq org-agenda-custom-commands + '(("x" agenda) + ("y" agenda*) + ("w" todo "WAITING") + ("W" todo-tree "WAITING") + ("u" tags "+boss-urgent") + ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent") + ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent") + ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>") + ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix + ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa") + ("hp" tags "+home+Peter") + ("hk" tags "+home+Kim"))) + +The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press +after the dispatcher command `C-c a' in order to access the command. +Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many +similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the +first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a +prefix key(1). The second parameter is the search type, followed by +the string or regular expression to be used for the matching. The +example above will therefore define: + +`C-c a x' + as a global search for agenda entries planned(2) this week/day. + +`C-c a y' + as a global search for agenda entries planned this week/day, but + only those with an hour specification like `[h]h:mm'--think of + them as appointments. + +`C-c a w' + as a global search for TODO entries with `WAITING' as the TODO + keyword + +`C-c a W' + as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying + the results as a sparse tree + +`C-c a u' + as a global tags search for headlines marked `:boss:' but not + `:urgent:' + +`C-c a v' + as the same search as `C-c a u', but limiting the search to + headlines that are also TODO items + +`C-c a U' + as the same search as `C-c a u', but only in the current buffer and + displaying the result as a sparse tree + +`C-c a f' + to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all + entries containing the word `FIXME' + +`C-c a h' + as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press + an additional key (`l', `p' or `k') to select a name (Lisa, Peter, + or Kim) as additional tag to match. + + Note that the `*-tree' agenda views need to be called from an Org +buffer as they operate on the current buffer only. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) You can provide a description for a prefix key by inserting a +cons cell with the prefix and the description. + + (2) _Planned_ means here that these entries have some planning +information attached to them, like a time-stamp, a scheduled or a +deadline string. See `org-agenda-entry-types' on how to set what +planning information will be taken into account. + + +File: org, Node: Block agenda, Next: Setting options, Prev: Storing searches, Up: Custom agenda views + +10.6.2 Block agenda +------------------- + +Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise +the results of _several_ commands, each of which creates a block in the +agenda buffer. The available commands include `agenda' for the daily +or weekly agenda (as created with `C-c a a'), `alltodo' for the global +TODO list (as constructed with `C-c a t'), and the matching commands +discussed above: `todo', `tags', and `tags-todo'. Here are two +examples: + + (setq org-agenda-custom-commands + '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks" + ((agenda "") + (tags-todo "home") + (tags "garden"))) + ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks" + ((agenda "") + (tags-todo "work") + (tags "office"))))) + +This will define `C-c a h' to create a multi-block view for stuff you +need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain +your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag +`home', and also all lines tagged with `garden'. Finally the command +`C-c a o' provides a similar view for office tasks. + + +File: org, Node: Setting options, Prev: Block agenda, Up: Custom agenda views + +10.6.3 Setting options for custom commands +------------------------------------------ + +Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction +and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda +commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change +some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting +options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the +right spot in `org-agenda-custom-commands'. For example: + + (setq org-agenda-custom-commands + '(("w" todo "WAITING" + ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down)) + (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: "))) + ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent" + ((org-show-context-detail 'minimal))) + ("N" search "" + ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org")) + (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil))))) + +Now the `C-c a w' command will sort the collected entries only by +priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say ` Mixed: ' +instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of +`C-c a U' will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the headline +hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match will be +shown. The command `C-c a N' will do a text search limited to only a +single file. + + For command sets creating a block agenda, +`org-agenda-custom-commands' has two separate spots for setting +options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single +command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in +the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter +must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block +agenda example (*note Block agenda::), let's change the sorting strategy +for the `C-c a h' commands to `priority-down', but let's sort the +results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order, `priority-up'. +This would look like this: + + (setq org-agenda-custom-commands + '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks" + ((agenda) + (tags-todo "home") + (tags "garden" + ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up))))) + ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down)))) + ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks" + ((agenda) + (tags-todo "work") + (tags "office"))))) + + As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex. +When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable--it +fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in +this interface, the _values_ are just Lisp expressions. So if the +value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value +yourself. + + To control whether an agenda command should be accessible from a +specific context, you can customize +`org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts'. Let's say for example that you +have an agenda command `"o"' displaying a view that you only need when +reading emails. Then you would configure this option like this: + + (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts + '(("o" (in-mode . "message-mode")))) + + You can also tell that the command key `"o"' should refer to another +command key `"r"'. In that case, add this command key like this: + + (setq org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts + '(("o" "r" (in-mode . "message-mode")))) + + See the docstring of the variable for more information. + + +File: org, Node: Exporting agenda views, Next: Agenda column view, Prev: Custom agenda views, Up: Agenda views + +10.7 Exporting agenda views +=========================== + +If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a +printed version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can +export custom agenda views as plain text, HTML(1), Postscript, PDF(2), +and iCalendar files. If you want to do this only occasionally, use the +command + +`C-x C-w (`org-agenda-write')' + Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of + the selected file name, the view will be exported as HTML + (extension `.html' or `.htm'), Postscript (extension `.ps'), + iCalendar (extension `.ics'), or plain text (any other extension). + Use the variable `org-agenda-exporter-settings' to set options for + `ps-print' and for `htmlize' to be used during export, for example + + (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings + '((ps-number-of-columns 2) + (ps-landscape-mode t) + (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5) + (htmlize-output-type 'css))) + + If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can +associate any custom agenda command with a list of output file names +(3). Here is an example that first defines custom commands for the +agenda and the global TODO list, together with a number of files to +which to export them. Then we define two block agenda commands and +specify file names for them as well. File names can be relative to the +current working directory, or absolute. + + (setq org-agenda-custom-commands + '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps")) + ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps")) + ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks" + ((agenda "") + (tags-todo "home") + (tags "garden")) + nil + ("~/views/home.html")) + ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks" + ((agenda) + (tags-todo "work") + (tags "office")) + nil + ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics")))) + + The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it +is `.html', Org mode will try to use the `htmlize.el' package to +convert the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the +extension is `.ps', `ps-print-buffer-with-faces' is used to produce +Postscript output. If the extension is `.ics', iCalendar export is run +export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and limit +the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other extension +produces a plain ASCII file. + + The export files are _not_ created when you use one of those +commands interactively because this might use too much overhead. +Instead, there is a special command to produce _all_ specified files in +one step: + +`C-c a e (`org-store-agenda-views')' + Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with + them. + + You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also +set options for the export commands. For example: + + (setq org-agenda-custom-commands + '(("X" agenda "" + ((ps-number-of-columns 2) + (ps-landscape-mode t) + (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ") + (org-agenda-with-colors nil) + (org-agenda-remove-tags t)) + ("theagenda.ps")))) + +This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it +print in two columns in landscape format--the resulting page can be cut +in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify +the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and +instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags +to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the +black-and-white printer. Settings specified in +`org-agenda-exporter-settings' will also apply, but the settings in +`org-agenda-custom-commands' take precedence. + +From the command line you may also use + emacs -eval (org-batch-store-agenda-views) -kill + or, if you need to modify some parameters(4) + emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \ + org-agenda-span (quote month) \ + org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \ + org-agenda-include-diary nil \ + org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \ + -kill + which will create the agenda views restricted to the file +`~/org/project.org', without diary entries and with a 30-day extent. + + You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further +processing by other programs. See *note Extracting agenda +information::, for more information. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) You need to install `htmlize.el' from Hrvoje Niksic's +repository. (https://github.com/hniksic/emacs-htmlize) + + (2) To create PDF output, the ghostscript `ps2pdf' utility must be +installed on the system. Selecting a PDF file will also create the +postscript file. + + (3) If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda or +the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for +them in order to be able to specify file names. + + (4) Quoting depends on the system you use, please check the FAQ for +examples. + + +File: org, Node: Agenda column view, Prev: Exporting agenda views, Up: Agenda views + +10.8 Using column view in the agenda +==================================== + +Column view (*note Column view::) is normally used to view and edit +properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It +can be quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where +entries are collected by certain criteria. + +`C-c C-x C-c (`org-agenda-columns')' + Turn on column view in the agenda. + + To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize +that the entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline +environment. This causes the following issues: + + 1. Org needs to make a decision which `COLUMNS' format to use. Since + the entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and + different files may have different `COLUMNS' formats, this is a + non-trivial problem. Org first checks if the variable + `org-agenda-overriding-columns-format' is currently set, and if + so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes the format + associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item + does not have a specific format--defined in a property, or in its + file--it uses `org-columns-default-format'. + + 2. If any of the columns has a summary type defined (*note Column + attributes::), turning on column view in the agenda will visit all + relevant agenda files and make sure that the computations of this + property are up to date. This is also true for the special + `CLOCKSUM' property. Org will then sum the values displayed in + the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will cover a + single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is + vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry + _twice_--for example as scheduled and as a deadline--and it may + show two entries from the same hierarchy--for example a _parent_ + and its _child_. In these cases, the summation in the agenda will + lead to incorrect results because some values will count double. + + 3. When the column view in the agenda shows the `CLOCKSUM', that is + always the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the + daily/weekly agenda, the clocksum listed in column view may + originate from times outside the current view. This has the + advantage that you can compare these values with a column listing + the planned total effort for a task--one of the major applications + for column view in the agenda. If you want information about + clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press + `R' in the agenda). + + 4. When the column view in the agenda shows the `CLOCKSUM_T', that is + always today's clocked time for this item. So even in the weekly + agenda, the clocksum listed in column view only originates from + today. This lets you compare the time you spent on a task for + today, with the time already spent --via `CLOCKSUM'--and with the + planned total effort for it. + + +File: org, Node: Markup, Next: Exporting, Prev: Agenda views, Up: Top + +11 Markup for rich export +************************* + +When exporting Org mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the +structure of the document as accurately as possible in the back-end. +Since export targets like HTML and LaTeX allow much richer formatting, +Org mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This +section summarizes the markup rules used in an Org mode buffer. + +* Menu: + +* Paragraphs:: The basic unit of text +* Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc. +* Horizontal rules:: Make a line +* Images and tables:: Images, tables and caption mechanism +* Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting +* Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols +* Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text +* Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents + + +File: org, Node: Paragraphs, Next: Emphasis and monospace, Up: Markup + +11.1 Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting +========================================= + +Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to +enforce a line break within a paragraph, use `\\' at the end of a line. + + To preserve the line breaks, indentation and blank lines in a +region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you can use this +construct, which can also be used to format poetry. + + #+BEGIN_VERSE + Great clouds overhead + Tiny black birds rise and fall + Snow covers Emacs + + -- AlexSchroeder + #+END_VERSE + + When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to +format this as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the +right margin. You can include quotations in Org mode documents like +this: + + #+BEGIN_QUOTE + Everything should be made as simple as possible, + but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein + #+END_QUOTE + + If you would like to center some text, do it like this: + #+BEGIN_CENTER + Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\ + but not any simpler + #+END_CENTER + + +File: org, Node: Emphasis and monospace, Next: Horizontal rules, Prev: Paragraphs, Up: Markup + +11.2 Emphasis and monospace +=========================== + +You can make words *bold*, /italic/, _underlined_, `=verbatim=' and +`~code~', and, if you must, `+strike-through+'. Text in the code and +verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific syntax, it is +exported verbatim. + + To turn off fontification for marked up text, you can set +`org-fontify-emphasized-text' to `nil'. To narrow down the list of +available markup syntax, you can customize `org-emphasis-alist'. To +fine tune what characters are allowed before and after the markup +characters, you can tweak `org-emphasis-regexp-components'. Beware +that changing one of the above variables will no take effect until you +reload Org, for which you may need to restart Emacs. + + +File: org, Node: Horizontal rules, Next: Images and tables, Prev: Emphasis and monospace, Up: Markup + +11.3 Horizontal rules +===================== + +A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be +exported as a horizontal line. + + +File: org, Node: Images and tables, Next: Literal examples, Prev: Horizontal rules, Up: Markup + +11.4 Images and Tables +====================== + +Both the native Org mode tables (*note Tables::) and tables formatted +with the `table.el' package will be exported properly. For Org mode +tables, the lines before the first horizontal separator line will +become table header lines. You can use the following lines somewhere +before the table to assign a caption and a label for cross references, +and in the text you can refer to the object with `[[tab:basic-data]]' +(*note Internal links::): + + #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link) + #+NAME: tab:basic-data + | ... | ...| + |-----|----| + + Optionally, the caption can take the form: + #+CAPTION[Caption for list of tables]: Caption for table. + + Some back-ends allow you to directly include images into the exported +document. Org does this, if a link to an image files does not have a +description part, for example `[[./img/a.jpg]]'. If you wish to define +a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal cross +references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede +it with `#+CAPTION' and `#+NAME' as follows: + + #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table) + #+NAME: fig:SED-HR4049 + [[./img/a.jpg]] + +Such images can be displayed within the buffer. *Note the discussion +of image links: Handling links. + + Even though images and tables are prominent examples of captioned +structures, the same caption mechanism can apply to many others (e.g., +LaTeX equations, source code blocks). Depending on the export +back-end, those may or may not be handled. + + +File: org, Node: Literal examples, Next: Special symbols, Prev: Images and tables, Up: Markup + +11.5 Literal examples +===================== + +You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to +markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well +suited for source code and similar examples. + + #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE + Some example from a text file. + #+END_EXAMPLE + + Note that such blocks may be indented in order to align nicely with +indented text and in particular with plain list structure (*note Plain +lists::). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start +the example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be +additional whitespace before the colon: + + Here is an example + : Some example from a text file. + + If the example is source code from a programming language, or any +other text that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for +the example to look like the fontified Emacs buffer(1). This is done +with the `src' block, where you also need to specify the name of the +major mode that should be used to fontify the example(2), see *note +Easy templates:: for shortcuts to easily insert code blocks. + + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp + (defun org-xor (a b) + "Exclusive or." + (if a (not b) b)) + #+END_SRC + + Both in `example' and in `src' snippets, you can add a `-n' switch +to the end of the `BEGIN' line, to get the lines of the example +numbered. The `-n' takes an optional numeric argument specifying the +starting line number of the block. If you use a `+n' switch, the +numbering from the previous numbered snippet will be continued in the +current one. The `+n' can also take a numeric argument. The value of +the argument will be added to the last line of the previous block to +determine the starting line number. + + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n 20 + ;; this will export with line number 20 + (message "This is line 21") + #+END_SRC + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp +n 10 + ;; This will be listed as line 31 + (message "This is line 32") + #+END_SRC + + In literal examples, Org will interpret strings like `(ref:name)' as +labels, and use them as targets for special hyperlinks like `[[(name)]]' +(i.e., the reference name enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, +hovering the mouse over such a link will remote-highlight the +corresponding code line, which is kind of cool. + + You can also add a `-r' switch which removes the labels from the +source code(3). With the `-n' switch, links to these references will +be labeled by the line numbers from the code listing, otherwise links +will use the labels with no parentheses. Here is an example: + + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r + (save-excursion (ref:sc) + (goto-char (point-min))) (ref:jump) + #+END_SRC + In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]] + jumps to point-min. + + Finally, you can use `-i' to preserve the indentation of a specific +code block (*note Editing source code::). + + If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language +syntax, use a `-l' switch to change the format, for example +`#+BEGIN_SRC pascal -n -r -l "((%s))"'. See also the variable +`org-coderef-label-format'. + + HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas +(*note Text areas in HTML export::). + + Because the `#+BEGIN_...' and `#+END_...' patterns need to be added +so often, shortcuts are provided using the Easy templates facility +(*note Easy templates::). + +`C-c '' + Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This + works by switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. + You need to exit by pressing `C-c '' again(4). The edited version + will then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width + regions (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) + will be edited using `artist-mode'(5) to allow creating ASCII + drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create + a new fixed-width region. + +`C-c l' + Calling `org-store-link' while editing a source code example in a + temporary buffer created with `C-c '' will prompt for a label. + Make sure that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it + with the proper formatting like `(ref:label)' at the end of the + current line. Then the label is stored as a link `(label)', for + retrieval with `C-c C-l'. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) This works automatically for the HTML back-end (it requires +version 1.34 of the `htmlize.el' package, which you need to install). +Fontified code chunks in LaTeX can be achieved using either the +listings +(https://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/macros/latex/contrib/listings/?lang=en) +or the minted (https://github.com/gpoore/minted) package. If you use +minted or listing, you must load the packages manually, for example by +adding the desired package to `org-latex-packages-alist'. Refer to +`org-latex-listings' for details. + + (2) Code in `src' blocks may also be evaluated either interactively +or on export. *Note Working with source code::, for more information +on evaluating code blocks. + + (3) Adding `-k' to `-n -r' will keep the labels in the source code +while using line numbers for the links, which might be useful to +explain those in an Org mode example code. + + (4) Upon exit, lines starting with `*', `,*', `#+' and `,#+' will +get a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted by Org as +outline nodes or special syntax. These commas will be stripped for +editing with `C-c '', and also for export. + + (5) You may select a different-mode with the variable +`org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode'. + + +File: org, Node: Special symbols, Next: Subscripts and superscripts, Prev: Literal examples, Up: Markup + +11.6 Special symbols +==================== + +You can use LaTeX-like syntax to insert special symbols--named +entities--like `\alpha' to indicate the Greek letter, or `\to' to +indicate an arrow. Completion for these symbols is available, just type +`\' and maybe a few letters, and press `M-<TAB>' to see possible +completions. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it with +a pair of curly brackets. For example + + Pro tip: Given a circle \Gamma of diameter d, the length of its circumference + is \pi{}d. + + A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both +HTML and LaTeX; you can comfortably browse the complete list from a +dedicated buffer using the command `org-entities-help'. It is also +possible to provide your own special symbols in the variable +`org-entities-user'. + + During export, these symbols are transformed into the native format +of the exporter back-end. Strings like `\alpha' are exported as +`α' in the HTML output, and as `\(\alpha\)' in the LaTeX output. +Similarly, `\nbsp' becomes ` ' in HTML and `~' in LaTeX. + + Entities may also be used as a may to escape markup in an Org +document, e.g., `\under{}not underlined\under' exports as `_not +underlined_'. + + If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF-8 characters, use +the following command(1): + +`C-c C-x \' + Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not + change the buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it + overlays the UTF-8 character for display purposes only. + + In addition to regular entities defined above, Org exports in a +special way(2) the following commonly used character combinations: `\-' +is treated as a shy hyphen, `--' and `---' are converted into dashes, +and `...' becomes a compact set of dots. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) You can turn this on by default by setting the variable +`org-pretty-entities', or on a per-file base with the `#+STARTUP' +option `entitiespretty'. + + (2) This behaviour can be disabled with `-' export setting (*note +Export settings::). + + +File: org, Node: Subscripts and superscripts, Next: Embedded LaTeX, Prev: Special symbols, Up: Markup + +11.7 Subscripts and superscripts +================================ + +`^' and `_' are used to indicate super- and subscripts. To increase +the readability of ASCII text, it is not necessary--but OK--to surround +multi-character sub- and superscripts with curly braces. Those are, +however, mandatory, when more than one word is involved. For example + + The radius of the sun is R_sun = 6.96 x 10^8 m. On the other hand, the + radius of Alpha Centauri is R_{Alpha Centauri} = 1.28 x R_{sun}. + + If you write a text where the underscore is often used in a different +context, Org's convention to always interpret these as subscripts can +get in your way. Configure the variable `org-use-sub-superscripts' to +change this convention. For example, when setting this variable to +`{}', `a_b' will not be interpreted as a subscript, but `a_{b}' will. + +`C-c C-x \' + In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command + will also format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way. + + +File: org, Node: Embedded LaTeX, Prev: Subscripts and superscripts, Up: Markup + +11.8 Embedded LaTeX +=================== + +Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. +Exceptions include scientific notes, which often require mathematical +symbols and the occasional formula. LaTeX(1) is widely used to +typeset scientific documents. Org mode supports embedding LaTeX code +into its files, because many academics are used to writing and reading +LaTeX source code, and because it can be readily processed to produce +pretty output for a number of export back-ends. + +* Menu: + +* LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy +* Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like? +* CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) LaTeX is a macro system based on Donald E. Knuth's TeX system. +Many of the features described here as "LaTeX" are really from TeX, but +for simplicity I am blurring this distinction. + + +File: org, Node: LaTeX fragments, Next: Previewing LaTeX fragments, Up: Embedded LaTeX + +11.8.1 LaTeX fragments +---------------------- + +Org mode can contain LaTeX math fragments, and it supports ways to +process these for several export back-ends. When exporting to LaTeX, +the code is left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org can use either +MathJax (http://www.mathjax.org) (*note Math formatting in HTML +export::) or transcode the math into images (see *note Previewing LaTeX +fragments::). + + LaTeX fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following +snippets will be identified as LaTeX source code: + * Environments of any kind(1). The only requirement is that the + `\begin' statement appears on a new line, at the beginning of the + line or after whitespaces only. + + * Text within the usual LaTeX math delimiters. To avoid conflicts + with currency specifications, single `$' characters are only + recognized as math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at + most two line breaks, is directly attached to the `$' characters + with no whitespace in between, and if the closing `$' is followed + by whitespace or punctuation (parentheses and quotes are + considered to be punctuation in this context). For the other + delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use + `\(...\)' as inline math delimiters. + +For example: + + \begin{equation} + x=\sqrt{b} + \end{equation} + + If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be + either $$ a=+\sqrt{2} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt{2} \]. + + LaTeX processing can be configured with the variable +`org-export-with-latex'. The default setting is `t' which means +MathJax for HTML, and no processing for ASCII and LaTeX back-ends. You +can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one of these lines: + + #+OPTIONS: tex:t Do the right thing automatically (MathJax) + #+OPTIONS: tex:nil Do not process LaTeX fragments at all + #+OPTIONS: tex:verbatim Verbatim export, for jsMath or so + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) When MathJax is used, only the environments recognized by +MathJax will be processed. When `dvipng' program, `dvisvgm' program or +`imagemagick' suite is used to create images, any LaTeX environment +will be handled. + + +File: org, Node: Previewing LaTeX fragments, Next: CDLaTeX mode, Prev: LaTeX fragments, Up: Embedded LaTeX + +11.8.2 Previewing LaTeX fragments +--------------------------------- + +If you have a working LaTeX installation and `dvipng', `dvisvgm' or +`convert' installed(1), LaTeX fragments can be processed to produce +images of the typeset expressions to be used for inclusion while +exporting to HTML (see *note LaTeX fragments::), or for inline +previewing within Org mode. + + You can customize the variables `org-format-latex-options' and +`org-format-latex-header' to influence some aspects of the preview. In +particular, the `:scale' (and for HTML export, `:html-scale') property +of the former can be used to adjust the size of the preview images. + +`C-c C-x C-l' + Produce a preview image of the LaTeX fragment at point and overlay + it over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, + process all fragments in the current entry (between two + headlines). When called with a prefix argument, process the + entire subtree. When called with two prefix arguments, or when + the cursor is before the first headline, process the entire buffer. + +`C-c C-c' + Remove the overlay preview images. + + You can turn on the previewing of all LaTeX fragments in a file with + + #+STARTUP: latexpreview + + To disable it, simply use + + #+STARTUP: nolatexpreview + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) These are respectively available at +`http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/', `http://dvisvgm.bplaced.net/' +and from the `imagemagick' suite. Choose the converter by setting the +variable `org-preview-latex-default-process' accordingly. + + +File: org, Node: CDLaTeX mode, Prev: Previewing LaTeX fragments, Up: Embedded LaTeX + +11.8.3 Using CDLaTeX to enter math +---------------------------------- + +CDLaTeX mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a +major LaTeX mode like AUCTeX in order to speed-up insertion of +environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of +some of the features of CDLaTeX mode. You need to install `cdlatex.el' +and `texmathp.el' (the latter comes also with AUCTeX) from +`https://staff.fnwi.uva.nl/c.dominik/Tools/cdlatex'. Don't use CDLaTeX +mode itself under Org mode, but use the light version +`org-cdlatex-mode' that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it on for the +current buffer with `M-x org-cdlatex-mode RET', or for all Org files +with + + (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex) + + When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for +more details see the documentation of CDLaTeX mode): + * Environment templates can be inserted with `C-c {'. + + * The <TAB> key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a + LaTeX fragment(1). For example, <TAB> will expand `fr' to + `\frac{}{}' and position the cursor correctly inside the first + brace. Another <TAB> will get you into the second brace. Even + outside fragments, <TAB> will expand environment abbreviations at + the beginning of a line. For example, if you write `equ' at the + beginning of a line and press <TAB>, this abbreviation will be + expanded to an `equation' environment. To get a list of all + abbreviations, type `M-x cdlatex-command-help RET'. + + * Pressing `_' and `^' inside a LaTeX fragment will insert these + characters together with a pair of braces. If you use <TAB> to + move out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single + character or macro, they are removed again (depending on the + variable `cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts'). + + * Pressing the grave accent ``' followed by a character inserts math + macros, also outside LaTeX fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 + seconds after the grave accent, a help window will pop up. + + * Pressing the apostrophe `'' followed by another character modifies + the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait + more than 1.5 seconds after the apostrophe, a help window will pop + up. Character modification will work only inside LaTeX fragments; + outside the quote is normal. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is inside such a +fragment, see the documentation of the function +`org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p'. + + +File: org, Node: Exporting, Next: Publishing, Prev: Markup, Up: Top + +12 Exporting +************ + +Sometimes, you may want to pretty print your notes, publish them on the +web or even share them with people not using Org. In these cases, the +Org export facilities can be used to convert your documents to a +variety of other formats, while retaining as much structure (*note +Document structure::) and markup (*note Markup::) as possible. + + Libraries responsible for such translation are called back-ends. +Org ships with the following ones + + * ascii (ASCII format) + + * beamer (LaTeX Beamer format) + + * html (HTML format) + + * icalendar (iCalendar format) + + * latex (LaTeX format) + + * md (Markdown format) + + * odt (OpenDocument Text format) + + * org (Org format) + + * texinfo (Texinfo format) + + * man (Man page format) + +Org also uses additional libraries located in `contrib/' directory +(*note Installation::). Users can install additional export libraries +for additional formats from the Emacs packaging system. For easy +discovery, these packages have a common naming scheme: `ox-NAME', where +NAME is one of the formats. For example, `ox-koma-letter' for +`koma-letter' back-end. + + Org loads back-ends for the following formats by default: `ascii', +`html', `icalendar', `latex' and `odt'. + + Org can load additional back-ends either of two ways: through the +`org-export-backends' variable configuration; or, by requiring the +library in the Emacs init file like this: + + (require 'ox-md) + +* Menu: + +* The export dispatcher:: The main interface +* Export settings:: Common export settings +* Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents +* Include files:: Include additional files into a document +* Macro replacement:: Use macros to create templates +* Comment lines:: What will not be exported +* ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding +* Beamer export:: Exporting as a Beamer presentation +* HTML export:: Exporting to HTML +* LaTeX export:: Exporting to LaTeX, and processing to PDF +* Markdown export:: Exporting to Markdown +* OpenDocument Text export:: Exporting to OpenDocument Text +* Org export:: Exporting to Org +* Texinfo export:: Exporting to Texinfo +* iCalendar export:: Exporting to iCalendar +* Other built-in back-ends:: Exporting to a man page +* Advanced configuration:: Fine-tuning the export output +* Export in foreign buffers:: Author tables and lists in Org syntax + + +File: org, Node: The export dispatcher, Next: Export settings, Up: Exporting + +12.1 The export dispatcher +========================== + +The export dispatcher is the main interface for Org's exports. A +hierarchical menu presents the currently configured export formats. +Options are shown as easy toggle switches on the same screen. + + Org also has a minimal prompt interface for the export dispatcher. +When the variable `org-export-dispatch-use-expert-ui' is set to a +non-`nil' value, Org prompts in the minibuffer. To switch back to the +hierarchical menu, press <?>. + +`C-c C-e' (`org-export-dispatch') + Invokes the export dispatcher interface. The options show default + settings. The `C-u' prefix argument preserves options from the + previous export, including any sub-tree selections. + + + Org exports the entire buffer by default. If the Org buffer has an +active region, then Org exports just that region. + + These are the export options, the key combinations that toggle them +(*note Export settings::): + +`C-a' + Toggles asynchronous export. Asynchronous export uses an external + Emacs process with a specially configured initialization file to + complete the exporting process in the background thereby releasing + the current interface. This is particularly useful when exporting + long documents. + + Output from an asynchronous export is saved on the "the export + stack". To view this stack, call the export dispatcher with a + double `C-u' prefix argument. If already in the export dispatcher + menu, `&' displays the stack. + + To make the background export process the default, customize the + variable, `org-export-in-background'. + +`C-b' + Toggle body-only export. Useful for excluding headers and footers + in the export. Affects only those back-end formats that have such + sections--like `<head>...</head>' in HTML. + +`C-s' + Toggle sub-tree export. When turned on, Org exports only the + sub-tree starting from the cursor position at the time the export + dispatcher was invoked. Org uses the top heading of this sub-tree + as the document's title. If the cursor is not on a heading, Org + uses the nearest enclosing header. If the cursor is in the + document preamble, Org signals an error and aborts export. + + To make the sub-tree export the default, customize the variable, + `org-export-initial-scope'. + +`C-v' + Toggle visible-only export. Useful for exporting only visible + parts of an Org document by adjusting outline visibility settings. + + +File: org, Node: Export settings, Next: Table of contents, Prev: The export dispatcher, Up: Exporting + +12.2 Export settings +==================== + +Export options can be set: globally with variables; for an individual +file by making variables buffer-local with in-buffer settings (*note +In-buffer settings::), by setting individual keywords, or by specifying +them in a compact form with the `#+OPTIONS' keyword; or for a tree by +setting properties (*note Properties and columns::). Options set at a +specific level override options set at a more general level. + + In-buffer settings may appear anywhere in the file, either directly +or indirectly through a file included using `#+SETUPFILE: filename or +URL' syntax. Option keyword sets tailored to a particular back-end can +be inserted from the export dispatcher (*note The export dispatcher::) +using the `Insert template' command by pressing <#>. To insert keywords +individually, a good way to make sure the keyword is correct is to type +`#+' and then to use `M-<TAB>'(1) for completion. + + The export keywords available for every back-end, and their +equivalent global variables, include: + +`AUTHOR' + The document author (`user-full-name'). + +`CREATOR' + Entity responsible for output generation + (`org-export-creator-string'). + +`DATE' + A date or a time-stamp(2). + +`EMAIL' + The email address (`user-mail-address'). + +`LANGUAGE' + Language to use for translating certain strings + (`org-export-default-language'). With `#+LANGUAGE: fr', for + example, Org translates _Table of contents_ to the French _Table + des matières_. + +`SELECT_TAGS' + The default value is `:export:'. When a tree is tagged with + `:export:' (`org-export-select-tags'), Org selects that tree and + its sub-trees for export. Org excludes trees with `:noexport:' + tags, see below. When selectively exporting files with `:export:' + tags set, Org does not export any text that appears before the + first headline. + +`EXCLUDE_TAGS' + The default value is `:noexport:'. When a tree is tagged with + `:noexport:' (`org-export-exclude-tags'), Org excludes that tree + and its sub-trees from export. Entries tagged with `:noexport:' + will be unconditionally excluded from the export, even if they + have an `:export:' tag. Even if a sub-tree is not exported, Org + will execute any code blocks contained in them. + +`TITLE' + Org displays this title. For long titles, use multiple `#+TITLE' + lines. + +`EXPORT_FILE_NAME' + The name of the output file to be generated. Otherwise, Org + generates the file name based on the buffer name and the extension + based on the back-end format. + + The `#+OPTIONS' keyword is a compact form. To configure multiple +options, use several `#+OPTIONS' lines. `#+OPTIONS' recognizes the +following arguments. + +`':' + Toggle smart quotes (`org-export-with-smart-quotes'). Depending + on the language used, when activated, Org treats pairs of double + quotes as primary quotes, pairs of single quotes as secondary + quotes, and single quote marks as apostrophes. + +`*:' + Toggle emphasized text (`org-export-with-emphasize'). + +`-:' + Toggle conversion of special strings + (`org-export-with-special-strings'). + +`::' + Toggle fixed-width sections (`org-export-with-fixed-width'). + +`<:' + Toggle inclusion of time/date active/inactive stamps + (`org-export-with-timestamps'). + +`\n:' + Toggles whether to preserve line breaks + (`org-export-preserve-breaks'). + +`^:' + Toggle TeX-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If you write + "^:{}", `a_{b}' will be interpreted, but the simple `a_b' will be + left as it is (`org-export-with-sub-superscripts'). + +`arch:' + Configure how archived trees are exported. When set to + `headline', the export process skips the contents and processes + only the headlines (`org-export-with-archived-trees'). + +`author:' + Toggle inclusion of author name into exported file + (`org-export-with-author'). + +`broken-links:' + Toggles if Org should continue exporting upon finding a broken + internal link. When set to `mark', Org clearly marks the problem + link in the output (`org-export-with-broken-links'). + +`c:' + Toggle inclusion of CLOCK keywords (`org-export-with-clocks'). + +`creator:' + Toggle inclusion of creator information in the exported file + (`org-export-with-creator'). + +`d:' + Toggles inclusion of drawers, or list of drawers to include, or + list of drawers to exclude (`org-export-with-drawers'). + +`date:' + Toggle inclusion of a date into exported file + (`org-export-with-date'). + +`e:' + Toggle inclusion of entities (`org-export-with-entities'). + +`email:' + Toggle inclusion of the author's e-mail into exported file + (`org-export-with-email'). + +`f:' + Toggle the inclusion of footnotes (`org-export-with-footnotes'). + +`H:' + Set the number of headline levels for export + (`org-export-headline-levels'). Below that level, headlines are + treated differently. In most back-ends, they become list items. + +`inline:' + Toggle inclusion of inlinetasks (`org-export-with-inlinetasks'). + +`num:' + Toggle section-numbers (`org-export-with-section-numbers'). When + set to number `n', Org numbers only those headlines at level `n' + or above. Setting `UNNUMBERED' property to non-`nil' disables + numbering of a heading. Since subheadings inherit from this + property, it affects their numbering, too. + +`p:' + Toggle export of planning information (`org-export-with-planning'). + "Planning information" comes from lines located right after the + headline and contain any combination of these cookies: + `SCHEDULED:', `DEADLINE:', or `CLOSED:'. + +`pri:' + Toggle inclusion of priority cookies (`org-export-with-priority'). + +`prop:' + Toggle inclusion of property drawers, or list the properties to + include (`org-export-with-properties'). + +`stat:' + Toggle inclusion of statistics cookies + (`org-export-with-statistics-cookies'). + +`tags:' + Toggle inclusion of tags, may also be `not-in-toc' + (`org-export-with-tags'). + +`tasks:' + Toggle inclusion of tasks (TODO items); or `nil' to remove all + tasks; or `todo' to remove DONE tasks; or list the keywords to keep + (`org-export-with-tasks'). + +`tex:' + `nil' does not export; `t' exports; `verbatim' keeps everything in + verbatim (`org-export-with-latex'). + +`timestamp:' + Toggle inclusion of the creation time in the exported file + (`org-export-time-stamp-file'). + +`title:' + Toggle inclusion of title (`org-export-with-title'). + +`toc:' + Toggle inclusion of the table of contents, or set the level limit + (`org-export-with-toc'). + +`todo:' + Toggle inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text + (`org-export-with-todo-keywords'). + +`|:' + Toggle inclusion of tables (`org-export-with-tables'). + + + When exporting sub-trees, special node properties in them can +override the above keywords. They are special because they have an +`EXPORT_' prefix. For example, `DATE' and `EXPORT_FILE_NAME' keywords +become, respectively, `EXPORT_DATE' and `EXPORT_FILE_NAME'. Except for +`SETUPFILE', all other keywords listed above have an `EXPORT_' +equivalent. + + If `org-export-allow-bind-keywords' is non-`nil', Emacs variables +can become buffer-local during export by using the BIND keyword. Its +syntax is `#+BIND: variable value'. This is particularly useful for +in-buffer settings that cannot be changed using keywords. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Many desktops intercept `M-TAB' to switch windows. Use `C-M-i' +or `<ESC> <TAB>' instead. + + (2) The variable `org-export-date-timestamp-format' defines how this +time-stamp will be exported. + + +File: org, Node: Table of contents, Next: Include files, Prev: Export settings, Up: Exporting + +12.3 Table of contents +====================== + +Org normally inserts the table of contents directly before the first +headline of the file. Org sets the TOC depth the same as the headline +levels in the file. Use a lower number for lower TOC depth. To turn +off TOC entirely, use `nil'. This is configured in the +`org-export-with-toc' variable or as keywords in an Org file as: + + #+OPTIONS: toc:2 only include two levels in TOC + #+OPTIONS: toc:nil no default TOC at all + + To move the table of contents to a different location, first turn +off the default with `org-export-with-toc' variable or with `#+OPTIONS: +toc:nil'. Then insert `#+TOC: headlines N' at the desired location(s). + + #+OPTIONS: toc:nil no default TOC + ... + #+TOC: headlines 2 insert TOC here, with two headline levels + + To adjust the TOC depth for a specific section of the Org document, +append an additional `local' parameter. This parameter becomes a +relative depth for the current level. + + Note that for this feature to work properly in LaTeX export, the Org +file requires the inclusion of the `titletoc' package. Because of +compatibility issues, `titletoc' has to be loaded _before_ `hyperref'. +Customize the `org-latex-default-packages-alist' variable. + + * Section #+TOC: headlines 1 local insert local TOC, with direct children + only + + Use the `TOC' keyword to generate list of tables (resp. all listings) +with captions. + + #+TOC: listings build a list of listings + #+TOC: tables build a list of tables + + Normally Org uses the headline for its entry in the table of +contents. But with `ALT_TITLE' property, a different entry can be +specified for the table of contents. + + +File: org, Node: Include files, Next: Macro replacement, Prev: Table of contents, Up: Exporting + +12.4 Include files +================== + +Include other files during export. For example, to include your +`.emacs' file, you could use: + + #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp + +The first parameter is the file name to include. The optional second +parameter specifies the block type: `example', `export' or `src'. The +optional third parameter specifies the source code language to use for +formatting the contents. This is relevant to both `export' and `src' +block types. + + If an include file is specified as having a markup language, Org +neither checks for valid syntax nor changes the contents in any way. +For `example' and `src' blocks, Org code-escapes the contents before +inclusion. + + If an include file is not specified as having any markup language, +Org assumes it be in Org format and proceeds as usual with a few +exceptions. Org makes the footnote labels (*note Footnotes::) in the +included file local to that file. The contents of the included file +will belong to the same structure--headline, item--containing the +`INCLUDE' keyword. In particular, headlines within the file will +become children of the current section. That behavior can be changed +by providing an additional keyword parameter, `:minlevel'. It shifts +the headlines in the included file to become the lowest level. For +example, this syntax makes the included file a sibling of the current +top-level headline: + + #+INCLUDE: "~/my-book/chapter2.org" :minlevel 1 + + Inclusion of only portions of files are specified using ranges +parameter with `:lines' keyword. The line at the upper end of the +range will not be included. The start and/or the end of the range may +be omitted to use the obvious defaults. + + #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10" Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded + #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10" Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded + #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-" Include lines from 10 to EOF + + Inclusions may specify a file-link to extract an object matched by +`org-link-search'(1) (*note Search options::). + + To extract only the contents of the matched object, set +`:only-contents' property to non-`nil'. This will omit any planning +lines or property drawers. The ranges for `:lines' keyword are +relative to the requested element. Some examples: + + #+INCLUDE: "./paper.org::#theory" :only-contents t + Include the body of the heading with the custom id `theory' + #+INCLUDE: "./paper.org::mytable" Include named element. + #+INCLUDE: "./paper.org::*conclusion" :lines 1-20 + Include the first 20 lines of the headline named `conclusion'. + +`C-c '' + Visit the include file at point. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Note that `org-link-search-must-match-exact-headline' is locally +bound to non-`nil'. Therefore, `org-link-search' only matches +headlines and named elements. + + +File: org, Node: Macro replacement, Next: Comment lines, Prev: Include files, Up: Exporting + +12.5 Macro replacement +====================== + +Macros replace text snippets during export. Macros are defined +globally in `org-export-global-macros', or document-wise with the +following syntax: + + #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments + +which can be referenced using `{{{name(arg1, arg2)}}}'(1). + + Org recognizes macro references in following Org markup areas: +paragraphs, headlines, verse blocks, tables cells and lists. Org also +recognizes macro references in keywords, such as `#+CAPTION', `#+TITLE', +`#+AUTHOR', `#+DATE', and for some back-end specific export options. + + Org comes with following pre-defined macros: + +`{{{title}}}' +`{{{author}}}' +`{{{email}}}' + Org replaces these macro references with available information at + the time of export. + +`{{{date}}}' +`{{{date(FORMAT)}}}' + This macro refers to the `#+DATE' keyword. FORMAT is an optional + argument to the `{{{date}}}' macro that will be used only if + `#+DATE' is a single timestamp. FORMAT should be a format string + understood by `format-time-string'. + +`{{{time(FORMAT)}}}' +`{{{modification-time(FORMAT, VC)}}}' + These macros refer to the document's date and time of export and + date and time of modification. FORMAT is a string understood by + `format-time-string'. If the second argument to the + `modification-time' macro is non-`nil', Org uses `vc.el' to + retrieve the document's modification time from the version control + system. Otherwise Org reads the file attributes. + +`{{{input-file}}}' + This macro refers to the filename of the exported file. + +`{{{property(PROPERTY-NAME)}}}' +`{{{property(PROPERTY-NAME,SEARCH-OPTION)}}}' + This macro returns the value of property PROPERTY-NAME in the + current entry. If SEARCH-OPTION (*note Search options::) refers + to a remote entry, that will be used instead. + +`{{{n}}}' +`{{{n(NAME)}}}' +`{{{n(NAME,ACTION)}}}' + This macro implements custom counters by returning the number of + times the macro has been expanded so far while exporting the + buffer. You can create more than one counter using different NAME + values. If ACTION is `-', previous value of the counter is held, + i.e. the specified counter is not incremented. If the value is a + number, the specified counter is set to that value. If it is any + other non-empty string, the specified counter is reset to 1. You + may leave NAME empty to reset the default counter. + + The surrounding brackets can be made invisible by setting +`org-hide-macro-markers' non-`nil'. + + Org expands macros at the very beginning of the export process. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Since commas separate the arguments, commas within arguments +have to be escaped with the backslash character. So only those +backslash characters before a comma need escaping with another +backslash character. + + +File: org, Node: Comment lines, Next: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Prev: Macro replacement, Up: Exporting + +12.6 Comment lines +================== + +Lines starting with zero or more whitespace characters followed by one +`#' and a whitespace are treated as comments and, as such, are not +exported. + + Likewise, regions surrounded by `#+BEGIN_COMMENT' ... +`#+END_COMMENT' are not exported. + + Finally, a `COMMENT' keyword at the beginning of an entry, but after +any other keyword or priority cookie, comments out the entire subtree. +In this case, the subtree is not exported and no code block within it +is executed either(1). The command below helps changing the comment +status of a headline. + +`C-c ;' + Toggle the `COMMENT' keyword at the beginning of an entry. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) For a less drastic behavior, consider using a select tag (*note +Export settings::) instead. + + +File: org, Node: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Next: Beamer export, Prev: Comment lines, Up: Exporting + +12.7 ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export +=============================== + +ASCII export produces an output file containing only plain ASCII +characters. This is the most simplest and direct text output. It does +not contain any Org markup either. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export use +additional characters and symbols available in these encoding +standards. All three of these export formats offer the most basic of +text output for maximum portability. + + On export, Org fills and justifies text according to the text width +set in `org-ascii-text-width'. + + Org exports links using a footnote-like style where the descriptive +part is in the text and the link is in a note before the next heading. +See the variable `org-ascii-links-to-notes' for details. + +ASCII export commands +--------------------- + +`C-c C-e t a/l/u (`org-ascii-export-to-ascii')' + Export as an ASCII file with a `.txt' extension. For `myfile.org', + Org exports to `myfile.txt', overwriting without warning. For + `myfile.txt', Org exports to `myfile.txt.txt' in order to prevent + data loss. + +`C-c C-e t A/L/U (`org-ascii-export-as-ascii')' + Export to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file. + +ASCII specific export settings +------------------------------ + +The ASCII export back-end has one extra keyword for customizing ASCII +output. Setting this keyword works similar to the general options +(*note Export settings::). + +`SUBTITLE' + The document subtitle. For long subtitles, use multiple + `#+SUBTITLE' lines in the Org file. Org prints them on one + continuous line, wrapping into multiple lines if necessary. + +Header and sectioning structure +------------------------------- + +Org converts the first three outline levels into headlines for ASCII +export. The remaining levels are turned into lists. To change this +cut-off point where levels become lists, *note Export settings::. + +Quoting ASCII text +------------------ + +To insert text within the Org file by the ASCII back-end, use one the +following constructs, inline, keyword, or export block: + + Inline text @@ascii:and additional text@@ within a paragraph. + + #+ASCII: Some text + + #+BEGIN_EXPORT ascii + Org exports text in this block only when using ASCII back-end. + #+END_EXPORT + +ASCII specific attributes +------------------------- + +ASCII back-end recognizes only one attribute, `:width', which specifies +the width of an horizontal rule in number of characters. The keyword +and syntax for specifying widths is: + + #+ATTR_ASCII: :width 10 + ----- + +ASCII special blocks +-------------------- + +Besides `#+BEGIN_CENTER' blocks (*note Paragraphs::), ASCII back-end has +these two left and right justification blocks: + + #+BEGIN_JUSTIFYLEFT + It's just a jump to the left... + #+END_JUSTIFYLEFT + + #+BEGIN_JUSTIFYRIGHT + ...and then a step to the right. + #+END_JUSTIFYRIGHT + + +File: org, Node: Beamer export, Next: HTML export, Prev: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Up: Exporting + +12.8 Beamer export +================== + +Org uses _Beamer_ export to convert an Org file tree structure into a +high-quality interactive slides for presentations. _Beamer_ is a LaTeX +document class for creating presentations in PDF, HTML, and other +popular display formats. + +* Menu: + +* Beamer export commands:: For creating Beamer documents. +* Beamer specific export settings:: For customizing Beamer export. +* Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer:: For composing Beamer slides. +* Beamer specific syntax:: For using in Org documents. +* Editing support:: For using helper functions. +* A Beamer example:: A complete presentation. + + +File: org, Node: Beamer export commands, Next: Beamer specific export settings, Up: Beamer export + +12.8.1 Beamer export commands +----------------------------- + +`C-c C-e l b (`org-beamer-export-to-latex')' + Export as LaTeX file with a `.tex' extension. For `myfile.org', + Org exports to `myfile.tex', overwriting without warning. + +`C-c C-e l B (`org-beamer-export-as-latex')' + Export to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file. + +`C-c C-e l P (`org-beamer-export-to-pdf')' + Export as LaTeX file and then convert it to PDF format. + +`C-c C-e l O' + Export as LaTeX file, convert it to PDF format, and then open the + PDF file. + + +File: org, Node: Beamer specific export settings, Next: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer, Prev: Beamer export commands, Up: Beamer export + +12.8.2 Beamer specific export settings +-------------------------------------- + +Beamer export back-end has several additional keywords for customizing +Beamer output. These keywords work similar to the general options +settings (*note Export settings::). + +`BEAMER_THEME' + The Beamer layout theme (`org-beamer-theme'). Use square brackets + for options. For example: + #+BEAMER_THEME: Rochester [height=20pt] + +`BEAMER_FONT_THEME' + The Beamer font theme. + +`BEAMER_INNER_THEME' + The Beamer inner theme. + +`BEAMER_OUTER_THEME' + The Beamer outer theme. + +`BEAMER_HEADER' + Arbitrary lines inserted in the preamble, just before the + `hyperref' settings. + +`DESCRIPTION' + The document description. For long descriptions, use multiple + `#+DESCRIPTION' keywords. By default, `hyperref' inserts + `#+DESCRIPTION' as metadata. Use `org-latex-hyperref-template' to + configure document metadata. Use `org-latex-title-command' to + configure typesetting of description as part of front matter. + +`KEYWORDS' + The keywords for defining the contents of the document. Use + multiple `#+KEYWORDS' lines if necessary. By default, `hyperref' + inserts `#+KEYWORDS' as metadata. Use + `org-latex-hyperref-template' to configure document metadata. Use + `org-latex-title-command' to configure typesetting of keywords as + part of front matter. + +`SUBTITLE' + Document's subtitle. For typesetting, use + `org-beamer-subtitle-format' string. Use + `org-latex-hyperref-template' to configure document metadata. Use + `org-latex-title-command' to configure typesetting of subtitle as + part of front matter. + + +File: org, Node: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer, Next: Beamer specific syntax, Prev: Beamer specific export settings, Up: Beamer export + +12.8.3 Sectioning, Frames and Blocks in Beamer +---------------------------------------------- + +Org transforms heading levels into Beamer's sectioning elements, frames +and blocks. Any Org tree with a not-too-deep-level nesting should in +principle be exportable as a Beamer presentation. + + - Org headlines become Beamer frames when the heading level in Org + is equal to `org-beamer-frame-level' or `H' value in an `OPTIONS' + line (*note Export settings::). + + Org overrides headlines to frames conversion for the current tree + of an Org file if it encounters the `BEAMER_ENV' property set to + `frame' or `fullframe'. Org ignores whatever + `org-beamer-frame-level' happens to be for that headline level in + the Org tree. In Beamer terminology, a `fullframe' is a frame + without its title. + + - Org exports a Beamer frame's objects as `block' environments. Org + can enforce wrapping in special block types when `BEAMER_ENV' + property is set(1). For valid values see + `org-beamer-environments-default'. To add more values, see + `org-beamer-environments-extra'. + + - If `BEAMER_ENV' is set to `appendix', Org exports the entry as an + appendix. When set to `note', Org exports the entry as a note + within the frame or between frames, depending on the entry's + heading level. When set to `noteNH', Org exports the entry as a + note without its title. When set to `againframe', Org exports the + entry with `\againframe' command, which makes setting the + `BEAMER_REF' property mandatory because `\againframe' needs frame + to resume. + + When `ignoreheading' is set, Org export ignores the entry's + headline but not its content. This is useful for inserting + content between frames. It is also useful for properly closing a + `column' environment. + + When `BEAMER_ACT' is set for a headline, Org export translates that +headline as an overlay or action specification. When enclosed in square +brackets, Org export makes the overlay specification a default. Use +`BEAMER_OPT' to set any options applicable to the current Beamer frame +or block. The Beamer export back-end wraps with appropriate angular or +square brackets. It also adds the `fragile' option for any code that +may require a verbatim block. + + To create a column on the Beamer slide, use the `BEAMER_COL' property +for its headline in the Org file. Set the value of `BEAMER_COL' to a +decimal number representing the fraction of the total text width. +Beamer export uses this value to set the column's width and fills the +column with the contents of the Org entry. If the Org entry has no +specific environment defined, Beamer export ignores the heading. If +the Org entry has a defined environment, Beamer export uses the heading +as title. Behind the scenes, Beamer export automatically handles LaTeX +column separations for contiguous headlines. To manually adjust them +for any unique configurations needs, use the `BEAMER_ENV' property. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) If `BEAMER_ENV' is set, Org export adds `:B_environment:' tag to +make it visible. The tag serves as a visual aid and has no semantic +relevance. + + +File: org, Node: Beamer specific syntax, Next: Editing support, Prev: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer, Up: Beamer export + +12.8.4 Beamer specific syntax +----------------------------- + +Since Org's Beamer export back-end is an extension of the LaTeX +back-end, it recognizes other LaTeX specific syntax--for example, +`#+LATEX:' or `#+ATTR_LATEX:'. *Note LaTeX export::, for details. + + Beamer export wraps the table of contents generated with `toc:t' +`OPTION' keyword in a `frame' environment. Beamer export does not wrap +the table of contents generated with `TOC' keyword (*note Table of +contents::). Use square brackets for specifying options. + + #+TOC: headlines [currentsection] + + Insert Beamer-specific code using the following constructs: + + #+BEAMER: \pause + + #+BEGIN_EXPORT beamer + Only Beamer export back-end will export this line. + #+END_BEAMER + + Text @@beamer:some code@@ within a paragraph. + + Inline constructs, such as the last one above, are useful for adding +overlay specifications to objects with `bold', `item', `link', +`radio-target' and `target' types. Enclose the value in angular +brackets and place the specification at the beginning the object as +shown in this example: + + A *@@beamer:<2->@@useful* feature + + Beamer export recognizes the `ATTR_BEAMER' keyword with the following +attributes from Beamer configurations: `:environment' for changing local +Beamer environment, `:overlay' for specifying Beamer overlays in angular +or square brackets, and `:options' for inserting optional arguments. + + #+ATTR_BEAMER: :environment nonindentlist + - item 1, not indented + - item 2, not indented + - item 3, not indented + + #+ATTR_BEAMER: :overlay <+-> + - item 1 + - item 2 + + #+ATTR_BEAMER: :options [Lagrange] + Let $G$ be a finite group, and let $H$ be + a subgroup of $G$. Then the order of $H$ divides the order of $G$. + + +File: org, Node: Editing support, Next: A Beamer example, Prev: Beamer specific syntax, Up: Beamer export + +12.8.5 Editing support +---------------------- + +The `org-beamer-mode' is a special minor mode for faster editing of +Beamer documents. + + #+STARTUP: beamer + +`C-c C-b (`org-beamer-select-environment')' + The `org-beamer-mode' provides this key for quicker selections in + Beamer normal environments, and for selecting the `BEAMER_COL' + property. + + +File: org, Node: A Beamer example, Prev: Editing support, Up: Beamer export + +12.8.6 A Beamer example +----------------------- + +Here is an example of an Org document ready for Beamer export. + + #+TITLE: Example Presentation + #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik + #+OPTIONS: H:2 toc:t num:t + #+LATEX_CLASS: beamer + #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation] + #+BEAMER_THEME: Madrid + #+COLUMNS: %45ITEM %10BEAMER_ENV(Env) %10BEAMER_ACT(Act) %4BEAMER_COL(Col) %8BEAMER_OPT(Opt) + + * This is the first structural section + + ** Frame 1 + *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :B_block: + :PROPERTIES: + :BEAMER_COL: 0.48 + :BEAMER_ENV: block + :END: + for the first viable Beamer setup in Org + *** Thanks to everyone else :B_block: + :PROPERTIES: + :BEAMER_COL: 0.48 + :BEAMER_ACT: <2-> + :BEAMER_ENV: block + :END: + for contributing to the discussion + **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note: + :PROPERTIES: + :BEAMER_env: note + :END: + ** Frame 2 (where we will not use columns) + *** Request + Please test this stuff! + + +File: org, Node: HTML export, Next: LaTeX export, Prev: Beamer export, Up: Exporting + +12.9 HTML export +================ + +Org mode contains an HTML exporter with extensive HTML formatting +compatible with XHTML 1.0 strict standard. + +* Menu: + +* HTML Export commands:: Invoking HTML export +* HTML Specific export settings:: Settings for HTML export +* HTML doctypes:: Exporting various (X)HTML flavors +* HTML preamble and postamble:: Inserting preamble and postamble +* Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org files +* Links in HTML export:: Interpreting and formatting links +* Tables in HTML export:: Formatting and modifying tables +* Images in HTML export:: Inserting figures with HTML output +* Math formatting in HTML export:: Handling math equations +* Text areas in HTML export:: Showing an alternate approach, an example +* CSS support:: Styling HTML output +* JavaScript support:: Folding scripting in the web browser + + +File: org, Node: HTML Export commands, Next: HTML Specific export settings, Up: HTML export + +12.9.1 HTML export commands +--------------------------- + +`C-c C-e h h (`org-html-export-to-html')' + Export as HTML file with a `.html' extension. For `myfile.org', + Org exports to `myfile.html', overwriting without warning. `C-c + C-e h o' Exports to HTML and opens it in a web browser. + +`C-c C-e h H (`org-html-export-as-html')' + Exports to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file. + + +File: org, Node: HTML Specific export settings, Next: HTML doctypes, Prev: HTML Export commands, Up: HTML export + +12.9.2 HTML Specific export settings +------------------------------------ + +HTML export has a number of keywords, similar to the general options +settings described in *note Export settings::. + +`DESCRIPTION' + This is the document's description, which the HTML exporter + inserts it as a HTML meta tag in the HTML file. For long + descriptions, use multiple `#+DESCRIPTION' lines. The exporter + takes care of wrapping the lines properly. + +`HTML_DOCTYPE' + Specify the document type, for example: HTML5 (`org-html-doctype'). + +`HTML_CONTAINER' + Specify the HTML container, such as `div', for wrapping sections + and elements (`org-html-container-element'). + +`HTML_LINK_HOME' + The URL for home link (`org-html-link-home'). + +`HTML_LINK_UP' + The URL for the up link of exported HTML pages + (`org-html-link-up'). + +`HTML_MATHJAX' + Options for MathJax (`org-html-mathjax-options'). MathJax is used + to typeset LaTeX math in HTML documents. *Note Math formatting in + HTML export::, for an example. + +`HTML_HEAD' + Arbitrary lines for appending to the HTML document's head + (`org-html-head'). + +`HTML_HEAD_EXTRA' + More arbitrary lines for appending to the HTML document's head + (`org-html-head-extra'). + +`KEYWORDS' + Keywords to describe the document's content. HTML exporter + inserts these keywords as HTML meta tags. For long keywords, use + multiple `#+KEYWORDS' lines. + +`LATEX_HEADER' + Arbitrary lines for appending to the preamble; HTML exporter + appends when transcoding LaTeX fragments to images (*note Math + formatting in HTML export::). + +`SUBTITLE' + The document's subtitle. HTML exporter formats subtitle if + document type is `HTML5' and the CSS has a `subtitle' class. + + Some of these keywords are explained in more detail in the following +sections of the manual. + + +File: org, Node: HTML doctypes, Next: HTML preamble and postamble, Prev: HTML Specific export settings, Up: HTML export + +12.9.3 HTML doctypes +-------------------- + +Org can export to various (X)HTML flavors. + + Set the `org-html-doctype' variable for different (X)HTML variants. +Depending on the variant, the HTML exporter adjusts the syntax of HTML +conversion accordingly. Org includes the following ready-made variants: + + * "html4-strict" + + * "html4-transitional" + + * "html4-frameset" + + * "xhtml-strict" + + * "xhtml-transitional" + + * "xhtml-frameset" + + * "xhtml-11" + + * "html5" + + * "xhtml5" + +See the variable `org-html-doctype-alist' for details. The default is +"xhtml-strict". + + Org's HTML exporter does not by default enable new block elements +introduced with the HTML5 standard. To enable them, set +`org-html-html5-fancy' to non-`nil'. Or use an `OPTIONS' line in the +file to set `html5-fancy'. HTML5 documents can now have arbitrary +`#+BEGIN' and `#+END' blocks. For example: + + #+BEGIN_aside + Lorem ipsum + #+END_aside + + Will export to: + + <aside> + <p>Lorem ipsum</p> + </aside> + + While this: + + #+ATTR_HTML: :controls controls :width 350 + #+BEGIN_video + #+HTML: <source src="movie.mp4" type="video/mp4"> + #+HTML: <source src="movie.ogg" type="video/ogg"> + Your browser does not support the video tag. + #+END_video + + Exports to: + + <video controls="controls" width="350"> + <source src="movie.mp4" type="video/mp4"> + <source src="movie.ogg" type="video/ogg"> + <p>Your browser does not support the video tag.</p> + </video> + + When special blocks do not have a corresponding HTML5 element, the +HTML exporter reverts to standard translation (see +`org-html-html5-elements'). For example, `#+BEGIN_lederhosen' exports +to `<div class="lederhosen">'. + + Special blocks cannot have headlines. For the HTML exporter to wrap +the headline and its contents in `<section>' or `<article>' tags, set +the `HTML_CONTAINER' property for the headline. + + +File: org, Node: HTML preamble and postamble, Next: Quoting HTML tags, Prev: HTML doctypes, Up: HTML export + +12.9.4 HTML preamble and postamble +---------------------------------- + +The HTML exporter has delineations for preamble and postamble. The +default value for `org-html-preamble' is `t', which makes the HTML +exporter insert the preamble. See the variable +`org-html-preamble-format' for the format string. + + Set `org-html-preamble' to a string to override the default format +string. If the string is a function, the HTML exporter expects the +function to return a string upon execution. The HTML exporter inserts +this string in the preamble. The HTML exporter will not insert a +preamble if `org-html-preamble' is set `nil'. + + The default value for `org-html-postamble' is `auto', which makes +the HTML exporter build a postamble from looking up author's name, email +address, creator's name, and date. Set `org-html-postamble' to `t' to +insert the postamble in the format specified in the +`org-html-postamble-format' variable. The HTML exporter will not insert +a postamble if `org-html-postamble' is set to `nil'. + + +File: org, Node: Quoting HTML tags, Next: Links in HTML export, Prev: HTML preamble and postamble, Up: HTML export + +12.9.5 Quoting HTML tags +------------------------ + +The HTML export back-end transforms `<' and `>' to `<' and `>'. +To include raw HTML code in the Org file so the HTML export back-end +can insert that HTML code in the output, use this inline syntax: +`@@html:'. For example: `@@html:<b>@@bold text@@html:</b>@@'. For +larger raw HTML code blocks, use these HTML export code blocks: + + #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export + +or + + #+BEGIN_EXPORT html + All lines between these markers are exported literally + #+END_EXPORT + + +File: org, Node: Links in HTML export, Next: Tables in HTML export, Prev: Quoting HTML tags, Up: HTML export + +12.9.6 Links in HTML export +--------------------------- + +The HTML export back-end transforms Org's internal links (*note +Internal links::) to equivalent HTML links in the output. The back-end +similarly handles Org's automatic links created by radio targets (*note +Radio targets::) similarly. For Org links to external files, the +back-end transforms the links to _relative_ paths. + + For Org links to other `.org' files, the back-end automatically +changes the file extension to `.html' and makes file paths relative. +If the `.org' files have an equivalent `.html' version at the same +location, then the converted links should work without any further +manual intervention. However, to disable this automatic path +translation, set `org-html-link-org-files-as-html' to `nil'. When +disabled, the HTML export back-end substitutes the `id:'-based links in +the HTML output. For more about linking files when publishing to a +directory, *note Publishing links::. + + Org files can also have special directives to the HTML export +back-end. For example, by using `#+ATTR_HTML' lines to specify new +format attributes to `<a>' or `<img>' tags. This example shows +changing the link's `title' and `style': + + #+ATTR_HTML: :title The Org mode homepage :style color:red; + [[http://orgmode.org]] + + +File: org, Node: Tables in HTML export, Next: Images in HTML export, Prev: Links in HTML export, Up: HTML export + +12.9.7 Tables in HTML export +---------------------------- + +The HTML export back-end uses `org-html-table-default-attributes' when +exporting Org tables to HTML. By default, the exporter does not draw +frames and cell borders. To change for this for a table, use the +following lines before the table in the Org file: + + #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells + #+ATTR_HTML: :border 2 :rules all :frame border + + The HTML export back-end preserves column groupings in Org tables +(*note Column groups::) when exporting to HTML. + + Additional options for customizing tables for HTML export. + +`org-html-table-align-individual-fields' + Non-`nil' attaches style attributes for alignment to each table + field. + +`org-html-table-caption-above' + Non-`nil' places caption string at the beginning of the table. + +`org-html-table-data-tags' + Opening and ending tags for table data fields. + +`org-html-table-default-attributes' + Default attributes and values for table tags. + +`org-html-table-header-tags' + Opening and ending tags for table's header fields. + +`org-html-table-row-tags' + Opening and ending tags for table rows. + +`org-html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column' + Non-`nil' formats column one in tables with header tags. + + +File: org, Node: Images in HTML export, Next: Math formatting in HTML export, Prev: Tables in HTML export, Up: HTML export + +12.9.8 Images in HTML export +---------------------------- + +The HTML export back-end has features to convert Org image links to HTML +inline images and HTML clickable image links. + + When the link in the Org file has no description, the HTML export +back-end by default in-lines that image. For example: +`[[file:myimg.jpg]]' is in-lined, while `[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]' +links to the text, `the image'. + + For more details, see the variable `org-html-inline-images'. + + On the other hand, if the description part of the Org link is itself +another link, such as `file:' or `http:' URL pointing to an image, the +HTML export back-end in-lines this image and links to the main image. +This Org syntax enables the back-end to link low-resolution thumbnail +to the high-resolution version of the image, as shown in this example: + + [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]] + + To change attributes of in-lined images, use `#+ATTR_HTML' lines in +the Org file. This example shows realignment to right, and adds `alt' +and `title' attributes in support of text viewers and modern web +accessibility standards. + + #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider + #+ATTR_HTML: :alt cat/spider image :title Action! :align right + [[./img/a.jpg]] + +The HTML export back-end copies the `http' links from the Org file as +is. + + +File: org, Node: Math formatting in HTML export, Next: Text areas in HTML export, Prev: Images in HTML export, Up: HTML export + +12.9.9 Math formatting in HTML export +------------------------------------- + +LaTeX math snippets (*note LaTeX fragments::) can be displayed in two +different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use MathJax +(http://www.mathjax.org) which should work out of the box with Org(1). +Some MathJax display options can be configured via +`org-html-mathjax-options', or in the buffer. For example, with the +following settings, + #+HTML_MATHJAX: align: left indent: 5em tagside: left font: Neo-Euler + equation labels will be displayed on the left margin and equations +will be five ems from the left margin. + +See the docstring of `org-html-mathjax-options' for all supported +variables. The MathJax template can be configure via +`org-html-mathjax-template'. + + If you prefer, you can also request that LaTeX fragments are +processed into small images that will be inserted into the browser +page. Before the availability of MathJax, this was the default method +for Org files. This method requires that the `dvipng' program, +`dvisvgm' or `imagemagick' suite is available on your system. You can +still get this processing with + + #+OPTIONS: tex:dvipng + + #+OPTIONS: tex:dvisvgm + + or: + + #+OPTIONS: tex:imagemagick + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) By default Org loads MathJax from cdnjs.com (https://cdnjs.com) +as recommended by MathJax (http://www.mathjax.org). + + +File: org, Node: Text areas in HTML export, Next: CSS support, Prev: Math formatting in HTML export, Up: HTML export + +12.9.10 Text areas in HTML export +--------------------------------- + +Before Org mode's Babel, one popular approach to publishing code in +HTML was by using `:textarea'. The advantage of this approach was that +copying and pasting was built into browsers with simple JavaScript +commands. Even editing before pasting was made simple. + + The HTML export back-end can create such text areas. It requires an +`#+ATTR_HTML:' line as shown in the example below with the `:textarea' +option. This must be followed by either an `example' or a `src' code +block. Other Org block types will not honor the `:textarea' option. + + By default, the HTML export back-end creates a text area 80 +characters wide and height just enough to fit the content. Override +these defaults with `:width' and `:height' options on the +`#+ATTR_HTML:' line. + + #+ATTR_HTML: :textarea t :width 40 + #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE + (defun org-xor (a b) + "Exclusive or." + (if a (not b) b)) + #+END_EXAMPLE + + +File: org, Node: CSS support, Next: JavaScript support, Prev: Text areas in HTML export, Up: HTML export + +12.9.11 CSS support +------------------- + +You can modify the CSS style definitions for the exported file. The +HTML exporter assigns the following special CSS classes(1) to +appropriate parts of the document--your style specifications may change +these, in addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, +tables, etc. + p.author author information, including email + p.date publishing date + p.creator creator info, about org mode version + .title document title + .subtitle document subtitle + .todo TODO keywords, all not-done states + .done the DONE keywords, all states that count as done + .WAITING each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself + .timestamp timestamp + .timestamp-kwd keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED + .timestamp-wrapper span around keyword plus timestamp + .tag tag in a headline + ._HOME each tag uses itself as a class, "@" replaced by "_" + .target target for links + .linenr the line number in a code example + .code-highlighted for highlighting referenced code lines + div.outline-N div for outline level N (headline plus text)) + div.outline-text-N extra div for text at outline level N + .section-number-N section number in headlines, different for each level + .figure-number label like "Figure 1:" + .table-number label like "Table 1:" + .listing-number label like "Listing 1:" + div.figure how to format an in-lined image + pre.src formatted source code + pre.example normal example + p.verse verse paragraph + div.footnotes footnote section headline + p.footnote footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote + .footref a footnote reference number (always a <sup>) + .footnum footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>) + .org-svg default class for a linked `.svg' image + + The HTML export back-end includes a compact default style in each +exported HTML file. To override the default style with another style, +use these keywords in the Org file. They will replace the global +defaults the HTML exporter uses. + + #+HTML_HEAD: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="style1.css" /> + #+HTML_HEAD_EXTRA: <link rel="alternate stylesheet" type="text/css" href="style2.css" /> + + To just turn off the default style, customize +`org-html-head-include-default-style' variable, or use this option line +in the Org file. + + #+OPTIONS: html-style:nil + +For longer style definitions, either use several `#+HTML_HEAD' and +`#+HTML_HEAD_EXTRA' lines, or use `<style>' `</style>' blocks around +them. Both of these approaches can avoid referring to an external file. + + In order to add styles to a sub-tree, use the +`:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:' property to assign a class to the tree. In +order to specify CSS styles for a particular headline, you can use the +id specified in a `:CUSTOM_ID:' property. + + Never change the `org-html-style-default' constant. Instead use +other simpler ways of customizing as described above. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) If the classes on TODO keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use +the variables `org-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix' and +`org-html-tag-class-prefix' to make them unique. + + +File: org, Node: JavaScript support, Prev: CSS support, Up: HTML export + +12.9.12 JavaScript supported display of web pages +------------------------------------------------- + +Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to +enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This +program enhances large files in two different ways of viewing. One is +an _Info_-like mode where each section is displayed separately and +navigation can be done with the `n' and `p' keys (and some other keys +as well, press `?' for an overview of the available keys). The second +one has a _folding_ view, much like Org provides inside Emacs. The +script is available at `http://orgmode.org/org-info.js' and the +documentation at `http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/'. The +script is hosted on `http://orgmode.org', but for reliability, prefer +installing it on your own web server. + + To use this program, just add this line to the Org file: + + #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil + +The HTML header now has the code needed to automatically invoke the +script. For setting options, use the syntax from the above line for +options described below: + + path: The path to the script. The default grabs the script from + `http://orgmode.org/org-info.js', but you might want to have + a local copy and use a path like `../scripts/org-info.js'. + view: Initial view when the website is first shown. Possible values are: + info Info-like interface with one section per page. + overview Folding interface, initially showing only top-level. + content Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible. + showall Folding interface, all headlines and text visible. + sdepth: Maximum headline level that will still become an independent + section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from + `org-export-headline-levels' (= the `H' switch in `#+OPTIONS'). + If this is smaller than in `org-export-headline-levels', each + info/folding section can still contain child headlines. + toc: Should the table of contents _initially_ be visible? + Even when `nil', you can always get to the "toc" with `i'. + tdepth: The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from + the variables `org-export-headline-levels' and `org-export-with-toc'. + ftoc: Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"? + If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section. + ltoc: Should there be short contents (children) in each section? + Make this `above' if the section should be above initial text. + mouse: Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be + `underline' (default) or a background color like `#cccccc'. + buttons: Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When `nil' (the + default), only one such button will be present. + You can choose default values for these options by customizing the +variable `org-html-infojs-options'. If you want the script to always +apply to your pages, configure the variable `org-html-use-infojs'. + + +File: org, Node: LaTeX export, Next: Markdown export, Prev: HTML export, Up: Exporting + +12.10 LaTeX export +================== + +The LaTeX export back-end can handle complex documents, incorporate +standard or custom LaTeX document classes, generate documents using +alternate LaTeX engines, and produce fully linked PDF files with +indexes, bibliographies, and tables of contents, destined for +interactive online viewing or high-quality print publication. + + While the details are covered in-depth in this section, here are +some quick references to variables for the impatient: for engines, see +`org-latex-compiler'; for build sequences, see `org-latex-pdf-process'; +for packages, see `org-latex-default-packages-alist' and +`org-latex-packages-alist'. + + An important note about the LaTeX export back-end: it is sensitive to +blank lines in the Org document. That's because LaTeX itself depends on +blank lines to tell apart syntactical elements, such as paragraphs. + +* Menu: + +* LaTeX export commands:: For producing LaTeX and PDF documents. +* LaTeX specific export settings:: Unique to this LaTeX back-end. +* LaTeX header and sectioning:: For file structure. +* Quoting LaTeX code:: Directly in the Org document. +* Tables in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to tables. +* Images in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to images. +* Plain lists in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to lists. +* Source blocks in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to source code blocks. +* Example blocks in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to example blocks. +* Special blocks in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to special blocks. +* Horizontal rules in LaTeX export:: Attributes specific to horizontal rules. + + +File: org, Node: LaTeX export commands, Next: LaTeX specific export settings, Up: LaTeX export + +12.10.1 LaTeX export commands +----------------------------- + +`C-c C-e l l (`org-latex-export-to-latex')' + Export as LaTeX file with a `.tex' extension. For `myfile.org', + Org exports to `myfile.tex', overwriting without warning. `C-c C-e + l l' Exports to LaTeX file. + +`C-c C-e l L (`org-latex-export-as-latex')' + Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file. + +`C-c C-e l p (`org-latex-export-to-pdf')' + Export as LaTeX file and convert it to PDF file. + +`C-c C-e l o' + Export as LaTeX file and convert it to PDF, then open the PDF + using the default viewer. + + The LaTeX export back-end can use any of these LaTeX engines: +`pdflatex', `xelatex', and `lualatex'. These engines compile LaTeX +files with different compilers, packages, and output options. The +LaTeX export back-end finds the compiler version to use from +`org-latex-compiler' variable or the `#+LATEX_COMPILER' keyword in the +Org file. See the docstring for the `org-latex-default-packages-alist' +for loading packages with certain compilers. Also see +`org-latex-bibtex-compiler' to set the bibliography compiler(1). + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) This does not allow setting different bibliography compilers for +different files. However, "smart" LaTeX compilation systems, such as +`latexmk', can select the correct bibliography compiler. + + +File: org, Node: LaTeX specific export settings, Next: LaTeX header and sectioning, Prev: LaTeX export commands, Up: LaTeX export + +12.10.2 LaTeX specific export settings +-------------------------------------- + +The LaTeX export back-end has several additional keywords for +customizing LaTeX output. Setting these keywords works similar to the +general options (*note Export settings::). + +`DESCRIPTION' + The document's description. The description along with author + name, keywords, and related file metadata are inserted in the + output file by the `hyperref' package. See + `org-latex-hyperref-template' for customizing metadata items. See + `org-latex-title-command' for typesetting description into the + document's front matter. Use multiple `#+DESCRIPTION' lines for + long descriptions. + +`LATEX_CLASS' + This is LaTeX document class, such as `article', `report', `book', + and so on, which contain predefined preamble and headline level + mapping that the LaTeX export back-end needs. The back-end reads + the default class name from the `org-latex-default-class' + variable. Org has `article' as the default class. A valid + default class must be an element of `org-latex-classes'. + +`LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS' + Options the LaTeX export back-end uses when calling the LaTeX + document class. + +`LATEX_COMPILER' + The compiler, such as `pdflatex', `xelatex', `lualatex', for + producing the PDF (`org-latex-compiler'). + +`LATEX_HEADER' + Arbitrary lines to add to the document's preamble, before the + `hyperref' settings. See `org-latex-classes' for adjusting the + structure and order of the LaTeX headers. + +`LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA' + Arbitrary lines to add to the document's preamble, before the + `hyperref' settings. See `org-latex-classes' for adjusting the + structure and order of the LaTeX headers. + +`KEYWORDS' + The keywords for the document. The description along with author + name, keywords, and related file metadata are inserted in the + output file by the `hyperref' package. See + `org-latex-hyperref-template' for customizing metadata items. See + `org-latex-title-command' for typesetting description into the + document's front matter. Use multiple `#+KEYWORDS' lines if + necessary. + +`SUBTITLE' + The document's subtitle. It is typeset as per + `org-latex-subtitle-format'. If `org-latex-subtitle-separate' is + non-`nil', it is typed as part of the `\title'-macro. See + `org-latex-hyperref-template' for customizing metadata items. See + `org-latex-title-command' for typesetting description into the + document's front matter. + + The following sections have further details. + + +File: org, Node: LaTeX header and sectioning, Next: Quoting LaTeX code, Prev: LaTeX specific export settings, Up: LaTeX export + +12.10.3 LaTeX header and sectioning structure +--------------------------------------------- + +The LaTeX export back-end converts the first three of Org's outline +levels into LaTeX headlines. The remaining Org levels are exported as +`itemize' or `enumerate' lists. To change this globally for the +cut-off point between levels and lists, (*note Export settings::). + + By default, the LaTeX export back-end uses the `article' class. + + To change the default class globally, edit `org-latex-default-class'. +To change the default class locally in an Org file, add option lines +`#+LATEX_CLASS: myclass'. To change the default class for just a part +of the Org file, set a sub-tree property, `EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS'. The +class name entered here must be valid member of `org-latex-classes'. +This variable defines a header template for each class into which the +exporter splices the values of `org-latex-default-packages-alist' and +`org-latex-packages-alist'. Use the same three variables to define +custom sectioning or custom classes. + + The LaTeX export back-end sends the `LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS' keyword and +`EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS' property as options to the LaTeX +`\documentclass' macro. The options and the syntax for specifying them, +including enclosing them in square brackets, follow LaTeX conventions. + + #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper,11pt,twoside,twocolumn] + + The LaTeX export back-end appends values from `LATEX_HEADER' and +`LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA' keywords to the LaTeX header. The docstring for +`org-latex-classes' explains in more detail. Also note that LaTeX +export back-end does not append `LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA' to the header when +previewing LaTeX snippets (*note Previewing LaTeX fragments::). + + A sample Org file with the above headers: + + #+LATEX_CLASS: article + #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [a4paper] + #+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage{xyz} + + * Headline 1 + some text + * Headline 2 + some more text + + +File: org, Node: Quoting LaTeX code, Next: Tables in LaTeX export, Prev: LaTeX header and sectioning, Up: LaTeX export + +12.10.4 Quoting LaTeX code +-------------------------- + +The LaTeX export back-end can insert any arbitrary LaTeX code, *note +Embedded LaTeX::. There are three ways to embed such code in the Org +file and they all use different quoting syntax. + + Inserting in-line quoted with symbols: + Code embedded in-line @@latex:any arbitrary LaTeX code@@ in a paragraph. + + Inserting as one or more keyword lines in the Org file: + #+LATEX: any arbitrary LaTeX code + + Inserting as an export block in the Org file, where the back-end +exports any code between begin and end markers: + #+BEGIN_EXPORT latex + any arbitrary LaTeX code + #+END_EXPORT + + +File: org, Node: Tables in LaTeX export, Next: Images in LaTeX export, Prev: Quoting LaTeX code, Up: LaTeX export + +12.10.5 Tables in LaTeX export +------------------------------ + +The LaTeX export back-end can pass several LaTeX attributes for table +contents and layout. Besides specifying label and caption (*note +Images and tables::), the other valid LaTeX attributes include: + +`:mode' + The LaTeX export back-end wraps the table differently depending on + the mode for accurate rendering of math symbols. Mode is either + `table', `math', `inline-math' or `verbatim'. For `math' or + `inline-math' mode, LaTeX export back-end wraps the table in a math + environment, but every cell in it is exported as-is. The LaTeX + export back-end determines the default mode from + `org-latex-default-table-mode'. For , The LaTeX export back-end + merges contiguous tables in the same mode into a single + environment. + +`:environment' + Set the default LaTeX table environment for the LaTeX export + back-end to use when exporting Org tables. Common LaTeX table + environments are provided by these packages: `tabularx', + `longtable', `array', `tabu', and `bmatrix'. For packages, such + as `tabularx' and `tabu', or any newer replacements, include them + in the `org-latex-packages-alist' variable so the LaTeX export + back-end can insert the appropriate load package headers in the + converted LaTeX file. Look in the docstring for the + `org-latex-packages-alist' variable for configuring these packages + for LaTeX snippet previews, if any. + +`:caption' + Use `#+CAPTION' keyword to set a simple caption for a table (*note + Images and tables::). For custom captions, use `:caption' + attribute, which accepts raw LaTeX code. `:caption' value + overrides `#+CAPTION' value. + +`:float' +`:placement' + The table environments by default are not floats in LaTeX. To + make them floating objects use `:float' with one of the following + options: `sideways', `multicolumn', `t', and `nil'. Note that + `sidewaystable' has been deprecated since Org 8.3. LaTeX floats + can also have additional layout `:placement' attributes. These + are the usual `[h t b p ! H]' permissions specified in square + brackets. Note that for `:float sideways' tables, the LaTeX + export back-end ignores `:placement' attributes. + +`:align' +`:font' +`:width' + The LaTeX export back-end uses these attributes for regular tables + to set their alignments, fonts, and widths. + +`:spread' + When `:spread' is non-`nil', the LaTeX export back-end spreads or + shrinks the table by the `:width' for `tabu' and `longtabu' + environments. `:spread' has no effect if `:width' is not set. + +`:booktabs' +`:center' +`:rmlines' + All three commands are toggles. `:booktabs' brings in modern + typesetting enhancements to regular tables. The `booktabs' + package has to be loaded through `org-latex-packages-alist'. + `:center' is for centering the table. `:rmlines' removes all but + the very first horizontal line made of ASCII characters from + "table.el" tables only. + +`:math-prefix' +`:math-suffix' +`:math-arguments' + The LaTeX export back-end inserts `:math-prefix' string value in a + math environment before the table. The LaTeX export back-end + inserts `:math-suffix' string value in a math environment after + the table. The LaTeX export back-end inserts `:math-arguments' + string value between the macro name and the table's contents. + `:math-arguments' comes in use for matrix macros that require more + than one argument, such as `qbordermatrix'. + + LaTeX table attributes help formatting tables for a wide range of +situations, such as matrix product or spanning multiple pages: + + #+ATTR_LATEX: :environment longtable :align l|lp{3cm}r|l + | ..... | ..... | + | ..... | ..... | + + #+ATTR_LATEX: :mode math :environment bmatrix :math-suffix \times + | a | b | + | c | d | + #+ATTR_LATEX: :mode math :environment bmatrix + | 1 | 2 | + | 3 | 4 | + + Set the caption with the LaTeX command +`\bicaption{HeadingA}{HeadingB}': + + #+ATTR_LATEX: :caption \bicaption{HeadingA}{HeadingB} + | ..... | ..... | + | ..... | ..... | + + +File: org, Node: Images in LaTeX export, Next: Plain lists in LaTeX export, Prev: Tables in LaTeX export, Up: LaTeX export + +12.10.6 Images in LaTeX export +------------------------------ + +The LaTeX export back-end processes image links in Org files that do not +have descriptions, such as these links `[[file:img.jpg]]' or +`[[./img.jpg]]', as direct image insertions in the final PDF output. In +the PDF, they are no longer links but actual images embedded on the +page. The LaTeX export back-end uses `\includegraphics' macro to +insert the image. But for TikZ(1) images, the back-end uses an +`\input' macro wrapped within a `tikzpicture' environment. + + For specifying image `:width', `:height', and other `:options', use +this syntax: + + #+ATTR_LATEX: :width 5cm :options angle=90 + [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]] + + For custom commands for captions, use the `:caption' attribute. It +will override the default `#+CAPTION' value: + + #+ATTR_LATEX: :caption \bicaption{HeadingA}{HeadingB} + [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]] + + When captions follow the method as described in *note Images and +tables::, the LaTeX export back-end wraps the picture in a floating +`figure' environment. To float an image without specifying a caption, +set the `:float' attribute to one of the following: + - `t': for a standard `figure' environment; used by default whenever + an image has a caption. + + - `multicolumn': to span the image across multiple columns of a + page; the back-end wraps the image in a `figure*' environment. + + - `wrap': for text to flow around the image on the right; the figure + occupies the left half of the page. + + - `sideways': for a new page with the image sideways, rotated ninety + degrees, in a `sidewaysfigure' environment; overrides `:placement' + setting. + + - `nil': to avoid a `:float' even if using a caption. + Use the `placement' attribute to modify a floating environment's +placement. + + #+ATTR_LATEX: :float wrap :width 0.38\textwidth :placement + {r}{0.4\textwidth} [[./img/hst.png]] + + The LaTeX export back-end centers all images by default. Setting +`:center' attribute to `nil' disables centering. To disable centering +globally, set `org-latex-images-centered' to `t'. + + Set the `:comment-include' attribute to non-`nil' value for the +LaTeX export back-end to comment out the `\includegraphics' macro. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) `http://sourceforge.net/projects/pgf/' + + +File: org, Node: Plain lists in LaTeX export, Next: Source blocks in LaTeX export, Prev: Images in LaTeX export, Up: LaTeX export + +12.10.7 Plain lists in LaTeX export +----------------------------------- + +The LaTeX export back-end accepts the `:environment' and `:options' +attributes for plain lists. Both attributes work together for +customizing lists, as shown in the examples: + + #+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage[inline]{enumitem} + Some ways to say "Hello": + #+ATTR_LATEX: :environment itemize* + #+ATTR_LATEX: :options [label={}, itemjoin={,}, itemjoin*={, and}] + - Hola + - Bonjour + - Guten Tag. + + Since LaTeX supports only four levels of nesting for lists, use an +external package, such as `enumitem' in LaTeX, for levels deeper than +four: + + #+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage{enumitem} + #+LATEX_HEADER: \renewlist{itemize}{itemize}{9} + #+LATEX_HEADER: \setlist[itemize]{label=$\circ$} + - One + - Two + - Three + - Four + - Five + + +File: org, Node: Source blocks in LaTeX export, Next: Example blocks in LaTeX export, Prev: Plain lists in LaTeX export, Up: LaTeX export + +12.10.8 Source blocks in LaTeX export +------------------------------------- + +The LaTeX export back-end can make source code blocks into floating +objects through the attributes `:float' and `:options'. For `:float': + + - `t': makes a source block float; by default floats any source + block with a caption. + + - `multicolumn': spans the source block across multiple columns of a + page. + + - `nil': avoids a `:float' even if using a caption; useful for + source code blocks that may not fit on a page. + + #+ATTR_LATEX: :float nil + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp + Lisp code that may not fit in a single page. + #+END_SRC + + The LaTeX export back-end passes string values in `:options' to +LaTeX packages for customization of that specific source block. In the +example below, the `:options' are set for Minted. Minted is a source +code highlighting LaTeXpackage with many configurable options. + + #+ATTR_LATEX: :options commentstyle=\bfseries + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp + (defun Fib (n) + (if (< n 2) n (+ (Fib (- n 1)) (Fib (- n 2))))) + #+END_SRC + + To apply similar configuration options for all source blocks in a +file, use the `org-latex-listings-options' and +`org-latex-minted-options' variables. + + +File: org, Node: Example blocks in LaTeX export, Next: Special blocks in LaTeX export, Prev: Source blocks in LaTeX export, Up: LaTeX export + +12.10.9 Example blocks in LaTeX export +-------------------------------------- + +The LaTeX export back-end wraps the contents of example blocks in a +`verbatim' environment. To change this behavior to use another +environment globally, specify an appropriate export filter (*note +Advanced configuration::). To change this behavior to use another +environment for each block, use the `:environment' parameter to specify +a custom environment. + + #+ATTR_LATEX: :environment myverbatim + #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE + This sentence is false. + #+END_EXAMPLE + + +File: org, Node: Special blocks in LaTeX export, Next: Horizontal rules in LaTeX export, Prev: Example blocks in LaTeX export, Up: LaTeX export + +12.10.10 Special blocks in LaTeX export +--------------------------------------- + +For other special blocks in the Org file, the LaTeX export back-end +makes a special environment of the same name. The back-end also takes +`:options', if any, and appends as-is to that environment's opening +string. For example: + + #+BEGIN_abstract + We demonstrate how to solve the Syracuse problem. + #+END_abstract + + #+ATTR_LATEX: :options [Proof of important theorem] + #+BEGIN_proof + ... + Therefore, any even number greater than 2 is the sum of two primes. + #+END_proof + +exports to + + \begin{abstract} + We demonstrate how to solve the Syracuse problem. + \end{abstract} + + \begin{proof}[Proof of important theorem] + ... + Therefore, any even number greater than 2 is the sum of two primes. + \end{proof} + + If you need to insert a specific caption command, use `:caption' +attribute. It will override standard `#+CAPTION' value, if any. For +example: + + #+ATTR_LATEX: :caption \MyCaption{HeadingA} + #+BEGIN_proof + ... + #+END_proof + + +File: org, Node: Horizontal rules in LaTeX export, Prev: Special blocks in LaTeX export, Up: LaTeX export + +12.10.11 Horizontal rules in LaTeX export +----------------------------------------- + +The LaTeX export back-end converts horizontal rules by the specified +`:width' and `:thickness' attributes. For example: + + #+ATTR_LATEX: :width .6\textwidth :thickness 0.8pt + ----- + + +File: org, Node: Markdown export, Next: OpenDocument Text export, Prev: LaTeX export, Up: Exporting + +12.11 Markdown export +===================== + +The Markdown export back-end, `md', converts an Org file to a Markdown +format, as defined at `http://daringfireball.net/projects/markdown/'. + + Since `md' is built on top of the HTML back-end, any Org constructs +not supported by Markdown, such as tables, the underlying `html' +back-end (*note HTML export::) converts them. + +Markdown export commands +------------------------ + +`C-c C-e m m (`org-md-export-to-markdown')' + Export to a text file with Markdown syntax. For `myfile.org', Org + exports to `myfile.md', overwritten without warning. + +`C-c C-e m M (`org-md-export-as-markdown')' + Export to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file. + +`C-c C-e m o' + Export as a text file with Markdown syntax, then open it. + +Header and sectioning structure +------------------------------- + +Based on `org-md-headline-style', markdown export can generate headlines +of both `atx' and `setext' types. `atx' limits headline levels to two. +`setext' limits headline levels to six. Beyond these limits, the +export back-end converts headlines to lists. To set a limit to a level +before the absolute limit (*note Export settings::). + + +File: org, Node: OpenDocument Text export, Next: Org export, Prev: Markdown export, Up: Exporting + +12.12 OpenDocument Text export +============================== + +The ODT export back-end handles creating of OpenDocument Text (ODT) +format files. The format complies with `OpenDocument-v1.2 +specification'(1) and is compatible with LibreOffice 3.4. + +* Menu: + +* Pre-requisites for ODT export:: Required packages. +* ODT export commands:: Invoking export. +* ODT specific export settings:: Configuration options. +* Extending ODT export:: Producing `.doc', `.pdf' files. +* Applying custom styles:: Styling the output. +* Links in ODT export:: Handling and formatting links. +* Tables in ODT export:: Org table conversions. +* Images in ODT export:: Inserting images. +* Math formatting in ODT export:: Formatting LaTeX fragments. +* Labels and captions in ODT export:: Rendering objects. +* Literal examples in ODT export:: For source code and example blocks. +* Advanced topics in ODT export:: For power users. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Open Document Format for Office Applications (OpenDocument) +Version 1.2 +(http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html) + + +File: org, Node: Pre-requisites for ODT export, Next: ODT export commands, Up: OpenDocument Text export + +12.12.1 Pre-requisites for ODT export +------------------------------------- + +The ODT export back-end relies on the `zip' program to create the final +compressed ODT output. Check if `zip' is locally available and +executable. Without `zip', export cannot finish. + + +File: org, Node: ODT export commands, Next: ODT specific export settings, Prev: Pre-requisites for ODT export, Up: OpenDocument Text export + +12.12.2 ODT export commands +--------------------------- + +`C-c C-e o o (`org-odt-export-to-odt')' + Export as OpenDocument Text file. + + If `org-odt-preferred-output-format' is specified, the ODT export + back-end automatically converts the exported file to that format. + *Note Automatically exporting to other formats: + x-export-to-other-formats. + + For `myfile.org', Org exports to `myfile.odt', overwriting without + warning. The ODT export back-end exports a region only if a + region was active. Note for exporting active regions, the + `transient-mark-mode' has to be turned on. + + If the selected region is a single tree, the ODT export back-end + makes the tree head the document title. Incidentally, `C-c @' + selects the current sub-tree. If the tree head entry has, or + inherits, an `EXPORT_FILE_NAME' property, the ODT export back-end + uses that for file name. + + `C-c C-e o O' Export to an OpenDocument Text file format and open + it. + + When `org-odt-preferred-output-format' is specified, open the + converted file instead. *Note Automatically exporting to other + formats: x-export-to-other-formats. + + +File: org, Node: ODT specific export settings, Next: Extending ODT export, Prev: ODT export commands, Up: OpenDocument Text export + +12.12.3 ODT specific export settings +------------------------------------ + +The ODT export back-end has several additional keywords for customizing +ODT output. Setting these keywords works similar to the general options +(*note Export settings::). + +`DESCRIPTION' + This is the document's description, which the ODT export back-end + inserts as document metadata. For long descriptions, use multiple + `#+DESCRIPTION' lines. + +`KEYWORDS' + The keywords for the document. The ODT export back-end inserts the + description along with author name, keywords, and related file + metadata as metadata in the output file. Use multiple + `#+KEYWORDS' lines if necessary. + +`ODT_STYLES_FILE' + The ODT export back-end uses the `org-odt-styles-file' by default. + See *note Applying custom styles:: for details. + +`SUBTITLE' + The document subtitle. + + +File: org, Node: Extending ODT export, Next: Applying custom styles, Prev: ODT specific export settings, Up: OpenDocument Text export + +12.12.4 Extending ODT export +---------------------------- + +The ODT export back-end can produce documents in other formats besides +ODT using a specialized ODT converter process. Its common interface +works with popular converters to produce formats such as `doc', or +convert a document from one format, say `csv', to another format, say +`xls'. + + Customize `org-odt-convert-process' variable to point to `unoconv', +which is the ODT's preferred converter. Working installations of +LibreOffice would already have `unoconv' installed. Alternatively, +other converters may be substituted here. *Note Configuring a document +converter::. + +Automatically exporting to other formats +........................................ + +If ODT format is just an intermediate step to get to other formats, +such as `doc', `docx', `rtf', or `pdf', etc., then extend the ODT +export back-end to directly produce that format. Specify the final +format in the `org-odt-preferred-output-format' variable. This is one +way to extend (*note Exporting to ODT: x-export-to-odt.). + +Converting between document formats +................................... + +The Org export back-end is made to be inter-operable with a wide range +of text document format converters. Newer generation converters, such +as LibreOffice and Pandoc, can handle hundreds of formats at once. Org +provides a consistent interaction with whatever converter is installed. +Here are some generic commands: + +`M-x org-odt-convert RET' + Convert an existing document from one format to another. With a + prefix argument, opens the newly produced file. + + +File: org, Node: Applying custom styles, Next: Links in ODT export, Prev: Extending ODT export, Up: OpenDocument Text export + +12.12.5 Applying custom styles +------------------------------ + +The ODT export back-end comes with many OpenDocument styles (*note +Working with OpenDocument style files::). To expand or further +customize these built-in style sheets, either edit the style sheets +directly or generate them using an application such as LibreOffice. +The example here shows creating a style using LibreOffice. + +Applying custom styles: the easy way +.................................... + + 1. Create a sample `example.org' file with settings as shown below, + and export it to ODT format. + + #+OPTIONS: H:10 num:t + + 2. Open the above `example.odt' using LibreOffice. Use the `Stylist' + to locate the target styles, which typically have the `Org' prefix. + Open one, modify, and save as either OpenDocument Text (`.odt') or + OpenDocument Template (`.ott') file. + + 3. Customize the variable `org-odt-styles-file' and point it to the + newly created file. For additional configuration options *note + Overriding factory styles: x-overriding-factory-styles. + + To apply and ODT style to a particular file, use the + `#+ODT_STYLES_FILE' option as shown in the example below: + + #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: "/path/to/example.ott" + + or + + #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: ("/path/to/file.ott" ("styles.xml" "image/hdr.png")) + + +Using third-party styles and templates +...................................... + +The ODT export back-end relies on many templates and style names. Using +third-party styles and templates can lead to mismatches. Templates +derived from built in ODT templates and styles seem to have fewer +problems. + + +File: org, Node: Links in ODT export, Next: Tables in ODT export, Prev: Applying custom styles, Up: OpenDocument Text export + +12.12.6 Links in ODT export +--------------------------- + +ODT export back-end creates native cross-references for internal links +and Internet-style links for all other link types. + + A link with no description and pointing to a +regular--un-itemized--outline heading is replaced with a +cross-reference and section number of the heading. + + A `\ref{label}'-style reference to an image, table etc. is replaced +with a cross-reference and sequence number of the labeled entity. +*Note Labels and captions in ODT export::. + + +File: org, Node: Tables in ODT export, Next: Images in ODT export, Prev: Links in ODT export, Up: OpenDocument Text export + +12.12.7 Tables in ODT export +---------------------------- + +The ODT export back-end handles native Org mode tables (*note Tables::) +and simple `table.el' tables. Complex `table.el' tables having column +or row spans are not supported. Such tables are stripped from the +exported document. + + By default, the ODT export back-end exports a table with top and +bottom frames and with ruled lines separating row and column groups +(*note Column groups::). All tables are typeset to occupy the same +width. The ODT export back-end honors any table alignments and +relative widths for columns (*note Column width and alignment::). + + Note that the ODT export back-end interprets column widths as +weighted ratios, the default weight being 1. + + Specifying `:rel-width' property on an `#+ATTR_ODT' line controls +the width of the table. For example: + + #+ATTR_ODT: :rel-width 50 + | Area/Month | Jan | Feb | Mar | Sum | + |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------| + | / | < | | | < | + | <l13> | <r5> | <r5> | <r5> | <r6> | + | North America | 1 | 21 | 926 | 948 | + | Middle East | 6 | 75 | 844 | 925 | + | Asia Pacific | 9 | 27 | 790 | 826 | + |---------------+-------+-------+-------+-------| + | Sum | 16 | 123 | 2560 | 2699 | + + On export, the above table takes 50% of text width area. The +exporter sizes the columns in the ratio: 13:5:5:5:6. The first column +is left-aligned and rest of the columns, right-aligned. Vertical rules +separate the header and the last column. Horizontal rules separate the +header and the last row. + + For even more customization, create custom table styles and +associate them with a table using the `#+ATTR_ODT' line. *Note +Customizing tables in ODT export::. + + +File: org, Node: Images in ODT export, Next: Math formatting in ODT export, Prev: Tables in ODT export, Up: OpenDocument Text export + +12.12.8 Images in ODT export +---------------------------- + +Embedding images +................ + +The ODT export back-end processes image links in Org files that do not +have descriptions, such as these links `[[file:img.jpg]]' or +`[[./img.jpg]]', as direct image insertions in the final output. Either +of these examples works: + + [[file:img.png]] + + [[./img.png]] + +Embedding clickable images +.......................... + +For clickable images, provide a link whose description is another link +to an image file. For example, to embed a image `org-mode-unicorn.png' +which when clicked jumps to `http://Orgmode.org' website, do the +following + + [[http://orgmode.org][./org-mode-unicorn.png]] + +Sizing and scaling of embedded images +..................................... + +Control the size and scale of the embedded images with the `#+ATTR_ODT' +attribute. + + The ODT export back-end starts with establishing the size of the +image in the final document. The dimensions of this size is measured +in centimeters. The back-end then queries the image file for its +dimensions measured in pixels. For this measurement, the back-end +relies on ImageMagick's `identify' program or Emacs `create-image' and +`image-size' API. ImageMagick is the preferred choice for large file +sizes or frequent batch operations. The back-end then converts the +pixel dimensions using `org-odt-pixels-per-inch' into the familiar 72 +dpi or 96 dpi. The default value for this is in +`display-pixels-per-inch', which can be tweaked for better results +based on the capabilities of the output device. Here are some common +image scaling operations: + +Explicitly size the image + To embed `img.png' as a 10 cm x 10 cm image, do the following: + + #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 :height 10 + [[./img.png]] + +Scale the image + To embed `img.png' at half its size, do the following: + + #+ATTR_ODT: :scale 0.5 + [[./img.png]] + +Scale the image to a specific width + To embed `img.png' with a width of 10 cm while retaining the + original height:width ratio, do the following: + + #+ATTR_ODT: :width 10 + [[./img.png]] + +Scale the image to a specific height + To embed `img.png' with a height of 10 cm while retaining the + original height:width ratio, do the following + + #+ATTR_ODT: :height 10 + [[./img.png]] + +Anchoring of images +................... + +The ODT export back-end can anchor images to `"as-char"', +`"paragraph"', or `"page"'. Set the preferred anchor using the +`:anchor' property of the `#+ATTR_ODT' line. + + To create an image that is anchored to a page: + #+ATTR_ODT: :anchor "page" + [[./img.png]] + + +File: org, Node: Math formatting in ODT export, Next: Labels and captions in ODT export, Prev: Images in ODT export, Up: OpenDocument Text export + +12.12.9 Math formatting in ODT export +------------------------------------- + +The ODT export back-end has special support built-in for handling math. + +* Menu: + +* Working with LaTeX math snippets:: Embedding in LaTeX format. +* Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files:: Embedding in native format. + + +File: org, Node: Working with LaTeX math snippets, Next: Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, Up: Math formatting in ODT export + +Working with LaTeX math snippets +................................ + +LaTeX math snippets (*note LaTeX fragments::) can be embedded in an ODT +document in one of the following ways: + + 1. MathML + + Add this line to the Org file. This option is activated on a + per-file basis. + + #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t + + With this option, LaTeX fragments are first converted into MathML + fragments using an external LaTeX-to-MathML converter program. The + resulting MathML fragments are then embedded as an OpenDocument + Formula in the exported document. + + To specify the LaTeX-to-MathML converter, customize the variables + `org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command' and + `org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file'. + + To use MathToWeb(1) as the preferred converter, configure the + above variables as + + (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command + "java -jar %j -unicode -force -df %o %I" + org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file + "/path/to/mathtoweb.jar") + To use LaTeXML(2) use + (setq org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command + "latexmlmath \"%i\" --presentationmathml=%o") + + To quickly verify the reliability of the LaTeX-to-MathML + converter, use the following commands: + + `M-x org-odt-export-as-odf RET' + Convert a LaTeX math snippet to an OpenDocument formula + (`.odf') file. + + `M-x org-odt-export-as-odf-and-open RET' + Convert a LaTeX math snippet to an OpenDocument formula + (`.odf') file and open the formula file with the + system-registered application. + + 2. PNG images + + Add this line to the Org file. This option is activated on a + per-file basis. + + #+OPTIONS: tex:dvipng + + #+OPTIONS: tex:dvisvgm + + or: + + #+OPTIONS: tex:imagemagick + + Under this option, LaTeX fragments are processed into PNG or SVG + images and the resulting images are embedded in the exported + document. This method requires `dvipng' program, `dvisvgm' or + `imagemagick' programs. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) See MathToWeb +(http://www.mathtoweb.com/cgi-bin/mathtoweb_home.pl). + + (2) See `http://dlmf.nist.gov/LaTeXML/'. + + +File: org, Node: Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files, Prev: Working with LaTeX math snippets, Up: Math formatting in ODT export + +Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files +................................................. + +When embedding LaTeX math snippets in ODT documents is not reliable, +there is one more option to try. Embed an equation by linking to its +MathML (`.mml') source or its OpenDocument formula (`.odf') file as +shown below: + + [[./equation.mml]] + + or + + [[./equation.odf]] + + +File: org, Node: Labels and captions in ODT export, Next: Literal examples in ODT export, Prev: Math formatting in ODT export, Up: OpenDocument Text export + +12.12.10 Labels and captions in ODT export +------------------------------------------ + +ODT format handles labeling and captioning of objects based on their +types. Inline images, tables, LaTeX fragments, and Math formulas are +numbered and captioned separately. Each object also gets a unique +sequence number based on its order of first appearance in the Org file. +Each category has its own sequence. A caption is just a label applied +to these objects. + + #+CAPTION: Bell curve + #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049 + [[./img/a.png]] + + When rendered, it may show as follows in the exported document: + + Figure 2: Bell curve + + To modify the category component of the caption, customize the option +`org-odt-category-map-alist'. For example, to tag embedded images with +the string `Illustration' instead of the default string `Figure', use +the following setting: + + (setq org-odt-category-map-alist + '(("__Figure__" "Illustration" "value" "Figure" org-odt--enumerable-image-p))) + + With the above modification, the previous example changes to: + + Illustration 2: Bell curve + + +File: org, Node: Literal examples in ODT export, Next: Advanced topics in ODT export, Prev: Labels and captions in ODT export, Up: OpenDocument Text export + +12.12.11 Literal examples in ODT export +--------------------------------------- + +The ODT export back-end supports literal examples (*note Literal +examples::) with full fontification. Internally, the ODT export +back-end relies on `htmlfontify.el' to generate the style definitions +needed for fancy listings. The auto-generated styles get `OrgSrc' +prefix and inherit colors from the faces used by Emacs `font-lock' +library for that source language. + + For custom fontification styles, customize the +`org-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks' option. + + To turn off fontification of literal examples, customize the +`org-odt-fontify-srcblocks' option. + + +File: org, Node: Advanced topics in ODT export, Prev: Literal examples in ODT export, Up: OpenDocument Text export + +12.12.12 Advanced topics in ODT export +-------------------------------------- + +The ODT export back-end has extensive features useful for power users +and frequent uses of ODT formats. + +* Menu: + +* Configuring a document converter:: Registering a document converter. +* Working with OpenDocument style files:: Exploring internals. +* Creating one-off styles:: Customizing styles, highlighting. +* Customizing tables in ODT export:: Defining table templates. +* Validating OpenDocument XML:: Debugging corrupted OpenDocument files. + + +File: org, Node: Configuring a document converter, Next: Working with OpenDocument style files, Up: Advanced topics in ODT export + +Configuring a document converter +................................ + +The ODT export back-end works with popular converters with little or no +extra configuration. *Note Extending ODT export::. The following is +for unsupported converters or tweaking existing defaults. + + 1. Register the converter + + Add the name of the converter to the `org-odt-convert-processes' + variable. Note that it also requires how the converter is invoked + on the command line. See the variable's docstring for details. + + 2. Configure its capabilities + + Specify which formats the converter can handle by customizing the + variable `org-odt-convert-capabilities'. Use the entry for the + default values in this variable for configuring the new converter. + Also see its docstring for details. + + 3. Choose the converter + + Select the newly added converter as the preferred one by + customizing the option `org-odt-convert-process'. + + +File: org, Node: Working with OpenDocument style files, Next: Creating one-off styles, Prev: Configuring a document converter, Up: Advanced topics in ODT export + +Working with OpenDocument style files +..................................... + +This section explores the internals of the ODT exporter; the means by +which it produces styled documents; the use of automatic and custom +OpenDocument styles. + +a) Factory styles +................. + +The ODT exporter relies on two files for generating its output. These +files are bundled with the distribution under the directory pointed to +by the variable `org-odt-styles-dir'. The two files are: + + * `OrgOdtStyles.xml' + + This file contributes to the `styles.xml' file of the final `ODT' + document. This file gets modified for the following purposes: + 1. To control outline numbering based on user settings. + + 2. To add styles generated by `htmlfontify.el' for fontification + of code blocks. + + * `OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml' + + This file contributes to the `content.xml' file of the final `ODT' + document. The contents of the Org outline are inserted between the + `<office:text>'...`</office:text>' elements of this file. + + Apart from serving as a template file for the final `content.xml', + the file serves the following purposes: + 1. It contains automatic styles for formatting of tables which + are referenced by the exporter. + + 2. It contains `<text:sequence-decl>'...`</text:sequence-decl>' + elements that control numbering of tables, images, equations, + and similar entities. + +b) Overriding factory styles +............................ + +The following two variables control the location from where the ODT +exporter picks up the custom styles and content template files. +Customize these variables to override the factory styles used by the +exporter. + + * `org-odt-styles-file' + + The ODT export back-end uses the file pointed to by this variable, + such as `styles.xml', for the final output. It can take one of + the following values: + + 1. A `styles.xml' file + + Use this file instead of the default `styles.xml' + + 2. A `.odt' or `.ott' file + + Use the `styles.xml' contained in the specified OpenDocument + Text or Template file + + 3. A `.odt' or `.ott' file and a subset of files contained + within them + + Use the `styles.xml' contained in the specified OpenDocument + Text or Template file. Additionally extract the specified + member files and embed those within the final `ODT' document. + + Use this option if the `styles.xml' file references + additional files like header and footer images. + + 4. `nil' + + Use the default `styles.xml' + + * `org-odt-content-template-file' + + Use this variable to specify the blank `content.xml' that will be + used in the final output. + + +File: org, Node: Creating one-off styles, Next: Customizing tables in ODT export, Prev: Working with OpenDocument style files, Up: Advanced topics in ODT export + +Creating one-off styles +....................... + +The ODT export back-end can read embedded raw OpenDocument XML from the +Org file. Such direct formatting are useful for one-off instances. + + 1. Embedding ODT tags as part of regular text + + Enclose OpenDocument syntax in `@@odt:...@@' for inline markup. + For example, to highlight a region of text do the following: + + @@odt:<text:span text:style-name="Highlight">This is highlighted + text</text:span>@@. But this is regular text. + + *Hint:* To see the above example in action, edit the `styles.xml' + (*note Factory styles: x-orgodtstyles-xml.) and add a custom + `Highlight' style as shown below: + + <style:style style:name="Highlight" style:family="text"> + <style:text-properties fo:background-color="#ff0000"/> + </style:style> + + 2. Embedding a one-line OpenDocument XML + + The ODT export back-end can read one-liner options with `#+ODT:' + in the Org file. For example, to force a page break: + + #+ODT: <text:p text:style-name="PageBreak"/> + + *Hint:* To see the above example in action, edit your `styles.xml' + (*note Factory styles: x-orgodtstyles-xml.) and add a custom + `PageBreak' style as shown below. + + <style:style style:name="PageBreak" style:family="paragraph" + style:parent-style-name="Text_20_body"> + <style:paragraph-properties fo:break-before="page"/> + </style:style> + + 3. Embedding a block of OpenDocument XML + + The ODT export back-end can also read ODT export blocks for + OpenDocument XML. Such blocks use the `#+BEGIN_EXPORT + odt'...`#+END_EXPORT' constructs. + + For example, to create a one-off paragraph that uses bold text, do + the following: + + #+BEGIN_EXPORT odt + <text:p text:style-name="Text_20_body_20_bold"> + This paragraph is specially formatted and uses bold text. + </text:p> + #+END_EXPORT + + + +File: org, Node: Customizing tables in ODT export, Next: Validating OpenDocument XML, Prev: Creating one-off styles, Up: Advanced topics in ODT export + +Customizing tables in ODT export +................................ + +Override the default table format by specifying a custom table style +with the `#+ATTR_ODT' line. For a discussion on default formatting of +tables *note Tables in ODT export::. + + This feature closely mimics the way table templates are defined in +the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification.(1) + + For quick preview of this feature, install the settings below and +export the table that follows: + + (setq org-odt-table-styles + (append org-odt-table-styles + '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom" + ((use-first-row-styles . t) + (use-first-column-styles . t))) + ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom" + ((use-first-row-styles . t) + (use-last-row-styles . t)))))) + + #+ATTR_ODT: :style TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn + | Name | Phone | Age | + | Peter | 1234 | 17 | + | Anna | 4321 | 25 | + + The example above used `Custom' template and installed two table +styles `TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn' and `TableWithFirstRowandLastRow'. +*Important:* The OpenDocument styles needed for producing the above +template were pre-defined. They are available in the section marked +`Custom Table Template' in `OrgOdtContentTemplate.xml' (*note Factory +styles: x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml. For adding new templates, define +new styles here. + + To use this feature proceed as follows: + + 1. Create a table template(2) + + A table template is set of `table-cell' and `paragraph' styles for + each of the following table cell categories: + + - Body + + - First column + + - Last column + + - First row + + - Last row + + - Even row + + - Odd row + + - Even column + + - Odd Column + + The names for the above styles must be chosen based on the name of + the table template using a well-defined convention. + + The naming convention is better illustrated with an example. For + a table template with the name `Custom', the needed style names + are listed in the following table. + + Table cell type `table-cell' style `paragraph' style + ------------------------------------------------------------------------------- + + Body `CustomTableCell' `CustomTableParagraph' + First column `CustomFirstColumnTableCell'`CustomFirstColumnTableParagraph' + Last column `CustomLastColumnTableCell' `CustomLastColumnTableParagraph' + First row `CustomFirstRowTableCell' `CustomFirstRowTableParagraph' + Last row `CustomLastRowTableCell' `CustomLastRowTableParagraph' + Even row `CustomEvenRowTableCell' `CustomEvenRowTableParagraph' + Odd row `CustomOddRowTableCell' `CustomOddRowTableParagraph' + Even column `CustomEvenColumnTableCell' `CustomEvenColumnTableParagraph' + Odd column `CustomOddColumnTableCell' `CustomOddColumnTableParagraph' + + To create a table template with the name `Custom', define the above + styles in the + `<office:automatic-styles>'...`</office:automatic-styles>' element + of the content template file (*note Factory styles: + x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml.). + + 2. Define a table style(3) + + To define a table style, create an entry for the style in the + variable `org-odt-table-styles' and specify the following: + + - the name of the table template created in step (1) + + - the set of cell styles in that template that are to be + activated + + For example, the entry below defines two different table styles + `TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn' and `TableWithFirstRowandLastRow' + based on the same template `Custom'. The styles achieve their + intended effect by selectively activating the individual cell + styles in that template. + + (setq org-odt-table-styles + (append org-odt-table-styles + '(("TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" "Custom" + ((use-first-row-styles . t) + (use-first-column-styles . t))) + ("TableWithFirstRowandLastRow" "Custom" + ((use-first-row-styles . t) + (use-last-row-styles . t)))))) + + 3. Associate a table with the table style + + To do this, specify the table style created in step (2) as part of + the `ATTR_ODT' line as shown below. + + #+ATTR_ODT: :style "TableWithHeaderRowAndColumn" + | Name | Phone | Age | + | Peter | 1234 | 17 | + | Anna | 4321 | 25 | + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) OpenDocument-v1.2 Specification +(http://docs.oasis-open.org/office/v1.2/OpenDocument-v1.2.html) + + (2) See the `<table:table-template>' element of the +OpenDocument-v1.2 specification + + (3) See the attributes `table:template-name', +`table:use-first-row-styles', `table:use-last-row-styles', +`table:use-first-column-styles', `table:use-last-column-styles', +`table:use-banding-rows-styles', and `table:use-banding-column-styles' +of the `<table:table>' element in the OpenDocument-v1.2 specification + + +File: org, Node: Validating OpenDocument XML, Prev: Customizing tables in ODT export, Up: Advanced topics in ODT export + +Validating OpenDocument XML +........................... + +Sometimes ODT format files may not open due to `.odt' file corruption. +To verify if the `.odt' file is corrupt, validate it against the +OpenDocument RELAX NG Compact Syntax--RNC--schema. But first the +`.odt' files have to be decompressed using `zip'. Note that `.odt' +files are `zip' archives: *note (emacs)File Archives::. The contents +of `.odt' files are in `.xml'. For general help with validation--and +schema-sensitive editing--of XML files: *note (nxml-mode)Introduction::. + + Customize `org-odt-schema-dir' to point to a directory with +OpenDocument `.rnc' files and the needed schema-locating rules. The +ODT export back-end takes care of updating the +`rng-schema-locating-files'. + + +File: org, Node: Org export, Next: Texinfo export, Prev: OpenDocument Text export, Up: Exporting + +12.13 Org export +================ + +`org' export back-end creates a normalized version of the Org document +in current buffer. The exporter evaluates Babel code (*note Evaluating +code blocks::) and removes content specific to other back-ends. + +Org export commands +------------------- + +`C-c C-e O o (`org-org-export-to-org')' + Export as an Org file with a `.org' extension. For `myfile.org', + Org exports to `myfile.org.org', overwriting without warning. + +`C-c C-e O O (`org-org-export-as-org')' + Export to a temporary buffer. Does not create a file. + +`C-c C-e O v' + Export to an Org file, then open it. + + +File: org, Node: Texinfo export, Next: iCalendar export, Prev: Org export, Up: Exporting + +12.14 Texinfo export +==================== + +The `texinfo' export back-end generates documents with Texinfo code that +can compile to Info format. + +* Menu: + +* Texinfo export commands:: Invoking commands. +* Texinfo specific export settings:: Setting the environment. +* Texinfo file header:: Generating the header. +* Texinfo title and copyright page:: Creating preamble pages. +* Info directory file:: Installing a manual in Info file hierarchy. +* Headings and sectioning structure:: Building document structure. +* Indices:: Creating indices. +* Quoting Texinfo code:: Incorporating literal Texinfo code. +* Plain lists in Texinfo export:: List attributes. +* Tables in Texinfo export:: Table attributes. +* Images in Texinfo export:: Image attributes. +* Special blocks in Texinfo export:: Special block attributes. +* A Texinfo example:: Processing Org to Texinfo. + + +File: org, Node: Texinfo export commands, Next: Texinfo specific export settings, Up: Texinfo export + +12.14.1 Texinfo export commands +------------------------------- + +`C-c C-e i t (`org-texinfo-export-to-texinfo')' + Export as a Texinfo file with `.texi' extension. For `myfile.org', + Org exports to `myfile.texi', overwriting without warning. + +`C-c C-e i i (`org-texinfo-export-to-info')' + Export to Texinfo format first and then process it to make an Info + file. To generate other formats, such as DocBook, customize the + `org-texinfo-info-process' variable. + + +File: org, Node: Texinfo specific export settings, Next: Texinfo file header, Prev: Texinfo export commands, Up: Texinfo export + +12.14.2 Texinfo specific export settings +---------------------------------------- + +The Texinfo export back-end has several additional keywords for +customizing Texinfo output. Setting these keywords works similar to +the general options (*note Export settings::). + +`SUBTITLE' + The document subtitle. + +`SUBAUTHOR' + The document subauthor. + +`TEXINFO_FILENAME' + The Texinfo filename. + +`TEXINFO_CLASS' + The default document class (`org-texinfo-default-class'), which + must be a member of `org-texinfo-classes'. + +`TEXINFO_HEADER' + Arbitrary lines inserted at the end of the header. + +`TEXINFO_POST_HEADER' + Arbitrary lines inserted after the end of the header. + +`TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY' + The directory category of the document. + +`TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE' + The directory title of the document. + +`TEXINFO_DIR_DESC' + The directory description of the document. + +`TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE' + The printed title of the document. + + +File: org, Node: Texinfo file header, Next: Texinfo title and copyright page, Prev: Texinfo specific export settings, Up: Texinfo export + +12.14.3 Texinfo file header +--------------------------- + +After creating the header for a Texinfo file, the Texinfo back-end +automatically generates a name and destination path for the Info file. +To override this default with a more sensible path and name, specify the +`#+TEXINFO_FILENAME' keyword. + + Along with the output's file name, the Texinfo header also contains +language details (*note Export settings::) and encoding system as set +in the `org-texinfo-coding-system' variable. Insert `#+TEXINFO_HEADER' +keywords for each additional command in the header, for example: +@code{@synindex}. + + Instead of repeatedly installing the same set of commands, define a +class in `org-texinfo-classes' once, and then activate it in the +document by setting the `#+TEXINFO_CLASS' keyword to that class. + + +File: org, Node: Texinfo title and copyright page, Next: Info directory file, Prev: Texinfo file header, Up: Texinfo export + +12.14.4 Texinfo title and copyright page +---------------------------------------- + +The default template for hard copy output has a title page with +`#+TITLE' and `#+AUTHOR' (*note Export settings::). To replace the +regular `#+TITLE' with something different for the printed version, use +the `#+TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE' and `#+SUBTITLE' keywords. Both expect +raw Texinfo code for setting their values. + + If one `#+AUTHOR' is not sufficient, add multiple `#+SUBAUTHOR' +keywords. They have to be set in raw Texinfo code. + + #+AUTHOR: Jane Smith + #+SUBAUTHOR: John Doe + #+TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE: This Long Title@inlinefmt{tex,@*} Is Broken in @TeX{} + + Copying material is defined in a dedicated headline with a non-`nil' +`:COPYING:' property. The back-end inserts the contents within a +`@copying' command at the beginning of the document. The heading +itself does not appear in the structure of the document. + + Copyright information is printed on the back of the title page. + + * Legalese + :PROPERTIES: + :COPYING: t + :END: + + This is a short example of a complete Texinfo file, version 1.0. + + Copyright \copy 2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + +File: org, Node: Info directory file, Next: Headings and sectioning structure, Prev: Texinfo title and copyright page, Up: Texinfo export + +12.14.5 Info directory file +--------------------------- + +The end result of the Texinfo export process is the creation of an Info +file. This Info file's metadata has variables for category, title, and +description: `#+TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY', `#+TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE', and +`#+TEXINFO_DIR_DESC' that establish where in the Info hierarchy the file +fits. + + Here is an example that writes to the Info directory file: + + #+TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY: Emacs + #+TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE: Org Mode: (org) + #+TEXINFO_DIR_DESC: Outline-based notes management and organizer + + +File: org, Node: Headings and sectioning structure, Next: Indices, Prev: Info directory file, Up: Texinfo export + +12.14.6 Headings and sectioning structure +----------------------------------------- + +The Texinfo export back-end uses a pre-defined scheme to convert Org +headlines to an equivalent Texinfo structuring commands. A scheme like +this maps top-level headlines to numbered chapters tagged as `@chapter' +and lower-level headlines to unnumbered chapters tagged as +`@unnumbered'. To override such mappings to introduce `@part' or other +Texinfo structuring commands, define a new class in +`org-texinfo-classes'. Activate the new class with the +`#+TEXINFO_CLASS' keyword. When no new class is defined and activated, +the Texinfo export back-end defaults to the `org-texinfo-default-class'. + + If an Org headline's level has no associated Texinfo structuring +command, or is below a certain threshold (*note Export settings::), +then the Texinfo export back-end makes it into a list item. + + The Texinfo export back-end makes any headline with a non-`nil' +`:APPENDIX:' property into an appendix. This happens independent of the +Org headline level or the `#+TEXINFO_CLASS'. + + The Texinfo export back-end creates a menu entry after the Org +headline for each regular sectioning structure. To override this with +a shorter menu entry, use the `:ALT_TITLE:' property (*note Table of +contents::). Texinfo menu entries also have an option for a longer +`:DESCRIPTION:' property. Here's an example that uses both to override +the default menu entry: + + * Controlling Screen Display + :PROPERTIES: + :ALT_TITLE: Display + :DESCRIPTION: Controlling Screen Display + :END: + + The text before the first headline belongs to the `Top' node, i.e., +the node in which a reader enters an Info manual. As such, it is +expected not to appear in printed output generated from the `.texi' +file. *note (texinfo)The Top Node::, for more information. + + +File: org, Node: Indices, Next: Quoting Texinfo code, Prev: Headings and sectioning structure, Up: Texinfo export + +12.14.7 Indices +--------------- + +The Texinfo export back-end recognizes these indexing keywords if used +in the Org file: `#+CINDEX', `#+FINDEX', `#+KINDEX', `#+PINDEX', +`#+TINDEX', and `#+VINDEX'. Write their value as verbatim Texinfo +code; in particular, `{', `}' and `@' characters need to be escaped +with `@' if they not belong to a Texinfo command. + + #+CINDEX: Defining indexing entries + + For the back-end to generate an index entry for a headline, set the +`:INDEX:' property to `cp' or `vr'. These abbreviations come from +Texinfo that stand for concept index and variable index. The Texinfo +manual has abbreviations for all other kinds of indexes. The back-end +exports the headline as an unnumbered chapter or section command, and +then inserts the index after its contents. + + * Concept Index + :PROPERTIES: + :INDEX: cp + :END: + + +File: org, Node: Quoting Texinfo code, Next: Plain lists in Texinfo export, Prev: Indices, Up: Texinfo export + +12.14.8 Quoting Texinfo code +---------------------------- + +Use any of the following three methods to insert or escape raw Texinfo +code: + + Richard @@texinfo:@sc{@@Stallman@@texinfo:}@@ commence' GNU. + + #+TEXINFO: @need800 + This paragraph is preceded by... + + #+BEGIN_EXPORT texinfo + @auindex Johnson, Mark + @auindex Lakoff, George + #+END_EXPORT + + +File: org, Node: Plain lists in Texinfo export, Next: Tables in Texinfo export, Prev: Quoting Texinfo code, Up: Texinfo export + +12.14.9 Plain lists in Texinfo export +------------------------------------- + +The Texinfo export back-end by default converts description lists in +the Org file using the default command `@table', which results in a +table with two columns. To change this behavior, specify `:table-type' +with `ftable' or `vtable' attributes. For more information, *note +(texinfo)Two-column Tables::. + + The Texinfo export back-end by default also applies a text highlight +based on the defaults stored in `org-texinfo-table-default-markup'. To +override the default highlight command, specify another one with the +`:indic' attribute. + + Org syntax is limited to one entry per list item. Nevertheless, the +Texinfo export back-end can split that entry according to any text +provided through the `:sep' attribute. Each part then becomes a new +entry in the first column of the table. + + The following example illustrates all the attributes above: + + #+ATTR_TEXINFO: :table-type vtable :sep , :indic asis + - foo, bar :: This is the common text for variables foo and bar. + +becomes + + @vtable @asis + @item foo + @itemx bar + This is the common text for variables foo and bar. + @end table + + +File: org, Node: Tables in Texinfo export, Next: Images in Texinfo export, Prev: Plain lists in Texinfo export, Up: Texinfo export + +12.14.10 Tables in Texinfo export +--------------------------------- + +When exporting tables, the Texinfo export back-end uses the widest cell +width in each column. To override this and instead specify as +fractions of line length, use the `:columns' attribute. See example +below. + + #+ATTR_TEXINFO: :columns .5 .5 + | a cell | another cell | + + +File: org, Node: Images in Texinfo export, Next: Special blocks in Texinfo export, Prev: Tables in Texinfo export, Up: Texinfo export + +12.14.11 Images in Texinfo export +--------------------------------- + +Insert a file link to the image in the Org file, and the Texinfo export +back-end inserts the image. These links must have the usual supported +image extensions and no descriptions. To scale the image, use `:width' +and `:height' attributes. For alternate text, use `:alt' and specify +the text using Texinfo code, as shown in the example: + + #+ATTR_TEXINFO: :width 1in :alt Alternate @i{text} + [[ridt.pdf]] + + +File: org, Node: Special blocks in Texinfo export, Next: A Texinfo example, Prev: Images in Texinfo export, Up: Texinfo export + +12.14.12 Special blocks +----------------------- + +The Texinfo export back-end converts special blocks to commands with +the same name. It also adds any `:options' attributes to the end of +the command, as shown in this example: + + #+ATTR_TEXINFO: :options org-org-export-to-org ... + #+begin_defun + A somewhat obsessive function. + #+end_defun + +becomes + + @defun org-org-export-to-org ... + A somewhat obsessive function. + @end defun + + +File: org, Node: A Texinfo example, Prev: Special blocks in Texinfo export, Up: Texinfo export + +12.14.13 A Texinfo example +-------------------------- + +Here is a more detailed example Org file. See *note GNU Sample Texts: +(texinfo)GNU Sample Texts. for an equivalent example using Texinfo code. + + #+TITLE: GNU Sample {{{version}}} + #+SUBTITLE: for version {{{version}}}, {{{updated}}} + #+AUTHOR: A.U. Thor + #+EMAIL: bug-sample@gnu.org + + #+OPTIONS: ':t toc:t author:t email:t + #+LANGUAGE: en + + #+MACRO: version 2.0 + #+MACRO: updated last updated 4 March 2014 + + #+TEXINFO_FILENAME: sample.info + #+TEXINFO_HEADER: @syncodeindex pg cp + + #+TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY: Texinfo documentation system + #+TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE: sample: (sample) + #+TEXINFO_DIR_DESC: Invoking sample + + #+TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE: GNU Sample + + This manual is for GNU Sample (version {{{version}}}, + {{{updated}}}). + + * Copying + :PROPERTIES: + :COPYING: t + :END: + + This manual is for GNU Sample (version {{{version}}}, + {{{updated}}}), which is an example in the Texinfo documentation. + + Copyright \copy 2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + + #+BEGIN_QUOTE + Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this + document under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, + Version 1.3 or any later version published by the Free Software + Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, + and with no Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in + the section entitled "GNU Free Documentation License". + #+END_QUOTE + + * Invoking sample + + #+PINDEX: sample + #+CINDEX: invoking @command{sample} + + This is a sample manual. There is no sample program to invoke, but + if there were, you could see its basic usage and command line + options here. + + * GNU Free Documentation License + :PROPERTIES: + :APPENDIX: t + :END: + + #+TEXINFO: @include fdl.texi + + * Index + :PROPERTIES: + :INDEX: cp + :END: + + +File: org, Node: iCalendar export, Next: Other built-in back-ends, Prev: Texinfo export, Up: Exporting + +12.15 iCalendar export +====================== + +A large part of Org mode's inter-operability success is its ability to +easily export to or import from external applications. The iCalendar +export back-end takes calendar data from Org files and exports to the +standard iCalendar format. + + The iCalendar export back-end can also incorporate TODO entries +based on the configuration of the `org-icalendar-include-todo' +variable. The back-end exports plain timestamps as VEVENT, TODO items +as VTODO, and also create events from deadlines that are in non-TODO +items. The back-end uses the deadlines and scheduling dates in Org +TODO items for setting the start and due dates for the iCalendar TODO +entry. Consult the `org-icalendar-use-deadline' and +`org-icalendar-use-scheduled' variables for more details. + + For tags on the headline, the iCalendar export back-end makes them +into iCalendar categories. To tweak the inheritance of tags and TODO +states, configure the variable `org-icalendar-categories'. To assign +clock alarms based on time, configure the `org-icalendar-alarm-time' +variable. + + The iCalendar format standard requires globally unique +identifier--UID--for each entry. The iCalendar export back-end creates +UIDs during export. To save a copy of the UID in the Org file set the +variable `org-icalendar-store-UID'. The back-end looks for the `:ID:' +property of the entry for re-using the same UID for subsequent exports. + + Since a single Org entry can result in multiple iCalendar entries--as +timestamp, deadline, scheduled item, or TODO item--Org adds prefixes to +the UID, depending on which part of the Org entry triggered the +creation of the iCalendar entry. Prefixing ensures UIDs remains +unique, yet enable synchronization programs trace the connections. + +`C-c C-e c f (`org-icalendar-export-to-ics')' + Create iCalendar entries from the current Org buffer and store + them in the same directory, using a file extension `.ics'. + +`C-c C-e c a (`org-icalendar-export-agenda-files')' + Create iCalendar entries from Org files in `org-agenda-files' and + store in a separate iCalendar file for each Org file. + +`C-c C-e c c (`org-icalendar-combine-agenda-files')' + Create a combined iCalendar file from Org files in + `org-agenda-files' and write it to + `org-icalendar-combined-agenda-file' file name. + + The iCalendar export back-end includes SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION, +LOCATION and TIMEZONE properties from the Org entries when exporting. +To force the back-end to inherit the LOCATION and TIMEZONE properties, +configure the `org-use-property-inheritance' variable. + + When Org entries do not have SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION +properties, the iCalendar export back-end derives the summary from the +headline, and derives the description from the body of the Org item. +The `org-icalendar-include-body' variable limits the maximum number of +characters of the content are turned into its description. + + The TIMEZONE property can be used to specify a per-entry time zone, +and will be applied to any entry with timestamp information. Time +zones should be specified as per the IANA time zone database format, +e.g. "Asia/Almaty". Alternately, the property value can be "UTC", to +force UTC time for this entry only. + + Exporting to iCalendar format depends in large part on the +capabilities of the destination application. Some are more lenient +than others. Consult the Org mode FAQ for advice on specific +applications. + + +File: org, Node: Other built-in back-ends, Next: Advanced configuration, Prev: iCalendar export, Up: Exporting + +12.16 Other built-in back-ends +============================== + +Other export back-ends included with Org are: + + * `ox-man.el': export to a man page. + + To activate such back-ends, either customize `org-export-backends' or +load directly with `(require 'ox-man)'. On successful load, the +back-end adds new keys in the export dispatcher (*note The export +dispatcher::). + + Follow the comment section of such files, for example, `ox-man.el', +for usage and configuration details. + + +File: org, Node: Advanced configuration, Next: Export in foreign buffers, Prev: Other built-in back-ends, Up: Exporting + +12.17 Advanced configuration +============================ + +Hooks +----- + +The export process executes two hooks before the actual exporting +begins. The first hook, `org-export-before-processing-hook', runs +before any expansions of macros, Babel code, and include keywords in +the buffer. The second hook, `org-export-before-parsing-hook', runs +before the buffer is parsed. Both hooks are specified as functions, +see example below. Their main use is for heavy duty structural +modifications of the Org content. For example, removing every headline +in the buffer during export: + + (defun my-headline-removal (backend) + "Remove all headlines in the current buffer. + BACKEND is the export back-end being used, as a symbol." + (org-map-entries + (lambda () (delete-region (point) (progn (forward-line) (point)))))) + + (add-hook 'org-export-before-parsing-hook 'my-headline-removal) + + Note that the hook function must have a mandatory argument that is a +symbol for the back-end. + +Filters +------- + +The Org export process relies on filters to process specific parts of +conversion process. Filters are just lists of functions to be applied +to certain parts for a given back-end. The output from the first +function in the filter is passed on to the next function in the filter. +The final output is the output from the final function in the filter. + + The Org export process has many filter sets applicable to different +types of objects, plain text, parse trees, export options, and final +output formats. The filters are named after the element type or object +type: `org-export-filter-TYPE-functions', where `TYPE' is the type +targeted by the filter. Valid types are: + +body bold babel-call +center-block clock code +diary-sexp drawer dynamic-block +entity example-block export-block +export-snippet final-output fixed-width +footnote-definition footnote-reference headline +horizontal-rule inline-babel-call inline-src-block +inlinetask italic item +keyword latex-environment latex-fragment +line-break link node-property +options paragraph parse-tree +plain-list plain-text planning +property-drawer quote-block radio-target +section special-block src-block +statistics-cookie strike-through subscript +superscript table table-cell +table-row target timestamp +underline verbatim verse-block + + Here is an example filter that replaces non-breaking spaces `~' in +the Org buffer with `_' for the LaTeX back-end. + + (defun my-latex-filter-nobreaks (text backend info) + "Ensure \"_\" are properly handled in LaTeX export." + (when (org-export-derived-backend-p backend 'latex) + (replace-regexp-in-string "_" "~" text))) + + (add-to-list 'org-export-filter-plain-text-functions + 'my-latex-filter-nobreaks) + + A filter requires three arguments: the code to be transformed, the +name of the back-end, and some optional information about the export +process. The third argument can be safely ignored. Note the use of +`org-export-derived-backend-p' predicate that tests for `latex' +back-end or any other back-end, such as `beamer', derived from `latex'. + +Defining filters for individual files +------------------------------------- + +The Org export can filter not just for back-ends, but also for specific +files through the `#+BIND' keyword. Here is an example with two +filters; one removes brackets from time stamps, and the other removes +strike-through text. The filter functions are defined in a `src' code +block in the same Org file, which is a handy location for debugging. + + #+BIND: org-export-filter-timestamp-functions (tmp-f-timestamp) + #+BIND: org-export-filter-strike-through-functions (tmp-f-strike-through) + #+begin_src emacs-lisp :exports results :results none + (defun tmp-f-timestamp (s backend info) + (replace-regexp-in-string "&[lg]t;\\|[][]" "" s)) + (defun tmp-f-strike-through (s backend info) "") + #+end_src + +Extending an existing back-end +------------------------------ + +Some parts of the conversion process can be extended for certain +elements so as to introduce a new or revised translation. That is how +the HTML export back-end was extended to handle Markdown format. The +extensions work seamlessly so any aspect of filtering not done by the +extended back-end is handled by the original back-end. Of all the +export customization in Org, extending is very powerful as it operates +at the parser level. + + For this example, make the `ascii' back-end display the language +used in a source code block. Also make it display only when some +attribute is non-`nil', like the following: + + #+ATTR_ASCII: :language t + + Then extend `ascii' back-end with a custom `my-ascii' back-end. + + (defun my-ascii-src-block (src-block contents info) + "Transcode a SRC-BLOCK element from Org to ASCII. + CONTENTS is nil. INFO is a plist used as a communication + channel." + (if (not (org-export-read-attribute :attr_ascii src-block :language)) + (org-export-with-backend 'ascii src-block contents info) + (concat + (format ",--[ %s ]--\n%s`----" + (org-element-property :language src-block) + (replace-regexp-in-string + "^" "| " + (org-element-normalize-string + (org-export-format-code-default src-block info))))))) + + (org-export-define-derived-backend 'my-ascii 'ascii + :translate-alist '((src-block . my-ascii-src-block))) + + The `my-ascii-src-block' function looks at the attribute above the +current element. If not true, hands over to `ascii' back-end. If true, +which it is in this example, it creates a box around the code and +leaves room for the inserting a string for language. The last form +creates the new back-end that springs to action only when translating +`src-block' type elements. + + To use the newly defined back-end, call the following from an Org +buffer: + + (org-export-to-buffer 'my-ascii "*Org MY-ASCII Export*") + + Further steps to consider would be an interactive function, +self-installing an item in the export dispatcher menu, and other +user-friendly improvements. + + +File: org, Node: Export in foreign buffers, Prev: Advanced configuration, Up: Exporting + +12.18 Export in foreign buffers +=============================== + +The export back-ends in Org often include commands to convert selected +regions. A convenient feature of this in-place conversion is that the +exported output replaces the original source. Here are such functions: + +`org-html-convert-region-to-html' + Convert the selected region into HTML. + +`org-latex-convert-region-to-latex' + Convert the selected region into LaTeX. + +`org-texinfo-convert-region-to-texinfo' + Convert the selected region into `Texinfo'. + +`org-md-convert-region-to-md' + Convert the selected region into `MarkDown'. + + In-place conversions are particularly handy for quick conversion of +tables and lists in foreign buffers. For example, turn on the minor +mode `M-x orgstruct-mode' in an HTML buffer, then use the convenient +Org keyboard commands to create a list, select it, and covert it to +HTML with `M-x org-html-convert-region-to-html RET'. + + +File: org, Node: Publishing, Next: Working with source code, Prev: Exporting, Up: Top + +13 Publishing +************* + +Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure +automatic HTML conversion of _projects_ composed of interlinked org +files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your +exported HTML pages and related attachments, such as images and source +code files, to a web server. + + You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML +and PDF conversion so that files are available in both formats on the +server. + + Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole. + +* Menu: + +* Configuration:: Defining projects +* Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server +* Sample configuration:: Example projects +* Triggering publication:: Publication commands + + +File: org, Node: Configuration, Next: Uploading files, Up: Publishing + +13.1 Configuration +================== + +Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination +and many other properties of a project. + +* Menu: + +* Project alist:: The central configuration variable +* Sources and destinations:: From here to there +* Selecting files:: What files are part of the project? +* Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing +* Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/LaTeX export +* Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing? +* Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages +* Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages + + +File: org, Node: Project alist, Next: Sources and destinations, Up: Configuration + +13.1.1 The variable `org-publish-project-alist' +----------------------------------------------- + +Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of +one variable, called `org-publish-project-alist'. Each element of the +list configures one project, and may be in one of the two following +forms: + + ("project-name" :property value :property value ...) + i.e., a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values + or + ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...)) + + In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property +values. A project defines the set of files that will be published, as +well as the publishing configuration to use when publishing those +files. When a project takes the second form listed above, the +individual members of the `:components' property are taken to be +sub-projects, which group together files requiring different publishing +options. When you publish such a "meta-project", all the components +will also be published, in the sequence given. + + +File: org, Node: Sources and destinations, Next: Selecting files, Prev: Project alist, Up: Configuration + +13.1.2 Sources and destinations for files +----------------------------------------- + +Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In +particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files, and where +to put published files. + +`:base-directory' Directory containing publishing source files +`:publishing-directory'Directory where output files will be published. + You can directly publish to a web server using a + file name syntax appropriate for the Emacs + `tramp' package. Or you can publish to a local + directory and use external tools to upload your + website (*note Uploading files::). +`:preparation-function'Function or list of functions to be called before + starting the publishing process, for example, to + run `make' for updating files to be published. + Each preparation function is called with a single + argument, the project property list. +`:completion-function' Function or list of functions called after + finishing the publishing process, for example, to + change permissions of the resulting files. Each + completion function is called with a single + argument, the project property list. + + +File: org, Node: Selecting files, Next: Publishing action, Prev: Sources and destinations, Up: Configuration + +13.1.3 Selecting files +---------------------- + +By default, all files with extension `.org' in the base directory are +considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the +properties +`:base-extension' Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This + actually is a regular expression. Set this to the + symbol `any' if you want to get all files in + `:base-directory', even without extension. +`:exclude' Regular expression to match file names that should + not be published, even though they have been selected + on the basis of their extension. +`:include' List of files to be included regardless of + `:base-extension' and `:exclude'. +`:recursive' non-`nil' means, check base-directory recursively for + files to publish. + + +File: org, Node: Publishing action, Next: Publishing options, Prev: Selecting files, Up: Configuration + +13.1.4 Publishing action +------------------------ + +Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and +possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to +export Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function +`org-html-publish-to-html', which calls the HTML exporter (*note HTML +export::). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using +`org-latex-publish-to-pdf' or as `ascii', `Texinfo', etc., using the +corresponding functions. + + If you want to publish the Org file as an `.org' file but with the +archived, commented and tag-excluded trees removed, use the function +`org-org-publish-to-org'. This will produce `file.org' and put it in +the publishing directory. If you want a htmlized version of this file, +set the parameter `:htmlized-source' to `t', it will produce +`file.org.html' in the publishing directory(1). + + Other files like images only need to be copied to the publishing +destination. For this you can use `org-publish-attachment'. For +non-org files, you always need to specify the publishing function: + +`:publishing-function' Function executing the publication of a file. + This may also be a list of functions, which will + all be called in turn. +`:htmlized-source' non-`nil' means, publish htmlized source. + + The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing +at least a `:publishing-directory' property, the name of the file to be +published and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. +It should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation +(if any) and place the result into the destination folder. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) If the publishing directory is the same than the source +directory, `file.org' will be exported as `file.org.org', so probably +don't want to do this. + + +File: org, Node: Publishing options, Next: Publishing links, Prev: Publishing action, Up: Configuration + +13.1.5 Options for the exporters +-------------------------------- + +The property list can be used to set export options during the +publishing process. In most cases, these properties correspond to user +variables in Org. While some properties are available for all export +back-ends, most of them are back-end specific. The following sections +list properties along with the variable they belong to. See the +documentation string of these options for details. + + When a property is given a value in `org-publish-project-alist', its +setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if any) +during publishing. Options set within a file (*note Export settings::), +however, override everything. + +Generic properties +.................. + +`:archived-trees' `org-export-with-archived-trees' +`:exclude-tags' `org-export-exclude-tags' +`:headline-levels' `org-export-headline-levels' +`:language' `org-export-default-language' +`:preserve-breaks' `org-export-preserve-breaks' +`:section-numbers' `org-export-with-section-numbers' +`:select-tags' `org-export-select-tags' +`:with-author' `org-export-with-author' +`:with-broken-links' `org-export-with-broken-links' +`:with-clocks' `org-export-with-clocks' +`:with-creator' `org-export-with-creator' +`:with-date' `org-export-with-date' +`:with-drawers' `org-export-with-drawers' +`:with-email' `org-export-with-email' +`:with-emphasize' `org-export-with-emphasize' +`:with-fixed-width' `org-export-with-fixed-width' +`:with-footnotes' `org-export-with-footnotes' +`:with-latex' `org-export-with-latex' +`:with-planning' `org-export-with-planning' +`:with-priority' `org-export-with-priority' +`:with-properties' `org-export-with-properties' +`:with-special-strings' `org-export-with-special-strings' +`:with-sub-superscript' `org-export-with-sub-superscripts' +`:with-tables' `org-export-with-tables' +`:with-tags' `org-export-with-tags' +`:with-tasks' `org-export-with-tasks' +`:with-timestamps' `org-export-with-timestamps' +`:with-title' `org-export-with-title' +`:with-toc' `org-export-with-toc' +`:with-todo-keywords' `org-export-with-todo-keywords' + +ASCII specific properties +......................... + +`:ascii-bullets' `org-ascii-bullets' +`:ascii-caption-above' `org-ascii-caption-above' +`:ascii-charset' `org-ascii-charset' +`:ascii-global-margin' `org-ascii-global-margin' +`:ascii-format-drawer-function' `org-ascii-format-drawer-function' +`:ascii-format-inlinetask-function' `org-ascii-format-inlinetask-function' +`:ascii-headline-spacing' `org-ascii-headline-spacing' +`:ascii-indented-line-width' `org-ascii-indented-line-width' +`:ascii-inlinetask-width' `org-ascii-inlinetask-width' +`:ascii-inner-margin' `org-ascii-inner-margin' +`:ascii-links-to-notes' `org-ascii-links-to-notes' +`:ascii-list-margin' `org-ascii-list-margin' +`:ascii-paragraph-spacing' `org-ascii-paragraph-spacing' +`:ascii-quote-margin' `org-ascii-quote-margin' +`:ascii-table-keep-all-vertical-lines' `org-ascii-table-keep-all-vertical-lines' +`:ascii-table-use-ascii-art' `org-ascii-table-use-ascii-art' +`:ascii-table-widen-columns' `org-ascii-table-widen-columns' +`:ascii-text-width' `org-ascii-text-width' +`:ascii-underline' `org-ascii-underline' +`:ascii-verbatim-format' `org-ascii-verbatim-format' + +Beamer specific properties +.......................... + +`:beamer-theme' `org-beamer-theme' +`:beamer-column-view-format' `org-beamer-column-view-format' +`:beamer-environments-extra' `org-beamer-environments-extra' +`:beamer-frame-default-options' `org-beamer-frame-default-options' +`:beamer-outline-frame-options' `org-beamer-outline-frame-options' +`:beamer-outline-frame-title' `org-beamer-outline-frame-title' +`:beamer-subtitle-format' `org-beamer-subtitle-format' + +HTML specific properties +........................ + +`:html-allow-name-attribute-in-anchors' `org-html-allow-name-attribute-in-anchors' +`:html-checkbox-type' `org-html-checkbox-type' +`:html-container' `org-html-container-element' +`:html-divs' `org-html-divs' +`:html-doctype' `org-html-doctype' +`:html-extension' `org-html-extension' +`:html-footnote-format' `org-html-footnote-format' +`:html-footnote-separator' `org-html-footnote-separator' +`:html-footnotes-section' `org-html-footnotes-section' +`:html-format-drawer-function' `org-html-format-drawer-function' +`:html-format-headline-function' `org-html-format-headline-function' +`:html-format-inlinetask-function' `org-html-format-inlinetask-function' +`:html-head-extra' `org-html-head-extra' +`:html-head-include-default-style' `org-html-head-include-default-style' +`:html-head-include-scripts' `org-html-head-include-scripts' +`:html-head' `org-html-head' +`:html-home/up-format' `org-html-home/up-format' +`:html-html5-fancy' `org-html-html5-fancy' +`:html-indent' `org-html-indent' +`:html-infojs-options' `org-html-infojs-options' +`:html-infojs-template' `org-html-infojs-template' +`:html-inline-image-rules' `org-html-inline-image-rules' +`:html-inline-images' `org-html-inline-images' +`:html-link-home' `org-html-link-home' +`:html-link-org-files-as-html' `org-html-link-org-files-as-html' +`:html-link-up' `org-html-link-up' +`:html-link-use-abs-url' `org-html-link-use-abs-url' +`:html-mathjax-options' `org-html-mathjax-options' +`:html-mathjax-template' `org-html-mathjax-template' +`:html-metadata-timestamp-format' `org-html-metadata-timestamp-format' +`:html-postamble-format' `org-html-postamble-format' +`:html-postamble' `org-html-postamble' +`:html-preamble-format' `org-html-preamble-format' +`:html-preamble' `org-html-preamble' +`:html-table-align-individual-fields' `org-html-table-align-individual-fields' +`:html-table-attributes' `org-html-table-default-attributes' +`:html-table-caption-above' `org-html-table-caption-above' +`:html-table-data-tags' `org-html-table-data-tags' +`:html-table-header-tags' `org-html-table-header-tags' +`:html-table-row-tags' `org-html-table-row-tags' +`:html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column' `org-html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column' +`:html-tag-class-prefix' `org-html-tag-class-prefix' +`:html-text-markup-alist' `org-html-text-markup-alist' +`:html-todo-kwd-class-prefix' `org-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix' +`:html-toplevel-hlevel' `org-html-toplevel-hlevel' +`:html-use-infojs' `org-html-use-infojs' +`:html-validation-link' `org-html-validation-link' +`:html-viewport' `org-html-viewport' +`:html-xml-declaration' `org-html-xml-declaration' + +LaTeX specific properties +......................... + +`:latex-active-timestamp-format' `org-latex-active-timestamp-format' +`:latex-caption-above' `org-latex-caption-above' +`:latex-classes' `org-latex-classes' +`:latex-class' `org-latex-default-class' +`:latex-compiler' `org-latex-compiler' +`:latex-default-figure-position' `org-latex-default-figure-position' +`:latex-default-table-environment' `org-latex-default-table-environment' +`:latex-default-table-mode' `org-latex-default-table-mode' +`:latex-diary-timestamp-format' `org-latex-diary-timestamp-format' +`:latex-footnote-defined-format' `org-latex-footnote-defined-format' +`:latex-footnote-separator' `org-latex-footnote-separator' +`:latex-format-drawer-function' `org-latex-format-drawer-function' +`:latex-format-headline-function' `org-latex-format-headline-function' +`:latex-format-inlinetask-function' `org-latex-format-inlinetask-function' +`:latex-hyperref-template' `org-latex-hyperref-template' +`:latex-image-default-height' `org-latex-image-default-height' +`:latex-image-default-option' `org-latex-image-default-option' +`:latex-image-default-width' `org-latex-image-default-width' +`:latex-images-centered' `org-latex-images-centered' +`:latex-inactive-timestamp-format' `org-latex-inactive-timestamp-format' +`:latex-inline-image-rules' `org-latex-inline-image-rules' +`:latex-link-with-unknown-path-format' `org-latex-link-with-unknown-path-format' +`:latex-listings-langs' `org-latex-listings-langs' +`:latex-listings-options' `org-latex-listings-options' +`:latex-listings' `org-latex-listings' +`:latex-minted-langs' `org-latex-minted-langs' +`:latex-minted-options' `org-latex-minted-options' +`:latex-prefer-user-labels' `org-latex-prefer-user-labels' +`:latex-subtitle-format' `org-latex-subtitle-format' +`:latex-subtitle-separate' `org-latex-subtitle-separate' +`:latex-table-scientific-notation' `org-latex-table-scientific-notation' +`:latex-tables-booktabs' `org-latex-tables-booktabs' +`:latex-tables-centered' `org-latex-tables-centered' +`:latex-text-markup-alist' `org-latex-text-markup-alist' +`:latex-title-command' `org-latex-title-command' +`:latex-toc-command' `org-latex-toc-command' + +Markdown specific properties +............................ + +`:md-footnote-format' `org-md-footnote-format' +`:md-footnotes-section' `org-md-footnotes-section' +`:md-headline-style' `org-md-headline-style' + +ODT specific properties +....................... + +`:odt-content-template-file' `org-odt-content-template-file' +`:odt-display-outline-level' `org-odt-display-outline-level' +`:odt-fontify-srcblocks' `org-odt-fontify-srcblocks' +`:odt-format-drawer-function' `org-odt-format-drawer-function' +`:odt-format-headline-function' `org-odt-format-headline-function' +`:odt-format-inlinetask-function' `org-odt-format-inlinetask-function' +`:odt-inline-formula-rules' `org-odt-inline-formula-rules' +`:odt-inline-image-rules' `org-odt-inline-image-rules' +`:odt-pixels-per-inch' `org-odt-pixels-per-inch' +`:odt-styles-file' `org-odt-styles-file' +`:odt-table-styles' `org-odt-table-styles' +`:odt-use-date-fields' `org-odt-use-date-fields' + +Texinfo specific properties +........................... + +`:texinfo-active-timestamp-format' `org-texinfo-active-timestamp-format' +`:texinfo-classes' `org-texinfo-classes' +`:texinfo-class' `org-texinfo-default-class' +`:texinfo-table-default-markup' `org-texinfo-table-default-markup' +`:texinfo-diary-timestamp-format' `org-texinfo-diary-timestamp-format' +`:texinfo-filename' `org-texinfo-filename' +`:texinfo-format-drawer-function' `org-texinfo-format-drawer-function' +`:texinfo-format-headline-function' `org-texinfo-format-headline-function' +`:texinfo-format-inlinetask-function' `org-texinfo-format-inlinetask-function' +`:texinfo-inactive-timestamp-format' `org-texinfo-inactive-timestamp-format' +`:texinfo-link-with-unknown-path-format' `org-texinfo-link-with-unknown-path-format' +`:texinfo-node-description-column' `org-texinfo-node-description-column' +`:texinfo-table-scientific-notation' `org-texinfo-table-scientific-notation' +`:texinfo-tables-verbatim' `org-texinfo-tables-verbatim' +`:texinfo-text-markup-alist' `org-texinfo-text-markup-alist' + + +File: org, Node: Publishing links, Next: Sitemap, Prev: Publishing options, Up: Configuration + +13.1.6 Links between published files +------------------------------------ + +To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use something +like `[[file:foo.org][The foo]]' or simply `file:foo.org' (*note +External links::). When published, this link becomes a link to +`foo.html'. You can thus interlink the pages of your "org web" project +and the links will work as expected when you publish them to HTML. If +you also publish the Org source file and want to link to it, use an +`http:' link instead of a `file:' link, because `file:' links are +converted to link to the corresponding `html' file. + + You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you +are careful with relative file names, and provided you have also +configured Org to upload the related files, these links will work too. +See *note Complex example::, for an example of this usage. + + Eventually, links between published documents can contain some +search options (*note Search options::), which will be resolved to the +appropriate location in the linked file. For example, once published +to HTML, the following links all point to a dedicated anchor in +`foo.html'. + + [[file:foo.org::*heading]] + [[file:foo.org::#custom-id]] + [[file:foo.org::target]] + + +File: org, Node: Sitemap, Next: Generating an index, Prev: Publishing links, Up: Configuration + +13.1.7 Generating a sitemap +--------------------------- + +The following properties may be used to control publishing of a map of +files for a given project. + +`:auto-sitemap' When non-`nil', publish a sitemap during + `org-publish-current-project' or + `org-publish-all'. +`:sitemap-filename' Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to + `sitemap.org' (which becomes `sitemap.html'). +`:sitemap-title' Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of + file. +`:sitemap-format-entry' With this option one can tell how a site-map + entry is formatted in the site-map. It is a + function called with three arguments: the file + or directory name relative to base directory + of the project, the site-map style and the + current project. It is expected to return a + string. Default value turns file names into + links and use document titles as descriptions. + For specific formatting needs, one can use + `org-publish-find-date', + `org-publish-find-title' and + `org-publish-find-property', to retrieve + additional information about published + documents. +`:sitemap-function' Plug-in function to use for generation of the + sitemap. It is called with two arguments: the + title of the site-map and a representation of + the files and directories involved in the + project as a radio list (*note Radio lists::). + The latter can further be transformed using + `org-list-to-generic', `org-list-to-subtree' + and alike. Default value generates a plain + list of links to all files in the project. +`:sitemap-sort-folders' Where folders should appear in the sitemap. + Set this to `first' (default) or `last' to + display folders first or last, respectively. + When set to `ignore', folders are ignored + altogether. Any other value will mix files + and folders. This variable has no effect when + site-map style is `tree'. +`:sitemap-sort-files' How the files are sorted in the site map. Set + this to `alphabetically' (default), + `chronologically' or `anti-chronologically'. + `chronologically' sorts the files with older + date first while `anti-chronologically' sorts + the files with newer date first. + `alphabetically' sorts the files + alphabetically. The date of a file is + retrieved with `org-publish-find-date'. +`:sitemap-ignore-case' Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default + `nil'. +`:sitemap-date-format' Format string for the `format-time-string' + function that tells how a sitemap entry's date + is to be formatted. This property bypasses + `org-publish-sitemap-date-format' which + defaults to `%Y-%m-%d'. + + +File: org, Node: Generating an index, Prev: Sitemap, Up: Configuration + +13.1.8 Generating an index +-------------------------- + +Org mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project. + +`:makeindex' When non-`nil', generate in index in the file + `theindex.org' and publish it as `theindex.html'. + + The file will be created when first publishing a project with the +`:makeindex' set. The file only contains a statement `#+INCLUDE: +"theindex.inc"'. You can then build around this include statement by +adding a title, style information, etc. + + Index entries are specified with `#+INDEX' keyword. An entry that +contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. + + * Curriculum Vitae + #+INDEX: CV + #+INDEX: Application!CV + + +File: org, Node: Uploading files, Next: Sample configuration, Prev: Configuration, Up: Publishing + +13.2 Uploading files +==================== + +For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as +`rsync' or `unison', it might be preferable not to use the built in +remote publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on Tramp. +Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be so efficient for +multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems under heavy +usage. + + Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In +addition to timestamp comparison, they also do content and +permissions/attribute checks. For this reason you might prefer to +publish your web to a local directory (possibly even in place with your +Org files) and then use `unison' or `rsync' to do the synchronization +with the remote host. + + Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to +transfer to a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the +project publishing definition. Simply keep all files in the correct +location, process your Org files with `org-publish' and let the +synchronization tool do the rest. You do not need, in this scenario, +to include attachments such as `jpg', `css' or `gif' files in the +project definition since the 3rd party tool syncs them. + + Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote +one, so that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. +If you set `org-publish-use-timestamps-flag' to `nil', you gain the main +benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source +example files you might include with `#+INCLUDE:'. The timestamp +mechanism in Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have +been modified. + + +File: org, Node: Sample configuration, Next: Triggering publication, Prev: Uploading files, Up: Publishing + +13.3 Sample configuration +========================= + +Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple +project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is more +complex, with a multi-component project. + +* Menu: + +* Simple example:: One-component publishing +* Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example + + +File: org, Node: Simple example, Next: Complex example, Up: Sample configuration + +13.3.1 Example: simple publishing configuration +----------------------------------------------- + +This example publishes a set of Org files to the `public_html' +directory on the local machine. + + (setq org-publish-project-alist + '(("org" + :base-directory "~/org/" + :publishing-directory "~/public_html" + :publishing-function org-html-publish-to-html + :section-numbers nil + :with-toc nil + :html-head "<link rel=\"stylesheet\" + href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" + type=\"text/css\"/>"))) + + +File: org, Node: Complex example, Prev: Simple example, Up: Sample configuration + +13.3.2 Example: complex publishing configuration +------------------------------------------------ + +This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including +Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and +style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are +excluded. + + To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate +your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file +paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in `~/org' and your +publishable images in `~/images', you would link to an image with + file:../images/myimage.png + On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the +same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the +right place on the web server, and publishing images to it. + + (setq org-publish-project-alist + '(("orgfiles" + :base-directory "~/org/" + :base-extension "org" + :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@host:~/html/notebook/" + :publishing-function org-html-publish-to-html + :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp + :headline-levels 3 + :section-numbers nil + :with-toc nil + :html-head "<link rel=\"stylesheet\" + href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>" + :html-preamble t) + + ("images" + :base-directory "~/images/" + :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png" + :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@host:~/html/images/" + :publishing-function org-publish-attachment) + + ("other" + :base-directory "~/other/" + :base-extension "css\\|el" + :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@host:~/html/other/" + :publishing-function org-publish-attachment) + ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other")))) + + +File: org, Node: Triggering publication, Prev: Sample configuration, Up: Publishing + +13.4 Triggering publication +=========================== + +Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands: + +`C-c C-e P x (`org-publish')' + Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to + it. + +`C-c C-e P p (`org-publish-current-project')' + Publish the project containing the current file. + +`C-c C-e P f (`org-publish-current-file')' + Publish only the current file. + +`C-c C-e P a (`org-publish-all')' + Publish every project. + + Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above +functions normally only publish changed files. You can override this +and force publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of +the commands above, or by customizing the variable +`org-publish-use-timestamps-flag'. This may be necessary in particular +if files include other files via `#+SETUPFILE:' or `#+INCLUDE:'. + + +File: org, Node: Working with source code, Next: Miscellaneous, Prev: Publishing, Up: Top + +14 Working with source code +*************************** + +Source code here refers to any code typed in Org mode documents. Org +can manage source code in any Org file once such code is tagged with +begin and end markers. Working with source code begins with tagging +source code blocks. Tagged `src' code blocks are not restricted to the +preamble or the end of an Org document; they can go anywhere--with a +few exceptions, such as not inside comments and fixed width areas. +Here's a sample `src' code block in emacs-lisp: + + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp + (defun org-xor (a b) + "Exclusive or." + (if a (not b) b)) + #+END_SRC + + Org can take the code in the block between the `#+BEGIN_SRC' and +`#+END_SRC' tags, and format, compile, execute, and show the results. +Org can simplify many housekeeping tasks essential to modern code +maintenance. That's why these blocks in Org mode literature are +sometimes referred to as `live code' blocks (as compared to the static +text and documentation around it). Users can control how `live' they +want each block by tweaking the headers for compiling, execution, +extraction. + + Org's `src' code block type is one of many block types, such as +quote, export, verse, latex, example, and verbatim. This section +pertains to `src' code blocks between `#+BEGIN_SRC' and `#+END_SRC' + + For editing `src' code blocks, Org provides native Emacs major-modes. +That leverages the latest Emacs features for that source code language +mode. + + For exporting, Org can then extract `src' code blocks into compilable +source files (in a conversion process known as "tangling" in literate +programming terminology). + + For publishing, Org's back-ends can handle the `src' code blocks and +the text for output to a variety of formats with native syntax +highlighting. + + For executing the source code in the `src' code blocks, Org provides +facilities that glue the tasks of compiling, collecting the results of +the execution, and inserting them back to the Org file. Besides text +output, results may include links to other data types that Emacs can +handle: audio, video, and graphics. + + An important feature of Org's execution of the `src' code blocks is +passing variables, functions, and results between `src' blocks. Such +interoperability uses a common syntax even if these `src' blocks are in +different source code languages. The integration extends to linking the +debugger's error messages to the line in the `src' code block in the Org +file. That should partly explain why this functionality by the original +contributors, Eric Schulte and Dan Davison, was called `Org Babel'. + + In literate programming, the main appeal is code and documentation +co-existing in one file. Org mode takes this several steps further. +First by enabling execution, and then by inserting results of that +execution back into the Org file. Along the way, Org provides +extensive formatting features, including handling tables. Org handles +multiple source code languages in one file, and provides a common +syntax for passing variables, functions, and results between `src' code +blocks. + + Org mode fulfills the promise of easy verification and maintenance of +publishing reproducible research by keeping all these in the same file: +text, data, code, configuration settings of the execution environment, +the results of the execution, and associated narratives, claims, +references, and internal and external links. + + Details of Org's facilities for working with source code are shown +next. + +* Menu: + +* Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described +* Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing +* Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results +* Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files +* Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org mode buffer +* Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks +* Languages:: List of supported code block languages +* Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality +* Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled +* Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org mode +* Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks +* Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line + + +File: org, Node: Structure of code blocks, Next: Editing source code, Up: Working with source code + +14.1 Structure of code blocks +============================= + +Org offers two ways to structure source code in Org documents: in a +`src' block, and directly inline. Both specifications are shown below. + + A `src' block conforms to this structure: + + #+NAME: <name> + #+BEGIN_SRC <language> <switches> <header arguments> + <body> + #+END_SRC + + Org mode's templates system (*note Easy templates::) speeds up +creating `src' code blocks with just three keystrokes. Do not be +put-off by having to remember the source block syntax. Org also works +with other completion systems in Emacs, some of which predate Org and +have custom domain-specific languages for defining templates. Regular +use of templates reduces errors, increases accuracy, and maintains +consistency. + + An inline code block conforms to this structure: + + src_<language>{<body>} + + or + + src_<language>[<header arguments>]{<body>} + +`#+NAME: <name>' + Optional. Names the `src' block so it can be called, like a + function, from other `src' blocks or inline blocks to evaluate or + to capture the results. Code from other blocks, other files, and + from table formulas (*note The spreadsheet::) can use the name to + reference a `src' block. This naming serves the same purpose as + naming Org tables. Org mode requires unique names. For duplicate + names, Org mode's behavior is undefined. + +`#+BEGIN_SRC' + +`#+END_SRC' + Mandatory. They mark the start and end of a block that Org + requires. The `#+BEGIN_SRC' line takes additional arguments, as + described next. + +`<language>' + Mandatory for live code blocks. It is the identifier of the + source code language in the block. *Note Languages::, for + identifiers of supported languages. + +`<switches>' + Optional. Switches provide finer control of the code execution, + export, and format (see the discussion of switches in *note + Literal examples::) + +`<header arguments>' + Optional. Heading arguments control many aspects of evaluation, + export and tangling of code blocks (*note Header arguments::). + Using Org's properties feature, header arguments can be + selectively applied to the entire buffer or specific sub-trees of + the Org document. + +`source code, header arguments' + +`<body>' + Source code in the dialect of the specified language identifier. + + +File: org, Node: Editing source code, Next: Exporting code blocks, Prev: Structure of code blocks, Up: Working with source code + +14.2 Editing source code +======================== + +`C-c '' for editing the current code block. It opens a new major-mode +edit buffer containing the body of the `src' code block, ready for any +edits. `C-c '' again to close the buffer and return to the Org buffer. + + <C-x C-s> saves the buffer and updates the contents of the Org +buffer. + + Set `org-edit-src-auto-save-idle-delay' to save the base buffer after +a certain idle delay time. + + Set `org-edit-src-turn-on-auto-save' to auto-save this buffer into a +separate file using `auto-save-mode'. + + `C-c '' to close the major-mode buffer and return back to the Org +buffer. + + While editing the source code in the major-mode, the `org-src-mode' +minor mode remains active. It provides these customization variables as +described below. For even more variables, look in the customization +group `org-edit-structure'. + +`org-src-lang-modes' + If an Emacs major-mode named `<lang>-mode' exists, where `<lang>' + is the language identifier from code block's header line, then the + edit buffer uses that major-mode. Use this variable to + arbitrarily map language identifiers to major modes. + +`org-src-window-setup' + For specifying Emacs window arrangement when the new edit buffer + is created. + +`org-src-preserve-indentation' + Default is `nil'. Source code is indented. This indentation + applies during export or tangling, and depending on the context, + may alter leading spaces and tabs. When non-`nil', source code is + aligned with the leftmost column. No lines are modified during + export or tangling, which is very useful for white-space sensitive + languages, such as Python. + +`org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer' + When `nil', Org returns to the edit buffer without further + prompts. The default prompts for a confirmation. + + Set `org-src-fontify-natively' to non-`nil' to turn on native code +fontification in the _Org_ buffer. Fontification of `src' code blocks +can give visual separation of text and code on the display page. To +further customize the appearance of `org-block' for specific languages, +customize `org-src-block-faces'. The following example shades the +background of regular blocks, and colors source blocks only for Python +and Emacs-Lisp languages. + (require 'color) + (set-face-attribute 'org-block nil :background + (color-darken-name + (face-attribute 'default :background) 3)) + + (setq org-src-block-faces '(("emacs-lisp" (:background "#EEE2FF")) + ("python" (:background "#E5FFB8")))) + + +File: org, Node: Exporting code blocks, Next: Extracting source code, Prev: Editing source code, Up: Working with source code + +14.3 Exporting code blocks +========================== + +Org can flexibly export just the _code_ from the code blocks, just the +_results_ of evaluation of the code block, _both_ the code and the +results of the code block evaluation, or _none_. Org defaults to +exporting _code_ for most languages. For some languages, such as +`ditaa', Org defaults to _results_. To export just the body of code +blocks, *note Literal examples::. To selectively export sub-trees of +an Org document, *note Exporting::. + + The `:exports' header arguments control exporting code blocks only +and not inline code: + +Header arguments: +................. + +`:exports code' + This is the default for most languages where the body of the code + block is exported. See *note Literal examples:: for more. + +`:exports results' + On export, Org includes only the results and not the code block. + After each evaluation, Org inserts the results after the end of + code block in the Org buffer. By default, Org replaces any + previous results. Org can also append results. + +`:exports both' + Org exports both the code block and the results. + +`:exports none' + Org does not export the code block nor the results. + + To stop Org from evaluating code blocks to speed exports, use the +header argument `:eval never-export' (*note eval::). To stop Org from +evaluating code blocks for greater security, set the +`org-export-use-babel' variable to `nil', but understand that header +arguments will have no effect. + + Turning off evaluation comes in handy when batch processing. For +example, markup languages for wikis, which have a high risk of +untrusted code. Stopping code block evaluation also stops evaluation +of all header arguments of the code block. This may not be desirable +in some circumstances. So during export, to allow evaluation of just +the header arguments but not any code evaluation in the source block, +set `:eval never-export' (*note eval::). + + Org never evaluates code blocks in commented sub-trees when exporting +(*note Comment lines::). On the other hand, Org does evaluate code +blocks in sub-trees excluded from export (*note Export settings::). + + +File: org, Node: Extracting source code, Next: Evaluating code blocks, Prev: Exporting code blocks, Up: Working with source code + +14.4 Extracting source code +=========================== + +Extracting source code from code blocks is a basic task in literate +programming. Org has features to make this easy. In literate +programming parlance, documents on creation are _woven_ with code and +documentation, and on export, the code is _tangled_ for execution by a +computer. Org facilitates weaving and tangling for producing, +maintaining, sharing, and exporting literate programming documents. +Org provides extensive customization options for extracting source code. + + When Org tangles `src' code blocks, it expands, merges, and +transforms them. Then Org recomposes them into one or more separate +files, as configured through the options. During this _tangling_ +process, Org expands variables in the source code, and resolves any +Noweb style references (*note Noweb reference syntax::). + +Header arguments +................ + +`:tangle no' + By default, Org does not tangle the `src' code block on export. + +`:tangle yes' + Org extracts the contents of the code block for the tangled + output. By default, the output file name is the same as the Org + file but with a file extension derived from the language + identifier of the `src' code block. + +`:tangle filename' + Override the default file name with this one for the tangled + output. + +Functions +......... + +`org-babel-tangle' + Tangle the current file. Bound to `C-c C-v t'. + + With prefix argument only tangle the current `src' code block. + +`org-babel-tangle-file' + Choose a file to tangle. Bound to `C-c C-v f'. + +Hooks +..... + +`org-babel-post-tangle-hook' + This hook runs from within code tangled by `org-babel-tangle', + making it suitable for post-processing, compilation, and + evaluation of code in the tangled files. + +Jumping between code and Org +............................ + +Debuggers normally link errors and messages back to the source code. +But for tangled files, we want to link back to the Org file, not to the +tangled source file. To make this extra jump, Org uses +`org-babel-tangle-jump-to-org' function with two additional source code +block header arguments: One, set `padline' (*note padline::) to true +(the default setting). Two, set `comments' (*note comments::) to +`link', which makes Org insert links to the Org file. + + +File: org, Node: Evaluating code blocks, Next: Library of Babel, Prev: Extracting source code, Up: Working with source code + +14.5 Evaluating code blocks +=========================== + +A note about security: With code evaluation comes the risk of harm. Org +safeguards by prompting for user's permission before executing any code +in the source block. To customize this safeguard (or disable it) see +*note Code evaluation security::. + + Org captures the results of the `src' code block evaluation and +inserts them in the Org file, right after the `src' code block. The +insertion point is after a newline and the `#+RESULTS' label. Org +creates the `#+RESULTS' label if one is not already there. + + By default, Org enables only `emacs-lisp' `src' code blocks for +execution. See *note Languages:: for identifiers to enable other +languages. + + Org provides many ways to execute `src' code blocks. `C-c C-c' or +`C-c C-v e' with the point on a `src' code block(1) calls the +`org-babel-execute-src-block' function, which executes the code in the +block, collects the results, and inserts them in the buffer. + + By calling a named code block(2) from an Org mode buffer or a table. +Org can call the named `src' code blocks from the current Org mode +buffer or from the "Library of Babel" (*note Library of Babel::). +Whether inline syntax or the `#+CALL:' syntax is used, the result is +wrapped based on the variable `org-babel-inline-result-wrap', which by +default is set to `"=%s="' to produce verbatim text suitable for markup. + + The syntax for `#+CALL:' is + + #+CALL: <name>(<arguments>) + #+CALL: <name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>) <end header arguments> + + The syntax for inline named code block is + + ... call_<name>(<arguments>) ... + ... call_<name>[<inside header arguments>](<arguments>)[<end header arguments>] ... + +`<name>' + This is the name of the code block to be evaluated (*note + Structure of code blocks::). + +`<arguments>' + Org passes arguments to the code block using standard function + call syntax. For example, a `#+CALL:' line that passes `4' to a + code block named `double', which declares the header argument + `:var n=2', would be written as `#+CALL: double(n=4)'. Note how + this function call syntax is different from the header argument + syntax. + +`<inside header arguments>' + Org passes inside header arguments to the named `src' code block + using the header argument syntax. Inside header arguments apply + to code block evaluation. For example, `[:results output]' + collects results printed to `STDOUT' during code execution of that + block. Note how this header argument syntax is different from the + function call syntax. + +`<end header arguments>' + End header arguments affect the results returned by the code + block. For example, `:results html' wraps the results in a + `BEGIN_EXPORT html' block before inserting the results in the Org + buffer. + + For more examples of header arguments for `#+CALL:' lines, *note + Arguments in function calls::. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) The option `org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c' can be used to +remove code evaluation from the `C-c C-c' key binding. + + (2) Actually, the constructs call_<name>() and src_<lang>{} are not +evaluated when they appear in a keyword line (i.e. lines starting with +`#+KEYWORD:', *note In-buffer settings::). + + +File: org, Node: Library of Babel, Next: Languages, Prev: Evaluating code blocks, Up: Working with source code + +14.6 Library of Babel +===================== + +The "Library of Babel" is a collection of code blocks. Like a function +library, these code blocks can be called from other Org files. A +collection of useful code blocks is available on Worg +(http://orgmode.org/worg/library-of-babel.html). For remote code block +evaluation syntax, *note Evaluating code blocks::. + + For any user to add code to the library, first save the code in +regular `src' code blocks of an Org file, and then load the Org file +with `org-babel-lob-ingest', which is bound to `C-c C-v i'. + + +File: org, Node: Languages, Next: Header arguments, Prev: Library of Babel, Up: Working with source code + +14.7 Languages +============== + +Org supports the following languages for the `src' code blocks: + +Language Identifier Language Identifier +---------------------------------------------------------------------------- +Asymptote asymptote Awk awk +C C C++ C++ +Clojure clojure CSS css +D d ditaa ditaa +Graphviz dot Emacs Calc calc +Emacs Lisp emacs-lisp Fortran fortran +gnuplot gnuplot Haskell haskell +Java java Javascript js +LaTeX latex Ledger ledger +Lisp lisp Lilypond lilypond +Lua lua MATLAB matlab +Mscgen mscgen Objective Caml ocaml +Octave octave Org mode org +Oz oz Perl perl +Plantuml plantuml Processing.js processing +Python python R R +Ruby ruby Sass sass +Scheme scheme GNU Screen screen +Sed sed shell sh +SQL sql SQLite sqlite +Vala vala + + Additional documentation for some languages are at +`http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages.html'. + + By default, only `emacs-lisp' is enabled for evaluation. To enable +or disable other languages, customize the `org-babel-load-languages' +variable either through the Emacs customization interface, or by adding +code to the init file as shown next: + + In this example, evaluation is disabled for `emacs-lisp', and enabled +for `R'. + + (org-babel-do-load-languages + 'org-babel-load-languages + '((emacs-lisp . nil) + (R . t))) + + Note that this is not the only way to enable a language. Org also +enables languages when loaded with `require' statement. For example, +the following enables execution of `clojure' code blocks: + + (require 'ob-clojure) + + +File: org, Node: Header arguments, Next: Results of evaluation, Prev: Languages, Up: Working with source code + +14.8 Header arguments +===================== + +Details of configuring header arguments are shown here. + +* Menu: + +* Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments +* Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments + + +File: org, Node: Using header arguments, Next: Specific header arguments, Up: Header arguments + +14.8.1 Using header arguments +----------------------------- + +Since header arguments can be set in several ways, Org prioritizes them +in case of overlaps or conflicts by giving local settings a higher +priority. Header values in function calls, for example, override +header values from global defaults. + +* Menu: + +* System-wide header arguments:: Set globally, language-specific +* Language-specific header arguments:: Set in the Org file's headers +* Header arguments in Org mode properties:: Set in the Org file +* Language-specific mode properties:: +* Code block specific header arguments:: The most commonly used method +* Arguments in function calls:: The most specific level, takes highest priority + + +File: org, Node: System-wide header arguments, Next: Language-specific header arguments, Up: Using header arguments + +System-wide header arguments +............................ + +System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by adapting the +`org-babel-default-header-args' variable: + + :session => "none" + :results => "replace" + :exports => "code" + :cache => "no" + :noweb => "no" + + This example sets `:noweb' header arguments to `yes', which makes +Org expand `:noweb' references by default. + + (setq org-babel-default-header-args + (cons '(:noweb . "yes") + (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args))) + + +File: org, Node: Language-specific header arguments, Next: Header arguments in Org mode properties, Prev: System-wide header arguments, Up: Using header arguments + +Language-specific header arguments +.................................. + +Each language can have separate default header arguments by customizing +the variable `org-babel-default-header-args:<lang>', where `<lang>' is +the name of the language. For details, see the language-specific online +documentation at `http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel'. + + +File: org, Node: Header arguments in Org mode properties, Next: Language-specific mode properties, Prev: Language-specific header arguments, Up: Using header arguments + +Header arguments in Org mode properties +....................................... + +For header arguments applicable to the buffer, use `#+PROPERTY:' lines +anywhere in the Org mode file (*note Property syntax::). + + The following example sets only for `R' code blocks to `session', +making all the `R' code blocks execute in the same session. Setting +`results' to `silent' ignores the results of executions for all blocks, +not just `R' code blocks; no results inserted for any block. + + #+PROPERTY: header-args:R :session *R* + #+PROPERTY: header-args :results silent + + Header arguments set through Org's property drawers (*note Property +syntax::) apply at the sub-tree level on down. Since these property +drawers can appear anywhere in the file hierarchy, Org uses outermost +call or source block to resolve the values. Org ignores +`org-use-property-inheritance' setting. + + In this example, `:cache' defaults to `yes' for all code blocks in +the sub-tree starting with `sample header'. + + * sample header + :PROPERTIES: + :header-args: :cache yes + :END: + + Properties defined through `org-set-property' function, bound to +`C-c C-x p', apply to all active languages. They override properties +set in `org-babel-default-header-args'. + + +File: org, Node: Language-specific mode properties, Next: Code block specific header arguments, Prev: Header arguments in Org mode properties, Up: Using header arguments + +Language-specific mode properties +................................. + +Language-specific header arguments are also read from properties +`header-args:<lang>' where `<lang>' is the language identifier. For +example, + + * Heading + :PROPERTIES: + :header-args:clojure: :session *clojure-1* + :header-args:R: :session *R* + :END: + ** Subheading + :PROPERTIES: + :header-args:clojure: :session *clojure-2* + :END: + + would force separate sessions for clojure blocks in Heading and +Subheading, but use the same session for all `R' blocks. Blocks in +Subheading inherit settings from Heading. + + +File: org, Node: Code block specific header arguments, Next: Arguments in function calls, Prev: Language-specific mode properties, Up: Using header arguments + +Code block specific header arguments +.................................... + +Header arguments are most commonly set at the `src' code block level, on +the `#+BEGIN_SRC' line. Arguments set at this level take precedence +over those set in the `org-babel-default-header-args' variable, and also +those set as header properties. + + In the following example, setting `results' to `silent' makes it +ignore results of the code execution. Setting `:exports' to `code' +exports only the body of the `src' code block to HTML or LaTeX.: + + #+NAME: factorial + #+BEGIN_SRC haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0 + fac 0 = 1 + fac n = n * fac (n-1) + #+END_SRC + + The same header arguments in an inline `src' code block: + + src_haskell[:exports both]{fac 5} + + Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using +`#+HEADER:' on each line. Note that Org currently accepts the plural +spelling of `#+HEADER:' only as a convenience for +backward-compatibility. It may be removed at some point. + + Multi-line header arguments on an unnamed `src' code block: + + #+HEADER: :var data1=1 + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data2=2 + (message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2) + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS: + : data1:1, data2:2 + + Multi-line header arguments on a named `src' code block: + + #+NAME: named-block + #+HEADER: :var data=2 + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp + (message "data:%S" data) + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS: named-block + : data:2 + + +File: org, Node: Arguments in function calls, Prev: Code block specific header arguments, Up: Using header arguments + +Arguments in function calls +........................... + +Header arguments in function calls are the most specific and override +all other settings in case of an overlap. They get the highest +priority. Two `#+CALL:' examples are shown below. For the complete +syntax of `#+CALL:' lines, see *note Evaluating code blocks::. + + In this example, `:exports results' header argument is applied to the +evaluation of the `#+CALL:' line. + + #+CALL: factorial(n=5) :exports results + + In this example, `:session special' header argument is applied to the +evaluation of `factorial' code block. + + #+CALL: factorial[:session special](n=5) + + +File: org, Node: Specific header arguments, Prev: Using header arguments, Up: Header arguments + +14.8.2 Specific header arguments +-------------------------------- + +Org comes with many header arguments common to all languages. New +header arguments are added for specific languages as they become +available for use in `src' code blocks. A header argument is specified +with an initial colon followed by the argument's name in lowercase. +Common header arguments are: + +* Menu: + +* var:: Pass arguments to `src' code blocks +* results:: Specify results type; how to collect +* file:: Specify a path for output file +* file-desc:: Specify a description for file results +* file-ext:: Specify an extension for file output +* output-dir:: Specify a directory for output file +* dir:: Specify the default directory for code block execution +* exports:: Specify exporting code, results, both, none +* tangle:: Toggle tangling; or specify file name +* mkdirp:: Toggle for parent directory creation for target files during tangling +* comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled code files +* padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled code files +* no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb expansion during tangling +* session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation +* noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references +* noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target +* noweb-sep:: String to separate noweb references +* cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks +* sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org +* hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables +* colnames:: Handle column names in tables +* rownames:: Handle row names in tables +* shebang:: Make tangled files executable +* tangle-mode:: Set permission of tangled files +* eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks +* wrap:: Mark source block evaluation results +* post:: Post processing of results of code block evaluation +* prologue:: Text to prepend to body of code block +* epilogue:: Text to append to body of code block + + For language-specific header arguments, see *note Languages::. + + +File: org, Node: var, Next: results, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.1 `:var' +............... + +Use `:var' for passing arguments to `src' code blocks. The specifics +of variables in `src' code blocks vary by the source language and are +covered in the language-specific documentation. The syntax for `:var', +however, is the same for all languages. This includes declaring a +variable, and assigning a default value. + + Arguments can take values as literals, or as references, or even as +Emacs Lisp code (*note Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables: var.). +References are names from the Org file from the lines `#+NAME:' or +`#+RESULTS:'. References can also refer to tables, lists, +`#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE' blocks, other types of `src' code blocks, or the +results of execution of `src' code blocks. + + For better performance, Org can cache results of evaluations. But +caching comes with severe limitations (*note cache::). + + Argument values are indexed like arrays (*note Indexable variable +values: var.). + + The following syntax is used to pass arguments to `src' code blocks +using the `:var' header argument. + + :var name=assign + + The `assign' is a literal value, such as a string `"string"', a +number `9', a reference to a table, a list, a literal example, another +code block (with or without arguments), or the results from evaluating +a code block. + + Here are examples of passing values by reference: + +"table" + an Org mode table named with either a `#+NAME:' line + + #+NAME: example-table + | 1 | + | 2 | + | 3 | + | 4 | + + #+NAME: table-length + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var table=example-table + (length table) + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS: table-length + : 4 + +"list" + a simple list named with a `#+NAME:' line. Note that only the top + level list items are passed along. Nested list items are ignored. + + #+NAME: example-list + - simple + - not + - nested + - list + + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=example-list + (print x) + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS: + | simple | list | + +"code block without arguments" + a code block name (from the example above), as assigned by + `#+NAME:', optionally followed by parentheses + + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var length=table-length() + (* 2 length) + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS: + : 8 + +"code block with arguments" + a `src' code block name, as assigned by `#+NAME:', followed by + parentheses and optional arguments passed within the parentheses + following the `src' code block name using standard function call + syntax + + #+NAME: double + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=8 + (* 2 input) + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS: double + : 16 + + #+NAME: squared + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=2) + (* input input) + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS: squared + : 4 + +"literal example" + a literal example block named with a `#+NAME:' line + + #+NAME: literal-example + #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE + A literal example + on two lines + #+END_EXAMPLE + + #+NAME: read-literal-example + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=literal-example + (concatenate 'string x " for you.") + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS: read-literal-example + : A literal example + : on two lines for you. + + +Indexable variable values +......................... + +Indexing variable values enables referencing portions of a variable. +Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting backwards from the +end. If an index is separated by `,'s then each subsequent section +will index as the next dimension. Note that this indexing occurs +_before_ other table-related header arguments are applied, such as +`:hlines', `:colnames' and `:rownames'. The following example assigns +the last cell of the first row the table `example-table' to the variable +`data': + + #+NAME: example-table + | 1 | a | + | 2 | b | + | 3 | c | + | 4 | d | + + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1] + data + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS: + : a + + Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers +separated by a `:', in which case the entire inclusive range is +referenced. For example the following assigns the middle three rows of +`example-table' to `data'. + + #+NAME: example-table + | 1 | a | + | 2 | b | + | 3 | c | + | 4 | d | + | 5 | 3 | + + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3] + data + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS: + | 2 | b | + | 3 | c | + | 4 | d | + + To pick the entire range, use an empty index, or the single character +`*'. `0:-1' does the same thing. Example below shows how to reference +the first column only. + + #+NAME: example-table + | 1 | a | + | 2 | b | + | 3 | c | + | 4 | d | + + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0] + data + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS: + | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | + + Index referencing can be used for tables and code blocks. Index +referencing can handle any number of dimensions. Commas delimit +multiple dimensions, as shown below. + + #+NAME: 3D + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp + '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9)) + ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18)) + ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27))) + #+END_SRC + + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1] + data + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS: + | 11 | 14 | 17 | + +Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables +.................................. + +Emacs lisp code can set the values for variables. To differentiate a +value from lisp code, Org interprets any value starting with `(', `[', +`'' or ``' as Emacs Lisp code. The result of evaluating that code is +then assigned to the value of that variable. The following example +shows how to reliably query and pass file name of the Org mode buffer +to a code block using headers. We need reliability here because the +file's name could change once the code in the block starts executing. + + #+BEGIN_SRC sh :var filename=(buffer-file-name) :exports both + wc -w $filename + #+END_SRC + + Note that values read from tables and lists will not be mistakenly +evaluated as Emacs Lisp code, as illustrated in the following example. + + #+NAME: table + | (a b c) | + + #+HEADER: :var data=table[0,0] + #+BEGIN_SRC perl + $data + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS: + : (a b c) + + +File: org, Node: results, Next: file, Prev: var, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.2 `:results' +................... + +There are four classes of `:results' header arguments. Each `src' code +block can take only one option per class. + + * collection for how the results should be collected from the `src' + code block + + * type for which type of result the code block will return; affects + how Org processes and inserts results in the Org buffer + + * format for the result; affects how Org processes and inserts + results in the Org buffer + + * handling for processing results after evaluation of the `src' code + block + +Collection +.......... + +Collection options specify the results. Choose one of the options; +they are mutually exclusive. + + * `value' Default. Functional mode. Result is the value returned + by the last statement in the `src' code block. Languages like + Python may require an explicit `return' statement in the `src' + code block. Usage example: `:results value'. + + * `output' Scripting mode. Result is collected from STDOUT during + execution of the code in the `src' code block. Usage example: + `:results output'. + +Type +.... + +Type tells what result types to expect from the execution of the code +block. Choose one of the options; they are mutually exclusive. The +default behavior is to automatically determine the result type. + + * `table', `vector' Interpret the results as an Org table. If the + result is a single value, create a table with one row and one + column. Usage example: `:results value table'. + + * `list' Interpret the results as an Org list. If the result is a + single value, create a list of one element. + + * `scalar', `verbatim' Interpret literally and insert as quoted + text. Do not create a table. Usage example: `:results value + verbatim'. + + * `file' Interpret as path to a file. Inserts a link to the file. + Usage example: `:results value file'. + +Format +...... + +Format pertains to the type of the result returned by the `src' code +block. Choose one of the options; they are mutually exclusive. The +default follows from the type specified above. + + * `raw' Interpreted as raw Org mode. Inserted directly into the + buffer. Aligned if it is a table. Usage example: `:results value + raw'. + + * `org' Results enclosed in a `BEGIN_SRC org' block. For + comma-escape, either `TAB' in the block, or export the file. + Usage example: `:results value org'. + + * `html' Results enclosed in a `BEGIN_EXPORT html' block. Usage + example: `:results value html'. + + * `latex' Results enclosed in a `BEGIN_EXPORT latex' block. Usage + example: `:results value latex'. + + * `code' Result enclosed in a `src' code block. Useful for parsing. + Usage example: `:results value code'. + + * `pp' Result converted to pretty-print source code. Enclosed in a + `src' code block. Languages supported: Emacs Lisp, Python, and + Ruby. Usage example: `:results value pp'. + + * `drawer' Result wrapped in a RESULTS drawer. Useful for + containing `raw' or `org' results for later scripting and + automated processing. Usage example: `:results value drawer'. + +Handling +........ + +Handling options after collecting the results. + + * `silent' Do not insert results in the Org mode buffer, but echo + them in the minibuffer. Usage example: `:results output silent'. + + * `replace' Default. Insert results in the Org buffer. Remove + previous results. Usage example: `:results output replace'. + + * `append' Append results to the Org buffer. Latest results are at + the bottom. Does not remove previous results. Usage example: + `:results output append'. + + * `prepend' Prepend results to the Org buffer. Latest results are + at the top. Does not remove previous results. Usage example: + `:results output prepend'. + + +File: org, Node: file, Next: file-desc, Prev: results, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.3 `:file' +................ + +An external `:file' that saves the results of execution of the code +block. The `:file' is either a file name or two strings, where the +first is the file name and the second is the description. A link to +the file is inserted. It uses an Org mode style `[[file:]]' link +(*note Link format::). Some languages, such as `R', `dot', `ditaa', and +`gnuplot', automatically wrap the source code in additional boilerplate +code. Such code wrapping helps recreate the output, especially graphics +output, by executing just the `:file' contents. + + +File: org, Node: file-desc, Next: file-ext, Prev: file, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.4 `:file-desc' +..................... + +A description of the results file. Org uses this description for the +link (see *note Link format::) it inserts in the Org file. If the +`:file-desc' has no value, Org will use file name for both the "link" +and the "description" portion of the Org mode link. + + +File: org, Node: file-ext, Next: output-dir, Prev: file-desc, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.5 `:file-ext' +.................... + +File name extension for the output file. Org generates the file's +complete name, and extension by combining `:file-ext', `#+NAME:' of the +source block, and the *note output-dir:: header argument. To override +this auto generated file name, use the `:file' header argument. + + +File: org, Node: output-dir, Next: dir, Prev: file-ext, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.6 `:output-dir' +...................... + +Specifies the `:output-dir' for the results file. Org accepts an +absolute path (beginning with `/') or a relative directory (without +`/'). The value can be combined with `#+NAME:' of the source block and +*note file:: or *note file-ext:: header arguments. + + +File: org, Node: dir, Next: exports, Prev: output-dir, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.7 `:dir' and remote execution +.................................... + +While the `:file' header argument can be used to specify the path to the +output file, `:dir' specifies the default directory during `src' code +block execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with +the current buffer is used. In other words, supplying `:dir path' +temporarily has the same effect as changing the current directory with +`M-x cd path RET', and then not supplying `:dir'. Under the surface, +`:dir' simply sets the value of the Emacs variable `default-directory'. + + When using `:dir', relative paths (for example, `:file myfile.jpg' +or `:file results/myfile.jpg') become relative to the default directory. + + For example, to save the plot file in the `Work' folder of the home +directory (notice tilde is expanded): + + #+BEGIN_SRC R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work + matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l") + #+END_SRC + +Remote execution +................ + +To evaluate the `src' code block on a remote machine, supply a remote s +directory name using `Tramp' syntax. For example: + + #+BEGIN_SRC R :file plot.png :dir /scp:dand@yakuba.princeton.edu: + plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE)) + #+END_SRC + + Org first captures the text results as usual for insertion in the +Org file. Then Org also inserts a link to the remote file, thanks to +Emacs `Tramp'. Org constructs the remote path to the file name from +`:dir' and `default-directory', as illustrated here: + + [[file:/scp:dand@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]] + +Some more warnings +.................. + + * When `:dir' is used with `:session', Org sets the starting + directory for a new session. But Org will not alter the directory + of an already existing session. + + * Do not use `:dir' with `:exports results' or with `:exports both' + to avoid Org inserting incorrect links to remote files. That is + because Org does not expand `default directory' to avoid some + underlying portability issues. + + +File: org, Node: exports, Next: tangle, Prev: dir, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.8 `:exports' +................... + +The `:exports' header argument is to specify if that part of the Org +file is exported to, say, HTML or LaTeX formats. Note that `:exports' +affects only `src' code blocks and not inline code. + + * `code' The default. The body of code is included into the + exported file. Example: `:exports code'. + + * `results' The results of evaluation of the code is included in the + exported file. Example: `:exports results'. + + * `both' Both the code and results of evaluation are included in the + exported file. Example: `:exports both'. + + * `none' Neither the code nor the results of evaluation is included + in the exported file. Whether the code is evaluated at all + depends on other options. Example: `:exports none'. + + +File: org, Node: tangle, Next: mkdirp, Prev: exports, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.9 `:tangle' +.................. + +The `:tangle' header argument specifies if the `src' code block is +exported to source file(s). + + * `tangle' Export the `src' code block to source file. The file + name for the source file is derived from the name of the Org file, + and the file extension is derived from the source code language + identifier. Example: `:tangle yes'. + + * `no' The default. Do not extract the code a source code file. + Example: `:tangle no'. + + * other Export the `src' code block to source file whose file name + is derived from any string passed to the `:tangle' header + argument. Org derives the file name as being relative to the + directory of the Org file's location. Example: `:tangle path'. + + +File: org, Node: mkdirp, Next: comments, Prev: tangle, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.10 `:mkdirp' +................... + +The `:mkdirp' header argument creates parent directories for tangled +files if the directory does not exist. `yes' enables directory creation +and `no' inhibits directory creation. + + +File: org, Node: comments, Next: padline, Prev: mkdirp, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.11 `:comments' +..................... + +Controls inserting comments into tangled files. These are above and +beyond whatever comments may already exist in the `src' code block. + + * `no' The default. Do not insert any extra comments during + tangling. + + * `link' Wrap the `src' code block in comments. Include links + pointing back to the place in the Org file from where the code was + tangled. + + * `yes' Kept for backward compatibility; same as "link". + + * `org' Nearest headline text from Org file is inserted as comment. + The exact text that is inserted is picked from the leading context + of the source block. + + * `both' Includes both "link" and "org" comment options. + + * `noweb' Includes "link" comment option, expands noweb references, + and wraps them in link comments inside the body of the `src' code + block. + + +File: org, Node: padline, Next: no-expand, Prev: comments, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.12 `:padline' +.................... + +Control insertion of newlines to pad `src' code blocks in the tangled +file. + * `yes' Default. Insert a newline before and after each `src' code + block in the tangled file. + + * `no' Do not insert newlines to pad the tangled `src' code blocks. + + +File: org, Node: no-expand, Next: session, Prev: padline, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.13 `:no-expand' +...................... + +By default Org expands `src' code blocks during tangling. The +`:no-expand' header argument turns off such expansions. Note that one +side-effect of expansion by `org-babel-expand-src-block' also assigns +values to `:var' (*note var::) variables. Expansions also replace Noweb +references with their targets (*note Noweb reference syntax::). Some of +these expansions may cause premature assignment, hence this option. +This option makes a difference only for tangling. It has no effect +when exporting since `src' code blocks for execution have to be +expanded anyway. + + +File: org, Node: session, Next: noweb, Prev: no-expand, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.14 `:session' +.................... + +The `:session' header argument is for running multiple source code +blocks under one session. Org runs `src' code blocks with the same +session name in the same interpreter process. + + * `none' Default. Each `src' code block gets a new interpreter + process to execute. The process terminates once the block is + evaluated. + + * `other' Any string besides `none' turns that string into the name + of that session. For example, `:session mysession' names it + `mysession'. If `:session' has no argument, then the session name + is derived from the source language identifier. Subsequent blocks + with the same source code language use the same session. + Depending on the language, state variables, code from other + blocks, and the overall interpreted environment may be shared. + Some interpreted languages support concurrent sessions when + subsequent source code language blocks change session names. + + +File: org, Node: noweb, Next: noweb-ref, Prev: session, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.15 `:noweb' +.................. + +The `:noweb' header argument controls expansion of Noweb syntax +references (*note Noweb reference syntax::). Expansions occur when +source code blocks are evaluated, tangled, or exported. + + * `no' Default. No expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body + of the code when evaluating, tangling, or exporting. + + * `yes' Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the + `src' code block when evaluating, tangling, or exporting. + + * `tangle' Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the + `src' code block when tangling. No expansion when evaluating or + exporting. + + * `no-export' Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of + the `src' code block when evaluating or tangling. No expansion + when exporting. + + * `strip-export' Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of + the `src' code block when expanding prior to evaluating or + tangling. Removes Noweb syntax references when exporting. + + * `eval' Expansion of Noweb syntax references in the body of the + `src' code block only before evaluating. + +Noweb prefix lines +.................. + +Noweb insertions now honor prefix characters that appear before the +Noweb syntax reference. + + This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the +`<<example>>' noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax, +each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented. + + With: + + #+NAME: example + #+BEGIN_SRC text + this is the + multi-line body of example + #+END_SRC + + this `src' code block: + + #+BEGIN_SRC sql :noweb yes + -- <<example>> + #+END_SRC + + expands to: + + -- this is the + -- multi-line body of example + + Since this change will not affect noweb replacement text without +newlines in them, inline noweb references are acceptable. + + This feature can also be used for management of indentation in +exported code snippets. + + With: + + #+NAME: if-true + #+BEGIN_SRC python :exports none + print('Do things when True') + #+END_SRC + + #+NAME: if-false + #+BEGIN_SRC python :exports none + print('Do things when False') + #+END_SRC + + this `src' code block: + + #+BEGIN_SRC python :noweb yes :results output + if True: + <<if-true>> + else: + <<if-false>> + #+END_SRC + + expands to: + + if True: + print('Do things when True') + else: + print('Do things when False') + + and evaluates to: + + Do things when True + + +File: org, Node: noweb-ref, Next: noweb-sep, Prev: noweb, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.16 `:noweb-ref' +...................... + +When expanding Noweb style references, Org concatenates `src' code +blocks by matching the reference name to either the code block name or +the `:noweb-ref' header argument. + + For simple concatenation, set this `:noweb-ref' header argument at +the sub-tree or file level. In the example Org file shown next, the +body of the source code in each block is extracted for concatenation to +a pure code file when tangled. + + #+BEGIN_SRC sh :tangle yes :noweb yes :shebang #!/bin/sh + <<fullest-disk>> + #+END_SRC + * the mount point of the fullest disk + :PROPERTIES: + :header-args: :noweb-ref fullest-disk + :END: + + ** query all mounted disks + #+BEGIN_SRC sh + df \ + #+END_SRC + + ** strip the header row + #+BEGIN_SRC sh + |sed '1d' \ + #+END_SRC + + ** output mount point of fullest disk + #+BEGIN_SRC sh + |awk '{if (u < +$5) {u = +$5; m = $6}} END {print m}' + #+END_SRC + + +File: org, Node: noweb-sep, Next: cache, Prev: noweb-ref, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.17 `:noweb-sep' +...................... + +By default a newline separates each noweb reference concatenation. To +change this newline separator, edit the `:noweb-sep' (*note +noweb-sep::) header argument. + + +File: org, Node: cache, Next: sep, Prev: noweb-sep, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.18 `:cache' +.................. + +The `:cache' header argument is for caching results of evaluating code +blocks. Caching results can avoid re-evaluating `src' code blocks that +have not changed since the previous run. To benefit from the cache and +avoid redundant evaluations, the source block must have a result +already present in the buffer, and neither the header arguments +(including the value of `:var' references) nor the text of the block +itself has changed since the result was last computed. This feature +greatly helps avoid long-running calculations. For some edge cases, +however, the cached results may not be reliable. + + The caching feature is best for when `src' blocks are pure functions, +that is functions that return the same value for the same input +arguments (*note var::), and that do not have side effects, and do not +rely on external variables other than the input arguments. Functions +that depend on a timer, file system objects, and random number +generators are clearly unsuitable for caching. + + A note of warning: when `:cache' is used for a `:session', caching +may cause unexpected results. + + When the caching mechanism tests for any source code changes, it +will not expand Noweb style references (*note Noweb reference +syntax::). For reasons why, see +`http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.emacs.orgmode/79046'. + + The `:cache' header argument can have one of two values: `yes' or +`no'. + + * `no' Default. No caching of results; `src' code block evaluated + every time. + + * `yes' Whether to run the code or return the cached results is + determined by comparing the SHA1 hash value of the combined `src' + code block and arguments passed to it. This hash value is packed + on the `#+RESULTS:' line from previous evaluation. When hash + values match, Org does not evaluate the `src' code block. When + hash values mismatch, Org evaluates the `src' code block, inserts + the results, recalculates the hash value, and updates `#+RESULTS:' + line. + + In this example, both functions are cached. But `caller' runs only +if the result from `random' has changed since the last run. + + #+NAME: random + #+BEGIN_SRC R :cache yes + runif(1) + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random + 0.4659510825295 + + #+NAME: caller + #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes + x + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller + 0.254227238707244 + + +File: org, Node: sep, Next: hlines, Prev: cache, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.19 `:sep' +................ + +The `:sep' header argument is the delimiter for saving results as tables +to files (*note file::) external to Org mode. Org defaults to tab +delimited output. The function, `org-open-at-point', which is bound to +`C-c C-o', also uses `:sep' for opening tabular results. + + +File: org, Node: hlines, Next: colnames, Prev: sep, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.20 `:hlines' +................... + +In-between each table row or below the table headings, sometimes +results have horizontal lines, which are also known as hlines. The +`:hlines' argument with the value `yes' accepts such lines. The +default is `no'. + + * `no' Strips horizontal lines from the input table. For most code, + this is desirable, or else those `hline' symbols raise unbound + variable errors. + + The default is `:hlines no'. The example shows hlines removed + from the input table. + + #+NAME: many-cols + | a | b | c | + |---+---+---| + | d | e | f | + |---+---+---| + | g | h | i | + + #+NAME: echo-table + #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols + return tab + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS: echo-table + | a | b | c | + | d | e | f | + | g | h | i | + + * `yes' For `:hlines yes', the example shows hlines unchanged. + + #+NAME: many-cols + | a | b | c | + |---+---+---| + | d | e | f | + |---+---+---| + | g | h | i | + + #+NAME: echo-table + #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes + return tab + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS: echo-table + | a | b | c | + |---+---+---| + | d | e | f | + |---+---+---| + | g | h | i | + + +File: org, Node: colnames, Next: rownames, Prev: hlines, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.21 `:colnames' +..................... + +The `:colnames' header argument accepts `yes', `no', or `nil' values. +The default value is `nil', which is unassigned. But this header +argument behaves differently depending on the source code language. + + * `nil' If an input table has column names (because the second row + is an hline), then Org removes the column names, processes the + table, puts back the column names, and then writes the table to + the results block. + + #+NAME: less-cols + | a | + |---| + | b | + | c | + + #+NAME: echo-table-again + #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=less-cols + return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab] + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS: echo-table-again + | a | + |----| + | b* | + | c* | + + Note that column names have to accounted for when using variable + indexing (*note Indexable variable values: var.) because column + names are not removed for indexing. + + * `no' Do not pre-process column names. + + * `yes' For an input table that has no hlines, process it like the + `nil' value. That is, Org removes the column names, processes the + table, puts back the column names, and then writes the table to + the results block. + + +File: org, Node: rownames, Next: shebang, Prev: colnames, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.22 `:rownames' +..................... + +The `:rownames' header argument can take on values `yes' or `no' +values. The default is `no'. Note that `emacs-lisp' code blocks +ignore `:rownames' header argument because of the ease of +table-handling in Emacs. + + * `no' Org will not pre-process row names. + + * `yes' If an input table has row names, then Org removes the row + names, processes the table, puts back the row names, and then + writes the table to the results block. + + #+NAME: with-rownames + | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 | + | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 | + + #+NAME: echo-table-once-again + #+BEGIN_SRC python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes + return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab] + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS: echo-table-once-again + | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 | + | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 | + + Note that row names have to accounted for when using variable + indexing (*note Indexable variable values: var.) because row names + are not removed for indexing. + + + +File: org, Node: shebang, Next: tangle-mode, Prev: rownames, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.23 `:shebang' +.................... + +This header argument can turn results into executable script files. By +setting the `:shebang' header argument to a string value (for example, +`:shebang "#!/bin/bash"'), Org inserts that string as the first line of +the tangled file that the `src' code block is extracted to. Org then +turns on the tangled file's executable permission. + + +File: org, Node: tangle-mode, Next: eval, Prev: shebang, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.24 `:tangle-mode' +........................ + +The `tangle-mode' header argument specifies what permissions to set for +tangled files by `set-file-modes'. For example, to make read-only +tangled file, use `:tangle-mode (identity #o444)'. To make it +executable, use `:tangle-mode (identity #o755)'. + + On `src' code blocks with `shebang' (*note shebang::) header +argument, Org will automatically set the tangled file to executable +permissions. But this can be overridden with custom permissions using +`tangle-mode' header argument. + + When multiple `src' code blocks tangle to a single file with +different and conflicting `tangle-mode' header arguments, Org's +behavior is undefined. + + +File: org, Node: eval, Next: wrap, Prev: tangle-mode, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.25 `:eval' +................. + +The `:eval' header argument can limit evaluation of specific code +blocks. It is useful for protection against evaluating untrusted `src' +code blocks by prompting for a confirmation. This protection is +independent of the `org-confirm-babel-evaluate' setting. + +`never or no' + Org will never evaluate this `src' code block. + +`query' + Org prompts the user for permission to evaluate this `src' code + block. + +`never-export or no-export' + Org will not evaluate this `src' code block when exporting, yet + the user can evaluate this source block interactively. + +`query-export' + Org prompts the user for permission to export this `src' code + block. + + If `:eval' header argument is not set for a source block, then Org +determines whether to evaluate from the `org-confirm-babel-evaluate' +variable (*note Code evaluation security::). + + +File: org, Node: wrap, Next: post, Prev: eval, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.26 `:wrap' +................. + +The `:wrap' header argument marks the results block by appending strings +to `#+BEGIN_' and `#+END_'. If no string is specified, Org wraps the +results in a `#+BEGIN/END_RESULTS' block. + + +File: org, Node: post, Next: prologue, Prev: wrap, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.27 `:post' +................. + +The `:post' header argument is for post-processing results from `src' +block evaluation. When `:post' has any value, Org binds the results to +`*this*' variable for easy passing to *note var:: header argument +specifications. That makes results available to other `src' code +blocks, or for even direct Emacs Lisp code execution. + + The following two examples illustrate `:post' header argument in +action. The first one shows how to attach `#+ATTR_LATEX:' line using +`:post'. + + #+name: attr_wrap + #+begin_src sh :var data="" :var width="\\textwidth" :results output + echo "#+ATTR_LATEX: :width $width" + echo "$data" + #+end_src + + #+header: :file /tmp/it.png + #+begin_src dot :post attr_wrap(width="5cm", data=*this*) :results drawer + digraph{ + a -> b; + b -> c; + c -> a; + } + #+end_src + + #+RESULTS: + :RESULTS: + #+ATTR_LATEX :width 5cm + [[file:/tmp/it.png]] + :END: + + The second example shows use of `:colnames' in `:post' to pass data +between `src' code blocks. + + #+name: round-tbl + #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var tbl="" fmt="%.3f" + (mapcar (lambda (row) + (mapcar (lambda (cell) + (if (numberp cell) + (format fmt cell) + cell)) + row)) + tbl) + #+end_src + + #+begin_src R :colnames yes :post round-tbl[:colnames yes](*this*) + set.seed(42) + data.frame(foo=rnorm(1)) + #+end_src + + #+RESULTS: + | foo | + |-------| + | 1.371 | + + +File: org, Node: prologue, Next: epilogue, Prev: post, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.28 `:prologue' +..................... + +The `prologue' header argument is for appending to the top of the code +block for execution. For example, a clear or reset code at the start +of new execution of a `src' code block. A `reset' for `gnuplot': +`:prologue "reset"'. See also *note epilogue::. + + (add-to-list 'org-babel-default-header-args:gnuplot + '((:prologue . "reset"))) + + +File: org, Node: epilogue, Prev: prologue, Up: Specific header arguments + +14.8.2.29 `:epilogue' +..................... + +The value of the `epilogue' header argument is for appending to the end +of the code block for execution. See also *note prologue::. + + +File: org, Node: Results of evaluation, Next: Noweb reference syntax, Prev: Header arguments, Up: Working with source code + +14.9 Results of evaluation +========================== + +How Org handles results of a code block execution depends on many header +arguments working together. Here is only a summary of these. For an +enumeration of all the header arguments that affect results, see *note +results::. + + The primary determinant is the execution context. Is it in a +`:session' or not? Orthogonal to that is if the expected result is a +`:results value' or `:results output', which is a concatenation of +output from start to finish of the `src' code block's evaluation. + + Non-session Session +`:results value' value of last value of last expression + expression +`:results output' contents of STDOUT concatenation of interpreter + output + + For `:session' and non-session, the `:results value' turns the +results into an Org mode table format. Single values are wrapped in a +one dimensional vector. Rows and columns of a table are wrapped in a +two-dimensional vector. + +14.9.1 Non-session +------------------ + +14.9.1.1 `:results value' +......................... + +Default. Org gets the value by wrapping the code in a function +definition in the language of the `src' block. That is why when using +`:results value', code should execute like a function and return a +value. For languages like Python, an explicit `return' statement is +mandatory when using `:results value'. + + This is one of four evaluation contexts where Org automatically +wraps the code in a function definition. + +14.9.1.2 `:results output' +.......................... + +For `:results output', the code is passed to an external process running +the interpreter. Org returns the contents of the standard output +stream as as text results. + +14.9.2 Session +-------------- + +14.9.2.1 `:results value' +......................... + +For `:results value' from a `:session', Org passes the code to an +interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior process. So only +languages that provide interactive evaluation can have session support. +Not all languages provide this support, such as `C' and `ditaa'. Even +those that do support, such as `Python' and `Haskell', they impose +limitations on allowable language constructs that can run +interactively. Org inherits those limitations for those `src' code +blocks running in a `:session'. + + Org gets the value from the source code interpreter's last statement +output. Org has to use language-specific methods to obtain the value. +For example, from the variable `_' in `Python' and `Ruby', and the +value of `.Last.value' in `R'). + +14.9.2.2 `:results output' +.......................... + +For `:results output', Org passes the code to the interpreter running as +an interactive Emacs inferior process. Org concatenates whatever text +output emitted by the interpreter to return the collection as a result. +Note that this collection is not the same as collected from `STDOUT' of +a non-interactive interpreter running as an external process. Compare +for example these two blocks: + + #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output + print "hello" + 2 + print "bye" + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS: + : hello + : bye + + In the above non-session mode, the "2" is not printed; so does not +appear in results. + + #+BEGIN_SRC python :results output :session + print "hello" + 2 + print "bye" + #+END_SRC + + #+RESULTS: + : hello + : 2 + : bye + + In the above `:session' mode, the interactive interpreter receives +and prints "2". Results show that. + + +File: org, Node: Noweb reference syntax, Next: Key bindings and useful functions, Prev: Results of evaluation, Up: Working with source code + +14.10 Noweb reference syntax +============================ + +Org supports named blocks in Noweb style syntax. For Noweb literate +programming details, see `http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/'). + + <<code-block-name>> + + For the header argument `:noweb yes', Org expands Noweb style +references in the `src' code block before evaluation. + + For the header argument `:noweb no', Org does not expand Noweb style +references in the `src' code block before evaluation. + + The default is `:noweb no'. Org defaults to `:noweb no' so as not +to cause errors in languages where Noweb syntax is ambiguous. Change +Org's default to `:noweb yes' for languages where there is no risk of +confusion. + + Org offers a more flexible way to resolve Noweb style references +(*note noweb-ref::). + + Org can include the _results_ of a code block rather than its body. +To that effect, append parentheses, possibly including arguments, to +the code block name, as show below. + + <<code-block-name(optional arguments)>> + + Note that when using the above approach to a code block's results, +the code block name set by `#+NAME' keyword is required; the reference +set by `:noweb-ref' will not work. + + Here is an example that demonstrates how the exported content +changes when Noweb style references are used with parentheses versus +without. + + With: + + #+NAME: some-code + #+BEGIN_SRC python :var num=0 :results output :exports none + print(num*10) + #+END_SRC + + this code block: + + #+BEGIN_SRC text :noweb yes + <<some-code>> + #+END_SRC + + expands to: + + print(num*10) + + Below, a similar Noweb style reference is used, but with +parentheses, while setting a variable `num' to 10: + + #+BEGIN_SRC text :noweb yes + <<some-code(num=10)>> + #+END_SRC + + Note that now the expansion contains the _results_ of the code block +`some-code', not the code block itself: + + 100 + + For faster tangling of large Org mode files, set +`org-babel-use-quick-and-dirty-noweb-expansion' variable to `t'. The +speedup comes at the expense of not correctly resolving inherited values +of the `:noweb-ref' header argument. + + +File: org, Node: Key bindings and useful functions, Next: Batch execution, Prev: Noweb reference syntax, Up: Working with source code + +14.11 Key bindings and useful functions +======================================= + +Many common Org mode key sequences are re-bound depending on the +context. + + Active key bindings in code blocks: + +`C-c C-c' `org-babel-execute-src-block' +`C-c C-o' `org-babel-open-src-block-result' +`M-<up>' `org-babel-load-in-session' +`M-<down>' `org-babel-switch-to-session' + + Active key bindings in Org mode buffer: + +`C-c C-v p' or `C-c C-v C-p' `org-babel-previous-src-block' +`C-c C-v n' or `C-c C-v C-n' `org-babel-next-src-block' +`C-c C-v e' or `C-c C-v C-e' `org-babel-execute-maybe' +`C-c C-v o' or `C-c C-v C-o' `org-babel-open-src-block-result' +`C-c C-v v' or `C-c C-v C-v' `org-babel-expand-src-block' +`C-c C-v u' or `C-c C-v C-u' `org-babel-goto-src-block-head' +`C-c C-v g' or `C-c C-v C-g' `org-babel-goto-named-src-block' +`C-c C-v r' or `C-c C-v C-r' `org-babel-goto-named-result' +`C-c C-v b' or `C-c C-v C-b' `org-babel-execute-buffer' +`C-c C-v s' or `C-c C-v C-s' `org-babel-execute-subtree' +`C-c C-v d' or `C-c C-v C-d' `org-babel-demarcate-block' +`C-c C-v t' or `C-c C-v C-t' `org-babel-tangle' +`C-c C-v f' or `C-c C-v C-f' `org-babel-tangle-file' +`C-c C-v c' or `C-c C-v C-c' `org-babel-check-src-block' +`C-c C-v j' or `C-c C-v C-j' `org-babel-insert-header-arg' +`C-c C-v l' or `C-c C-v C-l' `org-babel-load-in-session' +`C-c C-v i' or `C-c C-v C-i' `org-babel-lob-ingest' +`C-c C-v I' or `C-c C-v C-I' `org-babel-view-src-block-info' +`C-c C-v z' or `C-c C-v C-z' `org-babel-switch-to-session-with-code' +`C-c C-v a' or `C-c C-v C-a' `org-babel-sha1-hash' +`C-c C-v h' or `C-c C-v C-h' `org-babel-describe-bindings' +`C-c C-v x' or `C-c C-v C-x' `org-babel-do-key-sequence-in-edit-buffer' + + +File: org, Node: Batch execution, Prev: Key bindings and useful functions, Up: Working with source code + +14.12 Batch execution +===================== + +Org mode features, including working with source code facilities can be +invoked from the command line. This enables building shell scripts for +batch processing, running automated system tasks, and expanding Org +mode's usefulness. + + The sample script shows batch processing of multiple files using +`org-babel-tangle'. + + #!/bin/sh + # tangle files with org-mode + # + emacs -Q --batch --eval " + (progn + (require 'ob-tangle) + (dolist (file command-line-args-left) + (with-current-buffer (find-file-noselect file) + (org-babel-tangle)))) + " "$@" + + +File: org, Node: Miscellaneous, Next: Hacking, Prev: Working with source code, Up: Top + +15 Miscellaneous +**************** + +* Menu: + +* Completion:: M-TAB guesses completions +* Easy templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements +* Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline +* Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code +* Customization:: Adapting Org to changing tastes +* In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS +* The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c +* Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline +* TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty +* Interaction:: With other Emacs packages +* org-crypt:: Encrypting Org files + + +File: org, Node: Completion, Next: Easy templates, Up: Miscellaneous + +15.1 Completion +=============== + +Org has in-buffer completions. Unlike minibuffer completions, which are +useful for quick command interactions, Org's in-buffer completions are +more suitable for content creation in Org documents. Type one or more +letters and invoke the hot key to complete the text in-place. +Depending on the context and the keys, Org will offer different types +of completions. No minibuffer is involved. Such mode-specific hot +keys have become an integral part of Emacs and Org provides several +shortcuts. + +`M-<TAB>' + Complete word at point + * At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords. + + * After `\', complete TeX symbols supported by the exporter. + + * After `*', complete headlines in the current buffer so that + they can be used in search links like `[[*find this + headline]]'. + + * After `:' in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is + taken from the variable `org-tag-alist' (possibly set through + the `#+TAGS' in-buffer option, *note Setting tags::), or it + is created dynamically from all tags used in the current + buffer. + + * After `:' and not in a headline, complete property keys. The + list of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in + the current buffer. + + * After `[', complete link abbreviations (*note Link + abbreviations::). + + * After `#+', complete the special keywords like `TYP_TODO' or + file-specific `OPTIONS'. After option keyword is complete, + pressing `M-<TAB>' again will insert example settings for + that option. + + * After `#+STARTUP: ', complete startup keywords. + + * When the point is anywhere else, complete dictionary words + using Ispell. + If your desktop intercepts the combo `M-<TAB>' to switch windows, + use `C-M-i' or `<ESC> <TAB>' as an alternative or customize your + environment. + + +File: org, Node: Easy templates, Next: Speed keys, Prev: Completion, Up: Miscellaneous + +15.2 Easy templates +=================== + +With just a few keystrokes, Org's easy templates inserts empty pairs of +structural elements, such as `#+BEGIN_SRC' and `#+END_SRC'. Easy +templates use an expansion mechanism, which is native to Org, in a +process similar to `yasnippet' and other Emacs template expansion +packages. + + `<' `s' `<TAB>' expands to a `src' code block. + + `<' `l' `<TAB>' expands to: + + #+BEGIN_EXPORT latex + + #+END_EXPORT + + Org comes with these pre-defined easy templates: + +`s' `#+BEGIN_SRC ... #+END_SRC' +`e' `#+BEGIN_EXAMPLE ... #+END_EXAMPLE' +`q' `#+BEGIN_QUOTE ... #+END_QUOTE' +`v' `#+BEGIN_VERSE ... #+END_VERSE' +`c' `#+BEGIN_CENTER ... #+END_CENTER' +`C' `#+BEGIN_COMMENT ... #+END_COMMENT' +`l' `#+BEGIN_EXPORT latex ... #+END_EXPORT' +`L' `#+LATEX:' +`h' `#+BEGIN_EXPORT html ... #+END_EXPORT' +`H' `#+HTML:' +`a' `#+BEGIN_EXPORT ascii ... #+END_EXPORT' +`A' `#+ASCII:' +`i' `#+INDEX:' line +`I' `#+INCLUDE:' line + + More templates can added by customizing the variable +`org-structure-template-alist', whose docstring has additional details. + + +File: org, Node: Speed keys, Next: Code evaluation security, Prev: Easy templates, Up: Miscellaneous + +15.3 Speed keys +=============== + +Single keystrokes can execute custom commands in an Org file when the +cursor is on a headline. Without the extra burden of a meta or +modifier key, Speed Keys can speed navigation or execute custom +commands. Besides faster navigation, Speed Keys may come in handy on +small mobile devices that do not have full keyboards. Speed Keys may +also work on TTY devices known for their problems when entering Emacs +keychords. + + By default, Org has Speed Keys disabled. To activate Speed Keys, +set the variable `org-use-speed-commands' to a non-`nil' value. To +trigger a Speed Key, the cursor must be at the beginning of an Org +headline, before any of the stars. + + Org comes with a pre-defined list of Speed Keys. To add or modify +Speed Keys, customize the variable, `org-speed-commands-user'. For more +details, see the variable's docstring. With Speed Keys activated, `M-x +org-speed-command-help', or `?' when cursor is at the beginning of an +Org headline, shows currently active Speed Keys, including the +user-defined ones. + + +File: org, Node: Code evaluation security, Next: Customization, Prev: Speed keys, Up: Miscellaneous + +15.4 Code evaluation and security issues +======================================== + +Unlike plain text, running code comes with risk. Each `src' code block, +in terms of risk, is equivalent to an executable file. Org therefore +puts a few confirmation prompts by default. This is to alert the +casual user from accidentally running untrusted code. + + For users who do not run code blocks or write code regularly, Org's +default settings should suffice. However, some users may want to tweak +the prompts for fewer interruptions. To weigh the risks of automatic +execution of code blocks, here are some details about code evaluation. + + Org evaluates code in the following circumstances: + +Source code blocks + Org evaluates `src' code blocks in an Org file during export. Org + also evaluates a `src' code block with the `C-c C-c' key chord. + Users exporting or running code blocks must load files only from + trusted sources. Be wary of customizing variables that remove or + alter default security measures. + + -- User Option: org-confirm-babel-evaluate + When `t', Org prompts the user for confirmation before + executing each code block. When `nil', Org executes code + blocks without prompting the user for confirmation. When + this option is set to a custom function, Org invokes the + function with these two arguments: the source code language + and the body of the code block. The custom function must + return either a `t' or `nil', which determines if the user is + prompted. Each source code language can be handled + separately through this function argument. + + For example, this function enables execution of `ditaa' code + +blocks without prompting: + + (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body) + (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ; don't ask for ditaa + (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate 'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate) + +Following `shell' and `elisp' links + Org has two link types that can also directly evaluate code (*note + External links::). Because such code is not visible, these links + have a potential risk. Org therefore prompts the user when it + encounters such links. The customization variables are: + + -- User Option: org-confirm-shell-link-function + Function that prompts the user before executing a shell link. + + -- User Option: org-confirm-elisp-link-function + Function that prompts the user before executing an Emacs Lisp + link. + +Formulas in tables + Org executes formulas in tables (*note The spreadsheet::) either + through the _calc_ or the _Emacs Lisp_ interpreters. + + +File: org, Node: Customization, Next: In-buffer settings, Prev: Code evaluation security, Up: Miscellaneous + +15.5 Customization +================== + +Org has more than 500 variables for customization. They can be accessed +through the usual `M-x org-customize RET' command. Or through the Org +menu, `Org->Customization->Browse Org Group'. Org also has per-file +settings for some variables (*note In-buffer settings::). + + +File: org, Node: In-buffer settings, Next: The very busy C-c C-c key, Prev: Customization, Up: Miscellaneous + +15.6 Summary of in-buffer settings +================================== + +In-buffer settings start with `#+', followed by a keyword, a colon, and +then a word for each setting. Org accepts multiple settings on the same +line. Org also accepts multiple lines for a keyword. This manual +describes these settings throughout. A summary follows here. + + `C-c C-c' activates any changes to the in-buffer settings. Closing +and reopening the Org file in Emacs also activates the changes. + +`#+ARCHIVE: %s_done::' + Sets the archive location of the agenda file. This location + applies to the lines until the next `#+ARCHIVE' line, if any, in + the Org file. The first archive location in the Org file also + applies to any entries before it. The corresponding variable is + `org-archive-location'. + +`#+CATEGORY:' + Sets the category of the agenda file, which applies to the entire + document. + +`#+COLUMNS: %25ITEM ...' + Sets the default format for columns view. Org uses this format + for column views where there is no `COLUMNS' property. + +`#+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...' + Set file-local values for constants that table formulas can use. + This line sets the local variable + `org-table-formula-constants-local'. The global version of this + variable is `org-table-formula-constants'. + +`#+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:' + Set tags that all entries in the file will inherit from here, + including the top-level entries. + +`#+LINK: linkword replace' + Each line specifies one abbreviation for one link. Use multiple + `#+LINK:' lines for more, *note Link abbreviations::. The + corresponding variable is `org-link-abbrev-alist'. + +`#+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default' + This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All + three must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest + priority must have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority. + +`#+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value' + This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the + current buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a + property. + +`#+SETUPFILE: file or URL' + The setup file or a URL pointing to such file is for additional + in-buffer settings. Org loads this file and parses it for any + settings in it only when Org opens the main file. If URL is + specified, the contents are downloaded and stored in a temporary + file cache. `C-c C-c' on the settings line will parse and load + the file, and also reset the temporary file cache. Org also + parses and loads the document during normal exporting process. Org + parses the contents of this document as if it was included in the + buffer. It can be another Org file. To visit the file (not a + URL), `C-c '' while the cursor is on the line with the file name. + +`#+STARTUP:' + Startup options Org uses when first visiting a file. + + The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the + outline tree. The corresponding variable for global default + settings is `org-startup-folded' with a default value of `t', + which is the same as `overview'. + + overview top-level headlines only + content all headlines + showall no folding of any entries + showeverything show even drawer contents + + Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable + `org-startup-indented' + indent start with `org-indent-mode' turned on + noindent start with `org-indent-mode' turned off + + Aligns tables consistently upon visiting a file; useful for + restoring narrowed table columns. The corresponding variable is + `org-startup-align-all-tables' with `nil' as default value. + + align align all tables + noalign don't align tables on startup + + Whether Org should automatically display inline images. The + corresponding variable is `org-startup-with-inline-images', with a + default value `nil' to avoid delays when visiting a file. + inlineimages show inline images + noinlineimages don't show inline images on startup + + Whether Org should automatically convert LaTeX fragments to + images. The variable `org-startup-with-latex-preview', which + controls this setting, is set to `nil' by default to avoid startup + delays. + latexpreview preview LaTeX fragments + nolatexpreview don't preview LaTeX fragments + + Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock + intervals can be configured using these options (see variables + `org-log-done', `org-log-note-clock-out' and `org-log-repeat') + logdone record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE + lognotedone record timestamp and a note when DONE + nologdone don't record when items are marked DONE + logrepeat record a time when reinstating a repeating item + lognoterepeat record a note when reinstating a repeating item + nologrepeat do not record when reinstating repeating item + lognoteclock-out record a note when clocking out + nolognoteclock-out don't record a note when clocking out + logreschedule record a timestamp when scheduling time changes + lognotereschedule record a note when scheduling time changes + nologreschedule do not record when a scheduling date changes + logredeadline record a timestamp when deadline changes + lognoteredeadline record a note when deadline changes + nologredeadline do not record when a deadline date changes + logrefile record a timestamp when refiling + lognoterefile record a note when refiling + nologrefile do not record when refiling + logdrawer store log into drawer + nologdrawer store log outside of drawer + logstatesreversed reverse the order of states notes + nologstatesreversed do not reverse the order of states notes + + These options hide leading stars in outline headings, and indent + outlines. The corresponding variables are + `org-hide-leading-stars' and `org-odd-levels-only', both with a + default setting of `nil' (meaning `showstars' and `oddeven'). + hidestars hide all stars on the headline except one. + showstars show all stars on the headline + indent virtual indents according to the outline level + noindent no virtual indents + odd show odd outline levels only (1,3,...) + oddeven show all outline levels + + To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables + `org-put-time-stamp-overlays' and + `org-time-stamp-overlay-formats'), use + customtime overlay custom time format + + The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable + `constants-unit-system'). + constcgs `constants.el' should use the c-g-s unit system + constSI `constants.el' should use the SI unit system + + For footnote settings, use the following keywords. The + corresponding variables are `org-footnote-define-inline', + `org-footnote-auto-label', and `org-footnote-auto-adjust'. + fninline define footnotes inline + fnnoinline define footnotes in separate section + fnlocal define footnotes near first reference, but not inline + fnprompt prompt for footnote labels + fnauto create `[fn:1]'-like labels automatically (default) + fnconfirm offer automatic label for editing or confirmation + fnplain create `[1]'-like labels automatically + fnadjust automatically renumber and sort footnotes + nofnadjust do not renumber and sort automatically + + To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding + variable is `org-hide-block-startup'. + hideblocks Hide all begin/end blocks on startup + nohideblocks Do not hide blocks on startup + + The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the + variable `org-pretty-entities' and the keywords + entitiespretty Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible + entitiesplain Leave entities plain + +`#+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)' + These lines specify valid tags for this file. Org accepts + multiple tags lines. Tags could correspond to the _fast tag + selection_ keys. The corresponding variable is `org-tag-alist'. + +`#+TBLFM:' + This line is for formulas for the table directly above. A table + can have multiple `#+TBLFM:' lines. On table recalculation, Org + applies only the first `#+TBLFM:' line. For details see *note + Using multiple #+TBLFM lines:: in *note Editing and debugging + formulas::. + +`#+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+DATE:,' +`#+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:,' +`#+SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXCLUDE_TAGS:' + These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more + details see *note Export settings::. + +`#+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:' + These lines set the TODO keywords and their significance to the + current file. The corresponding variable is `org-todo-keywords'. + + +File: org, Node: The very busy C-c C-c key, Next: Clean view, Prev: In-buffer settings, Up: Miscellaneous + +15.7 The very busy C-c C-c key +============================== + +The `C-c C-c' key in Org serves many purposes depending on the context. +It is probably the most over-worked, multi-purpose key combination in +Org. Its uses are well-documented through out this manual, but here is +a consolidated list for easy reference. + + - If any highlights shown in the buffer from the creation of a + sparse tree, or from clock display, remove such highlights. + + - If the cursor is in one of the special `#+KEYWORD' lines, scan the + buffer for these lines and update the information. Also reset the + Org file cache used to temporary store the contents of URLs used + as values for keywords like `#+SETUPFILE'. + + - If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. The table + realigns even if automatic table editor is turned off. + + - If the cursor is on a `#+TBLFM' line, re-apply the formulas to the + entire table. + + - If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file + it. With a prefix argument, also jump to the target location + after saving the note. + + - If the cursor is on a `<<<target>>>', update radio targets and + corresponding links in this buffer. + + - If the cursor is on a property line or at the start or end of a + property drawer, offer property commands. + + - If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding + definition, and _vice versa_. + + - If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it. + + - If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the + status of the checkbox. + + - If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the + ordered list. + + - If the cursor is on the `#+BEGIN' line of a dynamic block, the + block is updated. + + - If the cursor is at a timestamp, fix the day name in the timestamp. + + +File: org, Node: Clean view, Next: TTY keys, Prev: The very busy C-c C-c key, Up: Miscellaneous + +15.8 A cleaner outline view +=========================== + +Org's default outline with stars and no indents can become too +cluttered for short documents. For _book-like_ long documents, the +effect is not as noticeable. Org provides an alternate stars and +indentation scheme, as shown on the right in the following table. It +uses only one star and indents text to line with the heading: + + * Top level headline | * Top level headline + ** Second level | * Second level + *** 3rd level | * 3rd level + some text | some text + *** 3rd level | * 3rd level + more text | more text + * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline + +To turn this mode on, use the minor mode, `org-indent-mode'. Text lines +that are not headlines are prefixed with spaces to vertically align +with the headline text(1). + + To make more horizontal space, the headlines are shifted by two +stars. This can be configured by the +`org-indent-indentation-per-level' variable. Only one star on each +headline is visible, the rest are masked with the same font color as +the background. This font face can be configured with the `org-hide' +variable. + + Note that turning on `org-indent-mode' sets `org-hide-leading-stars' +to `t' and `org-adapt-indentation' to `nil'; `2.' below shows how this +works. + + To globally turn on `org-indent-mode' for all files, customize the +variable `org-startup-indented'. + + To turn on indenting for individual files, use `#+STARTUP' option as +follows: + + #+STARTUP: indent + + Indent on startup makes Org use hard spaces to align text with +headings as shown in examples below. + + 1. _Indentation of text below headlines_ + Indent text to align with the headline. + + *** 3rd level + more text, now indented + + Org adapts indentations with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and + structure editing(2). + + 2. _Hiding leading stars_ + Org can make leading stars invisible. For global preference, + configure the variable `org-hide-leading-stars'. For per-file + preference, use these file `#+STARTUP' options: + + #+STARTUP: hidestars + #+STARTUP: showstars + + With stars hidden, the tree is shown as: + + * Top level headline + * Second level + * 3rd level + ... + + Because Org makes the font color same as the background color to + hide to stars, sometimes `org-hide' face may need tweaking to get + the effect right. For some black and white combinations, `grey90' + on a white background might mask the stars better. + + 3. Using stars for only odd levels, 1, 3, 5, ..., can also clean up + the clutter. This removes two stars from each level(3). For Org + to properly handle this cleaner structure during edits and + exports, configure the variable `org-odd-levels-only'. To set + this per-file, use either one of the following lines: + + #+STARTUP: odd + #+STARTUP: oddeven + + To switch between single and double stars layouts, use `M-x + org-convert-to-odd-levels RET' and `M-x + org-convert-to-oddeven-levels'. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) The `org-indent-mode' also sets the `wrap-prefix' correctly for +indenting and wrapping long lines of headlines or text. This minor +mode handles `visual-line-mode' and directly applied settings through +`word-wrap'. + + (2) Also see the variable `org-adapt-indentation'. + + (3) Because `LEVEL=2' has 3 stars, `LEVEL=3' has 4 stars, and so on + + +File: org, Node: TTY keys, Next: Interaction, Prev: Clean view, Up: Miscellaneous + +15.9 Using Org on a tty +======================= + +Org provides alternative key bindings for TTY and modern mobile devices +that cannot handle cursor keys and complex modifier key chords. Some +of these workarounds may be more cumbersome than necessary. Users +should look into customizing these further based on their usage needs. +For example, the normal `S-<cursor>' for editing timestamp might be +better with `C-c .' chord. + +Default Alternative 1 Speed Alternative 2 + key +`S-<TAB>' `C-u <TAB>' `C' +`M-<left>' `C-c C-x l' `l' `<Esc> <left>' +`M-S-<left>'`C-c C-x L' `L' +`M-<right>' `C-c C-x r' `r' `<Esc> + <right>' +`M-S-<right>'`C-c C-x R' `R' +`M-<up>' `C-c C-x u' ` ' `<Esc> <up>' +`M-S-<up>' `C-c C-x U' `U' +`M-<down>' `C-c C-x d' ` ' `<Esc> <down>' +`M-S-<down>'`C-c C-x D' `D' +`S-<RET>' `C-c C-x c' ` ' +`M-<RET>' `C-c C-x m' ` ' `<Esc> <RET>' +`M-S-<RET>' `C-c C-x M' ` ' +`S-<left>' `C-c <left>' ` ' +`S-<right>' `C-c <right>' ` ' +`S-<up>' `C-c <up>' ` ' +`S-<down>' `C-c <down>' ` ' +`C-S-<left>'`C-c C-x ` ' + <left>' +`C-S-<right>'`C-c C-x ` ' + <right>' + + +File: org, Node: Interaction, Next: org-crypt, Prev: TTY keys, Up: Miscellaneous + +15.10 Interaction with other packages +===================================== + +Org's compatibility and the level of interaction with other Emacs +packages are documented here. + +* Menu: + +* Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with +* Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts + + +File: org, Node: Cooperation, Next: Conflicts, Up: Interaction + +15.10.1 Packages that Org cooperates with +----------------------------------------- + +`calc.el' by Dave Gillespie + Org uses the Calc package for tables to implement spreadsheet + functionality (*note The spreadsheet::). Org also uses Calc for + embedded calculations. *Note Embedded Mode: (calc)Embedded Mode. + +`constants.el' by Carsten Dominik + Org can use names for constants in formulas in tables. Org can + also use calculation suffixes for units, such as `M' for `Mega'. + For a standard collection of such constants, install the + `constants' package. Install version 2.0 of this package, + available at `https://staff.fnwi.uva.nl/c.dominik/Tools/'. Org + checks if the function `constants-get' has been autoloaded. + Installation instructions are in the file, `constants.el'. + +`cdlatex.el' by Carsten Dominik + Org mode can use CDLaTeX package to efficiently enter LaTeX + fragments into Org files (*note CDLaTeX mode::). + +`imenu.el' by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg + Imenu creates dynamic menus based on an index of items in a file. + Org mode supports Imenu menus. Enable it with a mode hook as + follows: + (add-hook 'org-mode-hook + (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu"))) + By default the Imenu index is two levels deep. Change the index + depth using thes variable, `org-imenu-depth'. + +`speedbar.el' by Eric M. Ludlam + Speedbar package creates a special Emacs frame for displaying + files and index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar; users + can drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. The `<' in + the Speedbar frame tweaks the agenda commands to that file or to a + subtree. + +`table.el' by Takaaki Ota + Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and + row-spanning, and alignment can be created using the Emacs table + package by Takaaki Ota. Org mode recognizes such tables and + export them properly. `C-c '' to edit these tables in a special + buffer, much like Org's `src' code blocks. Because of + interference with other Org mode functionality, Takaaki Ota tables + cannot be edited directly in the Org buffer. + `C-c ' (`org-edit-special')' + Edit a `table.el' table. Works when the cursor is in a + table.el table. + + `C-c ~ (`org-table-create-with-table.el')' + Insert a `table.el' table. If there is already a table at + point, this command converts it between the `table.el' format + and the Org mode format. See the documentation string of the + command `org-convert-table' for details. + + +File: org, Node: Conflicts, Prev: Cooperation, Up: Interaction + +15.10.2 Packages that conflict with Org mode +-------------------------------------------- + + In Emacs, `shift-selection-mode' combines cursor motions with + shift key to enlarge regions. Emacs sets this mode by default. + This conflicts with Org's use of `S-<cursor>' commands to change + timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types, etc. + Since `S-<cursor>' commands outside of specific contexts don't do + anything, Org offers the variable `org-support-shift-select' for + customization. Org mode accommodates shift selection by (i) + making it available outside of the special contexts where special + commands apply, and (ii) extending an existing active region even + if the cursor moves across a special context. + +`CUA.el' by Kim. F. Storm + Org key bindings conflict with `S-<cursor>' keys used by CUA mode. + For Org to relinquish these bindings to CUA mode, configure the + variable `org-replace-disputed-keys'. When set, Org moves the + following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda buffer (but + not during date selection). + + S-UP => M-p S-DOWN => M-n + S-LEFT => M-- S-RIGHT => M-+ + C-S-LEFT => M-S-- C-S-RIGHT => M-S-+ + + Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. To + define a different replacement keys, look at the variable + `org-disputed-keys'. + +`ecomplete.el' by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@gnus.org> + Ecomplete provides "electric" address completion in address header + lines in message buffers. Sadly Orgtbl mode cuts ecompletes power + supply: No completion happens when Orgtbl mode is enabled in + message buffers while entering text in address header lines. If + one wants to use ecomplete one should _not_ follow the advice to + automagically turn on Orgtbl mode in message buffers (see *note + Orgtbl mode::), but instead--after filling in the message + headers--turn on Orgtbl mode manually when needed in the messages + body. + +`filladapt.el' by Kyle Jones + Org mode tries to do the right thing when filling paragraphs, list + items and other elements. Many users reported problems using both + `filladapt.el' and Org mode, so a safe thing to do is to disable + filladapt like this: + + (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-off-filladapt-mode) + +`yasnippet.el' + The way Org mode binds the <TAB> key (binding to `[tab]' instead of + `"\t"') overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following + code fixed this problem: + + (add-hook 'org-mode-hook + (lambda () + (setq-local yas/trigger-key [tab]) + (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-or-maybe-expand))) + + The latest version of yasnippet doesn't play well with Org mode. + If the above code does not fix the conflict, first define the + following function: + + (defun yas/org-very-safe-expand () + (let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand))) + + Then tell Org mode to use that function: + + (add-hook 'org-mode-hook + (lambda () + (make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key) + (setq yas/trigger-key [tab]) + (add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand) + (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field))) + +`windmove.el' by Hovav Shacham + This package also uses the `S-<cursor>' keys, so everything written + in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you + want make the windmove function active in locations where Org mode + does not have special functionality on `S-<cursor>', add this to + your configuration: + + ;; Make windmove work in org-mode: + (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up) + (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left) + (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down) + (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right) + +`viper.el' by Michael Kifer + Viper uses `C-c /' and therefore makes this key not access the + corresponding Org mode command `org-sparse-tree'. You need to find + another key for this command, or override the key in + `viper-vi-global-user-map' with + + (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree) + + + +File: org, Node: org-crypt, Prev: Interaction, Up: Miscellaneous + +15.11 org-crypt.el +================== + +Org crypt encrypts the text of an Org entry, but not the headline, or +properties. Org crypt uses the Emacs EasyPG library to encrypt and +decrypt. + + Any text below a headline that has a `:crypt:' tag will be +automatically be encrypted when the file is saved. To use a different +tag, customize the `org-crypt-tag-matcher' variable. + + Suggested Org crypt settings in Emacs init file: + + (require 'org-crypt) + (org-crypt-use-before-save-magic) + (setq org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance (quote ("crypt"))) + + (setq org-crypt-key nil) + ;; GPG key to use for encryption + ;; Either the Key ID or set to nil to use symmetric encryption. + + (setq auto-save-default nil) + ;; Auto-saving does not cooperate with org-crypt.el: so you need + ;; to turn it off if you plan to use org-crypt.el quite often. + ;; Otherwise, you'll get an (annoying) message each time you + ;; start Org. + + ;; To turn it off only locally, you can insert this: + ;; + ;; # -*- buffer-auto-save-file-name: nil; -*- + + Excluding the crypt tag from inheritance prevents encrypting +previously encrypted text. + + +File: org, Node: Hacking, Next: MobileOrg, Prev: Miscellaneous, Up: Top + +Appendix A Hacking +****************** + +This appendix covers some areas where users can extend the +functionality of Org. + +* Menu: + +* Hooks:: How to reach into Org's internals +* Add-on packages:: Available extensions +* Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types +* Adding export back-ends:: How to write new export back-ends +* Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands +* Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for LaTeX and other programs +* Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks +* Special agenda views:: Customized views +* Speeding up your agendas:: Tips on how to speed up your agendas +* Extracting agenda information:: Post-processing of agenda information +* Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties +* Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries + + +File: org, Node: Hooks, Next: Add-on packages, Up: Hacking + +A.1 Hooks +========= + +Org has a large number of hook variables for adding functionality. This +appendix illustrates using a few. A complete list of hooks with +documentation is maintained by the Worg project at +`http://orgmode.org/worg/doc.html#hooks'. + + +File: org, Node: Add-on packages, Next: Adding hyperlink types, Prev: Hooks, Up: Hacking + +A.2 Add-on packages +=================== + +Various authors wrote a large number of add-on packages for Org. + + These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as +contributed packages with the separate release available at +`http://orgmode.org'. See the `contrib/README' file in the source code +directory for a list of contributed files. Worg page with more +information is at: `http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/'. + + +File: org, Node: Adding hyperlink types, Next: Adding export back-ends, Prev: Add-on packages, Up: Hacking + +A.3 Adding hyperlink types +========================== + +Org has many built-in hyperlink types (*note Hyperlinks::), and an +interface for adding new link types. The example file, `org-man.el', +shows the process of adding Org links to Unix man pages, which look +like this: `[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]': + + ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org + + (require 'org) + + (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open) + (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link) + + (defcustom org-man-command 'man + "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page." + :group 'org-link + :type '(choice (const man) (const woman))) + + (defun org-man-open (path) + "Visit the manpage on PATH. + PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command." + (funcall org-man-command path)) + + (defun org-man-store-link () + "Store a link to a manpage." + (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode)) + ;; This is a man page, we do make this link + (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name)) + (link (concat "man:" page)) + (description (format "Manpage for %s" page))) + (org-store-link-props + :type "man" + :link link + :description description)))) + + (defun org-man-get-page-name () + "Extract the page name from the buffer name." + ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'. + (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name)) + (match-string 1 (buffer-name)) + (error "Cannot create link to this man page"))) + + (provide 'org-man) + + ;;; org-man.el ends here + +To activate links to man pages in Org, enter this in the init file: + + (require 'org-man) + +A review of `org-man.el': + 1. First, `(require 'org)' ensures `org.el' is loaded. + + 2. The `org-add-link-type' defines a new link type with `man' prefix. + The call contains the function to call that follows the link type. + + 3. The next line adds a function to `org-store-link-functions' that + records a useful link with the command `C-c l' in a buffer + displaying a man page. + + The rest of the file defines necessary variables and functions. +First is the customization variable `org-man-command'. It has two +options, `man' and `woman'. Next is a function whose argument is the +link path, which for man pages is the topic of the man command. To +follow the link, the function calls the `org-man-command' to display +the man page. + + `C-c l' constructs and stores the link. + + `C-c l' calls the function `org-man-store-link', which first checks +if the `major-mode' is appropriate. If check fails, the function +returns `nil'. Otherwise the function makes a link string by combining +the `man:' prefix with the man topic. The function then calls +`org-store-link-props' with `:type' and `:link' properties. A +`:description' property is an optional string that is displayed when the +function inserts the link in the Org buffer. + + `C-c C-l' inserts the stored link. + + To define new link types, define a function that implements +completion support with `C-c C-l'. This function should not accept any +arguments but return the appropriate prefix and complete link string. + + +File: org, Node: Adding export back-ends, Next: Context-sensitive commands, Prev: Adding hyperlink types, Up: Hacking + +A.4 Adding export back-ends +=========================== + +Org's export engine makes it easy for writing new back-ends. The +framework on which the engine was built makes it easy to derive new +back-ends from existing ones. + + The two main entry points to the export engine are: +`org-export-define-backend' and `org-export-define-derived-backend'. +To grok these functions, see `ox-latex.el' for an example of defining a +new back-end from scratch, and `ox-beamer.el' for an example of +deriving from an existing engine. + + For creating a new back-end from scratch, first set its name as a +symbol in an alist consisting of elements and export functions. To +make the back-end visible to the export dispatcher, set `:menu-entry' +keyword. For export options specific to this back-end, set the +`:options-alist'. + + For creating a new back-end from an existing one, set +`:translate-alist' to an alist of export functions. This alist +replaces the parent back-end functions. + + For complete documentation, see the Org Export Reference on Worg +(http://orgmode.org/worg/dev/org-export-reference.html). + + +File: org, Node: Context-sensitive commands, Next: Tables in arbitrary syntax, Prev: Adding export back-ends, Up: Hacking + +A.5 Context-sensitive commands +============================== + +Org has facilities for building context sensitive commands. Authors of +Org add-ons can tap into this functionality. + + Some Org commands change depending on the context. The most +important example of this behavior is the `C-c C-c' (*note The very +busy C-c C-c key::). Other examples are `M-cursor' and `M-S-cursor'. + + These context sensitive commands work by providing a function that +detects special context for that add-on and executes functionality +appropriate for that context. + + +File: org, Node: Tables in arbitrary syntax, Next: Dynamic blocks, Prev: Context-sensitive commands, Up: Hacking + +A.6 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax +======================================== + +Because of Org's success in handling tables with Orgtbl, a frequently +asked feature is to Org's usability functions to other table formats +native to other modem's, such as LaTeX. This would be hard to do in a +general way without complicated customization nightmares. Moreover, +that would take Org away from its simplicity roots that Orgtbl has +proven. There is, however, an alternate approach to accomplishing the +same. + + This approach involves implementing a custom _translate_ function +that operates on a native Org _source table_ to produce a table in +another format. This strategy would keep the excellently working +Orgtbl simple and isolate complications, if any, confined to the +translate function. To add more alien table formats, we just add more +translate functions. Also the burden of developing custom translate +functions for new table formats will be in the hands of those who know +those formats best. + + For an example of how this strategy works, see Orgstruct mode. In +that mode, Bastien added the ability to use Org's facilities to edit +and re-structure lists. He did by turning `orgstruct-mode' on, and +then exporting the list locally to another format, such as HTML, LaTeX +or Texinfo. + +* Menu: + +* Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables +* A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial +* Translator functions:: Copy and modify +* Radio lists:: Sending and receiving lists + + +File: org, Node: Radio tables, Next: A LaTeX example, Up: Tables in arbitrary syntax + +A.6.1 Radio tables +------------------ + +Radio tables are target locations for translated tables that are not +near their source. Org finds the target location and inserts the +translated table. + + The key to finding the target location are the magic words `BEGIN/END +RECEIVE ORGTBL'. They have to appear as comments in the current mode. +If the mode is C, then: + + /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */ + /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */ + +At the location of source, Org needs a special line to direct Orgtbl to +translate and to find the target for inserting the translated table. +For example: + #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments... + +`table_name' is the table's reference name, which is also used in the +receiver lines, and the `translation_function' is the Lisp function that +translates. This line, in addition, may also contain alternating key +and value arguments at the end. The translation function gets these +values as a property list. A few standard parameters are already +recognized and acted upon before the translation function is called: + +`:skip N' + Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count; include + them if they are to be skipped. + +`:skipcols (n1 n2 ...)' + List of columns to be skipped. First Org automatically discards + columns with calculation marks and then sends the table to the + translator function, which then skips columns as specified in + `skipcols'. + +To keep the source table intact in the buffer without being disturbed +when the source file is compiled or otherwise being worked on, use one +of these strategies: + + * Place the table in a block comment. For example, in C mode you + could wrap the table between `/*' and `*/' lines. + + * Put the table after an `END' statement. For example `\bye' in TeX + and `\end{document}' in LaTeX. + + * Comment and uncomment each line of the table during edits. The + `M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment RET' command makes toggling easy. + + +File: org, Node: A LaTeX example, Next: Translator functions, Prev: Radio tables, Up: Tables in arbitrary syntax + +A.6.2 A LaTeX example of radio tables +------------------------------------- + +To wrap a source table in LaTeX, use the `comment' environment provided +by `comment.sty'. To activate it, put `\usepackage{comment}' in the +document header. Orgtbl mode inserts a radio table skeleton(1) with +the command `M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table RET', which prompts for a +table name. For example, if `salesfigures' is the name, the template +inserts: + + % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures + % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures + \begin{comment} + #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex + | | | + \end{comment} + +The line `#+ORGTBL: SEND' tells Orgtbl mode to use the function +`orgtbl-to-latex' to convert the table to LaTeX format, then insert the +table at the target (receive) location named `salesfigures'. Now the +table is ready for data entry. It can even use spreadsheet features(2): + + % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures + % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures + \begin{comment} + #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex + | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day | + |-------+------+---------+---------| + | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 | + | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 | + | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 | + #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f + % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote) + \end{comment} + +After editing, `C-c C-c' inserts translated table at the target +location, between the two marker lines. + + For hand-made custom tables, note that the translator needs to skip +the first two lines of the source table. Also the command has to +_splice_ out the target table without the header and footer. + + \begin{tabular}{lrrr} + Month & \multicolumn{1}{c}{Days} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\ + % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures + % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures + \end{tabular} + % + \begin{comment} + #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2 + | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day | + |-------+------+---------+---------| + | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 | + | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 | + | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 | + #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f + \end{comment} + + The LaTeX translator function `orgtbl-to-latex' is already part of +Orgtbl mode and uses `tabular' environment by default to typeset the +table and mark the horizontal lines with `\hline'. For additional +parameters to control output, *note Translator functions::: + +`:splice nil/t' + When non-`nil', returns only table body lines; not wrapped in + tabular environment. Default is `nil'. + +`:fmt fmt' + Format to warp each field. It should contain `%s' for the original + field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollar + symbol, you could use `:fmt "$%s$"'. Format can also wrap a + property list with column numbers and formats, for example `:fmt + (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")'. In place of a string, a function of one + argument can be used; the function must return a formatted string. + +`:efmt efmt' + Format numbers as exponentials. The spec should have `%s' twice + for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example + `"%s\\times10^{%s}"'. This may also be a property list with + column numbers and formats, for example `:efmt (2 + "$%s\\times10^{%s}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^{%s}$")'. After `efmt' has + been applied to a value, `fmt' will also be applied. Functions + with two arguments can be supplied instead of strings. By default, + no special formatting is applied. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) By default this works only for LaTeX, HTML, and Texinfo. +Configure the variable `orgtbl-radio-table-templates' to install +templates for other export formats. + + (2) If the `#+TBLFM' line contains an odd number of dollar +characters, this may cause problems with font-lock in LaTeX mode. As +shown in the example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the +`comment' environment that is used to balance the dollar expressions. +If you are using AUCTeX with the font-latex library, a much better +solution is to add the `comment' environment to the variable +`LaTeX-verbatim-environments'. + + +File: org, Node: Translator functions, Next: Radio lists, Prev: A LaTeX example, Up: Tables in arbitrary syntax + +A.6.3 Translator functions +-------------------------- + +Orgtbl mode has built-in translator functions: `orgtbl-to-csv' +(comma-separated values), `orgtbl-to-tsv' (TAB-separated values), +`orgtbl-to-latex', `orgtbl-to-html', `orgtbl-to-texinfo', +`orgtbl-to-unicode' and `orgtbl-to-orgtbl'. They use the generic +translator, `orgtbl-to-generic', which delegates translations to various +export back-ends. + + Properties passed to the function through the `ORGTBL SEND' line take +precedence over properties defined inside the function. For example, +this overrides the default LaTeX line endings, `\\', with `\\[2mm]': + + #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]" + + For a new language translator, define a converter function. It can +be a generic function, such as shown in this example. It marks a +beginning and ending of a table with `!BTBL!' and `!ETBL!'; a beginning +and ending of lines with `!BL!' and `!EL!'; and uses a TAB for a field +separator: + + (defun orgtbl-to-language (table params) + "Convert the orgtbl-mode TABLE to language." + (orgtbl-to-generic + table + (org-combine-plists + '(:tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!" :lstart "!BL!" :lend "!EL!" :sep "\t") + params))) + +The documentation for the `orgtbl-to-generic' function shows a complete +list of parameters, each of which can be passed through to +`orgtbl-to-latex', `orgtbl-to-texinfo', and any other function using +that generic function. + + For complicated translations the generic translator function could be +replaced by a custom translator function. Such a custom function must +take two arguments and return a single string containing the formatted +table. The first argument is the table whose lines are a list of +fields or the symbol `hline'. The second argument is the property list +consisting of parameters specified in the `#+ORGTBL: SEND' line. +Please share your translator functions by posting them to the Org users +mailing list, <emacs-orgmode@gnu.org>. + + +File: org, Node: Radio lists, Prev: Translator functions, Up: Tables in arbitrary syntax + +A.6.4 Radio lists +----------------- + +Call the `org-list-insert-radio-list' function to insert a radio list +template in HTML, LaTeX, and Texinfo mode documents. Sending and +receiving radio lists works is the same as for radio tables (*note +Radio tables::) except for these differences: + + - Orgstruct mode must be active. + + - Use `ORGLST' keyword instead of `ORGTBL'. + + - `C-c C-c' works only on the first list item. + + Built-in translators functions are: `org-list-to-latex', +`org-list-to-html' and `org-list-to-texinfo'. They use the +`org-list-to-generic' translator function. See its documentation for +parameters for accurate customizations of lists. Here is a LaTeX +example: + + % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy + % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy + \begin{comment} + #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex + - a new house + - a new computer + + a new keyboard + + a new mouse + - a new life + \end{comment} + + `C-c C-c' on `a new house' inserts the translated LaTeX list +in-between the BEGIN and END marker lines. + + +File: org, Node: Dynamic blocks, Next: Special agenda views, Prev: Tables in arbitrary syntax, Up: Hacking + +A.7 Dynamic blocks +================== + +Org supports _dynamic blocks_ in Org documents. They are inserted with +begin and end markers like any other `src' code block, but the contents +are updated automatically by a user function. For example, `C-c C-x +C-r' inserts a dynamic table that updates the work time (*note Clocking +work time::). + + Dynamic blocks can have names and function parameters. The syntax +is similar to `src' code block specifications: + + #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ... + + #+END: + + These command update dynamic blocks: + +`C-c C-x C-u (`org-dblock-update')' + Update dynamic block at point. + +`C-u C-c C-x C-u' + Update all dynamic blocks in the current file. + + Before updating a dynamic block, Org removes content between the +BEGIN and END markers. Org then reads the parameters on the BEGIN line +for passing to the writer function. If the function expects to access +the removed content, then Org expects an extra parameter, `:content', +on the BEGIN line. + + To syntax for calling a writer function with a named block, `myblock' +is: `org-dblock-write:myblock'. Parameters come from the BEGIN line. + + The following is an example of a dynamic block and a block writer +function that updates the time when the function was last run: + + #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M" + + #+END: + +The dynamic block's writer function: + + (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params) + (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y"))) + (insert "Last block update at: " + (format-time-string fmt)))) + + To keep dynamic blocks up-to-date in an Org file, use the function, +`org-update-all-dblocks' in hook, such as `before-save-hook'. The +`org-update-all-dblocks' function does not run if the file is not in +Org mode. + + Dynamic blocks, like any other block, can be narrowed with +`org-narrow-to-block'. + + +File: org, Node: Special agenda views, Next: Speeding up your agendas, Prev: Dynamic blocks, Up: Hacking + +A.8 Special agenda views +======================== + +Org provides a special hook to further limit items in agenda views: +`agenda', `agenda*'(1), `todo', `alltodo', `tags', `tags-todo', +`tags-tree'. Specify a custom function that tests inclusion of every +matched item in the view. This function can also skip as much as is +needed. + + For a global condition applicable to agenda views, use the +`org-agenda-skip-function-global' variable. Org uses a global condition +with `org-agenda-skip-function' for custom searching. + + This example defines a function for a custom view showing TODO items +with WAITING status. Manually this is a multi step search process, but +with a custom view, this can be automated as follows: + + The custom function searches the subtree for the WAITING tag and +returns `nil' on match. Otherwise it gives the location from where the +search continues. + + (defun my-skip-unless-waiting () + "Skip trees that are not waiting" + (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t)))) + (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t) + nil ; tag found, do not skip + subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree + + To use this custom function in a custom agenda command: + + (org-add-agenda-custom-command + '("b" todo "PROJECT" + ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting) + (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: ")))) + + Note that this also binds `org-agenda-overriding-header' to a more +meaningful string suitable for the agenda view. + + Search for entries with a limit set on levels for the custom search. +This is a general approach to creating custom searches in Org. To +include all levels, use `LEVEL>0'(2). Then to selectively pick the +matched entries, use `org-agenda-skip-function', which also accepts Lisp +forms, such as `org-agenda-skip-entry-if' and +`org-agenda-skip-subtree-if'. For example: + +`(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)' + Skip current entry if it has been scheduled. + +`(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)' + Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled. + +`(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)' + Skip current entry if it has a deadline. + +`(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)' + Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled. + +`(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))' + Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING. + +`(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)' + Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state. + +`(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)' + Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline + or scheduled. + +`(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'regexp "regular expression")' + Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry. + +`(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notregexp "regular expression")' + Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches. + +`(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")' + Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree. + + The following is an example of a search for `WAITING' without the +special function: + + (org-add-agenda-custom-command + '("b" todo "PROJECT" + ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if + 'regexp ":waiting:")) + (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: ")))) + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) The `agenda*' view is the same as `agenda' except that it only +considers _appointments_, i.e., scheduled and deadline items that have +a time specification `[h]h:mm' in their time-stamps. + + (2) Note that, for `org-odd-levels-only', a level number corresponds +to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of stars. + + +File: org, Node: Speeding up your agendas, Next: Extracting agenda information, Prev: Special agenda views, Up: Hacking + +A.9 Speeding up your agendas +============================ + +Some agenda commands slow down when the Org files grow in size or +number. Here are tips to speed up: + + 1. Reduce the number of Org agenda files to avoid slowdowns due to + hard drive accesses. + + 2. Reduce the number of `DONE' and archived headlines so agenda + operations that skip over these can finish faster. + + 3. Do not dim blocked tasks: + (setq org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks nil) + + 4. Stop preparing agenda buffers on startup: + (setq org-agenda-inhibit-startup nil) + + 5. Disable tag inheritance for agendas: + (setq org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance nil) + + These options can be applied to selected agenda views. For more +details about generation of agenda views, see the docstrings for the +relevant variables, and this dedicated Worg page +(http://orgmode.org/worg/agenda-optimization.html) for agenda +optimization. + + +File: org, Node: Extracting agenda information, Next: Using the property API, Prev: Speeding up your agendas, Up: Hacking + +A.10 Extracting agenda information +================================== + +Org provides commands to access agendas through Emacs batch mode. +Through this command-line interface, agendas are automated for further +processing or printing. + + `org-batch-agenda' creates an agenda view in ASCII and outputs to +STDOUT. This command takes one string parameter. When string +length=1, Org uses it as a key to `org-agenda-custom-commands'. These +are the same ones available through `C-c a'. + + This example command line directly prints the TODO list to the +printer: + + emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr + + When the string parameter length is two or more characters, Org +matches it with tags/TODO strings. For example, this example command +line prints items tagged with `shop', but excludes items tagged with +`NewYork': + + emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \ + -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr + +An example showing on-the-fly parameter modifications: + + emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \ + -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \ + org-agenda-span (quote month) \ + org-agenda-include-diary nil \ + org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \ + | lpr + +which will produce an agenda for the next 30 days from just the +`~/org/projects.org' file. + + For structured processing of agenda output, use +`org-batch-agenda-csv' with the following fields: + + category The category of the item + head The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY + type The type of the agenda entry, can be + todo selected in TODO match + tagsmatch selected in tags match + diary imported from diary + deadline a deadline + scheduled scheduled + timestamp appointment, selected by timestamp + closed entry was closed on date + upcoming-deadline warning about nearing deadline + past-scheduled forwarded scheduled item + block entry has date block including date + todo The TODO keyword, if any + tags All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons + date The relevant date, like 2007-2-14 + time The time, like 15:00-16:50 + extra String with extra planning info + priority-l The priority letter if any was given + priority-n The computed numerical priority + +If the selection of the agenda item was based on a timestamp, including +those items with `DEADLINE' and `SCHEDULED' keywords, then Org includes +date and time in the output. + + If the selection of the agenda item was based on a timestamp (or +deadline/scheduled), then Org includes date and time in the output. + + Here is an example of a post-processing script in Perl. It takes +the CSV output from Emacs and prints with a checkbox: + + #!/usr/bin/perl + + # define the Emacs command to run + $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'"; + + # run it and capture the output + $agenda = qx{$cmd 2>/dev/null}; + + # loop over all lines + foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) { + # get the individual values + ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra, + $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line); + # process and print + print "[ ] $head\n"; + } + + +File: org, Node: Using the property API, Next: Using the mapping API, Prev: Extracting agenda information, Up: Hacking + +A.11 Using the property API +=========================== + +Functions for working with properties. + + -- Function: org-entry-properties &optional pom which + Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM. + This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for + deadline, scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties + defined in the entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may + occur multiple times if the property key was used several times. + POM may also be `nil', in which case the current entry is used. + If WHICH is `nil' or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is + `special' or `standard', only get that subclass. + + -- Function: org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit + Get value of `PROPERTY' for entry at point-or-marker `POM'. By + default, this only looks at properties defined locally in the + entry. If `INHERIT' is non-`nil' and the entry does not have the + property, then also check higher levels of the hierarchy. If + `INHERIT' is the symbol `selective', use inheritance if and only + if the setting of `org-use-property-inheritance' selects + `PROPERTY' for inheritance. + + -- Function: org-entry-delete pom property + Delete the property `PROPERTY' from entry at point-or-marker POM. + + -- Function: org-entry-put pom property value + Set `PROPERTY' to `VALUE' for entry at point-or-marker POM. + + -- Function: org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials + Get all property keys in the current buffer. + + -- Function: org-insert-property-drawer + Insert a property drawer for the current entry. + + -- Function: org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest + values + Set `PROPERTY' at point-or-marker `POM' to `VALUES'. `VALUES' + should be a list of strings. They will be concatenated, with + spaces as separators. + + -- Function: org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property + Treat the value of the property `PROPERTY' as a + whitespace-separated list of values and return the values as a + list of strings. + + -- Function: org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value + Treat the value of the property `PROPERTY' as a + whitespace-separated list of values and make sure that `VALUE' is + in this list. + + -- Function: org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property + value + Treat the value of the property `PROPERTY' as a + whitespace-separated list of values and make sure that `VALUE' is + _not_ in this list. + + -- Function: org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property + value + Treat the value of the property `PROPERTY' as a + whitespace-separated list of values and check if `VALUE' is in + this list. + + -- User Option: org-property-allowed-value-functions + Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific + property. The functions must take a single argument, the name of + the property, and return a flat list of allowed values. If `:ETC' + is one of the values, use the values as completion help, but allow + also other values to be entered. The functions must return `nil' + if they are not responsible for this property. + + +File: org, Node: Using the mapping API, Prev: Using the property API, Up: Hacking + +A.12 Using the mapping API +========================== + +Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities for finding entries. Org +uses this functionality internally for generating agenda views. Org +also exposes an API for executing arbitrary functions for each selected +entry. The API's main entry point is: + + -- Function: org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip + Call `FUNC' at each headline selected by `MATCH' in `SCOPE'. + + `FUNC' is a function or a Lisp form. With the cursor positioned + at the beginning of the headline, call the function without + arguments. Org returns an alist of return values of calls to the + function. + + To avoid preserving point, Org wraps the call to `FUNC' in + save-excursion form. After evaluation, Org moves the cursor to + the end of the line that was just processed. Search continues + from that point forward. This may not always work as expected + under some conditions, such as if the current sub-tree was removed + by a previous archiving operation. In such rare circumstances, + Org skips the next entry entirely when it should not. To stop Org + from such skips, make `FUNC' set the variable + `org-map-continue-from' to a specific buffer position. + + `MATCH' is a tags/property/TODO match. Org iterates only matched + headlines. Org iterates over all headlines when `MATCH' is `nil' + or `t'. + + `SCOPE' determines the scope of this command. It can be any of: + + nil the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any + tree the subtree started with the entry at point + region The entries within the active region, if any + file the current buffer, without restriction + file-with-archives + the current buffer, and any archives associated with it + agenda all agenda files + agenda-with-archives + all agenda files with any archive files associated with them + (file1 file2 ...) + if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned + The remaining args are treated as settings for the scanner's + skipping facilities. Valid args are: + + archive skip trees with the archive tag + comment skip trees with the COMMENT keyword + function or Lisp form + will be used as value for `org-agenda-skip-function', + so whenever the function returns t, FUNC + will not be called for that entry and search will + continue from the point where the function leaves it + + The mapping routine can call any arbitrary function, even functions +that change meta data or query the property API (*note Using the +property API::). Here are some handy functions: + + -- Function: org-todo &optional arg + Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the + functions for the many possible values for the argument `ARG'. + + -- Function: org-priority &optional action + Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this + function for the possible values for `ACTION'. + + -- Function: org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff + Toggle the tag `TAG' in the current entry. Setting `ONOFF' to + either `on' or `off' will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is + either on or off. + + -- Function: org-promote + Promote the current entry. + + -- Function: org-demote + Demote the current entry. + + This example turns all entries tagged with `TOMORROW' into TODO +entries with keyword `UPCOMING'. Org ignores entries in comment trees +and archive trees. + + (org-map-entries + '(org-todo "UPCOMING") + "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment) + + The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword +`WAITING', in all agenda files. + + (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda)) + + +File: org, Node: MobileOrg, Next: History and acknowledgments, Prev: Hacking, Up: Top + +Appendix B MobileOrg +******************** + +MobileOrg is a companion mobile app that runs on iOS and Android +devices. MobileOrg enables offline-views and capture support for an +Org mode system that is rooted on a "real" computer. MobileOrg can +record changes to existing entries. + + The iOS implementation (https://github.com/MobileOrg/) for the +_iPhone/iPod Touch/iPad_ series of devices, was started by Richard +Moreland and is now in the hands Sean Escriva. Android users should +check out MobileOrg Android +(http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/) by Matt Jones. +Though the two implementations are not identical, they offer similar +features. + + This appendix describes Org's support for agenda view formats +compatible with MobileOrg. It also describes synchronizing changes, +such as to notes, between MobileOrg and the computer. + + To change tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, first customize the +variables `org-todo-keywords' and `org-tag-alist'. These should cover +all the important tags and TODO keywords, even if Org files use only +some of them. Though MobileOrg has in-buffer settings, it understands +TODO states _sets_ (*note Per-file keywords::) and _mutually exclusive_ +tags (*note Setting tags::) only for those set in these variables. + +* Menu: + +* Setting up the staging area:: For the mobile device +* Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas +* Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items + + +File: org, Node: Setting up the staging area, Next: Pushing to MobileOrg, Up: MobileOrg + +B.1 Setting up the staging area +=============================== + +MobileOrg needs access to a file directory on a server to interact with +Emacs. With a public server, consider encrypting the files. MobileOrg +version 1.5 supports encryption for the iPhone. Org also requires +`openssl' installed on the local computer. To turn on encryption, set +the same password in MobileOrg and in Emacs. Set the password in the +variable `org-mobile-use-encryption'(1). Note that even after +MobileOrg encrypts the file contents, the file names will remain +visible on the file systems of the local computer, the server, and the +mobile device. + + For a server to host files, consider options like Dropbox.com +(http://dropbox.com) account(2). On first connection, MobileOrg +creates a directory `MobileOrg/' on Dropbox. Pass its location to +Emacs through an init file variable as follows: + + (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg") + + Org copies files to the above directory for MobileOrg. Org also +uses the same directory for sharing notes between Org and MobileOrg. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) If Emacs is configured for safe storing of passwords, then +configure the variable, `org-mobile-encryption-password'; please read +the docstring of that variable. + + (2) An alternative is to use webdav server. MobileOrg documentation +has details of webdav server configuration. Additional help is at FAQ +entry (http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav). + + +File: org, Node: Pushing to MobileOrg, Next: Pulling from MobileOrg, Prev: Setting up the staging area, Up: MobileOrg + +B.2 Pushing to MobileOrg +======================== + +Org pushes files listed in `org-mobile-files' to +`org-mobile-directory'. Files include agenda files (as listed in +`org-agenda-files'). Customize `org-mobile-files' to add other files. +File names will be staged with paths relative to `org-directory', so +all files should be inside this directory(1). + + Push creates a special Org file `agendas.org' with custom agenda +views defined by the user(2). + + Org writes the file `index.org', containing links to other files. +MobileOrg reads this file first from the server to determine what other +files to download for agendas. For faster downloads, MobileOrg will +read only those files whose checksums(3) have changed. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) Symbolic links in `org-directory' should have the same name as +their targets. + + (2) While creating the agendas, Org mode will force ID properties on +all referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely +identified if MobileOrg flags them for further action. To avoid +setting properties configure the variable +`org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items' to `nil'. Org mode will then +rely on outline paths, assuming they are unique. + + (3) Checksums are stored automatically in the file `checksums.dat'. + + +File: org, Node: Pulling from MobileOrg, Prev: Pushing to MobileOrg, Up: MobileOrg + +B.3 Pulling from MobileOrg +========================== + +When MobileOrg synchronizes with the server, it pulls the Org files for +viewing. It then appends to the file `mobileorg.org' on the server the +captured entries, pointers to flagged and changed entries. Org +integrates its data in an inbox file format. + + 1. Org moves all entries found in `mobileorg.org'(1) and appends them + to the file pointed to by the variable + `org-mobile-inbox-for-pull'. Each captured entry and each editing + event is a top-level entry in the inbox file. + + 2. After moving the entries, Org attempts changes to MobileOrg. Some + changes are applied directly and without user interaction. + Examples include changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body + text. Entries for further action are tagged as `:FLAGGED:'. Org + marks entries with problems with an error message in the inbox. + They have to be resolved manually. + + 3. Org generates an agenda view for flagged entries for user + intervention to clean up. For notes stored in flagged entries, + MobileOrg displays them in the echo area when the cursor is on the + corresponding agenda item. + + `?' + Pressing `?' displays the entire flagged note in another + window. Org also pushes it to the kill ring. To store + flagged note as a normal note, use `? z C-y C-c C-c'. + Pressing `?' twice does these things: first it removes the + `:FLAGGED:' tag; second, it removes the flagged note from the + property drawer; third, it signals that manual editing of the + flagged entry is now finished. + + `C-c a ?' returns to the agenda view to finish processing flagged +entries. Note that these entries may not be the most recent since +MobileOrg searches files that were last pulled. To get an updated +agenda view with changes since the last pull, pull again. + + ---------- Footnotes ---------- + + (1) `mobileorg.org' will be empty after this operation. + + +File: org, Node: History and acknowledgments, Next: GNU Free Documentation License, Prev: MobileOrg, Up: Top + +Appendix C History and acknowledgments +************************************** + +C.1 From Carsten +================ + +Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the +Emacs Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, +and using Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to +remember eleven different commands with two or three keys per command, +only to hide and show parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely +unacceptable. Also, when using outlines to take notes, I constantly +wanted to restructure the tree, organizing it paralleling my thoughts +and plans. _Visibility cycling_ and _structure editing_ were +originally implemented in the package `outline-magic.el', but quickly +moved to the more general `org.el'. As this environment became +comfortable for project planning, the next step was adding _TODO +entries_, basic _timestamps_, and _table support_. These areas +highlighted the two main goals that Org still has today: to be a new, +outline-based, plain text mode with innovative and intuitive editing +features, and to incorporate project planning functionality directly +into a notes file. + + Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to +<emacs-orgmode@gnu.org> have provided a constant stream of bug reports, +feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code. Many +thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am trying +to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence in +shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be complete, if I +have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and let me know. + + Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order: + +Bastien Guerry + Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of + them integrated into the core by now), including the LaTeX + exporter and the plain list parser. His support during the early + days was central to the success of this project. Bastien also + invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and + sponsored hosting costs for the orgmode.org website. Bastien + stepped in as maintainer of Org between 2011 and 2013, at a time + when I desperately needed a break. + +Eric Schulte and Dan Davison + Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, + which turns Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating + code and doing literate programming and reproducible research. + This has become one of Org's killer features that define what Org + is today. + +John Wiegley + John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly + to Org, including the attachment system (`org-attach.el'), + integration with Apple Mail (`org-mac-message.el'), hierarchical + dependencies of TODO items, habit tracking (`org-habits.el'), and + encryption (`org-crypt.el'). Also, the capture system is really + an extended copy of his great `remember.el'. + +Sebastian Rose + Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the + pitiful work of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this + part of Org onto a much higher level. He also wrote + `org-info.js', a Java script for displaying web pages derived from + Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with single-key + navigation. + +See below for the full list of contributions! Again, please let me +know what I am missing here! + +C.2 From Bastien +================ + +I (Bastien) have been maintaining Org between 2011 and 2013. This +appendix would not be complete without adding a few more +acknowledgments and thanks. + + I am first grateful to Carsten for his trust while handing me over +the maintainership of Org. His unremitting support is what really +helped me getting more confident over time, with both the community and +the code. + + When I took over maintainership, I knew I would have to make Org more +collaborative than ever, as I would have to rely on people that are more +knowledgeable than I am on many parts of the code. Here is a list of +the persons I could rely on, they should really be considered +co-maintainers, either of the code or the community: + +Eric Schulte + Eric is maintaining the Babel parts of Org. His reactivity here + kept me away from worrying about possible bugs here and let me + focus on other parts. + +Nicolas Goaziou + Nicolas is maintaining the consistency of the deepest parts of + Org. His work on `org-element.el' and `ox.el' has been + outstanding, and it opened the doors for many new ideas and + features. He rewrote many of the old exporters to use the new + export engine, and helped with documenting this major change. + More importantly (if that's possible), he has been more than + reliable during all the work done for Org 8.0, and always very + reactive on the mailing list. + +Achim Gratz + Achim rewrote the building process of Org, turning some _ad hoc_ + tools into a flexible and conceptually clean process. He + patiently coped with the many hiccups that such a change can + create for users. + +Nick Dokos + The Org mode mailing list would not be such a nice place without + Nick, who patiently helped users so many times. It is impossible + to overestimate such a great help, and the list would not be so + active without him. + + I received support from so many users that it is clearly impossible +to be fair when shortlisting a few of them, but Org's history would not +be complete if the ones above were not mentioned in this manual. + +C.3 List of contributions +========================= + + * Russel Adams came up with the idea for drawers. + + * Suvayu Ali has steadily helped on the mailing list, providing + useful feedback on many features and several patches. + + * Luis Anaya wrote `ox-man.el'. + + * Thomas Baumann wrote `org-bbdb.el' and `org-mhe.el'. + + * Michael Brand helped by reporting many bugs and testing many + features. He also implemented the distinction between empty + fields and 0-value fields in Org's spreadsheets. + + * Christophe Bataillon created the great unicorn logo that we use on + the Org mode website. + + * Alex Bochannek provided a patch for rounding timestamps. + + * Jan Böcker wrote `org-docview.el'. + + * Brad Bozarth showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org mode files. + + * Tom Breton wrote `org-choose.el'. + + * Charles Cave's suggestion sparked the implementation of templates + for Remember, which are now templates for capture. + + * Pavel Chalmoviansky influenced the agenda treatment of items with + specified time. + + * Gregory Chernov patched support for Lisp forms into table + calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by + porting `nouline.el' to XEmacs. + + * Sacha Chua suggested copying some linking code from Planner, and + helped make Org popular through her blog. + + * Toby S. Cubitt contributed to the code for clock formats. + + * Baoqiu Cui contributed the first DocBook exporter. In Org 8.0, we + go a different route: you can now export to Texinfo and export the + `.texi' file to DocBook using `makeinfo'. + + * Eddward DeVilla proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also + came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an + API for them. + + * Nick Dokos tracked down several nasty bugs. + + * Kees Dullemond used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so + inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He + also asked for a way to narrow wide table columns. + + * Jason Dunsmore has been maintaining the Org-Mode server at + Rackspace for several years now. He also sponsored the hosting + costs until Rackspace started to host us for free. + + * Thomas S. Dye contributed documentation on Worg and helped + integrating the Org-Babel documentation into the manual. + + * Christian Egli converted the documentation into Texinfo format, + inspired the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML + exporter, and wrote `org-taskjuggler.el', which has been rewritten + by Nicolas Goaziou as `ox-taskjuggler.el' for Org 8.0. + + * David Emery provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported + HTML agendas. + + * Sean Escriva took over MobileOrg development on the iPhone + platform. + + * Nic Ferrier contributed mailcap and XOXO support. + + * Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva implemented hierarchical checkboxes. + + * John Foerch figured out how to make incremental search show context + around a match in a hidden outline tree. + + * Raimar Finken wrote `org-git-line.el'. + + * Mikael Fornius works as a mailing list moderator. + + * Austin Frank works as a mailing list moderator. + + * Eric Fraga drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and + testing. + + * Barry Gidden did proofreading the manual in preparation for the + book publication through Network Theory Ltd. + + * Niels Giesen had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees. + + * Nicolas Goaziou rewrote much of the plain list code. He also wrote + `org-element.el' and `org-export.el', which was a huge step forward + in implementing a clean framework for Org exporters. + + * Kai Grossjohann pointed out key-binding conflicts with other + packages. + + * Brian Gough of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as + a book. + + * Bernt Hansen has driven much of the support for auto-repeating + tasks, task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear + explanations have been critical when we started to adopt the Git + version control system. + + * Manuel Hermenegildo has contributed various ideas, small fixes and + patches. + + * Phil Jackson wrote `org-irc.el'. + + * Scott Jaderholm proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between + folded entries, and column view for properties. + + * Matt Jones wrote MobileOrg Android. + + * Tokuya Kameshima wrote `org-wl.el' and `org-mew.el'. + + * Jonathan Leech-Pepin wrote `ox-texinfo.el'. + + * Shidai Liu ("Leo") asked for embedded LaTeX and tested it. He also + provided frequent feedback and some patches. + + * Matt Lundin has proposed last-row references for table formulas + and named invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ. + + * David Maus wrote `org-atom.el', maintains the issues file for Org, + and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent + replies, small fixes and patches. + + * Jason F. McBrayer suggested agenda export to CSV format. + + * Max Mikhanosha came up with the idea of refiling and sticky + agendas. + + * Dmitri Minaev sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file + basis. + + * Stefan Monnier provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler + happy. + + * Richard Moreland wrote MobileOrg for the iPhone. + + * Rick Moynihan proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file + and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree. + + * Todd Neal provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms. + + * Greg Newman refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form. + + * Tim O'Callaghan suggested in-file links, search options for general + file links, and TAGS. + + * Osamu Okano wrote `orgcard2ref.pl', a Perl program to create a text + version of the reference card. + + * Takeshi Okano translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial + into Japanese. + + * Oliver Oppitz suggested multi-state TODO items. + + * Scott Otterson sparked the introduction of descriptive text for + links, among other things. + + * Pete Phillips helped during the development of the TAGS feature, + and provided frequent feedback. + + * Francesco Pizzolante provided patches that helped speeding up the + agenda generation. + + * Martin Pohlack provided the code snippet to bundle character + insertion into bundles of 20 for undo. + + * Rackspace.com is hosting our website for free. Thank you + Rackspace! + + * T.V. Raman reported bugs and suggested improvements. + + * Matthias Rempe (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality + control. + + * Paul Rivier provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. + He also acted as mailing list moderator for some time. + + * Kevin Rogers contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts. + + * Frank Ruell solved the mystery of the `keymapp nil' bug, a + conflict with `allout.el'. + + * Jason Riedy generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl + tables with extensive patches. + + * Philip Rooke created the Org reference card, provided lots of + feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation. + + * Christian Schlauer proposed angular brackets around links, among + other things. + + * Christopher Schmidt reworked `orgstruct-mode' so that users can + enjoy folding in non-org buffers by using Org headlines in + comments. + + * Paul Sexton wrote `org-ctags.el'. + + * Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by Tom Shannon's + `organizer-mode.el'. + + * Ilya Shlyakhter proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in + literal examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code + lines. + + * Stathis Sideris wrote the `ditaa.jar' ASCII to PNG converter that + is now packaged into Org's `contrib' directory. + + * Daniel Sinder came up with the idea of internal archiving by + locking subtrees. + + * Dale Smith proposed link abbreviations. + + * James TD Smith has contributed a large number of patches for useful + tweaks and features. + + * Adam Spiers asked for global linking commands, inspired the link + extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the + mapping API. + + * Ulf Stegemann created the table to translate special symbols to + HTML, LaTeX, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII. + + * Andy Stewart contributed code to `org-w3m.el', to copy HTML content + with links transformation to Org syntax. + + * David O'Toole wrote `org-publish.el' and drafted the manual + chapter about publishing. + + * Jambunathan K contributed the ODT exporter and rewrote the HTML + exporter. + + * Sebastien Vauban reported many issues with LaTeX and BEAMER export + and enabled source code highlighting in Gnus. + + * Stefan Vollmar organized a video-recorded talk at the + Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation + of a concept index for HTML export. + + * Jürgen Vollmer contributed code generating the table of contents + in HTML output. + + * Samuel Wales has provided important feedback and bug reports. + + * Chris Wallace provided a patch implementing the `QUOTE' keyword. + + * David Wainberg suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking + system. + + * Carsten Wimmer suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in + linking to Gnus. + + * Roland Winkler requested additional key bindings to make Org work + on a tty. + + * Piotr Zielinski wrote `org-mouse.el', proposed agenda blocks and + contributed various ideas and code snippets. + + * Marco Wahl wrote `org-eww.el'. + + +File: org, Node: GNU Free Documentation License, Next: Main Index, Prev: History and acknowledgments, Up: Top + +Appendix D GNU Free Documentation License +***************************************** + + Version 1.3, 3 November 2008 + + Copyright (C) 2000, 2001, 2002, 2007, 2008, 2013, 2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc. + `http://fsf.org/' + + Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies + of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. + + 0. PREAMBLE + + The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other + functional and useful document "free" in the sense of freedom: to + assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it, + with or without modifying it, either commercially or + noncommercially. Secondarily, this License preserves for the + author and publisher a way to get credit for their work, while not + being considered responsible for modifications made by others. + + This License is a kind of "copyleft", which means that derivative + works of the document must themselves be free in the same sense. + It complements the GNU General Public License, which is a copyleft + license designed for free software. + + We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for + free software, because free software needs free documentation: a + free program should come with manuals providing the same freedoms + that the software does. But this License is not limited to + software manuals; it can be used for any textual work, regardless + of subject matter or whether it is published as a printed book. + We recommend this License principally for works whose purpose is + instruction or reference. + + 1. APPLICABILITY AND DEFINITIONS + + This License applies to any manual or other work, in any medium, + that contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it + can be distributed under the terms of this License. Such a notice + grants a world-wide, royalty-free license, unlimited in duration, + to use that work under the conditions stated herein. The + "Document", below, refers to any such manual or work. Any member + of the public is a licensee, and is addressed as "you". You + accept the license if you copy, modify or distribute the work in a + way requiring permission under copyright law. + + A "Modified Version" of the Document means any work containing the + Document or a portion of it, either copied verbatim, or with + modifications and/or translated into another language. + + A "Secondary Section" is a named appendix or a front-matter section + of the Document that deals exclusively with the relationship of the + publishers or authors of the Document to the Document's overall + subject (or to related matters) and contains nothing that could + fall directly within that overall subject. (Thus, if the Document + is in part a textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may not + explain any mathematics.) The relationship could be a matter of + historical connection with the subject or with related matters, or + of legal, commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position + regarding them. + + The "Invariant Sections" are certain Secondary Sections whose + titles are designated, as being those of Invariant Sections, in + the notice that says that the Document is released under this + License. If a section does not fit the above definition of + Secondary then it is not allowed to be designated as Invariant. + The Document may contain zero Invariant Sections. If the Document + does not identify any Invariant Sections then there are none. + + The "Cover Texts" are certain short passages of text that are + listed, as Front-Cover Texts or Back-Cover Texts, in the notice + that says that the Document is released under this License. A + Front-Cover Text may be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may + be at most 25 words. + + A "Transparent" copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy, + represented in a format whose specification is available to the + general public, that is suitable for revising the document + straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images + composed of pixels) generic paint programs or (for drawings) some + widely available drawing editor, and that is suitable for input to + text formatters or for automatic translation to a variety of + formats suitable for input to text formatters. A copy made in an + otherwise Transparent file format whose markup, or absence of + markup, has been arranged to thwart or discourage subsequent + modification by readers is not Transparent. An image format is + not Transparent if used for any substantial amount of text. A + copy that is not "Transparent" is called "Opaque". + + Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain + ASCII without markup, Texinfo input format, LaTeX input format, + SGML or XML using a publicly available DTD, and + standard-conforming simple HTML, PostScript or PDF designed for + human modification. Examples of transparent image formats include + PNG, XCF and JPG. Opaque formats include proprietary formats that + can be read and edited only by proprietary word processors, SGML or + XML for which the DTD and/or processing tools are not generally + available, and the machine-generated HTML, PostScript or PDF + produced by some word processors for output purposes only. + + The "Title Page" means, for a printed book, the title page itself, + plus such following pages as are needed to hold, legibly, the + material this License requires to appear in the title page. For + works in formats which do not have any title page as such, "Title + Page" means the text near the most prominent appearance of the + work's title, preceding the beginning of the body of the text. + + The "publisher" means any person or entity that distributes copies + of the Document to the public. + + A section "Entitled XYZ" means a named subunit of the Document + whose title either is precisely XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses + following text that translates XYZ in another language. (Here XYZ + stands for a specific section name mentioned below, such as + "Acknowledgements", "Dedications", "Endorsements", or "History".) + To "Preserve the Title" of such a section when you modify the + Document means that it remains a section "Entitled XYZ" according + to this definition. + + The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice + which states that this License applies to the Document. These + Warranty Disclaimers are considered to be included by reference in + this License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other + implication that these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and + has no effect on the meaning of this License. + + 2. VERBATIM COPYING + + You may copy and distribute the Document in any medium, either + commercially or noncommercially, provided that this License, the + copyright notices, and the license notice saying this License + applies to the Document are reproduced in all copies, and that you + add no other conditions whatsoever to those of this License. You + may not use technical measures to obstruct or control the reading + or further copying of the copies you make or distribute. However, + you may accept compensation in exchange for copies. If you + distribute a large enough number of copies you must also follow + the conditions in section 3. + + You may also lend copies, under the same conditions stated above, + and you may publicly display copies. + + 3. COPYING IN QUANTITY + + If you publish printed copies (or copies in media that commonly + have printed covers) of the Document, numbering more than 100, and + the Document's license notice requires Cover Texts, you must + enclose the copies in covers that carry, clearly and legibly, all + these Cover Texts: Front-Cover Texts on the front cover, and + Back-Cover Texts on the back cover. Both covers must also clearly + and legibly identify you as the publisher of these copies. The + front cover must present the full title with all words of the + title equally prominent and visible. You may add other material + on the covers in addition. Copying with changes limited to the + covers, as long as they preserve the title of the Document and + satisfy these conditions, can be treated as verbatim copying in + other respects. + + If the required texts for either cover are too voluminous to fit + legibly, you should put the first ones listed (as many as fit + reasonably) on the actual cover, and continue the rest onto + adjacent pages. + + If you publish or distribute Opaque copies of the Document + numbering more than 100, you must either include a + machine-readable Transparent copy along with each Opaque copy, or + state in or with each Opaque copy a computer-network location from + which the general network-using public has access to download + using public-standard network protocols a complete Transparent + copy of the Document, free of added material. If you use the + latter option, you must take reasonably prudent steps, when you + begin distribution of Opaque copies in quantity, to ensure that + this Transparent copy will remain thus accessible at the stated + location until at least one year after the last time you + distribute an Opaque copy (directly or through your agents or + retailers) of that edition to the public. + + It is requested, but not required, that you contact the authors of + the Document well before redistributing any large number of + copies, to give them a chance to provide you with an updated + version of the Document. + + 4. MODIFICATIONS + + You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document + under the conditions of sections 2 and 3 above, provided that you + release the Modified Version under precisely this License, with + the Modified Version filling the role of the Document, thus + licensing distribution and modification of the Modified Version to + whoever possesses a copy of it. In addition, you must do these + things in the Modified Version: + + A. Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title + distinct from that of the Document, and from those of + previous versions (which should, if there were any, be listed + in the History section of the Document). You may use the + same title as a previous version if the original publisher of + that version gives permission. + + B. List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or + entities responsible for authorship of the modifications in + the Modified Version, together with at least five of the + principal authors of the Document (all of its principal + authors, if it has fewer than five), unless they release you + from this requirement. + + C. State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the + Modified Version, as the publisher. + + D. Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document. + + E. Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications + adjacent to the other copyright notices. + + F. Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license + notice giving the public permission to use the Modified + Version under the terms of this License, in the form shown in + the Addendum below. + + G. Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant + Sections and required Cover Texts given in the Document's + license notice. + + H. Include an unaltered copy of this License. + + I. Preserve the section Entitled "History", Preserve its Title, + and add to it an item stating at least the title, year, new + authors, and publisher of the Modified Version as given on + the Title Page. If there is no section Entitled "History" in + the Document, create one stating the title, year, authors, + and publisher of the Document as given on its Title Page, + then add an item describing the Modified Version as stated in + the previous sentence. + + J. Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document + for public access to a Transparent copy of the Document, and + likewise the network locations given in the Document for + previous versions it was based on. These may be placed in + the "History" section. You may omit a network location for a + work that was published at least four years before the + Document itself, or if the original publisher of the version + it refers to gives permission. + + K. For any section Entitled "Acknowledgements" or "Dedications", + Preserve the Title of the section, and preserve in the + section all the substance and tone of each of the contributor + acknowledgements and/or dedications given therein. + + L. Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document, + unaltered in their text and in their titles. Section numbers + or the equivalent are not considered part of the section + titles. + + M. Delete any section Entitled "Endorsements". Such a section + may not be included in the Modified Version. + + N. Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled + "Endorsements" or to conflict in title with any Invariant + Section. + + O. Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers. + + If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or + appendices that qualify as Secondary Sections and contain no + material copied from the Document, you may at your option + designate some or all of these sections as invariant. To do this, + add their titles to the list of Invariant Sections in the Modified + Version's license notice. These titles must be distinct from any + other section titles. + + You may add a section Entitled "Endorsements", provided it contains + nothing but endorsements of your Modified Version by various + parties--for example, statements of peer review or that the text + has been approved by an organization as the authoritative + definition of a standard. + + You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, + and a passage of up to 25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end + of the list of Cover Texts in the Modified Version. Only one + passage of Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be + added by (or through arrangements made by) any one entity. If the + Document already includes a cover text for the same cover, + previously added by you or by arrangement made by the same entity + you are acting on behalf of, you may not add another; but you may + replace the old one, on explicit permission from the previous + publisher that added the old one. + + The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this + License give permission to use their names for publicity for or to + assert or imply endorsement of any Modified Version. + + 5. COMBINING DOCUMENTS + + You may combine the Document with other documents released under + this License, under the terms defined in section 4 above for + modified versions, provided that you include in the combination + all of the Invariant Sections of all of the original documents, + unmodified, and list them all as Invariant Sections of your + combined work in its license notice, and that you preserve all + their Warranty Disclaimers. + + The combined work need only contain one copy of this License, and + multiple identical Invariant Sections may be replaced with a single + copy. If there are multiple Invariant Sections with the same name + but different contents, make the title of each such section unique + by adding at the end of it, in parentheses, the name of the + original author or publisher of that section if known, or else a + unique number. Make the same adjustment to the section titles in + the list of Invariant Sections in the license notice of the + combined work. + + In the combination, you must combine any sections Entitled + "History" in the various original documents, forming one section + Entitled "History"; likewise combine any sections Entitled + "Acknowledgements", and any sections Entitled "Dedications". You + must delete all sections Entitled "Endorsements." + + 6. COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS + + You may make a collection consisting of the Document and other + documents released under this License, and replace the individual + copies of this License in the various documents with a single copy + that is included in the collection, provided that you follow the + rules of this License for verbatim copying of each of the + documents in all other respects. + + You may extract a single document from such a collection, and + distribute it individually under this License, provided you insert + a copy of this License into the extracted document, and follow + this License in all other respects regarding verbatim copying of + that document. + + 7. AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS + + A compilation of the Document or its derivatives with other + separate and independent documents or works, in or on a volume of + a storage or distribution medium, is called an "aggregate" if the + copyright resulting from the compilation is not used to limit the + legal rights of the compilation's users beyond what the individual + works permit. When the Document is included in an aggregate, this + License does not apply to the other works in the aggregate which + are not themselves derivative works of the Document. + + If the Cover Text requirement of section 3 is applicable to these + copies of the Document, then if the Document is less than one half + of the entire aggregate, the Document's Cover Texts may be placed + on covers that bracket the Document within the aggregate, or the + electronic equivalent of covers if the Document is in electronic + form. Otherwise they must appear on printed covers that bracket + the whole aggregate. + + 8. TRANSLATION + + Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may + distribute translations of the Document under the terms of section + 4. Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special + permission from their copyright holders, but you may include + translations of some or all Invariant Sections in addition to the + original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a + translation of this License, and all the license notices in the + Document, and any Warranty Disclaimers, provided that you also + include the original English version of this License and the + original versions of those notices and disclaimers. In case of a + disagreement between the translation and the original version of + this License or a notice or disclaimer, the original version will + prevail. + + If a section in the Document is Entitled "Acknowledgements", + "Dedications", or "History", the requirement (section 4) to + Preserve its Title (section 1) will typically require changing the + actual title. + + 9. TERMINATION + + You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document + except as expressly provided under this License. Any attempt + otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute it is void, + and will automatically terminate your rights under this License. + + However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your + license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated (a) + provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly + and finally terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the + copyright holder fails to notify you of the violation by some + reasonable means prior to 60 days after the cessation. + + Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is + reinstated permanently if the copyright holder notifies you of the + violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you have + received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from + that copyright holder, and you cure the violation prior to 30 days + after your receipt of the notice. + + Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate + the licenses of parties who have received copies or rights from + you under this License. If your rights have been terminated and + not permanently reinstated, receipt of a copy of some or all of + the same material does not give you any rights to use it. + + 10. FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE + + The Free Software Foundation may publish new, revised versions of + the GNU Free Documentation License from time to time. Such new + versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may + differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. See + `http://www.gnu.org/copyleft/'. + + Each version of the License is given a distinguishing version + number. If the Document specifies that a particular numbered + version of this License "or any later version" applies to it, you + have the option of following the terms and conditions either of + that specified version or of any later version that has been + published (not as a draft) by the Free Software Foundation. If + the Document does not specify a version number of this License, + you may choose any version ever published (not as a draft) by the + Free Software Foundation. If the Document specifies that a proxy + can decide which future versions of this License can be used, that + proxy's public statement of acceptance of a version permanently + authorizes you to choose that version for the Document. + + 11. RELICENSING + + "Massive Multiauthor Collaboration Site" (or "MMC Site") means any + World Wide Web server that publishes copyrightable works and also + provides prominent facilities for anybody to edit those works. A + public wiki that anybody can edit is an example of such a server. + A "Massive Multiauthor Collaboration" (or "MMC") contained in the + site means any set of copyrightable works thus published on the MMC + site. + + "CC-BY-SA" means the Creative Commons Attribution-Share Alike 3.0 + license published by Creative Commons Corporation, a not-for-profit + corporation with a principal place of business in San Francisco, + California, as well as future copyleft versions of that license + published by that same organization. + + "Incorporate" means to publish or republish a Document, in whole or + in part, as part of another Document. + + An MMC is "eligible for relicensing" if it is licensed under this + License, and if all works that were first published under this + License somewhere other than this MMC, and subsequently + incorporated in whole or in part into the MMC, (1) had no cover + texts or invariant sections, and (2) were thus incorporated prior + to November 1, 2008. + + The operator of an MMC Site may republish an MMC contained in the + site under CC-BY-SA on the same site at any time before August 1, + 2009, provided the MMC is eligible for relicensing. + + +ADDENDUM: How to use this License for your documents +==================================================== + +To use this License in a document you have written, include a copy of +the License in the document and put the following copyright and license +notices just after the title page: + + Copyright (C) YEAR YOUR NAME. + Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document + under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 + or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; + with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover + Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU + Free Documentation License''. + + If you have Invariant Sections, Front-Cover Texts and Back-Cover +Texts, replace the "with...Texts." line with this: + + with the Invariant Sections being LIST THEIR TITLES, with + the Front-Cover Texts being LIST, and with the Back-Cover Texts + being LIST. + + If you have Invariant Sections without Cover Texts, or some other +combination of the three, merge those two alternatives to suit the +situation. + + If your document contains nontrivial examples of program code, we +recommend releasing these examples in parallel under your choice of +free software license, such as the GNU General Public License, to +permit their use in free software. + + +File: org, Node: Main Index, Next: Key Index, Prev: GNU Free Documentation License, Up: Top + +Concept index +************* + + +* Menu: + +* #+ARCHIVE: Moving subtrees. (line 35) +* #+ASCII: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. + (line 57) +* #+ATTR_ASCII: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. + (line 68) +* #+ATTR_BEAMER: Beamer specific syntax. + (line 35) +* #+ATTR_HTML <1>: Images in HTML export. + (line 29) +* #+ATTR_HTML <2>: Tables in HTML export. + (line 11) +* #+ATTR_HTML: Links in HTML export. + (line 27) +* #+ATTR_LATEX, in example blocks: Example blocks in LaTeX export. + (line 6) +* #+ATTR_LATEX, in horizontal rules: Horizontal rules in LaTeX export. + (line 6) +* #+ATTR_LATEX, in images: Images in LaTeX export. + (line 6) +* #+ATTR_LATEX, in plain lists: Plain lists in LaTeX export. + (line 6) +* #+ATTR_LATEX, in source blocks: Source blocks in LaTeX export. + (line 6) +* #+ATTR_LATEX, in special blocks: Special blocks in LaTeX export. + (line 6) +* #+ATTR_LATEX, in tables: Tables in LaTeX export. + (line 6) +* #+ATTR_ODT <1>: Customizing tables in ODT export. + (line 6) +* #+ATTR_ODT <2>: Images in ODT export. + (line 31) +* #+ATTR_ODT: Tables in ODT export. + (line 20) +* #+ATTR_TEXINFO, in images: Images in Texinfo export. + (line 6) +* #+ATTR_TEXINFO, in plain lists: Plain lists in Texinfo export. + (line 6) +* #+ATTR_TEXINFO, in special blocks: Special blocks in Texinfo export. + (line 6) +* #+ATTR_TEXINFO, in tables: Tables in Texinfo export. + (line 6) +* #+AUTHOR: Export settings. (line 25) +* #+BEAMER: Beamer specific syntax. + (line 19) +* #+BEAMER_FONT_THEME: Beamer specific export settings. + (line 16) +* #+BEAMER_HEADER: Beamer specific export settings. + (line 25) +* #+BEAMER_INNER_THEME: Beamer specific export settings. + (line 19) +* #+BEAMER_OUTER_THEME: Beamer specific export settings. + (line 22) +* #+BEAMER_THEME: Beamer specific export settings. + (line 11) +* #+BEGIN, clocktable: The clock table. (line 36) +* #+BEGIN, columnview: Capturing column view. + (line 11) +* #+BEGIN:dynamic block: Dynamic blocks. (line 15) +* #+BEGIN_CENTER: Paragraphs. (line 31) +* #+BEGIN_COMMENT: Comment lines. (line 10) +* #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE: Literal examples. (line 8) +* #+BEGIN_EXPORT ascii: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. + (line 57) +* #+BEGIN_EXPORT beamer: Beamer specific syntax. + (line 19) +* #+BEGIN_EXPORT html: Quoting HTML tags. (line 12) +* #+BEGIN_EXPORT latex: Quoting LaTeX code. (line 17) +* #+BEGIN_EXPORT texinfo: Quoting Texinfo code. + (line 9) +* #+BEGIN_JUSTIFYLEFT: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. + (line 78) +* #+BEGIN_JUSTIFYRIGHT: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. + (line 78) +* #+BEGIN_QUOTE: Paragraphs. (line 26) +* #+BEGIN_SRC <1>: Structure of code blocks. + (line 6) +* #+BEGIN_SRC: Literal examples. (line 28) +* #+BEGIN_VERSE: Paragraphs. (line 13) +* #+BIND: Export settings. (line 211) +* #+CALL: Evaluating code blocks. + (line 25) +* #+CAPTION <1>: Images in HTML export. + (line 29) +* #+CAPTION <2>: Tables in HTML export. + (line 11) +* #+CAPTION: Images and tables. (line 6) +* #+CATEGORY: Categories. (line 6) +* #+CINDEX: Indices. (line 6) +* #+COLUMNS: Scope of column definitions. + (line 8) +* #+CONSTANTS: References. (line 110) +* #+CREATOR: Export settings. (line 28) +* #+DATE: Export settings. (line 32) +* #+DESCRIPTION (Beamer): Beamer specific export settings. + (line 29) +* #+DESCRIPTION (HTML): HTML Specific export settings. + (line 10) +* #+DESCRIPTION (LaTeX): LaTeX specific export settings. + (line 11) +* #+DESCRIPTION (ODT): ODT specific export settings. + (line 11) +* #+EMAIL: Export settings. (line 35) +* #+EXCLUDE_TAGS: Export settings. (line 52) +* #+EXPORT_FILE_NAME: Export settings. (line 64) +* #+FILETAGS: Tag inheritance. (line 20) +* #+FINDEX: Indices. (line 6) +* #+HEADER:: Code block specific header arguments. + (line 30) +* #+HTML: Quoting HTML tags. (line 12) +* #+HTML_CONTAINER: HTML Specific export settings. + (line 19) +* #+HTML_DOCTYPE: HTML Specific export settings. + (line 16) +* #+HTML_HEAD <1>: CSS support. (line 48) +* #+HTML_HEAD: HTML Specific export settings. + (line 35) +* #+HTML_HEAD_EXTRA <1>: CSS support. (line 48) +* #+HTML_HEAD_EXTRA: HTML Specific export settings. + (line 39) +* #+HTML_INCLUDE_STYLE: CSS support. (line 43) +* #+HTML_LINK_HOME: HTML Specific export settings. + (line 23) +* #+HTML_LINK_UP: HTML Specific export settings. + (line 26) +* #+HTML_MATHJAX: HTML Specific export settings. + (line 30) +* #+INCLUDE: Include files. (line 7) +* #+INDEX: Generating an index. (line 16) +* #+INFOJS_OPT: JavaScript support. (line 20) +* #+KEYWORDS (Beamer): Beamer specific export settings. + (line 36) +* #+KEYWORDS (HTML): HTML Specific export settings. + (line 43) +* #+KEYWORDS (LaTeX): LaTeX specific export settings. + (line 46) +* #+KEYWORDS (ODT): ODT specific export settings. + (line 16) +* #+KINDEX: Indices. (line 6) +* #+LANGUAGE: Export settings. (line 38) +* #+LATEX: Quoting LaTeX code. (line 13) +* #+LATEX_CLASS <1>: LaTeX header and sectioning. + (line 23) +* #+LATEX_CLASS: LaTeX specific export settings. + (line 20) +* #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS <1>: LaTeX header and sectioning. + (line 23) +* #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: LaTeX specific export settings. + (line 28) +* #+LATEX_COMPILER: LaTeX specific export settings. + (line 32) +* #+LATEX_HEADER <1>: LaTeX header and sectioning. + (line 30) +* #+LATEX_HEADER: LaTeX specific export settings. + (line 36) +* #+LATEX_HEADER (HTML): HTML Specific export settings. + (line 48) +* #+LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA <1>: LaTeX header and sectioning. + (line 30) +* #+LATEX_HEADER_EXTRA: LaTeX specific export settings. + (line 41) +* #+LINK: Link abbreviations. (line 49) +* #+MACRO: Macro replacement. (line 6) +* #+NAME <1>: Structure of code blocks. + (line 6) +* #+NAME <2>: Images and tables. (line 6) +* #+NAME: Internal links. (line 21) +* #+NAME, for table: References. (line 131) +* #+ODT_STYLES_FILE: Applying custom styles. + (line 25) +* #+OPTIONS: Export settings. (line 6) +* #+ORGLST: Radio lists. (line 11) +* #+ORGTBL: Radio tables. (line 19) +* #+ORGTBL, SEND: A LaTeX example. (line 13) +* #+PINDEX: Indices. (line 6) +* #+PLOT: Org-Plot. (line 6) +* #+PRIORITIES: Priorities. (line 43) +* #+PROPERTY: Property syntax. (line 44) +* #+RESULTS: Evaluating code blocks. + (line 6) +* #+SELECT_TAGS: Export settings. (line 44) +* #+SEQ_TODO: Per-file keywords. (line 6) +* #+SETUPFILE <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 52) +* #+SETUPFILE: Export settings. (line 13) +* #+STARTUP: In-buffer settings. (line 67) +* #+SUBAUTHOR <1>: Texinfo title and copyright page. + (line 12) +* #+SUBAUTHOR: Texinfo specific export settings. + (line 14) +* #+SUBTITLE (ASCII): ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. + (line 40) +* #+SUBTITLE (Beamer): Beamer specific export settings. + (line 44) +* #+SUBTITLE (HTML): HTML Specific export settings. + (line 53) +* #+SUBTITLE (LaTeX): LaTeX specific export settings. + (line 55) +* #+SUBTITLE (Texinfo): Texinfo specific export settings. + (line 11) +* #+TAGS: Setting tags. (line 29) +* #+TBLFM <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 176) +* #+TBLFM <2>: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 99) +* #+TBLFM: Field and range formulas. + (line 12) +* #+TBLFM line, multiple: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 99) +* #+TBLFM, switching: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 99) +* #+TEXINFO: Quoting Texinfo code. + (line 9) +* #+TEXINFO_CLASS <1>: Headings and sectioning structure. + (line 6) +* #+TEXINFO_CLASS <2>: Texinfo file header. (line 11) +* #+TEXINFO_CLASS: Texinfo specific export settings. + (line 20) +* #+TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY <1>: Info directory file. (line 6) +* #+TEXINFO_DIR_CATEGORY: Texinfo specific export settings. + (line 30) +* #+TEXINFO_DIR_DESC <1>: Info directory file. (line 6) +* #+TEXINFO_DIR_DESC: Texinfo specific export settings. + (line 36) +* #+TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE <1>: Info directory file. (line 6) +* #+TEXINFO_DIR_TITLE: Texinfo specific export settings. + (line 33) +* #+TEXINFO_FILENAME <1>: Texinfo file header. (line 6) +* #+TEXINFO_FILENAME: Texinfo specific export settings. + (line 17) +* #+TEXINFO_HEADER <1>: Texinfo file header. (line 11) +* #+TEXINFO_HEADER: Texinfo specific export settings. + (line 24) +* #+TEXINFO_POST_HEADER: Texinfo specific export settings. + (line 27) +* #+TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE <1>: Texinfo title and copyright page. + (line 6) +* #+TEXINFO_PRINTED_TITLE: Texinfo specific export settings. + (line 39) +* #+TINDEX: Indices. (line 6) +* #+TITLE: Export settings. (line 60) +* #+TOC: Table of contents. (line 6) +* #+TODO: Per-file keywords. (line 6) +* #+TYP_TODO: Per-file keywords. (line 6) +* #+VINDEX: Indices. (line 6) +* %:annotation template expansion in capture: capture protocol. + (line 23) +* %:description template expansion in capture: capture protocol. + (line 23) +* %:link template expansion in capture: capture protocol. (line 23) +* :base-url property in open-source protocol: open-source protocol. + (line 13) +* :cache, src header argument <1>: cache. (line 6) +* :cache, src header argument: System-wide header arguments. + (line 9) +* :colnames, src header argument: colnames. (line 6) +* :comments, src header argument: comments. (line 6) +* :dir, src header argument: dir. (line 6) +* :epilogue, src header argument: epilogue. (line 6) +* :eval, src header argument: eval. (line 6) +* :exports, src header argument <1>: exports. (line 6) +* :exports, src header argument <2>: System-wide header arguments. + (line 9) +* :exports, src header argument: Exporting code blocks. + (line 20) +* :file, src header argument: file. (line 6) +* :file-ext, src header argument: file-ext. (line 6) +* :hlines, src header argument: hlines. (line 6) +* :indic attribute, in Texinfo export: Plain lists in Texinfo export. + (line 12) +* :mkdirp, src header argument: mkdirp. (line 6) +* :no-expand, src header argument: no-expand. (line 6) +* :noweb, src header argument <1>: noweb. (line 6) +* :noweb, src header argument: System-wide header arguments. + (line 9) +* :noweb-ref, src header argument: noweb-ref. (line 6) +* :noweb-sep, src header argument: noweb-sep. (line 6) +* :online-suffix property in open-source protocol: open-source protocol. + (line 13) +* :output-dir, src header argument: output-dir. (line 6) +* :padline, src header argument: padline. (line 6) +* :post, src header argument: post. (line 6) +* :prologue, src header argument: prologue. (line 6) +* :results, src header argument <1>: Results of evaluation. + (line 33) +* :results, src header argument <2>: results. (line 6) +* :results, src header argument: System-wide header arguments. + (line 9) +* :rewrites property in open-source protocol: open-source protocol. + (line 43) +* :rownames, src header argument: rownames. (line 6) +* :sep attribute, in Texinfo export: Plain lists in Texinfo export. + (line 17) +* :sep, src header argument: sep. (line 6) +* :session, src header argument <1>: session. (line 6) +* :session, src header argument: System-wide header arguments. + (line 9) +* :shebang, src header argument: shebang. (line 6) +* :table-type attribute, in Texinfo export: Plain lists in Texinfo export. + (line 6) +* :tangle, src header argument <1>: tangle. (line 6) +* :tangle, src header argument: Extracting source code. + (line 23) +* :tangle-mode, src header argument: tangle-mode. (line 6) +* :var, src header argument: var. (line 6) +* :working-directory property in open-source protocol: open-source protocol. + (line 13) +* :working-suffix property in open-source protocol: open-source protocol. + (line 13) +* :wrap, src header argument: wrap. (line 6) +* abbreviation, links: Link abbreviations. (line 6) +* abstract, in LaTeX export: Special blocks in LaTeX export. + (line 6) +* acknowledgments: History and acknowledgments. + (line 6) +* action, for publishing: Publishing action. (line 6) +* activation: Activation. (line 6) +* active region <1>: ODT export commands. (line 6) +* active region <2>: Built-in table editor. + (line 162) +* active region: Structure editing. (line 139) +* add-on packages: Add-on packages. (line 6) +* add-ons, context-sensitive commands: Context-sensitive commands. + (line 6) +* agenda: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 6) +* agenda dispatcher: Agenda dispatcher. (line 6) +* agenda files: Agenda files. (line 6) +* agenda files, removing buffers: Agenda commands. (line 519) +* agenda views: Agenda views. (line 6) +* agenda views, custom: Custom agenda views. (line 6) +* agenda views, exporting <1>: Exporting agenda views. + (line 6) +* agenda views, exporting: Agenda commands. (line 505) +* agenda views, main example: Storing searches. (line 9) +* agenda views, optimization: Speeding up your agendas. + (line 6) +* agenda views, user-defined: Special agenda views. + (line 6) +* agenda*, as an agenda views: Storing searches. (line 9) +* agenda, as an agenda views: Storing searches. (line 9) +* agenda, column view: Agenda column view. (line 6) +* agenda, pipe: Extracting agenda information. + (line 6) +* agenda, sticky: Agenda dispatcher. (line 50) +* agenda, with block views: Block agenda. (line 6) +* align, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 88) +* alignment in tables: Column width and alignment. + (line 6) +* anniversaries, from BBDB: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 79) +* API, for mapping: Using the mapping API. + (line 6) +* API, for properties <1>: Using the property API. + (line 6) +* API, for properties: Property API. (line 6) +* appointment <1>: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 126) +* appointment: Timestamps. (line 14) +* appointment reminders: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 126) +* appt.el: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 126) +* archive locations: Moving subtrees. (line 25) +* archive tag: Internal archiving. (line 6) +* archived entries, in agenda views: Agenda views. (line 37) +* Archives mode: Agenda commands. (line 134) +* archiving: Archiving. (line 6) +* ASCII export: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. + (line 6) +* Atom feeds: RSS feeds. (line 6) +* attachments: Attachments. (line 6) +* author: Feedback. (line 6) +* author, macro: Macro replacement. (line 24) +* autoload: Activation. (line 6) +* babel, languages: Languages. (line 6) +* babel, library of: Library of Babel. (line 6) +* backtrace of an error: Feedback. (line 66) +* BBDB links: External links. (line 6) +* BBDB, anniversaries: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 79) +* Beamer export: Beamer export. (line 6) +* begin block, end block: Structure of code blocks. + (line 46) +* block agenda: Block agenda. (line 6) +* blocking, of checkboxes: Checkboxes. (line 46) +* blocks, folding: Blocks. (line 6) +* bold text, markup rules: Emphasis and monospace. + (line 6) +* Boolean logic, for tag/property searches: Matching tags and properties. + (line 34) +* bug reports: Feedback. (line 6) +* C-c C-c, overview: The very busy C-c C-c key. + (line 6) +* calc package: The spreadsheet. (line 6) +* calc.el: Cooperation. (line 6) +* calculations, in tables <1>: The spreadsheet. (line 6) +* calculations, in tables: Built-in table editor. + (line 162) +* calendar commands, from agenda: Agenda commands. (line 454) +* calendar integration: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 32) +* calendar, for selecting date: The date/time prompt. + (line 76) +* capture <1>: Capture. (line 6) +* capture: Capture - Refile - Archive. + (line 6) +* capture protocol: capture protocol. (line 6) +* capture, %:annotation placeholder: capture protocol. (line 23) +* capture, %:description placeholder: capture protocol. (line 23) +* capture, %:link placeholder: capture protocol. (line 23) +* capturing, from agenda: Agenda commands. (line 348) +* category: Categories. (line 6) +* category filtering, in agenda: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 17) +* category, require for tags/property match: Matching tags and properties. + (line 72) +* CDLaTeX: CDLaTeX mode. (line 6) +* cdlatex.el: Cooperation. (line 21) +* center blocks: Paragraphs. (line 31) +* center image (LaTeX export): Images in LaTeX export. + (line 50) +* checkbox blocking: Checkboxes. (line 46) +* checkbox statistics: Checkboxes. (line 30) +* checkboxes: Checkboxes. (line 6) +* checkboxes and TODO dependencies: TODO dependencies. (line 52) +* children, subtree visibility state: Global and local cycling. + (line 10) +* clean outline view: Clean view. (line 6) +* clocking time: Clocking work time. (line 6) +* clocktable, dynamic block: The clock table. (line 6) +* code block, batch execution: Batch execution. (line 6) +* code block, editing: Editing source code. (line 6) +* code block, evaluating: Evaluating code blocks. + (line 6) +* code block, exporting: Exporting code blocks. + (line 6) +* code block, extracting source code: Extracting source code. + (line 6) +* code block, header arguments: Header arguments. (line 6) +* code block, key bindings: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 6) +* code block, languages: Languages. (line 6) +* code block, library: Library of Babel. (line 6) +* code block, noweb reference: Noweb reference syntax. + (line 6) +* code block, results of evaluation: Results of evaluation. + (line 6) +* code block, structure: Structure of code blocks. + (line 6) +* code line references, markup rules: Literal examples. (line 6) +* code text, markup rules: Emphasis and monospace. + (line 6) +* column formula: Column formulas. (line 6) +* column view, for properties: Defining columns. (line 6) +* column view, in agenda: Agenda column view. (line 6) +* column, of field coordinates: References. (line 86) +* commands, in agenda buffer: Agenda commands. (line 6) +* comment lines: Comment lines. (line 6) +* comment trees: Comment lines. (line 13) +* commented entries, in agenda views: Agenda views. (line 37) +* completion, of dictionary words: Completion. (line 6) +* completion, of file names: Handling links. (line 89) +* completion, of link abbreviations: Completion. (line 6) +* completion, of links: Handling links. (line 66) +* completion, of option keywords <1>: Completion. (line 6) +* completion, of option keywords: Per-file keywords. (line 23) +* completion, of property keys: Completion. (line 6) +* completion, of tags <1>: Completion. (line 6) +* completion, of tags: Setting tags. (line 11) +* completion, of TeX symbols: Completion. (line 6) +* completion, of TODO keywords <1>: Completion. (line 6) +* completion, of TODO keywords: Workflow states. (line 15) +* concept index, in Texinfo export: Indices. (line 6) +* constants, in calculations: References. (line 110) +* constants.el: Cooperation. (line 12) +* constcgs, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 146) +* constSI, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 146) +* content, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 74) +* content, STARTUP keyword: Initial visibility. (line 6) +* contents, global visibility state: Global and local cycling. + (line 18) +* context-sensitive commands, hooks: Context-sensitive commands. + (line 6) +* continuous clocking: Resolving idle time. (line 78) +* convert: Configuring a document converter. + (line 6) +* converter: Configuring a document converter. + (line 6) +* coordinates, of field: References. (line 86) +* copying notes: Refile and copy. (line 6) +* copying, of subtrees: Structure editing. (line 6) +* countdown timer: Timers. (line 6) +* counter, macro: Macro replacement. (line 55) +* creating timestamps: Creating timestamps. (line 6) +* CSS, for HTML export: CSS support. (line 6) +* CUA.el: Conflicts. (line 18) +* custom agenda views: Custom agenda views. (line 6) +* custom date/time format: Custom time format. (line 6) +* custom search strings: Custom searches. (line 6) +* customization: Customization. (line 6) +* customtime, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 142) +* cutting, of subtrees: Structure editing. (line 6) +* cycling, in plain lists: Plain lists. (line 69) +* cycling, of agenda files: Agenda files. (line 22) +* cycling, of TODO states: TODO basics. (line 14) +* cycling, visibility: Visibility cycling. (line 6) +* daily agenda: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 6) +* dash, special symbol: Special symbols. (line 39) +* data type index, in Texinfo export: Indices. (line 6) +* date format, custom: Custom time format. (line 6) +* date range: Timestamps. (line 42) +* date stamp: Dates and times. (line 6) +* date stamps: Timestamps. (line 6) +* date tree: Using capture. (line 9) +* date, macro: Macro replacement. (line 29) +* date, reading in minibuffer: The date/time prompt. + (line 6) +* dates: Dates and times. (line 6) +* Davison, Dan: Working with source code. + (line 6) +* DEADLINE keyword: Deadlines and scheduling. + (line 11) +* deadlines: Timestamps. (line 6) +* debugging, of table formulas: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 132) +* defining new protocols: Protocols. (line 25) +* demotion, of subtrees: Structure editing. (line 6) +* dependencies, of TODO states: TODO dependencies. (line 6) +* diary entries, creating from agenda: Agenda commands. (line 459) +* diary integration: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 32) +* dictionary word completion: Completion. (line 6) +* dir file, in Texinfo export: Info directory file. (line 6) +* directories, for publishing: Sources and destinations. + (line 6) +* dispatching agenda commands: Agenda dispatcher. (line 6) +* display changing, in agenda: Agenda commands. (line 69) +* doc, docx, rtf: Configuring a document converter. + (line 6) +* document structure: Document structure. (line 6) +* document title: Export settings. (line 60) +* Dominik, Carsten: Cooperation. (line 12) +* DONE, final TODO keyword: Per-file keywords. (line 26) +* dragging, agenda lines: Agenda commands. (line 353) +* drawer, for properties: Property syntax. (line 6) +* drawer, for state change recording: Tracking TODO state changes. + (line 6) +* drawers: Drawers. (line 6) +* Duration, computing: Durations and time values. + (line 6) +* dvipng <1>: Working with LaTeX math snippets. + (line 48) +* dvipng: Math formatting in HTML export. + (line 6) +* dvisvgm <1>: Working with LaTeX math snippets. + (line 48) +* dvisvgm: Math formatting in HTML export. + (line 6) +* dynamic blocks: Dynamic blocks. (line 6) +* dynamic indentation: Clean view. (line 6) +* ecomplete.el: Conflicts. (line 33) +* editing tables: Tables. (line 6) +* editing, of table formulas: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 6) +* edits, catching invisible: Catching invisible edits. + (line 6) +* effort estimates: Effort estimates. (line 6) +* effort filtering, in agenda: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 17) +* Elisp links: External links. (line 6) +* ellipsis, special symbol: Special symbols. (line 39) +* ELPA: Activation. (line 6) +* email, macro: Macro replacement. (line 24) +* embedding images in ODT: Images in ODT export. + (line 6) +* entitiesplain, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 169) +* entitiespretty, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 169) +* entitiespretty, STARTUP keyword: Special symbols. (line 34) +* escaping characters: Special symbols. (line 27) +* evaluate time range: Creating timestamps. (line 62) +* even, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 132) +* example blocks, in LaTeX export: Example blocks in LaTeX export. + (line 6) +* export back-end: Exporting. (line 12) +* export back-ends, built-in: Other built-in back-ends. + (line 6) +* Export, dispatcher: The export dispatcher. + (line 6) +* export, OpenDocument: OpenDocument Text export. + (line 6) +* Export, settings: Export settings. (line 6) +* Export, writing back-ends: Adding export back-ends. + (line 6) +* exporting: Exporting. (line 6) +* exporting agenda views <1>: Exporting agenda views. + (line 13) +* exporting agenda views: Agenda commands. (line 505) +* exporting, not: Comment lines. (line 6) +* extended TODO keywords: TODO extensions. (line 6) +* external archiving: Moving subtrees. (line 6) +* external links: External links. (line 6) +* external links, in HTML export: Links in HTML export. + (line 6) +* faces, for TODO keywords: Faces for TODO keywords. + (line 6) +* FAQ: Summary. (line 49) +* feedback: Feedback. (line 6) +* field coordinates: References. (line 86) +* field formula: Field and range formulas. + (line 6) +* field references: References. (line 15) +* file links: External links. (line 6) +* file links, searching: Search options. (line 6) +* file name completion: Handling links. (line 89) +* files for agenda: Agenda files. (line 6) +* files, adding to agenda list: Agenda files. (line 15) +* files, selecting for publishing: Selecting files. (line 6) +* filladapt.el: Conflicts. (line 44) +* filtering, by tag, category, top headline and effort, in agenda: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 17) +* Filters, exporting: Advanced configuration. + (line 32) +* fnadjust, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 152) +* fnauto, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 152) +* fnconfirm, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 152) +* fninline, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 152) +* fnlocal, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 152) +* fnplain, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 152) +* fnprompt, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 152) +* folded, subtree visibility state: Global and local cycling. + (line 10) +* folding, sparse trees: Sparse trees. (line 6) +* following links: Handling links. (line 101) +* footnotes: Footnotes. (line 6) +* format specifier: Formula syntax for Calc. + (line 14) +* format, of links: Link format. (line 6) +* formatting source code, markup rules: Literal examples. (line 23) +* formula debugging: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 132) +* formula editing: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 6) +* formula syntax, Calc: Formula syntax for Calc. + (line 6) +* formula, for individual table field: Field and range formulas. + (line 6) +* formula, for range of fields: Field and range formulas. + (line 6) +* formula, for table column: Column formulas. (line 6) +* formula, in tables: Built-in table editor. + (line 162) +* function index, in Texinfo export: Indices. (line 6) +* Gillespie, Dave: Cooperation. (line 6) +* global cycling: Global and local cycling. + (line 18) +* global key bindings: Activation. (line 6) +* global TODO list: Global TODO list. (line 6) +* global visibility states: Global and local cycling. + (line 18) +* Gnus links: External links. (line 6) +* graph, in tables: Org-Plot. (line 6) +* group tags: Tag hierarchy. (line 6) +* group tags, as regular expressions: Matching tags and properties. + (line 65) +* grouping columns in tables: Column groups. (line 6) +* habits: Tracking your habits. + (line 6) +* hacking: Hacking. (line 6) +* handle rewritten URL in open-source protocol: open-source protocol. + (line 32) +* header, for LaTeX files: LaTeX header and sectioning. + (line 6) +* headline navigation: Motion. (line 6) +* headline tagging: Tags. (line 6) +* headline, promotion and demotion: Structure editing. (line 6) +* headlines: Headlines. (line 6) +* hide text: Visibility cycling. (line 6) +* hideblocks, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 164) +* hideblocks, STARTUP keyword: Blocks. (line 13) +* hidestars, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 132) +* hiding leading stars: Clean view. (line 6) +* history: History and acknowledgments. + (line 6) +* hooks: Hooks. (line 6) +* horizontal rules, in ASCII export: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. + (line 68) +* horizontal rules, in LaTeX export: Horizontal rules in LaTeX export. + (line 6) +* horizontal rules, markup rules: Horizontal rules. (line 6) +* HTML entities: Special symbols. (line 6) +* HTML export: HTML export. (line 6) +* HTML export, CSS: CSS support. (line 6) +* HTML, and Orgtbl mode: Translator functions. + (line 6) +* HTML5, export new elements: HTML doctypes. (line 33) +* hyperlinks: Hyperlinks. (line 6) +* hyperlinks, adding new types: Adding hyperlink types. + (line 6) +* iCalendar export: iCalendar export. (line 6) +* identify, ImageMagick: Images in ODT export. + (line 34) +* idle, resolve, dangling: Resolving idle time. (line 9) +* image, centering (LaTeX export): Images in LaTeX export. + (line 50) +* imagemagick <1>: Working with LaTeX math snippets. + (line 48) +* imagemagick: Math formatting in HTML export. + (line 6) +* images, embedding in ODT: Images in ODT export. + (line 6) +* images, inline in HTML: Images in HTML export. + (line 6) +* images, inline in LaTeX: Images in LaTeX export. + (line 6) +* images, inlining: Handling links. (line 136) +* imenu.el: Cooperation. (line 25) +* in-buffer settings: In-buffer settings. (line 6) +* inactive timestamp: Timestamps. (line 51) +* include files, during export: Include files. (line 6) +* indent, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 79) +* indentation, in source blocks <1>: Editing source code. (line 38) +* indentation, in source blocks: Literal examples. (line 72) +* index, in a publishing project: Generating an index. (line 6) +* Info directory file, in Texinfo export: Info directory file. + (line 6) +* Info links: External links. (line 6) +* inheritance, of properties: Property inheritance. + (line 6) +* inheritance, of tags: Tag inheritance. (line 6) +* inline, in LaTeX export: Quoting LaTeX code. (line 10) +* inlined images, markup rules: Images and tables. (line 22) +* inlineimages, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 93) +* inlineimages, STARTUP keyword: Handling links. (line 136) +* inlining images: Handling links. (line 136) +* inlining images in HTML: Images in HTML export. + (line 6) +* inlining images in LaTeX: Images in LaTeX export. + (line 6) +* input file, macro: Macro replacement. (line 44) +* inserting links: Handling links. (line 66) +* insertion, of templates: Easy templates. (line 6) +* install-info parameters, in Texinfo export: Info directory file. + (line 6) +* installation: Installation. (line 6) +* Installing Org protocol: Protocols. (line 14) +* internal links: Internal links. (line 6) +* internal links, in HTML export: Links in HTML export. + (line 6) +* introduction: Introduction. (line 6) +* iPhone: MobileOrg. (line 6) +* IRC links: External links. (line 6) +* italic text, markup rules: Emphasis and monospace. + (line 6) +* jumping, to headlines: Motion. (line 6) +* key bindings, global: Activation. (line 6) +* keystroke index, in Texinfo export: Indices. (line 6) +* keyword options: Per-file keywords. (line 6) +* LaTeX class: LaTeX header and sectioning. + (line 6) +* LaTeX entities: Special symbols. (line 6) +* LaTeX export: LaTeX export. (line 6) +* LaTeX fragments: LaTeX fragments. (line 6) +* LaTeX fragments, preview: Previewing LaTeX fragments. + (line 6) +* LaTeX header: LaTeX header and sectioning. + (line 6) +* LaTeX interpretation: Embedded LaTeX. (line 6) +* LaTeX sectioning structure: LaTeX header and sectioning. + (line 6) +* LaTeX, and Orgtbl mode: A LaTeX example. (line 6) +* latexpreview, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 100) +* Latin-1 export: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. + (line 6) +* level, require for tags/property match: Matching tags and properties. + (line 72) +* LibreOffice <1>: Extending ODT export. + (line 12) +* LibreOffice: OpenDocument Text export. + (line 6) +* limits, in agenda: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 118) +* link abbreviations: Link abbreviations. (line 6) +* link abbreviations, completion of: Completion. (line 6) +* link completion: Handling links. (line 66) +* link format: Link format. (line 6) +* links, external: External links. (line 6) +* links, finding next/previous: Handling links. (line 156) +* links, handling: Handling links. (line 6) +* links, in HTML export: Links in HTML export. + (line 6) +* links, in ODT export: Links in ODT export. (line 6) +* links, internal: Internal links. (line 6) +* links, publishing: Publishing links. (line 6) +* links, radio targets: Radio targets. (line 6) +* links, returning to: Handling links. (line 149) +* linter: Org syntax. (line 24) +* Lisp forms, as table formulas: Formula syntax for Lisp. + (line 6) +* list of listings: Table of contents. (line 6) +* list of tables: Table of contents. (line 6) +* lists, in other modes: Tables in arbitrary syntax. + (line 6) +* lists, ordered: Plain lists. (line 6) +* lists, plain: Plain lists. (line 6) +* literal examples, markup rules: Literal examples. (line 6) +* logdone, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* logdrawer, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* logging, of progress: Progress logging. (line 6) +* lognoteclock-out, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* lognotedone, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* lognoteredeadline, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* lognoterefile, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* lognoterepeat, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* lognotereschedule, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* logredeadline, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* logrefile, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* logrepeat, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* logreschedule, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* logstatesreversed, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* lookup functions in tables: Lookup functions. (line 6) +* Ludlam, Eric M.: Cooperation. (line 34) +* macro replacement, during export: Macro replacement. (line 6) +* maintainer: Feedback. (line 6) +* mapping entries, API: Using the mapping API. + (line 6) +* mark ring: Handling links. (line 145) +* Markdown export: Markdown export. (line 6) +* marking characters, tables: Advanced features. (line 39) +* match view: Matching tags and properties. + (line 6) +* matching, of properties: Matching tags and properties. + (line 6) +* matching, of tags: Matching tags and properties. + (line 6) +* matching, tags: Tags. (line 6) +* math symbols: Special symbols. (line 6) +* MathJax: Math formatting in HTML export. + (line 6) +* MathML: Working with LaTeX math snippets. + (line 9) +* MH-E links: External links. (line 6) +* minor mode for structure editing: Orgstruct mode. (line 6) +* minor mode for tables: Orgtbl mode. (line 6) +* MobileOrg: MobileOrg. (line 6) +* mode, for calc: Formula syntax for Calc. + (line 14) +* modification time, macro: Macro replacement. (line 36) +* motion commands in agenda: Agenda commands. (line 19) +* motion, between headlines: Motion. (line 6) +* Multiple entries in two-column tables, in Texinfo export: Plain lists in Texinfo export. + (line 17) +* n, macro: Macro replacement. (line 55) +* name, of column or field: References. (line 110) +* named references: References. (line 110) +* names as TODO keywords: TODO types. (line 6) +* narrow columns in tables: Column width and alignment. + (line 6) +* noalign, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 88) +* nofnadjust, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 152) +* nofninline, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 152) +* nohideblocks, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 164) +* nohideblocks, STARTUP keyword: Blocks. (line 13) +* noindent, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 79) +* noinlineimages, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 93) +* noinlineimages, STARTUP keyword: Handling links. (line 136) +* nolatexpreview, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 100) +* nologdone, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* nologdrawer, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* nolognoteclock-out, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* nologredeadline, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* nologrefile, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* nologrepeat, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* nologreschedule, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* nologstatesreversed, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 106) +* occur, command: Sparse trees. (line 6) +* occur-tree: Storing searches. (line 9) +* odd, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 132) +* odd-levels-only outlines: Clean view. (line 6) +* ODT: OpenDocument Text export. + (line 6) +* ODT_STYLES_FILE: ODT specific export settings. + (line 22) +* open-source protocol: open-source protocol. + (line 6) +* OpenDocument: OpenDocument Text export. + (line 6) +* option keyword completion: Completion. (line 6) +* options, for custom agenda views: Setting options. (line 6) +* options, for customization: Customization. (line 6) +* options, for publishing: Publishing options. (line 6) +* ordered lists: Plain lists. (line 6) +* Org entities: Special symbols. (line 6) +* Org export: Org export. (line 6) +* Org mode, turning on: Activation. (line 21) +* Org protocol, set-up: Protocols. (line 14) +* Org syntax: Org syntax. (line 6) +* org-agenda, command: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 9) +* org-capture-last-stored: Using capture. (line 50) +* org-crypt.el: org-crypt. (line 6) +* org-decrypt-entry: org-crypt. (line 6) +* org-hide-block-startup: In-buffer settings. (line 163) +* org-insert-drawer <1>: Property syntax. (line 90) +* org-insert-drawer: Drawers. (line 6) +* org-list-insert-radio-list: Radio lists. (line 6) +* org-pretty-entities: In-buffer settings. (line 168) +* org-publish-project-alist: Project alist. (line 6) +* Orgstruct mode: Orgstruct mode. (line 6) +* Orgtbl mode <1>: Tables in arbitrary syntax. + (line 6) +* Orgtbl mode: Orgtbl mode. (line 6) +* Ota, Takaaki: Cooperation. (line 41) +* Outline mode: Outlines. (line 6) +* outline tree: Headlines. (line 6) +* outlines: Outlines. (line 6) +* overview, global visibility state: Global and local cycling. + (line 18) +* overview, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 74) +* overview, STARTUP keyword: Initial visibility. (line 6) +* packages, interaction with other: Interaction. (line 6) +* paragraphs, markup rules: Paragraphs. (line 6) +* pasting, of subtrees: Structure editing. (line 6) +* PDF export: LaTeX export. (line 6) +* per-file keywords: Per-file keywords. (line 6) +* plain lists: Plain lists. (line 6) +* plain lists, in LaTeX export: Plain lists in LaTeX export. + (line 6) +* plain text external links: External links. (line 68) +* plot tables using Gnuplot: Org-Plot. (line 6) +* presentation, of agenda items: Presentation and sorting. + (line 6) +* print edition: Summary. (line 52) +* printing sparse trees: Sparse trees. (line 53) +* priorities: Priorities. (line 6) +* priorities, of agenda items: Sorting agenda items. + (line 6) +* program index, in Texinfo export: Indices. (line 6) +* progress logging: Progress logging. (line 6) +* projects, for publishing: Project alist. (line 6) +* promotion, of subtrees: Structure editing. (line 6) +* proof, in LaTeX export: Special blocks in LaTeX export. + (line 6) +* properties: Properties and columns. + (line 6) +* properties, API <1>: Using the property API. + (line 6) +* properties, API: Property API. (line 6) +* properties, column view: Defining columns. (line 6) +* properties, inheritance: Property inheritance. + (line 6) +* properties, searching: Property searches. (line 6) +* properties, special: Special properties. (line 6) +* property EXPORT_FILE_NAME: ODT export commands. (line 7) +* property syntax: Property syntax. (line 6) +* property, +: Property syntax. (line 52) +* property, _ALL: Property syntax. (line 44) +* property, ALT_TITLE: Table of contents. (line 41) +* property, APPENDIX: Headings and sectioning structure. + (line 20) +* property, ARCHIVE <1>: Moving subtrees. (line 37) +* property, ARCHIVE: Property inheritance. + (line 34) +* property, ATTACH_DIR: Attachments. (line 74) +* property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT: Attachments. (line 79) +* property, BEAMER_ACT: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer. + (line 41) +* property, BEAMER_COL: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer. + (line 49) +* property, BEAMER_ENV: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer. + (line 14) +* property, BEAMER_OPT: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer. + (line 41) +* property, BEAMER_REF: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer. + (line 27) +* property, CATEGORY <1>: Categories. (line 12) +* property, CATEGORY: Property inheritance. + (line 30) +* property, COLUMNS <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 26) +* property, COLUMNS: Property inheritance. + (line 22) +* property, COOKIE_DATA <1>: Checkboxes. (line 30) +* property, COOKIE_DATA: Breaking down tasks. (line 21) +* property, COPYING: Texinfo title and copyright page. + (line 19) +* property, CUSTOM_ID <1>: Handling links. (line 21) +* property, CUSTOM_ID: Internal links. (line 6) +* property, DESCRIPTION <1>: iCalendar export. (line 51) +* property, DESCRIPTION: Headings and sectioning structure. + (line 24) +* property, Effort: Effort estimates. (line 6) +* property, EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS: LaTeX header and sectioning. + (line 23) +* property, EXPORT_LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS: LaTeX header and sectioning. + (line 23) +* property, ID <1>: iCalendar export. (line 26) +* property, ID <2>: Capturing column view. + (line 22) +* property, ID: Handling links. (line 21) +* property, INDEX: Indices. (line 14) +* property, LOCATION: iCalendar export. (line 51) +* property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER <1>: Clocking commands. (line 7) +* property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER: Tracking TODO state changes. + (line 6) +* property, LOGGING <1>: Property inheritance. + (line 38) +* property, LOGGING: Tracking TODO state changes. + (line 45) +* property, macro: Macro replacement. (line 48) +* property, ORDERED <1>: Checkboxes. (line 46) +* property, ORDERED: TODO dependencies. (line 6) +* property, special, ALLTAGS: Special properties. (line 13) +* property, special, BLOCKED: Special properties. (line 13) +* property, special, CLOCKSUM <1>: Agenda column view. (line 28) +* property, special, CLOCKSUM: Special properties. (line 13) +* property, special, CLOCKSUM_T <1>: Agenda column view. (line 51) +* property, special, CLOCKSUM_T: Special properties. (line 13) +* property, special, CLOSED: Special properties. (line 13) +* property, special, DEADLINE: Special properties. (line 13) +* property, special, FILE: Special properties. (line 13) +* property, special, ITEM: Special properties. (line 13) +* property, special, PRIORITY: Special properties. (line 13) +* property, special, SCHEDULED: Special properties. (line 13) +* property, special, TAGS: Special properties. (line 13) +* property, special, TIMESTAMP: Special properties. (line 13) +* property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA: Special properties. (line 13) +* property, special, TODO: Special properties. (line 13) +* property, SUMMARY: iCalendar export. (line 51) +* property, TIMEZONE: iCalendar export. (line 51) +* property, UNNUMBERED: Export settings. (line 149) +* property, VISIBILITY: Initial visibility. (line 17) +* property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL: Clocking commands. (line 20) +* property: LAST_REPEAT: Clocking commands. (line 20) +* protocol, capture: capture protocol. (line 6) +* protocol, new protocol: Protocols. (line 25) +* protocol, open-source: open-source protocol. + (line 6) +* protocol, open-source rewritten URL: open-source protocol. + (line 32) +* protocol, open-source, :base-url property: open-source protocol. + (line 13) +* protocol, open-source, :online-suffix property: open-source protocol. + (line 13) +* protocol, open-source, :rewrites property: open-source protocol. + (line 43) +* protocol, open-source, :working-directory property: open-source protocol. + (line 13) +* protocol, open-source, :working-suffix property: open-source protocol. + (line 13) +* protocol, open-source, set-up mapping: open-source protocol. + (line 67) +* protocol, store-link: store-link protocol. (line 6) +* protocols, for external access: Protocols. (line 6) +* publishing: Publishing. (line 6) +* query editing, in agenda: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 17) +* quote blocks: Paragraphs. (line 26) +* radio lists: Radio lists. (line 6) +* radio tables: Radio tables. (line 6) +* radio targets: Radio targets. (line 6) +* range formula: Field and range formulas. + (line 6) +* range references: References. (line 63) +* ranges, time: Timestamps. (line 6) +* recomputing table fields: Updating the table. (line 6) +* references: References. (line 6) +* references, named: References. (line 110) +* references, remote: References. (line 131) +* references, to a different table: References. (line 131) +* references, to fields: References. (line 15) +* references, to ranges: References. (line 63) +* refiling notes: Refile and copy. (line 6) +* region, active <1>: ODT export commands. (line 6) +* region, active <2>: Built-in table editor. + (line 162) +* region, active: Structure editing. (line 139) +* regular expressions, with tags search: Matching tags and properties. + (line 61) +* relative timer: Timers. (line 6) +* reminders: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 126) +* remote editing, bulk, from agenda: Agenda commands. (line 364) +* remote editing, from agenda: Agenda commands. (line 227) +* remote editing, undo: Agenda commands. (line 228) +* remote references: References. (line 131) +* repeated tasks: Repeated tasks. (line 6) +* report, of clocked time: The clock table. (line 6) +* resolve idle time: Resolving idle time. (line 9) +* revealing context: Global and local cycling. + (line 38) +* RMAIL links: External links. (line 6) +* Rose, Sebastian: JavaScript support. (line 6) +* row, of field coordinates: References. (line 86) +* RSS feeds: RSS feeds. (line 6) +* rsync: Uploading files. (line 6) +* SCHEDULED keyword: Deadlines and scheduling. + (line 31) +* scheduling: Timestamps. (line 6) +* Schulte, Eric: Working with source code. + (line 6) +* Scripts, for agenda processing: Extracting agenda information. + (line 6) +* search option in file links: Search options. (line 6) +* search strings, custom: Custom searches. (line 6) +* search view: Search view. (line 6) +* searching for tags: Tag searches. (line 6) +* searching, for text: Search view. (line 6) +* searching, of properties: Property searches. (line 6) +* sectioning structure, for LaTeX export: LaTeX header and sectioning. + (line 6) +* set startup visibility, command: Global and local cycling. + (line 33) +* set-up mappings in open-source protocol: open-source protocol. + (line 67) +* setting tags: Setting tags. (line 6) +* SHELL links: External links. (line 6) +* shift-selection-mode <1>: Conflicts. (line 6) +* shift-selection-mode: Plain lists. (line 94) +* show all, command: Global and local cycling. + (line 35) +* show all, global visibility state: Global and local cycling. + (line 18) +* show branches, command: Global and local cycling. + (line 47) +* show children, command: Global and local cycling. + (line 51) +* show hidden text: Visibility cycling. (line 6) +* showall, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 74) +* showall, STARTUP keyword: Initial visibility. (line 6) +* showeverything, STARTUP keyword <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 74) +* showeverything, STARTUP keyword: Initial visibility. (line 6) +* showstars, STARTUP keyword: In-buffer settings. (line 132) +* shy hyphen, special symbol: Special symbols. (line 39) +* sitemap, of published pages: Sitemap. (line 6) +* sorting, of agenda items: Sorting agenda items. + (line 6) +* sorting, of plain list: Plain lists. (line 154) +* sorting, of subtrees: Structure editing. (line 6) +* source blocks, in LaTeX export: Source blocks in LaTeX export. + (line 6) +* source code, batch execution: Batch execution. (line 6) +* source code, block header arguments: Header arguments. (line 6) +* source code, block structure: Structure of code blocks. + (line 6) +* source code, editing: Editing source code. (line 6) +* source code, evaluating: Evaluating code blocks. + (line 6) +* source code, exporting: Exporting code blocks. + (line 6) +* source code, extracting: Extracting source code. + (line 6) +* source code, inline: Structure of code blocks. + (line 24) +* source code, language: Structure of code blocks. + (line 51) +* source code, languages: Languages. (line 6) +* source code, library: Library of Babel. (line 6) +* source code, noweb reference: Noweb reference syntax. + (line 6) +* source code, results of evaluation: Results of evaluation. + (line 6) +* source code, switches: Structure of code blocks. + (line 56) +* source code, working with: Working with source code. + (line 6) +* sparse tree, for deadlines: Inserting deadline/schedule. + (line 24) +* sparse tree, for TODO: TODO basics. (line 41) +* sparse tree, tag based: Tags. (line 6) +* sparse trees: Sparse trees. (line 6) +* special blocks, in ASCII export: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. + (line 78) +* special blocks, in LaTeX export: Special blocks in LaTeX export. + (line 6) +* special keywords: In-buffer settings. (line 6) +* special symbols: Special symbols. (line 6) +* special symbols, in-buffer display: Special symbols. (line 31) +* speed keys: Speed keys. (line 6) +* speedbar.el: Cooperation. (line 34) +* spreadsheet capabilities: The spreadsheet. (line 6) +* square brackets, around links: External links. (line 68) +* statistics, for checkboxes: Checkboxes. (line 30) +* statistics, for TODO items: Breaking down tasks. (line 6) +* store-link protocol: store-link protocol. (line 6) +* storing links: Handling links. (line 10) +* Storm, Kim. F.: Conflicts. (line 18) +* strike-through text, markup rules: Emphasis and monospace. + (line 6) +* structure editing: Structure editing. (line 6) +* structure of document: Document structure. (line 6) +* styles, custom <1>: Working with OpenDocument style files. + (line 6) +* styles, custom: Applying custom styles. + (line 6) +* sublevels, inclusion into tags match: Tag inheritance. (line 6) +* sublevels, inclusion into TODO list: Global TODO list. (line 35) +* subscript: Subscripts and superscripts. + (line 6) +* SUBTITLE (ODT): ODT specific export settings. + (line 26) +* subtree cycling: Global and local cycling. + (line 10) +* subtree visibility states: Global and local cycling. + (line 10) +* subtree, cut and paste: Structure editing. (line 6) +* subtree, subtree visibility state: Global and local cycling. + (line 10) +* subtrees, cut and paste: Structure editing. (line 6) +* summary: Summary. (line 6) +* superscript: Subscripts and superscripts. + (line 6) +* syntax checker: Org syntax. (line 24) +* syntax, noweb: Noweb reference syntax. + (line 6) +* syntax, of formulas: Formula syntax for Calc. + (line 6) +* table editor, built-in: Built-in table editor. + (line 6) +* table editor, table.el: Cooperation. (line 41) +* table lookup functions: Lookup functions. (line 6) +* table of contents: Table of contents. (line 6) +* table.el: Cooperation. (line 38) +* tables: Tables. (line 6) +* tables, in HTML: Tables in HTML export. + (line 6) +* tables, in LaTeX export: Tables in LaTeX export. + (line 6) +* tables, in ODT export <1>: Customizing tables in ODT export. + (line 6) +* tables, in ODT export: Tables in ODT export. + (line 6) +* tables, in other modes: Tables in arbitrary syntax. + (line 6) +* tables, markup rules: Images and tables. (line 6) +* tag completion: Completion. (line 6) +* tag filtering, in agenda: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 17) +* tag hierarchy: Tag hierarchy. (line 6) +* tag inheritance: Tag inheritance. (line 6) +* tag searches: Tag searches. (line 6) +* tags: Tags. (line 6) +* tags view: Matching tags and properties. + (line 6) +* tags, as an agenda view: Storing searches. (line 9) +* tags, groups: Tag hierarchy. (line 6) +* tags, setting: Setting tags. (line 6) +* tags-todo: Storing searches. (line 9) +* tags-tree: Storing searches. (line 9) +* tangling: Extracting source code. + (line 6) +* targets, for links: Internal links. (line 6) +* targets, radio: Radio targets. (line 6) +* tasks, breaking down: Breaking down tasks. (line 6) +* tasks, repeated: Repeated tasks. (line 6) +* template insertion: Easy templates. (line 6) +* template, custom <1>: Working with OpenDocument style files. + (line 6) +* template, custom: Applying custom styles. + (line 6) +* templates, for Capture: Capture templates. (line 6) +* TeX interpretation: Embedded LaTeX. (line 6) +* TeX symbol completion: Completion. (line 6) +* Texinfo export: Texinfo export. (line 6) +* Texinfo export, data type index: Indices. (line 6) +* Texinfo export, dir file: Info directory file. (line 6) +* Texinfo export, index, concept: Indices. (line 6) +* Texinfo export, index, function: Indices. (line 6) +* Texinfo export, Info directory file: Info directory file. (line 6) +* Texinfo export, install-info parameters: Info directory file. + (line 6) +* Texinfo export, keystroke index: Indices. (line 6) +* Texinfo export, program index: Indices. (line 6) +* Texinfo export, Top node: Headings and sectioning structure. + (line 37) +* Texinfo export, variable index: Indices. (line 6) +* text areas, in HTML: Text areas in HTML export. + (line 6) +* text search: Search view. (line 6) +* thanks: History and acknowledgments. + (line 6) +* The Top node, in Texinfo export: Headings and sectioning structure. + (line 37) +* time clocking: Clocking work time. (line 6) +* time format, custom: Custom time format. (line 6) +* time grid: Time-of-day specifications. + (line 26) +* Time, computing: Durations and time values. + (line 6) +* time, macro: Macro replacement. (line 36) +* time, reading in minibuffer: The date/time prompt. + (line 6) +* time-of-day specification: Time-of-day specifications. + (line 6) +* timerange: Timestamps. (line 42) +* times: Dates and times. (line 6) +* timestamp <1>: Timestamps. (line 14) +* timestamp: Dates and times. (line 6) +* timestamp, inactive: Timestamps. (line 51) +* timestamp, with repeater interval: Timestamps. (line 25) +* timestamps: Timestamps. (line 6) +* timestamps, creating: Creating timestamps. (line 6) +* title, macro: Macro replacement. (line 24) +* TODO dependencies: TODO dependencies. (line 6) +* TODO dependencies, NOBLOCKING: TODO dependencies. (line 6) +* TODO items: TODO items. (line 6) +* TODO keyword matching: Global TODO list. (line 18) +* TODO keyword matching, with tags search: Matching tags and properties. + (line 72) +* TODO keyword sets: Multiple sets in one file. + (line 6) +* TODO keywords completion: Completion. (line 6) +* TODO list, global: Global TODO list. (line 6) +* TODO types: TODO types. (line 6) +* TODO workflow: Workflow states. (line 6) +* todo, as an agenda view: Storing searches. (line 9) +* todo-tree: Storing searches. (line 9) +* top headline filtering, in agenda: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 17) +* transient mark mode <1>: Built-in table editor. + (line 162) +* transient mark mode: Structure editing. (line 139) +* transient-mark-mode: ODT export commands. (line 6) +* translator function: Translator functions. + (line 6) +* trees, sparse: Sparse trees. (line 6) +* trees, visibility: Visibility cycling. (line 6) +* tty key bindings: TTY keys. (line 6) +* Two-column tables, in Texinfo export: Plain lists in Texinfo export. + (line 6) +* types as TODO keywords: TODO types. (line 6) +* underlined text, markup rules: Emphasis and monospace. + (line 6) +* undoing remote-editing events: Agenda commands. (line 228) +* unison: Uploading files. (line 6) +* unoconv: Extending ODT export. + (line 12) +* updating, table: Updating the table. (line 6) +* URL links: External links. (line 6) +* USENET links: External links. (line 6) +* UTF-8 export: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. + (line 6) +* variable index, in Texinfo export: Indices. (line 6) +* variables, for customization: Customization. (line 6) +* vectors, in table calculations: Formula syntax for Calc. + (line 11) +* verbatim blocks, in LaTeX export: Example blocks in LaTeX export. + (line 6) +* verbatim text, markup rules: Emphasis and monospace. + (line 6) +* verse blocks: Paragraphs. (line 13) +* viper.el: Conflicts. (line 91) +* visibility cycling: Visibility cycling. (line 6) +* visibility cycling, drawers: Drawers. (line 6) +* visibility, initialize: Initial visibility. (line 6) +* visible text, printing: Sparse trees. (line 53) +* VM links: External links. (line 41) +* WANDERLUST links: External links. (line 41) +* weekly agenda: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 6) +* windmove.el: Conflicts. (line 78) +* workflow states as TODO keywords: Workflow states. (line 6) +* yasnippet.el: Conflicts. (line 52) +* zip: Pre-requisites for ODT export. + (line 6) + + +File: org, Node: Key Index, Next: Command and Function Index, Prev: Main Index, Up: Top + +Key index +********* + + +* Menu: + +* $: Agenda commands. (line 262) +* %: Agenda commands. (line 381) +* ': CDLaTeX mode. (line 43) +* *: Agenda commands. (line 366) +* +: Agenda commands. (line 284) +* ,: Agenda commands. (line 276) +* -: Agenda commands. (line 289) +* .: Agenda commands. (line 102) +* / <1>: Agenda commands. (line 203) +* /: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 17) +* :: Agenda commands. (line 272) +* ;: Timers. (line 6) +* < <1>: Agenda commands. (line 207) +* < <2>: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 67) +* < <3>: Agenda files. (line 57) +* < <4>: The date/time prompt. + (line 82) +* <: Using column view. (line 71) +* <RET> <1>: Agenda commands. (line 42) +* <RET> <2>: The date/time prompt. + (line 82) +* <RET> <3>: Setting tags. (line 117) +* <RET> <4>: Handling links. (line 122) +* <RET>: Built-in table editor. + (line 69) +* <SPC> <1>: Agenda commands. (line 34) +* <SPC>: Setting tags. (line 114) +* <TAB> <1>: CDLaTeX mode. (line 23) +* <TAB> <2>: Agenda commands. (line 39) +* <TAB> <3>: Setting tags. (line 108) +* <TAB> <4>: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 57) +* <TAB> <5>: Plain lists. (line 68) +* <TAB> <6>: Structure editing. (line 35) +* <TAB>: Global and local cycling. + (line 10) +* = <1>: Agenda commands. (line 215) +* =: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 81) +* > <1>: Agenda commands. (line 325) +* > <2>: Agenda files. (line 61) +* > <3>: The date/time prompt. + (line 82) +* >: Using column view. (line 71) +* ?: Pulling from MobileOrg. + (line 28) +* [ <1>: Agenda commands. (line 126) +* [: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 57) +* ]: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 57) +* ^ <1>: CDLaTeX mode. (line 33) +* ^ <2>: Agenda commands. (line 211) +* ^: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 77) +* _ <1>: CDLaTeX mode. (line 33) +* _ <2>: Agenda commands. (line 218) +* _: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 91) +* `: CDLaTeX mode. (line 39) +* a: Agenda commands. (line 250) +* A: Agenda commands. (line 69) +* a: Using column view. (line 60) +* B: Agenda commands. (line 384) +* b: Agenda commands. (line 99) +* C: Agenda commands. (line 487) +* c: Agenda commands. (line 454) +* C-#: Advanced features. (line 10) +* C-': Agenda files. (line 22) +* C-,: Agenda files. (line 22) +* C-0 C-c C-w: Refile and copy. (line 47) +* C-<RET>: Structure editing. (line 23) +* C-_: Agenda commands. (line 228) +* C-c !: Creating timestamps. (line 15) +* C-c #: Checkboxes. (line 85) +* C-c $: Moving subtrees. (line 9) +* C-c %: Handling links. (line 142) +* C-c &: Handling links. (line 146) +* C-c ' <1>: Cooperation. (line 48) +* C-c ' <2>: Editing source code. (line 6) +* C-c ' <3>: Include files. (line 59) +* C-c ' <4>: Literal examples. (line 87) +* C-c ' <5>: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 36) +* C-c ': Footnotes. (line 85) +* C-c * <1>: Updating the table. (line 13) +* C-c * <2>: Plain lists. (line 139) +* C-c *: Structure editing. (line 128) +* C-c +: Built-in table editor. + (line 162) +* C-c ,: Priorities. (line 24) +* C-c - <1>: Built-in table editor. + (line 105) +* C-c -: Plain lists. (line 127) +* C-c .: Creating timestamps. (line 10) +* C-c / <1>: Conflicts. (line 91) +* C-c /: Sparse trees. (line 15) +* C-c / /: Sparse trees. (line 17) +* C-c / a: Inserting deadline/schedule. + (line 31) +* C-c / b: Inserting deadline/schedule. + (line 28) +* C-c / d: Inserting deadline/schedule. + (line 21) +* C-c / m <1>: Property searches. (line 10) +* C-c / m: Tag searches. (line 9) +* C-c / p: Property searches. (line 29) +* C-c / r: Sparse trees. (line 17) +* C-c / t: TODO basics. (line 38) +* C-c ;: Comment lines. (line 19) +* C-c <: Creating timestamps. (line 29) +* C-c <RET>: Built-in table editor. + (line 109) +* C-c <TAB>: Global and local cycling. + (line 51) +* C-c = <1>: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 13) +* C-c =: Column formulas. (line 32) +* C-c >: Creating timestamps. (line 33) +* C-c ?: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 22) +* C-c @: Structure editing. (line 65) +* C-c [: Agenda files. (line 15) +* C-c \ <1>: Property searches. (line 10) +* C-c \: Tag searches. (line 9) +* C-c ]: Agenda files. (line 19) +* C-c ^ <1>: Built-in table editor. + (line 113) +* C-c ^ <2>: Plain lists. (line 154) +* C-c ^: Structure editing. (line 107) +* C-c `: Built-in table editor. + (line 180) +* C-c a: Conventions. (line 35) +* C-c a !: Stuck projects. (line 14) +* C-c a #: Stuck projects. (line 13) +* C-c a ?: Pulling from MobileOrg. + (line 37) +* C-c a a: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 9) +* C-c a C: Storing searches. (line 9) +* C-c a e: Exporting agenda views. + (line 64) +* C-c a M: Matching tags and properties. + (line 17) +* C-c a m: Matching tags and properties. + (line 12) +* C-c a M: Property searches. (line 16) +* C-c a m: Property searches. (line 12) +* C-c a M: Tag searches. (line 17) +* C-c a m: Tag searches. (line 13) +* C-c a s: Search view. (line 9) +* C-c a T: Global TODO list. (line 15) +* C-c a t <1>: Global TODO list. (line 9) +* C-c a t: TODO basics. (line 49) +* C-c c <1>: Using capture. (line 6) +* C-c c: Conventions. (line 35) +* C-c c C: Capture templates. (line 10) +* C-c C-*: Plain lists. (line 144) +* C-c C-a <1>: Agenda commands. (line 297) +* C-c C-a: Attachments. (line 26) +* C-c C-a a: Attachments. (line 31) +* C-c C-a c: Attachments. (line 37) +* C-c C-a D: Attachments. (line 69) +* C-c C-a d: Attachments. (line 66) +* C-c C-a F: Attachments. (line 63) +* C-c C-a f: Attachments. (line 60) +* C-c C-a i: Attachments. (line 78) +* C-c C-a l: Attachments. (line 37) +* C-c C-a m: Attachments. (line 37) +* C-c C-a n: Attachments. (line 44) +* C-c C-a O: Attachments. (line 57) +* C-c C-a o: Attachments. (line 51) +* C-c C-a s: Attachments. (line 73) +* C-c C-a u: Attachments. (line 41) +* C-c C-a z: Attachments. (line 47) +* C-c C-b <1>: Editing support. (line 11) +* C-c C-b: Motion. (line 15) +* C-c C-c <1>: Cooperation. (line 41) +* C-c C-c <2>: The very busy C-c C-c key. + (line 6) +* C-c C-c <3>: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 11) +* C-c C-c <4>: Evaluating code blocks. + (line 20) +* C-c C-c <5>: Previewing LaTeX fragments. + (line 23) +* C-c C-c <6>: Using capture. (line 15) +* C-c C-c <7>: The clock table. (line 16) +* C-c C-c <8>: Clocking commands. (line 51) +* C-c C-c <9>: Creating timestamps. (line 26) +* C-c C-c <10>: Capturing column view. + (line 54) +* C-c C-c <11>: Using column view. (line 53) +* C-c C-c <12>: Property syntax. (line 92) +* C-c C-c <13>: Setting tags. (line 20) +* C-c C-c <14>: Checkboxes. (line 52) +* C-c C-c <15>: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 47) +* C-c C-c <16>: Built-in table editor. + (line 58) +* C-c C-c <17>: Footnotes. (line 74) +* C-c C-c: Plain lists. (line 122) +* C-c C-c c: Property syntax. (line 110) +* C-c C-c D: Property syntax. (line 107) +* C-c C-c d: Property syntax. (line 104) +* C-c C-c s: Property syntax. (line 96) +* C-c C-d <1>: Agenda commands. (line 304) +* C-c C-d: Inserting deadline/schedule. + (line 9) +* C-c C-e: The export dispatcher. + (line 15) +* C-c C-e c a: iCalendar export. (line 40) +* C-c C-e c c: iCalendar export. (line 44) +* C-c C-e c f: iCalendar export. (line 38) +* C-c C-e C-v: Sparse trees. (line 53) +* C-c C-e h H: HTML Export commands. + (line 11) +* C-c C-e h h: HTML Export commands. + (line 6) +* C-c C-e i i: Texinfo export commands. + (line 8) +* C-c C-e i t: Texinfo export commands. + (line 6) +* C-c C-e l B: Beamer export commands. + (line 8) +* C-c C-e l b: Beamer export commands. + (line 6) +* C-c C-e l L: LaTeX export commands. + (line 11) +* C-c C-e l l: LaTeX export commands. + (line 6) +* C-c C-e l p: LaTeX export commands. + (line 12) +* C-c C-e l P: Beamer export commands. + (line 11) +* C-c C-e m M: Markdown export. (line 18) +* C-c C-e m m: Markdown export. (line 16) +* C-c C-e O O: Org export. (line 17) +* C-c C-e O o: Org export. (line 13) +* C-c C-e o o: ODT export commands. (line 6) +* C-c C-e P a: Triggering publication. + (line 16) +* C-c C-e P f: Triggering publication. + (line 13) +* C-c C-e P p: Triggering publication. + (line 10) +* C-c C-e P x: Triggering publication. + (line 8) +* C-c C-e t A/L/U: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. + (line 27) +* C-c C-e t a/l/u: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. + (line 23) +* C-c C-f: Motion. (line 12) +* C-c C-j: Motion. (line 21) +* C-c C-k <1>: Using capture. (line 31) +* C-c C-k: Global and local cycling. + (line 47) +* C-c C-l: Handling links. (line 65) +* C-c C-n: Motion. (line 8) +* C-c C-o <1>: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 11) +* C-c C-o <2>: Agenda commands. (line 61) +* C-c C-o <3>: Creating timestamps. (line 38) +* C-c C-o <4>: Handling links. (line 101) +* C-c C-o: Footnotes. (line 78) +* C-c C-p: Motion. (line 9) +* C-c C-q <1>: Setting tags. (line 10) +* C-c C-q: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 50) +* C-c C-r <1>: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 53) +* C-c C-r: Global and local cycling. + (line 38) +* C-c C-s <1>: Agenda commands. (line 300) +* C-c C-s: Inserting deadline/schedule. + (line 16) +* C-c C-t <1>: Clocking commands. (line 67) +* C-c C-t: TODO basics. (line 13) +* C-c C-u: Motion. (line 18) +* C-c C-v a: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 36) +* C-c C-v b: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 25) +* C-c C-v c: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 30) +* C-c C-v C-a: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 36) +* C-c C-v C-b: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 25) +* C-c C-v C-c: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 30) +* C-c C-v C-d: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 27) +* C-c C-v C-e: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 19) +* C-c C-v C-f: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 29) +* C-c C-v C-g: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 23) +* C-c C-v C-h: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 37) +* C-c C-v C-I: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 34) +* C-c C-v C-i: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 33) +* C-c C-v C-j: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 31) +* C-c C-v C-l: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 32) +* C-c C-v C-n: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 18) +* C-c C-v C-o: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 20) +* C-c C-v C-p: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 18) +* C-c C-v C-r: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 24) +* C-c C-v C-s: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 26) +* C-c C-v C-t: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 28) +* C-c C-v C-u: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 22) +* C-c C-v C-v: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 21) +* C-c C-v C-x: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 38) +* C-c C-v C-z: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 35) +* C-c C-v d: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 27) +* C-c C-v e: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 19) +* C-c C-v f: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 29) +* C-c C-v g: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 23) +* C-c C-v h: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 37) +* C-c C-v I: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 34) +* C-c C-v i <1>: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 33) +* C-c C-v i: Library of Babel. (line 12) +* C-c C-v j: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 31) +* C-c C-v l: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 32) +* C-c C-v n: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 18) +* C-c C-v o: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 20) +* C-c C-v p: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 18) +* C-c C-v r: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 24) +* C-c C-v s: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 26) +* C-c C-v t <1>: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 28) +* C-c C-v t: Extracting source code. + (line 36) +* C-c C-v u: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 22) +* C-c C-v v: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 21) +* C-c C-v x: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 38) +* C-c C-v z: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 35) +* C-c C-w <1>: Agenda commands. (line 247) +* C-c C-w <2>: Refile and copy. (line 14) +* C-c C-w <3>: Using capture. (line 22) +* C-c C-w: Structure editing. (line 103) +* C-c C-x ,: Timers. (line 44) +* C-c C-x -: Timers. (line 35) +* C-c C-x .: Timers. (line 31) +* C-c C-x 0: Timers. (line 12) +* C-c C-x ;: Timers. (line 20) +* C-c C-x <: Agenda files. (line 42) +* C-c C-x > <1>: Agenda commands. (line 193) +* C-c C-x >: Agenda files. (line 49) +* C-c C-x \ <1>: Subscripts and superscripts. + (line 20) +* C-c C-x \: Special symbols. (line 34) +* C-c C-x _: Timers. (line 47) +* C-c C-x A: Agenda commands. (line 258) +* C-c C-x a: Agenda commands. (line 255) +* C-c C-x A: Internal archiving. (line 50) +* C-c C-x a: Internal archiving. (line 37) +* C-c C-x b <1>: Agenda commands. (line 52) +* C-c C-x b: Global and local cycling. + (line 55) +* C-c C-x c: Structure editing. (line 95) +* C-c C-x C-a <1>: Agenda commands. (line 250) +* C-c C-x C-a: Archiving. (line 11) +* C-c C-x C-b: Checkboxes. (line 56) +* C-c C-x C-c <1>: Agenda column view. (line 11) +* C-c C-x C-c <2>: Agenda commands. (line 182) +* C-c C-x C-c: Using column view. (line 9) +* C-c C-x C-d: Clocking commands. (line 80) +* C-c C-x C-e <1>: Effort estimates. (line 17) +* C-c C-x C-e: Clocking commands. (line 48) +* C-c C-x C-i: Clocking commands. (line 6) +* C-c C-x C-j: Clocking commands. (line 75) +* C-c C-x C-l: Previewing LaTeX fragments. + (line 17) +* C-c C-x C-n: Handling links. (line 152) +* C-c C-x C-o: Clocking commands. (line 34) +* C-c C-x C-p: Handling links. (line 152) +* C-c C-x C-q: Clocking commands. (line 71) +* C-c C-x C-r: The clock table. (line 10) +* C-c C-x C-s <1>: Agenda commands. (line 262) +* C-c C-x C-s: Moving subtrees. (line 9) +* C-c C-x C-t: Custom time format. (line 12) +* C-c C-x C-u <1>: Dynamic blocks. (line 21) +* C-c C-x C-u <2>: The clock table. (line 16) +* C-c C-x C-u: Capturing column view. + (line 54) +* C-c C-x C-v: Handling links. (line 133) +* C-c C-x C-w <1>: Built-in table editor. + (line 136) +* C-c C-x C-w: Structure editing. (line 69) +* C-c C-x C-x: Clocking commands. (line 42) +* C-c C-x C-y <1>: Built-in table editor. + (line 140) +* C-c C-x C-y: Structure editing. (line 77) +* C-c C-x d: Drawers. (line 6) +* C-c C-x e: Effort estimates. (line 14) +* C-c C-x f: Footnotes. (line 41) +* C-c C-x G: RSS feeds. (line 27) +* C-c C-x g: RSS feeds. (line 23) +* C-c C-x i: Capturing column view. + (line 52) +* C-c C-x M-w <1>: Built-in table editor. + (line 132) +* C-c C-x M-w: Structure editing. (line 73) +* C-c C-x o <1>: Checkboxes. (line 77) +* C-c C-x o: TODO dependencies. (line 37) +* C-c C-x p <1>: Header arguments in Org mode properties. + (line 31) +* C-c C-x p: Property syntax. (line 83) +* C-c C-x q: Tag hierarchy. (line 86) +* C-c C-x v: Global and local cycling. + (line 61) +* C-c C-y <1>: Clocking commands. (line 51) +* C-c C-y: Creating timestamps. (line 59) +* C-c C-z <1>: Agenda commands. (line 292) +* C-c C-z: Drawers. (line 35) +* C-c l <1>: Literal examples. (line 95) +* C-c l: Handling links. (line 9) +* C-c M-w: Refile and copy. (line 12) +* C-c SPC: Built-in table editor. + (line 59) +* C-c { <1>: CDLaTeX mode. (line 21) +* C-c {: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 32) +* C-c |: Built-in table editor. + (line 41) +* C-c }: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 26) +* C-c ~: Cooperation. (line 50) +* C-k: Agenda commands. (line 241) +* C-M-i: Completion. (line 47) +* C-S-<left> <1>: Agenda commands. (line 239) +* C-S-<left>: Multiple sets in one file. + (line 25) +* C-S-<RET>: Structure editing. (line 30) +* C-S-<right> <1>: Agenda commands. (line 236) +* C-S-<right>: Multiple sets in one file. + (line 25) +* C-S-<up/down>: Clocking commands. (line 56) +* C-TAB: Internal archiving. (line 47) +* C-u C-c !: Creating timestamps. (line 19) +* C-u C-c *: Updating the table. (line 16) +* C-u C-c .: Creating timestamps. (line 19) +* C-u C-c = <1>: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 13) +* C-u C-c =: Field and range formulas. + (line 27) +* C-u C-c c: Using capture. (line 43) +* C-u C-c C-c: Updating the table. (line 19) +* C-u C-c C-l: Handling links. (line 86) +* C-u C-c C-t: TODO basics. (line 27) +* C-u C-c C-w: Refile and copy. (line 33) +* C-u C-c C-x a: Internal archiving. (line 40) +* C-u C-c C-x C-s: Moving subtrees. (line 11) +* C-u C-c C-x C-u <1>: Dynamic blocks. (line 22) +* C-u C-c C-x C-u <2>: The clock table. (line 20) +* C-u C-c C-x C-u: Capturing column view. + (line 58) +* C-u C-u <TAB> <1>: Initial visibility. (line 21) +* C-u C-u <TAB>: Global and local cycling. + (line 33) +* C-u C-u C-c *: Updating the table. (line 22) +* C-u C-u C-c =: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 16) +* C-u C-u C-c c: Using capture. (line 45) +* C-u C-u C-c C-c: Updating the table. (line 22) +* C-u C-u C-c C-t: Multiple sets in one file. + (line 25) +* C-u C-u C-c C-w: Refile and copy. (line 36) +* C-u C-u C-c C-x C-s: Moving subtrees. (line 18) +* C-u C-u C-u <TAB>: Global and local cycling. + (line 35) +* C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t: TODO dependencies. (line 42) +* C-v: The date/time prompt. + (line 82) +* C-x C-s <1>: Agenda commands. (line 178) +* C-x C-s: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 47) +* C-x C-w <1>: Exporting agenda views. + (line 12) +* C-x C-w: Agenda commands. (line 504) +* C-x n b: Structure editing. (line 122) +* C-x n s: Structure editing. (line 119) +* C-x n w: Structure editing. (line 125) +* C-y: Structure editing. (line 83) +* D: Agenda commands. (line 111) +* d: Agenda commands. (line 74) +* E: Agenda commands. (line 156) +* e: Using column view. (line 47) +* f: Agenda commands. (line 93) +* F: Agenda commands. (line 45) +* g: Agenda commands. (line 175) +* G: Agenda commands. (line 164) +* g: Using column view. (line 24) +* H: Agenda commands. (line 491) +* i: Agenda commands. (line 459) +* I: Agenda commands. (line 330) +* J: Agenda commands. (line 108) +* j: Agenda commands. (line 105) +* k: Agenda commands. (line 343) +* l: Agenda commands. (line 115) +* L: Agenda commands. (line 36) +* M: Agenda commands. (line 478) +* m: Agenda commands. (line 364) +* M-*: Agenda commands. (line 378) +* M-<down> <1>: Agenda commands. (line 357) +* M-<down> <2>: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 77) +* M-<down> <3>: Built-in table editor. + (line 94) +* M-<down> <4>: Plain lists. (line 97) +* M-<down>: Structure editing. (line 56) +* M-<left> <1>: Built-in table editor. + (line 86) +* M-<left> <2>: Plain lists. (line 103) +* M-<left>: Structure editing. (line 41) +* M-<RET> <1>: Timers. (line 40) +* M-<RET> <2>: Built-in table editor. + (line 147) +* M-<RET> <3>: Plain lists. (line 79) +* M-<RET>: Structure editing. (line 6) +* M-<right> <1>: Built-in table editor. + (line 86) +* M-<right> <2>: Plain lists. (line 103) +* M-<right>: Structure editing. (line 44) +* M-<TAB> <1>: Completion. (line 15) +* M-<TAB> <2>: Property syntax. (line 80) +* M-<TAB> <3>: Setting tags. (line 6) +* M-<TAB> <4>: Per-file keywords. (line 23) +* M-<TAB>: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 64) +* M-<up> <1>: Agenda commands. (line 353) +* M-<up> <2>: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 77) +* M-<up> <3>: Built-in table editor. + (line 94) +* M-<up> <4>: Plain lists. (line 97) +* M-<up>: Structure editing. (line 53) +* M-a: Built-in table editor. + (line 74) +* M-down: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 13) +* M-e: Built-in table editor. + (line 78) +* M-g M-n: Sparse trees. (line 29) +* M-g M-p: Sparse trees. (line 32) +* M-g n: Sparse trees. (line 29) +* M-g p: Sparse trees. (line 32) +* M-h: Structure editing. (line 59) +* M-m: Agenda commands. (line 375) +* M-S-<down> <1>: The date/time prompt. + (line 82) +* M-S-<down> <2>: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 72) +* M-S-<down>: Built-in table editor. + (line 101) +* M-S-<left> <1>: The date/time prompt. + (line 82) +* M-S-<left> <2>: Built-in table editor. + (line 88) +* M-S-<left> <3>: Plain lists. (line 108) +* M-S-<left>: Structure editing. (line 47) +* M-S-<RET> <1>: Checkboxes. (line 74) +* M-S-<RET> <2>: Plain lists. (line 89) +* M-S-<RET>: Structure editing. (line 26) +* M-S-<right> <1>: The date/time prompt. + (line 82) +* M-S-<right> <2>: Built-in table editor. + (line 91) +* M-S-<right> <3>: Plain lists. (line 108) +* M-S-<right>: Structure editing. (line 50) +* M-S-<up> <1>: The date/time prompt. + (line 82) +* M-S-<up> <2>: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 72) +* M-S-<up>: Built-in table editor. + (line 98) +* M-up: Key bindings and useful functions. + (line 12) +* M-v: The date/time prompt. + (line 82) +* M-x org-iswitchb: Agenda files. (line 26) +* mouse-1 <1>: The date/time prompt. + (line 82) +* mouse-1 <2>: Handling links. (line 124) +* mouse-1: Footnotes. (line 78) +* mouse-2 <1>: Agenda commands. (line 39) +* mouse-2 <2>: Handling links. (line 124) +* mouse-2: Footnotes. (line 78) +* mouse-3 <1>: Agenda commands. (line 34) +* mouse-3: Handling links. (line 129) +* N: Agenda commands. (line 23) +* n <1>: Agenda commands. (line 19) +* n: Using column view. (line 43) +* O: Agenda commands. (line 334) +* o: Agenda commands. (line 71) +* P: Agenda commands. (line 26) +* p <1>: Agenda commands. (line 20) +* p: Using column view. (line 43) +* q <1>: Agenda commands. (line 518) +* q: Using column view. (line 27) +* r: Agenda commands. (line 168) +* R: Agenda commands. (line 137) +* r <1>: Global TODO list. (line 23) +* r: Using column view. (line 20) +* S: Agenda commands. (line 482) +* s: Agenda commands. (line 178) +* S-<down> <1>: Agenda commands. (line 289) +* S-<down> <2>: The date/time prompt. + (line 82) +* S-<down> <3>: Creating timestamps. (line 47) +* S-<down> <4>: Priorities. (line 28) +* S-<down> <5>: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 67) +* S-<down>: Plain lists. (line 90) +* S-<left> <1>: Agenda commands. (line 321) +* S-<left> <2>: The clock table. (line 24) +* S-<left> <3>: The date/time prompt. + (line 82) +* S-<left> <4>: Creating timestamps. (line 42) +* S-<left> <5>: Using column view. (line 36) +* S-<left> <6>: Property syntax. (line 100) +* S-<left> <7>: Multiple sets in one file. + (line 32) +* S-<left> <8>: TODO basics. (line 33) +* S-<left> <9>: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 67) +* S-<left>: Plain lists. (line 149) +* S-<RET>: Built-in table editor. + (line 165) +* S-<right> <1>: Agenda commands. (line 307) +* S-<right> <2>: The clock table. (line 24) +* S-<right> <3>: The date/time prompt. + (line 82) +* S-<right> <4>: Creating timestamps. (line 42) +* S-<right> <5>: Using column view. (line 36) +* S-<right> <6>: Property syntax. (line 100) +* S-<right> <7>: Multiple sets in one file. + (line 32) +* S-<right> <8>: TODO basics. (line 33) +* S-<right> <9>: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 67) +* S-<right>: Plain lists. (line 149) +* S-<TAB> <1>: Built-in table editor. + (line 66) +* S-<TAB>: Global and local cycling. + (line 18) +* S-<up> <1>: Agenda commands. (line 284) +* S-<up> <2>: The date/time prompt. + (line 82) +* S-<up> <3>: Creating timestamps. (line 47) +* S-<up> <4>: Priorities. (line 28) +* S-<up>: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 67) +* S-M-<left>: Using column view. (line 76) +* S-M-<RET>: TODO basics. (line 57) +* S-M-<right>: Using column view. (line 73) +* S-M-<up/down>: Clocking commands. (line 60) +* T: Agenda commands. (line 267) +* t: Agenda commands. (line 232) +* TAB: Built-in table editor. + (line 62) +* U: Agenda commands. (line 372) +* u: Agenda commands. (line 369) +* v: Using column view. (line 56) +* v [: Agenda commands. (line 126) +* v A: Agenda commands. (line 133) +* v a: Agenda commands. (line 130) +* v c: Agenda commands. (line 148) +* v d: Agenda commands. (line 74) +* v E: Agenda commands. (line 156) +* v L: Agenda commands. (line 118) +* v l: Agenda commands. (line 115) +* v m: Agenda commands. (line 79) +* v R: Agenda commands. (line 137) +* v SPC: Agenda commands. (line 81) +* v t: Agenda commands. (line 78) +* v w: Agenda commands. (line 77) +* v y: Agenda commands. (line 80) +* w: Agenda commands. (line 77) +* x: Agenda commands. (line 519) +* X: Agenda commands. (line 337) +* z: Agenda commands. (line 292) +* {: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 57) +* | <1>: Agenda commands. (line 221) +* |: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 112) +* }: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 57) +* ~: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 154) + + +File: org, Node: Command and Function Index, Next: Variable Index, Prev: Key Index, Up: Top + +Command and function index +************************** + + +* Menu: + +* lisp-complete-symbol: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 64) +* next-error: Sparse trees. (line 29) +* org-agenda <1>: Conventions. (line 35) +* org-agenda: Activation. (line 6) +* org-agenda-add-note: Agenda commands. (line 292) +* org-agenda-archive: Agenda commands. (line 262) +* org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation: Agenda commands. + (line 250) +* org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling: Agenda commands. (line 258) +* org-agenda-archives-mode: Agenda commands. (line 130) +* org-agenda-archives-mode 'files: Agenda commands. (line 133) +* org-agenda-bulk-action: Agenda commands. (line 384) +* org-agenda-bulk-mark: Agenda commands. (line 364) +* org-agenda-bulk-mark-all: Agenda commands. (line 366) +* org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp: Agenda commands. (line 381) +* org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks: Agenda commands. (line 372) +* org-agenda-bulk-toggle: Agenda commands. (line 375) +* org-agenda-bulk-toggle-all: Agenda commands. (line 378) +* org-agenda-bulk-unmark: Agenda commands. (line 369) +* org-agenda-capture: Agenda commands. (line 343) +* org-agenda-clock-cancel: Agenda commands. (line 337) +* org-agenda-clock-goto: Agenda commands. (line 108) +* org-agenda-clock-in: Agenda commands. (line 330) +* org-agenda-clock-out: Agenda commands. (line 334) +* org-agenda-clockreport-mode: Agenda commands. (line 137) +* org-agenda-columns <1>: Agenda column view. (line 11) +* org-agenda-columns: Agenda commands. (line 182) +* org-agenda-convert-date: Agenda commands. (line 487) +* org-agenda-date-prompt: Agenda commands. (line 325) +* org-agenda-day-view: Agenda commands. (line 74) +* org-agenda-deadline: Agenda commands. (line 304) +* org-agenda-diary-entry: Agenda commands. (line 459) +* org-agenda-do-date-earlier: Agenda commands. (line 321) +* org-agenda-do-date-later: Agenda commands. (line 307) +* org-agenda-drag-line-backward: Agenda commands. (line 353) +* org-agenda-drag-line-forward: Agenda commands. (line 357) +* org-agenda-earlier: Agenda commands. (line 99) +* org-agenda-entry-text-mode: Agenda commands. (line 156) +* org-agenda-exit: Agenda commands. (line 519) +* org-agenda-file-to-front: Agenda files. (line 15) +* org-agenda-filter-by-category <1>: Agenda commands. (line 207) +* org-agenda-filter-by-category: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 67) +* org-agenda-filter-by-effort <1>: Agenda commands. (line 218) +* org-agenda-filter-by-effort: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 91) +* org-agenda-filter-by-regexp <1>: Agenda commands. (line 215) +* org-agenda-filter-by-regexp: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 81) +* org-agenda-filter-by-tag <1>: Agenda commands. (line 203) +* org-agenda-filter-by-tag: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 17) +* org-agenda-filter-by-top-headline <1>: Agenda commands. (line 211) +* org-agenda-filter-by-top-headline: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 77) +* org-agenda-filter-remove-all <1>: Agenda commands. (line 221) +* org-agenda-filter-remove-all: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 112) +* org-agenda-follow-mode: Agenda commands. (line 45) +* org-agenda-fortnight-view: Agenda commands. (line 78) +* org-agenda-goto: Agenda commands. (line 39) +* org-agenda-goto-calendar: Agenda commands. (line 454) +* org-agenda-goto-date: Agenda commands. (line 105) +* org-agenda-goto-today: Agenda commands. (line 102) +* org-agenda-holidays: Agenda commands. (line 491) +* org-agenda-kill: Agenda commands. (line 241) +* org-agenda-later: Agenda commands. (line 93) +* org-agenda-limit-interactively: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 154) +* org-agenda-list: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 9) +* org-agenda-list-stuck-projects: Stuck projects. (line 13) +* org-agenda-log-mode: Agenda commands. (line 115) +* org-agenda-manipulate-query-add: Agenda commands. (line 126) +* org-agenda-month-view: Agenda commands. (line 79) +* org-agenda-next-item: Agenda commands. (line 23) +* org-agenda-next-line: Agenda commands. (line 19) +* org-agenda-open-link: Agenda commands. (line 61) +* org-agenda-phases-of-moon: Agenda commands. (line 478) +* org-agenda-previous-item: Agenda commands. (line 26) +* org-agenda-previous-line: Agenda commands. (line 20) +* org-agenda-priority-down: Agenda commands. (line 289) +* org-agenda-priority-up: Agenda commands. (line 284) +* org-agenda-quit: Agenda commands. (line 518) +* org-agenda-recenter: Agenda commands. (line 36) +* org-agenda-redo: Agenda commands. (line 168) +* org-agenda-refile: Agenda commands. (line 247) +* org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock <1>: Agenda commands. (line 193) +* org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock: Agenda files. (line 49) +* org-agenda-reset-view: Agenda commands. (line 81) +* org-agenda-schedule: Agenda commands. (line 300) +* org-agenda-set-restriction-lock: Agenda files. (line 42) +* org-agenda-set-tags: Agenda commands. (line 272) +* org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up: Agenda commands. (line 34) +* org-agenda-show-priority: Agenda commands. (line 281) +* org-agenda-show-tags: Agenda commands. (line 267) +* org-agenda-sunrise-sunset: Agenda commands. (line 482) +* org-agenda-switch-to: Agenda commands. (line 42) +* org-agenda-todo: Agenda commands. (line 232) +* org-agenda-todo-nextset: Agenda commands. (line 236) +* org-agenda-todo-previousset: Agenda commands. (line 239) +* org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag: Agenda commands. (line 255) +* org-agenda-toggle-diary: Agenda commands. (line 111) +* org-agenda-toggle-time-grid: Agenda commands. (line 164) +* org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer: Agenda commands. (line 52) +* org-agenda-undo: Agenda commands. (line 228) +* org-agenda-week-view: Agenda commands. (line 77) +* org-agenda-write <1>: Exporting agenda views. + (line 12) +* org-agenda-write: Agenda commands. (line 504) +* org-agenda-year-view: Agenda commands. (line 80) +* org-archive-subtree: Moving subtrees. (line 9) +* org-archive-subtree-default: Archiving. (line 11) +* org-archive-to-archive-sibling: Internal archiving. (line 50) +* org-ascii-export-as-ascii: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. + (line 27) +* org-ascii-export-to-ascii: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. + (line 23) +* org-attach <1>: Agenda commands. (line 297) +* org-attach: Attachments. (line 26) +* org-attach-attach: Attachments. (line 31) +* org-attach-delete-all: Attachments. (line 69) +* org-attach-delete-one: Attachments. (line 66) +* org-attach-new: Attachments. (line 44) +* org-attach-open: Attachments. (line 51) +* org-attach-open-in-emacs: Attachments. (line 57) +* org-attach-reveal: Attachments. (line 60) +* org-attach-reveal-in-emacs: Attachments. (line 63) +* org-attach-set-directory: Attachments. (line 73) +* org-attach-set-inherit: Attachments. (line 78) +* org-attach-sync: Attachments. (line 47) +* org-attach-url: Attachments. (line 41) +* org-backward-same-level: Motion. (line 15) +* org-beamer-export-as-latex: Beamer export commands. + (line 8) +* org-beamer-export-to-latex: Beamer export commands. + (line 6) +* org-beamer-export-to-pdf: Beamer export commands. + (line 11) +* org-beamer-select-environment: Editing support. (line 11) +* org-buffer-property-keys: Using the property API. + (line 34) +* org-calendar-goto-agenda: Agenda commands. (line 455) +* org-capture <1>: Using capture. (line 6) +* org-capture <2>: Conventions. (line 35) +* org-capture: Activation. (line 6) +* org-capture-finalize: Using capture. (line 15) +* org-capture-kill: Using capture. (line 31) +* org-capture-refile: Using capture. (line 22) +* org-check-after-date: Inserting deadline/schedule. + (line 31) +* org-check-before-date: Inserting deadline/schedule. + (line 28) +* org-check-deadlines: Inserting deadline/schedule. + (line 21) +* org-clock-cancel: Clocking commands. (line 71) +* org-clock-display: Clocking commands. (line 80) +* org-clock-goto: Clocking commands. (line 75) +* org-clock-in: Clocking commands. (line 6) +* org-clock-in-last: Clocking commands. (line 42) +* org-clock-modify-effort-estimate <1>: Effort estimates. (line 17) +* org-clock-modify-effort-estimate: Clocking commands. (line 48) +* org-clock-out: Clocking commands. (line 34) +* org-clock-report: The clock table. (line 10) +* org-clock-timestamps-up/down: Clocking commands. (line 56) +* org-clocktable-try-shift: The clock table. (line 24) +* org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift: Structure editing. (line 95) +* org-columns: Using column view. (line 9) +* org-columns-delete: Using column view. (line 76) +* org-columns-edit-allowed: Using column view. (line 60) +* org-columns-edit-value: Using column view. (line 47) +* org-columns-narrow: Using column view. (line 71) +* org-columns-new: Using column view. (line 73) +* org-columns-next-allowed-value: Using column view. (line 43) +* org-columns-previous-allowed-value: Using column view. (line 43) +* org-columns-quit: Using column view. (line 27) +* org-columns-redo: Using column view. (line 20) +* org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle: Using column view. (line 53) +* org-columns-show-value: Using column view. (line 56) +* org-columns-widen: Using column view. (line 71) +* org-compute-property-at-point: Property syntax. (line 110) +* org-copy: Refile and copy. (line 12) +* org-copy-subtree: Structure editing. (line 73) +* org-copy-visible: Global and local cycling. + (line 61) +* org-cut-subtree: Structure editing. (line 69) +* org-cycle <1>: Plain lists. (line 68) +* org-cycle <2>: Structure editing. (line 35) +* org-cycle: Global and local cycling. + (line 10) +* org-cycle-agenda-files: Agenda files. (line 22) +* org-date-from-calendar: Creating timestamps. (line 29) +* org-dblock-update <1>: Dynamic blocks. (line 21) +* org-dblock-update <2>: The clock table. (line 16) +* org-dblock-update: Capturing column view. + (line 54) +* org-deadline: Inserting deadline/schedule. + (line 9) +* org-delete-property: Property syntax. (line 104) +* org-delete-property-globally: Property syntax. (line 107) +* org-demote: Using the mapping API. + (line 78) +* org-demote-subtree: Structure editing. (line 50) +* org-do-demote: Structure editing. (line 44) +* org-do-promote: Structure editing. (line 41) +* org-edit-special: Cooperation. (line 48) +* org-entities-help: Special symbols. (line 16) +* org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property: Using the property API. + (line 51) +* org-entry-delete: Using the property API. + (line 28) +* org-entry-get: Using the property API. + (line 19) +* org-entry-get-multivalued-property: Using the property API. + (line 46) +* org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property: Using the property API. + (line 63) +* org-entry-properties: Using the property API. + (line 9) +* org-entry-put: Using the property API. + (line 31) +* org-entry-put-multivalued-property: Using the property API. + (line 41) +* org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property: Using the property API. + (line 57) +* org-evaluate-time-range <1>: Clocking commands. (line 51) +* org-evaluate-time-range: Creating timestamps. (line 59) +* org-export-dispatch: The export dispatcher. + (line 15) +* org-feed-goto-inbox: RSS feeds. (line 27) +* org-feed-update-all: RSS feeds. (line 23) +* org-force-cycle-archived: Internal archiving. (line 47) +* org-forward-same-level: Motion. (line 12) +* org-global-cycle: Global and local cycling. + (line 18) +* org-goto: Motion. (line 21) +* org-goto-calendar: Creating timestamps. (line 33) +* org-html-export-as-html: HTML Export commands. + (line 11) +* org-html-export-to-html: HTML Export commands. + (line 6) +* org-icalendar-combine-agenda-files: iCalendar export. (line 44) +* org-icalendar-export-agenda-files: iCalendar export. (line 40) +* org-icalendar-export-to-ics: iCalendar export. (line 38) +* org-insert-columns-dblock: Capturing column view. + (line 52) +* org-insert-heading <1>: Timers. (line 40) +* org-insert-heading: Plain lists. (line 79) +* org-insert-heading-respect-content: Structure editing. (line 23) +* org-insert-link: Handling links. (line 65) +* org-insert-property-drawer: Using the property API. + (line 18) +* org-insert-todo-heading <1>: Checkboxes. (line 74) +* org-insert-todo-heading <2>: TODO basics. (line 57) +* org-insert-todo-heading: Structure editing. (line 26) +* org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content: Structure editing. (line 30) +* org-iswitchb: Activation. (line 6) +* org-latex-export-as-latex: LaTeX export commands. + (line 11) +* org-latex-export-to-latex: LaTeX export commands. + (line 6) +* org-latex-export-to-pdf: LaTeX export commands. + (line 12) +* org-lookup-all: Lookup functions. (line 22) +* org-lookup-first: Lookup functions. (line 8) +* org-lookup-last: Lookup functions. (line 18) +* org-map-entries: Using the mapping API. + (line 12) +* org-mark-element: Structure editing. (line 59) +* org-mark-ring-goto: Handling links. (line 146) +* org-mark-ring-push: Handling links. (line 142) +* org-mark-subtree: Structure editing. (line 65) +* org-match-sparse-tree <1>: Property searches. (line 10) +* org-match-sparse-tree: Tag searches. (line 9) +* org-md-export-as-markdown: Markdown export. (line 18) +* org-md-export-to-markdown: Markdown export. (line 16) +* org-meta-return: Structure editing. (line 6) +* org-move-subtree-down: Structure editing. (line 56) +* org-move-subtree-up: Structure editing. (line 53) +* org-narrow-to-block: Structure editing. (line 122) +* org-narrow-to-subtree: Structure editing. (line 119) +* org-next-link: Handling links. (line 152) +* org-next-visible-heading: Motion. (line 8) +* org-occur: Sparse trees. (line 17) +* org-odt-export-to-odt: ODT export commands. (line 6) +* org-open-at-point <1>: Creating timestamps. (line 38) +* org-open-at-point: Handling links. (line 101) +* org-org-export-as-org: Org export. (line 17) +* org-org-export-to-org: Org export. (line 13) +* org-paste-subtree: Structure editing. (line 77) +* org-previous-link: Handling links. (line 152) +* org-previous-visible-heading: Motion. (line 9) +* org-priority <1>: Using the mapping API. + (line 66) +* org-priority: Priorities. (line 24) +* org-priority-down: Priorities. (line 28) +* org-priority-up: Priorities. (line 28) +* org-promote: Using the mapping API. + (line 75) +* org-promote-subtree: Structure editing. (line 47) +* org-property-action: Property syntax. (line 92) +* org-property-next-allowed-value: Property syntax. (line 100) +* org-property-previous-allowed-value: Property syntax. (line 100) +* org-protocol-create: open-source protocol. + (line 67) +* org-protocol-create-for-org: open-source protocol. + (line 67) +* org-publish: Triggering publication. + (line 8) +* org-publish-all: Triggering publication. + (line 16) +* org-publish-current-file: Triggering publication. + (line 13) +* org-publish-current-project: Triggering publication. + (line 10) +* org-refile <1>: Refile and copy. (line 14) +* org-refile: Structure editing. (line 103) +* org-refile-cache-clear: Refile and copy. (line 47) +* org-refile-goto-last-stored: Refile and copy. (line 36) +* org-remove-file: Agenda files. (line 19) +* org-reveal: Global and local cycling. + (line 38) +* org-save-all-org-buffers: Agenda commands. (line 178) +* org-schedule: Inserting deadline/schedule. + (line 16) +* org-search-view: Search view. (line 9) +* org-set-effort: Effort estimates. (line 14) +* org-set-property: Property syntax. (line 83) +* org-set-startup-visibility <1>: Initial visibility. (line 21) +* org-set-startup-visibility: Global and local cycling. + (line 33) +* org-set-tags-command: Setting tags. (line 10) +* org-show-todo-tree: TODO basics. (line 38) +* org-sort: Structure editing. (line 107) +* org-sparse-tree: Sparse trees. (line 15) +* org-speed-command-help: Speed keys. (line 19) +* org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction: Agenda files. (line 57) +* org-store-agenda-views: Exporting agenda views. + (line 64) +* org-store-link <1>: Handling links. (line 9) +* org-store-link: Activation. (line 6) +* org-table-align: Built-in table editor. + (line 58) +* org-table-beginning-of-field: Built-in table editor. + (line 74) +* org-table-blank-field: Built-in table editor. + (line 59) +* org-table-copy-down: Built-in table editor. + (line 165) +* org-table-copy-region: Built-in table editor. + (line 132) +* org-table-create-or-convert-from-region: Built-in table editor. + (line 41) +* org-table-create-with-table.el: Cooperation. (line 50) +* org-table-cut-region: Built-in table editor. + (line 136) +* org-table-delete-column: Built-in table editor. + (line 88) +* org-table-edit-field: Built-in table editor. + (line 180) +* org-table-edit-formulas: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 36) +* org-table-end-of-field: Built-in table editor. + (line 78) +* org-table-eval-formula <1>: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 13) +* org-table-eval-formula <2>: Column formulas. (line 32) +* org-table-eval-formula: Field and range formulas. + (line 27) +* org-table-export: Built-in table editor. + (line 205) +* org-table-fedit-abort: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 50) +* org-table-fedit-finish: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 47) +* org-table-fedit-line-down: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 72) +* org-table-fedit-line-up: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 72) +* org-table-fedit-lisp-indent: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 57) +* org-table-fedit-ref-down: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 67) +* org-table-fedit-ref-left: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 67) +* org-table-fedit-ref-right: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 67) +* org-table-fedit-ref-up: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 67) +* org-table-fedit-scroll-down: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 77) +* org-table-fedit-scroll-up: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 77) +* org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 53) +* org-table-field-info: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 22) +* org-table-hline-and-move: Built-in table editor. + (line 109) +* org-table-insert-column: Built-in table editor. + (line 91) +* org-table-insert-hline: Built-in table editor. + (line 105) +* org-table-insert-row: Built-in table editor. + (line 101) +* org-table-iterate: Updating the table. (line 22) +* org-table-iterate-buffer-tables: Updating the table. (line 33) +* org-table-kill-row: Built-in table editor. + (line 98) +* org-table-move-column-left: Built-in table editor. + (line 86) +* org-table-move-column-right: Built-in table editor. + (line 86) +* org-table-move-row-down: Built-in table editor. + (line 94) +* org-table-move-row-up: Built-in table editor. + (line 94) +* org-table-next-field: Built-in table editor. + (line 62) +* org-table-next-row: Built-in table editor. + (line 69) +* org-table-paste-rectangle: Built-in table editor. + (line 140) +* org-table-previous-field: Built-in table editor. + (line 66) +* org-table-recalculate: Updating the table. (line 13) +* org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables: Updating the table. (line 30) +* org-table-rotate-recalc-marks: Advanced features. (line 10) +* org-table-sort-lines: Built-in table editor. + (line 113) +* org-table-sum: Built-in table editor. + (line 162) +* org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 26) +* org-table-toggle-formula-debugger: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 32) +* org-table-wrap-region: Built-in table editor. + (line 147) +* org-tags-view <1>: Matching tags and properties. + (line 12) +* org-tags-view <2>: Property searches. (line 12) +* org-tags-view: Tag searches. (line 13) +* org-texinfo-export-to-info: Texinfo export commands. + (line 8) +* org-texinfo-export-to-texinfo: Texinfo export commands. + (line 6) +* org-time-stamp: Creating timestamps. (line 10) +* org-time-stamp-inactive: Creating timestamps. (line 15) +* org-timer: Timers. (line 31) +* org-timer-item: Timers. (line 35) +* org-timer-pause-or-continue: Timers. (line 44) +* org-timer-set-timer: Timers. (line 20) +* org-timer-start: Timers. (line 12) +* org-timer-stop: Timers. (line 47) +* org-timestamp-down-day: Creating timestamps. (line 42) +* org-timestamp-down-down: Creating timestamps. (line 47) +* org-timestamp-up: Creating timestamps. (line 47) +* org-timestamp-up-day: Creating timestamps. (line 42) +* org-timestamp-up/down: Clocking commands. (line 60) +* org-todo <1>: Using the mapping API. + (line 62) +* org-todo <2>: Clocking commands. (line 67) +* org-todo: TODO basics. (line 13) +* org-todo-list <1>: Global TODO list. (line 9) +* org-todo-list: TODO basics. (line 49) +* org-toggle-archive-tag: Internal archiving. (line 37) +* org-toggle-checkbox: Checkboxes. (line 52) +* org-toggle-heading: Structure editing. (line 128) +* org-toggle-inline-images: Handling links. (line 133) +* org-toggle-ordered-property <1>: Checkboxes. (line 77) +* org-toggle-ordered-property: TODO dependencies. (line 37) +* org-toggle-tag: Using the mapping API. + (line 70) +* org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays: Custom time format. (line 12) +* org-tree-to-indirect-buffer: Global and local cycling. + (line 55) +* org-update-all-dblocks: Capturing column view. + (line 58) +* org-update-statistics-cookies: Checkboxes. (line 85) +* org-yank: Structure editing. (line 83) +* outline-show-all: Global and local cycling. + (line 35) +* outline-show-branches: Global and local cycling. + (line 47) +* outline-show-children: Global and local cycling. + (line 51) +* outline-up-heading: Motion. (line 18) +* pcomplete: Property syntax. (line 80) +* previous-error: Sparse trees. (line 32) +* widen: Structure editing. (line 125) + + +File: org, Node: Variable Index, Prev: Command and Function Index, Up: Top + +Variable index +************** + +This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that +are mentioned in the manual. For a complete list, use `M-x +org-customize <RET>'. + + +* Menu: + +* cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts: CDLaTeX mode. (line 33) +* constants-unit-system <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 145) +* constants-unit-system: References. (line 117) +* htmlize-output-type: Exporting agenda views. + (line 20) +* LaTeX-verbatim-environments: A LaTeX example. (line 20) +* org-adapt-indentation: Clean view. (line 52) +* org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines: Exporting agenda views. + (line 20) +* org-agenda-bulk-custom-functions: Agenda commands. (line 364) +* org-agenda-category-filter-preset: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 68) +* org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks: Agenda commands. (line 151) +* org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum: Effort estimates. + (line 41) +* org-agenda-confirm-kill: Agenda commands. (line 244) +* org-agenda-custom-commands <1>: Extracting agenda information. + (line 6) +* org-agenda-custom-commands <2>: Setting options. (line 6) +* org-agenda-custom-commands <3>: Storing searches. (line 9) +* org-agenda-custom-commands: Sparse trees. (line 37) +* org-agenda-custom-commands-contexts: Setting options. (line 61) +* org-agenda-diary-file: Agenda commands. (line 462) +* org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks <1>: Speeding up your agendas. + (line 15) +* org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks: TODO dependencies. (line 47) +* org-agenda-effort-filter-preset: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 92) +* org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines: Agenda commands. (line 159) +* org-agenda-exporter-settings <1>: Exporting agenda views. + (line 13) +* org-agenda-exporter-settings: Agenda commands. (line 505) +* org-agenda-files <1>: iCalendar export. (line 43) +* org-agenda-files <2>: Sorting agenda items. + (line 8) +* org-agenda-files: Agenda files. (line 6) +* org-agenda-inhibit-startup <1>: Speeding up your agendas. + (line 18) +* org-agenda-inhibit-startup: Initial visibility. (line 6) +* org-agenda-log-mode-items: Agenda commands. (line 118) +* org-agenda-max-effort: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 118) +* org-agenda-max-entries: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 118) +* org-agenda-max-tags: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 118) +* org-agenda-max-todos: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 118) +* org-agenda-ndays: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 15) +* org-agenda-overriding-header: Special agenda views. + (line 38) +* org-agenda-prefix-format: Presentation and sorting. + (line 6) +* org-agenda-regexp-filter-preset: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 82) +* org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit: Agenda views. (line 42) +* org-agenda-show-inherited-tags <1>: Speeding up your agendas. + (line 21) +* org-agenda-show-inherited-tags: Agenda commands. (line 270) +* org-agenda-skip-archived-trees <1>: Agenda views. (line 37) +* org-agenda-skip-archived-trees: Internal archiving. (line 22) +* org-agenda-skip-comment-trees: Agenda views. (line 37) +* org-agenda-skip-deadline-prewarning-if-scheduled: Deadlines and scheduling. + (line 14) +* org-agenda-skip-function <1>: Using the mapping API. + (line 49) +* org-agenda-skip-function: Special agenda views. + (line 6) +* org-agenda-skip-function-global: Special agenda views. + (line 6) +* org-agenda-skip-scheduled-delay-if-deadline: Deadlines and scheduling. + (line 42) +* org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-deadline-is-shown: Repeated tasks. + (line 72) +* org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done: Deadlines and scheduling. + (line 34) +* org-agenda-sorting-strategy: Sorting agenda items. + (line 27) +* org-agenda-span <1>: Agenda commands. (line 82) +* org-agenda-span: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 15) +* org-agenda-start-day: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 15) +* org-agenda-start-on-weekday: Weekly/daily agenda. (line 15) +* org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode: Agenda commands. (line 140) +* org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode: Agenda commands. (line 159) +* org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode: Agenda commands. (line 48) +* org-agenda-sticky: Agenda dispatcher. (line 50) +* org-agenda-tag-filter-preset: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 18) +* org-agenda-tags-column: Presentation and sorting. + (line 6) +* org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options: Matching tags and properties. + (line 20) +* org-agenda-text-search-extra-files <1>: Search view. (line 24) +* org-agenda-text-search-extra-files: Agenda dispatcher. (line 29) +* org-agenda-time-grid <1>: Agenda commands. (line 167) +* org-agenda-time-grid: Time-of-day specifications. + (line 41) +* org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines: Global TODO list. (line 38) +* org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled: Global TODO list. (line 38) +* org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp: Global TODO list. (line 38) +* org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date: Global TODO list. (line 38) +* org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels <1>: Global TODO list. (line 47) +* org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels: Breaking down tasks. (line 6) +* org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance <1>: Speeding up your agendas. + (line 21) +* org-agenda-use-tag-inheritance: Tag inheritance. (line 32) +* org-agenda-use-time-grid <1>: Agenda commands. (line 167) +* org-agenda-use-time-grid: Time-of-day specifications. + (line 41) +* org-agenda-window-setup: Agenda views. (line 42) +* org-archive-default-command <1>: Agenda commands. (line 253) +* org-archive-default-command: Archiving. (line 12) +* org-archive-location <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 14) +* org-archive-location: Moving subtrees. (line 10) +* org-archive-save-context-info: Moving subtrees. (line 41) +* org-ascii-links-to-notes: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. + (line 16) +* org-ascii-text-width: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export. + (line 13) +* org-attach-directory: Attachments. (line 6) +* org-attach-method: Attachments. (line 32) +* org-babel-default-header-args <1>: Header arguments in Org mode properties. + (line 31) +* org-babel-default-header-args: System-wide header arguments. + (line 6) +* org-babel-load-languages: Languages. (line 35) +* org-beamer-environments-default: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer. + (line 21) +* org-beamer-environments-extra: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer. + (line 21) +* org-beamer-frame-level: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer. + (line 10) +* org-beamer-subtitle-format: Beamer specific export settings. + (line 44) +* org-beamer-theme: Beamer specific export settings. + (line 11) +* org-calc-default-modes: Formula syntax for Calc. + (line 14) +* org-capture-bookmark: Using capture. (line 50) +* org-capture-templates-contexts: Templates in contexts. + (line 6) +* org-capture-use-agenda-date: Agenda commands. (line 348) +* org-catch-invisible-edits: Catching invisible edits. + (line 6) +* org-checkbox-hierarchical-statistics: Checkboxes. (line 30) +* org-clock-continuously <1>: Resolving idle time. (line 78) +* org-clock-continuously: Clocking commands. (line 7) +* org-clock-idle-time: Resolving idle time. (line 14) +* org-clock-into-drawer: Clocking commands. (line 7) +* org-clock-modeline-total: Clocking commands. (line 20) +* org-clock-report-include-clocking-task: Agenda commands. (line 140) +* org-clock-x11idle-program-name: Resolving idle time. (line 9) +* org-clocktable-defaults: The clock table. (line 38) +* org-closed-keep-when-no-todo: Closing items. (line 11) +* org-coderef-label-format: Literal examples. (line 75) +* org-columns-default-format <1>: Agenda column view. (line 18) +* org-columns-default-format <2>: Agenda commands. (line 185) +* org-columns-default-format <3>: Effort estimates. (line 31) +* org-columns-default-format: Using column view. (line 10) +* org-columns-skip-archived-trees: Internal archiving. (line 32) +* org-columns-summary-types: Column attributes. (line 65) +* org-confirm-babel-evaluate: Code evaluation security. + (line 26) +* org-confirm-elisp-link-function: Code evaluation security. + (line 53) +* org-confirm-shell-link-function: Code evaluation security. + (line 50) +* org-create-file-search-functions: Custom searches. (line 12) +* org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook: Context-sensitive commands. + (line 6) +* org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree: Headlines. (line 6) +* org-cycle-emulate-tab: Global and local cycling. + (line 16) +* org-cycle-global-at-bob: Global and local cycling. + (line 29) +* org-cycle-include-plain-lists: Plain lists. (line 69) +* org-cycle-open-archived-trees: Internal archiving. (line 12) +* org-cycle-separator-lines: Headlines. (line 26) +* org-deadline-warning-days <1>: Inserting deadline/schedule. + (line 24) +* org-deadline-warning-days: Deadlines and scheduling. + (line 14) +* org-default-notes-file <1>: Template elements. (line 49) +* org-default-notes-file: Setting up capture. (line 9) +* org-default-priority <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 45) +* org-default-priority: Priorities. (line 37) +* org-display-custom-times: Custom time format. (line 6) +* org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer: Handling links. + (line 132) +* org-disputed-keys: Conflicts. (line 28) +* org-done (face): Faces for TODO keywords. + (line 6) +* org-edit-footnote-reference: Footnotes. (line 85) +* org-edit-src-auto-save-idle-delay: Editing source code. (line 6) +* org-edit-src-turn-on-auto-save: Editing source code. (line 6) +* org-emphasis-alist: Emphasis and monospace. + (line 6) +* org-emphasis-regexp-components: Emphasis and monospace. + (line 6) +* org-enforce-todo-dependencies: TODO dependencies. (line 6) +* org-entities-user: Special symbols. (line 16) +* org-execute-file-search-functions: Custom searches. (line 12) +* org-export-allow-bind-keywords: Export settings. (line 211) +* org-export-async-init-file: The export dispatcher. + (line 28) +* org-export-backends <1>: Other built-in back-ends. + (line 6) +* org-export-backends: Exporting. (line 42) +* org-export-before-parsing-hook: Advanced configuration. + (line 9) +* org-export-before-processing-hook: Advanced configuration. + (line 9) +* org-export-creator-string <1>: HTML preamble and postamble. + (line 6) +* org-export-creator-string: Export settings. (line 28) +* org-export-date-timestamp-format: Export settings. (line 32) +* org-export-default-language: Export settings. (line 38) +* org-export-dispatch-use-expert-ui: The export dispatcher. + (line 6) +* org-export-exclude-tags: Export settings. (line 52) +* org-export-global-macros: Macro replacement. (line 6) +* org-export-headline-levels: Export settings. (line 141) +* org-export-in-background: The export dispatcher. + (line 39) +* org-export-initial-scope: The export dispatcher. + (line 48) +* org-export-preserve-breaks: Export settings. (line 93) +* org-export-select-tags: Export settings. (line 44) +* org-export-time-stamp-file <1>: HTML preamble and postamble. + (line 6) +* org-export-time-stamp-file: Export settings. (line 186) +* org-export-use-babel: Exporting code blocks. + (line 36) +* org-export-with-archived-trees <1>: Export settings. (line 102) +* org-export-with-archived-trees: Internal archiving. (line 28) +* org-export-with-author: Export settings. (line 107) +* org-export-with-broken-links: Export settings. (line 111) +* org-export-with-clocks: Export settings. (line 116) +* org-export-with-creator: Export settings. (line 119) +* org-export-with-date: Export settings. (line 127) +* org-export-with-drawers <1>: Export settings. (line 123) +* org-export-with-drawers: Drawers. (line 38) +* org-export-with-email: Export settings. (line 134) +* org-export-with-entities: Export settings. (line 131) +* org-export-with-fixed-width: Export settings. (line 86) +* org-export-with-footnotes: Export settings. (line 138) +* org-export-with-inlinetasks: Export settings. (line 146) +* org-export-with-latex <1>: Export settings. (line 182) +* org-export-with-latex: LaTeX fragments. (line 38) +* org-export-with-planning: Export settings. (line 156) +* org-export-with-priority: Export settings. (line 162) +* org-export-with-properties <1>: Export settings. (line 165) +* org-export-with-properties: Drawers. (line 38) +* org-export-with-section-numbers: Export settings. (line 149) +* org-export-with-smart-quotes: Export settings. (line 73) +* org-export-with-special-strings: Export settings. (line 82) +* org-export-with-statistics-cookies: Export settings. (line 169) +* org-export-with-sub-superscripts: Export settings. (line 97) +* org-export-with-tables: Export settings. (line 201) +* org-export-with-tags: Export settings. (line 173) +* org-export-with-tasks: Export settings. (line 177) +* org-export-with-timestamps: Export settings. (line 89) +* org-export-with-title: Export settings. (line 190) +* org-export-with-toc <1>: Table of contents. (line 6) +* org-export-with-toc: Export settings. (line 193) +* org-export-with-todo-keywords: Export settings. (line 197) +* org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo: Fast access to TODO states. + (line 16) +* org-fast-tag-selection-single-key: Setting tags. (line 143) +* org-file-apps <1>: Attachments. (line 52) +* org-file-apps: Handling links. (line 104) +* org-fontify-emphasized-text: Emphasis and monospace. + (line 6) +* org-footnote-auto-adjust <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 150) +* org-footnote-auto-adjust: Footnotes. (line 48) +* org-footnote-auto-label <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 150) +* org-footnote-auto-label: Footnotes. (line 34) +* org-footnote-define-inline <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 150) +* org-footnote-define-inline: Footnotes. (line 48) +* org-footnote-section <1>: Footnotes. (line 48) +* org-footnote-section: Headlines. (line 18) +* org-format-latex-header <1>: Previewing LaTeX fragments. + (line 12) +* org-format-latex-header: LaTeX fragments. (line 6) +* org-format-latex-options: Previewing LaTeX fragments. + (line 12) +* org-from-is-user-regexp: Template expansion. (line 49) +* org-global-properties <1>: Effort estimates. (line 31) +* org-global-properties: Property syntax. (line 75) +* org-goto-auto-isearch: Motion. (line 26) +* org-goto-interface: Motion. (line 37) +* org-group-tags: Tag hierarchy. (line 86) +* org-hide (face): Clean view. (line 70) +* org-hide-block-startup: Blocks. (line 6) +* org-hide-leading-stars <1>: Clean view. (line 55) +* org-hide-leading-stars: In-buffer settings. (line 129) +* org-hierarchical-todo-statistics: Breaking down tasks. (line 25) +* org-highest-priority <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 45) +* org-highest-priority: Priorities. (line 37) +* org-html-container-element: HTML Specific export settings. + (line 19) +* org-html-doctype <1>: HTML doctypes. (line 8) +* org-html-doctype: HTML Specific export settings. + (line 16) +* org-html-doctype-alist: HTML doctypes. (line 8) +* org-html-head <1>: CSS support. (line 43) +* org-html-head: HTML Specific export settings. + (line 35) +* org-html-head-extra <1>: CSS support. (line 43) +* org-html-head-extra: HTML Specific export settings. + (line 39) +* org-html-head-include-default-style: CSS support. (line 43) +* org-html-html5-elements: HTML doctypes. (line 66) +* org-html-html5-fancy: HTML doctypes. (line 33) +* org-html-infojs-options: JavaScript support. (line 51) +* org-html-inline-images: Images in HTML export. + (line 6) +* org-html-link-home: HTML Specific export settings. + (line 23) +* org-html-link-org-files-as-html: Links in HTML export. + (line 6) +* org-html-link-up: HTML Specific export settings. + (line 26) +* org-html-mathjax-options: HTML Specific export settings. + (line 30) +* org-html-postamble: HTML preamble and postamble. + (line 6) +* org-html-postamble-format: HTML preamble and postamble. + (line 6) +* org-html-preamble: HTML preamble and postamble. + (line 6) +* org-html-preamble-format: HTML preamble and postamble. + (line 6) +* org-html-style-default: CSS support. (line 43) +* org-html-table-align-individual-fields: Tables in HTML export. + (line 19) +* org-html-table-caption-above: Tables in HTML export. + (line 23) +* org-html-table-data-tags: Tables in HTML export. + (line 26) +* org-html-table-default-attributes: Tables in HTML export. + (line 6) +* org-html-table-header-tags: Tables in HTML export. + (line 32) +* org-html-table-row-tags: Tables in HTML export. + (line 35) +* org-html-table-use-header-tags-for-first-column: Tables in HTML export. + (line 38) +* org-html-tag-class-prefix: CSS support. (line 6) +* org-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix: CSS support. (line 6) +* org-html-use-infojs: JavaScript support. (line 51) +* org-html-validation-link: HTML preamble and postamble. + (line 6) +* org-icalendar-alarm-time: iCalendar export. (line 6) +* org-icalendar-categories: iCalendar export. (line 6) +* org-icalendar-combined-agenda-file: iCalendar export. (line 47) +* org-icalendar-include-body: iCalendar export. (line 51) +* org-icalendar-include-todo: iCalendar export. (line 6) +* org-icalendar-store-UID: iCalendar export. (line 26) +* org-icalendar-use-deadline: iCalendar export. (line 6) +* org-icalendar-use-scheduled: iCalendar export. (line 6) +* org-id-link-to-org-use-id: Handling links. (line 21) +* org-imenu-depth: Cooperation. (line 30) +* org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file: Activation. (line 27) +* org-irc-link-to-logs: Handling links. (line 45) +* org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion: Handling links. (line 66) +* org-latex-bibtex-compiler: LaTeX export commands. + (line 21) +* org-latex-classes <1>: LaTeX header and sectioning. + (line 13) +* org-latex-classes: LaTeX specific export settings. + (line 20) +* org-latex-compiler <1>: LaTeX specific export settings. + (line 32) +* org-latex-compiler: LaTeX export commands. + (line 21) +* org-latex-default-class <1>: LaTeX header and sectioning. + (line 13) +* org-latex-default-class: LaTeX specific export settings. + (line 20) +* org-latex-default-packages-alist <1>: LaTeX header and sectioning. + (line 13) +* org-latex-default-packages-alist: LaTeX export commands. + (line 21) +* org-latex-default-table-environment: Tables in LaTeX export. + (line 22) +* org-latex-default-table-mode: Tables in LaTeX export. + (line 11) +* org-latex-images-centered: Images in LaTeX export. + (line 50) +* org-latex-listings: Literal examples. (line 23) +* org-latex-listings-options: Source blocks in LaTeX export. + (line 23) +* org-latex-minted-options: Source blocks in LaTeX export. + (line 23) +* org-latex-packages-alist: LaTeX header and sectioning. + (line 13) +* org-latex-subtitle-format: LaTeX specific export settings. + (line 55) +* org-latex-subtitle-separate: LaTeX specific export settings. + (line 55) +* org-latex-tables-booktabs: Tables in LaTeX export. + (line 64) +* org-latex-tables-centered: Tables in LaTeX export. + (line 64) +* org-latex-to-mathml-convert-command: Working with LaTeX math snippets. + (line 21) +* org-latex-to-mathml-jar-file: Working with LaTeX math snippets. + (line 21) +* org-link-abbrev-alist <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 40) +* org-link-abbrev-alist: Link abbreviations. (line 12) +* org-link-frame-setup: Handling links. (line 104) +* org-link-parameters: Handling links. (line 66) +* org-list-allow-alphabetical: Plain lists. (line 14) +* org-list-automatic-rules <1>: Checkboxes. (line 6) +* org-list-automatic-rules: Plain lists. (line 62) +* org-list-demote-modify-bullet: Plain lists. (line 56) +* org-list-indent-offset: Plain lists. (line 56) +* org-list-use-circular-motion: Plain lists. (line 94) +* org-log-done <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 104) +* org-log-done <2>: Agenda commands. (line 118) +* org-log-done: Tracking TODO state changes. + (line 29) +* org-log-into-drawer <1>: Agenda commands. (line 295) +* org-log-into-drawer: Tracking TODO state changes. + (line 6) +* org-log-note-clock-out <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 104) +* org-log-note-clock-out: Clocking commands. (line 37) +* org-log-refile: Refile and copy. (line 17) +* org-log-repeat <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 104) +* org-log-repeat: Repeated tasks. (line 37) +* org-log-states-order-reversed: Tracking TODO state changes. + (line 6) +* org-lowest-priority <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 45) +* org-lowest-priority: Priorities. (line 37) +* org-M-RET-may-split-line <1>: Plain lists. (line 82) +* org-M-RET-may-split-line: Structure editing. (line 7) +* org-md-headline-style: Markdown export. (line 29) +* org-odd-levels-only <1>: Special agenda views. + (line 41) +* org-odd-levels-only <2>: Clean view. (line 75) +* org-odd-levels-only <3>: In-buffer settings. (line 129) +* org-odd-levels-only: Matching tags and properties. + (line 72) +* org-odt-category-map-alist: Labels and captions in ODT export. + (line 21) +* org-odt-convert: Extending ODT export. + (line 36) +* org-odt-convert-capabilities: Configuring a document converter. + (line 18) +* org-odt-convert-process: Configuring a document converter. + (line 25) +* org-odt-convert-processes: Configuring a document converter. + (line 12) +* org-odt-create-custom-styles-for-srcblocks: Literal examples in ODT export. + (line 16) +* org-odt-fontify-srcblocks: Literal examples in ODT export. + (line 13) +* org-odt-pixels-per-inch: Images in ODT export. + (line 34) +* org-odt-preferred-output-format <1>: Extending ODT export. + (line 21) +* org-odt-preferred-output-format: ODT export commands. (line 9) +* org-odt-schema-dir: Validating OpenDocument XML. + (line 14) +* org-odt-styles-file <1>: Applying custom styles. + (line 25) +* org-odt-styles-file: ODT specific export settings. + (line 22) +* org-odt-table-styles: Customizing tables in ODT export. + (line 13) +* org-outline-path-complete-in-steps: Refile and copy. (line 17) +* org-overriding-columns-format: Agenda column view. (line 18) +* org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator: Plain lists. (line 14) +* org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt: The date/time prompt. + (line 76) +* org-preview-latex-default-process: Previewing LaTeX fragments. + (line 6) +* org-priority-faces: Priorities. (line 13) +* org-priority-start-cycle-with-default: Priorities. (line 32) +* org-property-allowed-value-functions: Using the property API. + (line 68) +* org-protocol-default-template-key: capture protocol. (line 19) +* org-protocol-project-alist: open-source protocol. + (line 13) +* org-publish-project-alist <1>: Publishing options. (line 13) +* org-publish-project-alist: Project alist. (line 6) +* org-publish-use-timestamps-flag: Triggering publication. + (line 21) +* org-put-time-stamp-overlays: In-buffer settings. (line 140) +* org-read-date-display-live: The date/time prompt. + (line 91) +* org-read-date-force-compatible-dates: The date/time prompt. + (line 61) +* org-read-date-prefer-future: The date/time prompt. + (line 6) +* org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes: Refile and copy. (line 17) +* org-refile-keep: Refile and copy. (line 17) +* org-refile-targets: Refile and copy. (line 17) +* org-refile-use-cache: Refile and copy. (line 17) +* org-refile-use-outline-path: Refile and copy. (line 17) +* org-remove-highlights-with-change <1>: Clocking commands. (line 83) +* org-remove-highlights-with-change: Sparse trees. (line 20) +* org-replace-disputed-keys: Conflicts. (line 18) +* org-return-follows-link: Handling links. (line 123) +* org-reverse-note-order: Refile and copy. (line 17) +* org-scheduled-delay-days: Deadlines and scheduling. + (line 42) +* org-show-context-detail: Sparse trees. (line 6) +* org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high: Filtering/limiting agenda items. + (line 92) +* org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees: Internal archiving. (line 18) +* org-special-ctrl-a/e: Headlines. (line 6) +* org-special-ctrl-k: Headlines. (line 6) +* org-speed-commands-user: Speed keys. (line 19) +* org-startup-align-all-tables <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 84) +* org-startup-align-all-tables: Column width and alignment. + (line 33) +* org-startup-folded <1>: Speeding up your agendas. + (line 18) +* org-startup-folded <2>: In-buffer settings. (line 74) +* org-startup-folded: Initial visibility. (line 6) +* org-startup-indented: In-buffer settings. (line 79) +* org-startup-with-inline-images <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 91) +* org-startup-with-inline-images: Handling links. (line 136) +* org-startup-with-latex-preview <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 97) +* org-startup-with-latex-preview: Previewing LaTeX fragments. + (line 28) +* org-store-link-functions: Adding hyperlink types. + (line 61) +* org-stuck-projects: Stuck projects. (line 17) +* org-support-shift-select <1>: Conflicts. (line 6) +* org-support-shift-select: Plain lists. (line 94) +* org-table-auto-blank-field: Built-in table editor. + (line 30) +* org-table-copy-increment: Built-in table editor. + (line 168) +* org-table-duration-custom-format: Durations and time values. + (line 6) +* org-table-export-default-format: Built-in table editor. + (line 205) +* org-table-formula: In-buffer settings. (line 30) +* org-table-formula-constants <1>: Cooperation. (line 12) +* org-table-formula-constants <2>: In-buffer settings. (line 30) +* org-table-formula-constants: References. (line 110) +* org-table-use-standard-references <1>: Editing and debugging formulas. + (line 6) +* org-table-use-standard-references: References. (line 17) +* org-tag-alist <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 174) +* org-tag-alist: Setting tags. (line 23) +* org-tag-faces: Tags. (line 10) +* org-tag-persistent-alist: Setting tags. (line 38) +* org-tags-column: Setting tags. (line 11) +* org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance: Tag inheritance. (line 22) +* org-tags-match-list-sublevels <1>: Matching tags and properties. + (line 20) +* org-tags-match-list-sublevels <2>: Property searches. (line 19) +* org-tags-match-list-sublevels <3>: Tag searches. (line 20) +* org-tags-match-list-sublevels: Tag inheritance. (line 26) +* org-texinfo-classes <1>: Headings and sectioning structure. + (line 6) +* org-texinfo-classes: Texinfo file header. (line 11) +* org-texinfo-coding-system: Texinfo file header. (line 11) +* org-texinfo-default-class <1>: Headings and sectioning structure. + (line 6) +* org-texinfo-default-class: Texinfo specific export settings. + (line 20) +* org-texinfo-info-process: Texinfo export commands. + (line 6) +* org-texinfo-table-default-markup: Plain lists in Texinfo export. + (line 12) +* org-time-stamp-custom-formats: Custom time format. (line 6) +* org-time-stamp-overlay-formats: In-buffer settings. (line 140) +* org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes: Creating timestamps. (line 23) +* org-todo (face): Faces for TODO keywords. + (line 6) +* org-todo-keyword-faces: Faces for TODO keywords. + (line 6) +* org-todo-keywords <1>: In-buffer settings. (line 192) +* org-todo-keywords <2>: Global TODO list. (line 18) +* org-todo-keywords <3>: TODO extensions. (line 6) +* org-todo-keywords: TODO basics. (line 41) +* org-todo-repeat-to-state: Repeated tasks. (line 19) +* org-todo-state-tags-triggers: TODO basics. (line 62) +* org-track-ordered-property-with-tag <1>: Checkboxes. (line 80) +* org-track-ordered-property-with-tag: TODO dependencies. (line 38) +* org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change: Structure editing. + (line 29) +* org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change: TODO basics. + (line 34) +* org-use-fast-todo-selection: TODO basics. (line 14) +* org-use-property-inheritance <1>: Using the property API. + (line 18) +* org-use-property-inheritance <2>: Header arguments in Org mode properties. + (line 17) +* org-use-property-inheritance <3>: iCalendar export. (line 51) +* org-use-property-inheritance: Property inheritance. + (line 6) +* org-use-speed-commands: Speed keys. (line 14) +* org-use-sub-superscripts: Subscripts and superscripts. + (line 14) +* org-use-tag-inheritance: Tag inheritance. (line 22) +* org-yank-adjusted-subtrees: Structure editing. (line 86) +* org-yank-folded-subtrees: Structure editing. (line 86) +* orgstruct-heading-prefix-regexp: Orgstruct mode. (line 26) +* parse-time-months: The date/time prompt. + (line 57) +* parse-time-weekdays: The date/time prompt. + (line 57) +* ps-landscape-mode: Exporting agenda views. + (line 20) +* ps-number-of-columns: Exporting agenda views. + (line 20) +* user-full-name: Export settings. (line 25) +* user-mail-address: Export settings. (line 35) + + + +Tag Table: +Node: Top892 +Node: Introduction24390 +Node: Summary24831 +Node: Installation27528 +Node: Activation30224 +Ref: Activation-Footnote-131744 +Node: Feedback31866 +Ref: Feedback-Footnote-135483 +Node: Conventions35610 +Node: Document structure37647 +Node: Outlines38638 +Node: Headlines39267 +Ref: Headlines-Footnote-140469 +Ref: Headlines-Footnote-240645 +Node: Visibility cycling40716 +Node: Global and local cycling41095 +Ref: Global and local cycling-Footnote-143722 +Ref: Global and local cycling-Footnote-243780 +Node: Initial visibility44049 +Ref: Initial visibility-Footnote-145084 +Node: Catching invisible edits45265 +Node: Motion45730 +Node: Structure editing47057 +Node: Sparse trees53655 +Ref: Sparse trees-Footnote-156165 +Ref: Sparse trees-Footnote-256276 +Node: Plain lists56347 +Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-163759 +Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-264113 +Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-364209 +Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-464456 +Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-564627 +Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-664727 +Ref: Plain lists-Footnote-764829 +Node: Drawers64895 +Ref: Drawers-Footnote-166759 +Node: Blocks66895 +Node: Footnotes67454 +Ref: Footnotes-Footnote-171398 +Ref: Footnotes-Footnote-271495 +Node: Orgstruct mode71572 +Node: Org syntax73202 +Node: Tables74175 +Node: Built-in table editor74816 +Ref: Built-in table editor-Footnote-184537 +Node: Column width and alignment84637 +Ref: Column width and alignment-Footnote-187198 +Node: Column groups87295 +Node: Orgtbl mode88866 +Node: The spreadsheet89675 +Node: References91135 +Ref: References-Footnote-197853 +Ref: References-Footnote-298075 +Ref: References-Footnote-398344 +Ref: References-Footnote-498457 +Node: Formula syntax for Calc98747 +Ref: Formula syntax for Calc-Footnote-1103899 +Node: Formula syntax for Lisp104223 +Node: Durations and time values105958 +Node: Field and range formulas107334 +Node: Column formulas109731 +Node: Lookup functions111819 +Node: Editing and debugging formulas113742 +Ref: Using multiple #+TBLFM lines118003 +Ref: Editing and debugging formulas-Footnote-1119252 +Node: Updating the table119388 +Node: Advanced features120744 +Ref: Advanced features-Footnote-1125225 +Node: Org-Plot125331 +Node: Hyperlinks129525 +Node: Link format130282 +Node: Internal links131541 +Ref: Internal links-Footnote-1133836 +Ref: Internal links-Footnote-2134076 +Node: Radio targets134214 +Node: External links134881 +Ref: External links-Footnote-1138917 +Ref: External links-Footnote-2139336 +Node: Handling links139592 +Ref: Handling links-Footnote-1147447 +Ref: Handling links-Footnote-2147606 +Ref: Handling links-Footnote-3147788 +Ref: Handling links-Footnote-4148083 +Ref: Handling links-Footnote-5148329 +Ref: Handling links-Footnote-6148448 +Ref: Handling links-Footnote-7148520 +Node: Using links outside Org148604 +Node: Link abbreviations149089 +Node: Search options151858 +Ref: Search options-Footnote-1153740 +Node: Custom searches153821 +Node: TODO items154831 +Ref: TODO items-Footnote-1155939 +Node: TODO basics156053 +Node: TODO extensions158877 +Node: Workflow states159907 +Ref: Workflow states-Footnote-1161208 +Node: TODO types161301 +Ref: TODO types-Footnote-1162899 +Node: Multiple sets in one file162968 +Node: Fast access to TODO states164822 +Ref: Fast access to TODO states-Footnote-1165695 +Ref: Fast access to TODO states-Footnote-2165779 +Node: Per-file keywords166072 +Ref: Per-file keywords-Footnote-1167443 +Node: Faces for TODO keywords167644 +Node: TODO dependencies168685 +Node: Progress logging171020 +Node: Closing items171732 +Ref: Closing items-Footnote-1172709 +Ref: Closing items-Footnote-2172778 +Node: Tracking TODO state changes172852 +Ref: Tracking TODO state changes-Footnote-1175888 +Ref: Tracking TODO state changes-Footnote-2175943 +Ref: Tracking TODO state changes-Footnote-3176083 +Node: Tracking your habits176371 +Node: Priorities180605 +Ref: Priorities-Footnote-1182577 +Node: Breaking down tasks182646 +Ref: Breaking down tasks-Footnote-1184625 +Node: Checkboxes184721 +Ref: Checkboxes-Footnote-1189348 +Ref: Checkboxes-Footnote-2189472 +Ref: Checkboxes-Footnote-3189646 +Node: Tags189766 +Node: Tag inheritance190822 +Ref: Tag inheritance-Footnote-1192637 +Ref: Tag inheritance-Footnote-2192737 +Node: Setting tags192863 +Ref: Setting tags-Footnote-1199174 +Node: Tag hierarchy199257 +Node: Tag searches202625 +Node: Properties and columns203907 +Node: Property syntax205343 +Node: Special properties209684 +Node: Property searches211329 +Node: Property inheritance212764 +Node: Column view214580 +Node: Defining columns215815 +Node: Scope of column definitions216193 +Node: Column attributes217098 +Ref: Column attributes-Footnote-1221892 +Ref: Column attributes-Footnote-2222048 +Ref: Column attributes-Footnote-3222261 +Ref: Column attributes-Footnote-4222544 +Node: Using column view222677 +Node: Capturing column view225602 +Ref: Capturing column view-Footnote-1228679 +Node: Property API228815 +Node: Dates and times229169 +Node: Timestamps230076 +Ref: Timestamps-Footnote-1232476 +Ref: Timestamps-Footnote-2232662 +Ref: Timestamps-Footnote-3232793 +Node: Creating timestamps233562 +Node: The date/time prompt236386 +Ref: The date/time prompt-Footnote-1240968 +Ref: The date/time prompt-Footnote-2241131 +Ref: The date/time prompt-Footnote-3241237 +Node: Custom time format241331 +Node: Deadlines and scheduling243053 +Ref: Deadlines and scheduling-Footnote-1246534 +Node: Inserting deadline/schedule246689 +Ref: Inserting deadline/schedule-Footnote-1248489 +Ref: Inserting deadline/schedule-Footnote-2248597 +Node: Repeated tasks248705 +Ref: Repeated tasks-Footnote-1253108 +Ref: Repeated tasks-Footnote-2253357 +Node: Clocking work time253556 +Ref: Clocking work time-Footnote-1254741 +Ref: Clocking work time-Footnote-2254885 +Node: Clocking commands255023 +Ref: Clocking commands-Footnote-1259928 +Ref: Clocking commands-Footnote-2260035 +Ref: Clocking commands-Footnote-3260085 +Ref: Clocking commands-Footnote-4260143 +Node: The clock table260221 +Ref: The clock table-Footnote-1267756 +Ref: The clock table-Footnote-2267850 +Node: Resolving idle time267975 +Ref: Resolving idle time-Footnote-1271822 +Node: Effort estimates272290 +Ref: Effort estimates-Footnote-1275043 +Node: Timers275150 +Node: Capture - Refile - Archive277442 +Node: Capture278432 +Node: Setting up capture279500 +Ref: Setting up capture-Footnote-1279909 +Node: Using capture279975 +Node: Capture templates282383 +Node: Template elements284348 +Ref: Template elements-Footnote-1290925 +Ref: Template elements-Footnote-2291242 +Node: Template expansion291429 +Ref: Template expansion-Footnote-1295497 +Ref: Template expansion-Footnote-2295584 +Ref: Template expansion-Footnote-3295847 +Ref: Template expansion-Footnote-4296029 +Node: Templates in contexts296127 +Node: Attachments296949 +Ref: Attachments-Footnote-1300396 +Node: RSS feeds300546 +Node: Protocols302023 +Node: `store-link' protocol303474 +Node: `capture' protocol304282 +Node: `open-source' protocol305394 +Node: Refile and copy308449 +Ref: Refile and copy-Footnote-1310871 +Node: Archiving310967 +Node: Moving subtrees311667 +Node: Internal archiving313691 +Node: Agenda views316323 +Node: Agenda files318651 +Ref: Agenda files-Footnote-1321454 +Ref: Agenda files-Footnote-2321603 +Node: Agenda dispatcher321796 +Ref: Agenda dispatcher-Footnote-1324627 +Ref: Agenda dispatcher-Footnote-2324721 +Node: Built-in agenda views324823 +Node: Weekly/daily agenda325407 +Ref: Weekly/daily agenda-Footnote-1331142 +Ref: Weekly/daily agenda-Footnote-2331369 +Node: Global TODO list331544 +Node: Matching tags and properties334072 +Node: Search view341024 +Node: Stuck projects342337 +Ref: Stuck projects-Footnote-1344397 +Node: Presentation and sorting344427 +Node: Categories345384 +Node: Time-of-day specifications346113 +Node: Sorting agenda items348082 +Node: Filtering/limiting agenda items349651 +Ref: Filtering/limiting agenda items-Footnote-1356799 +Node: Agenda commands357214 +Ref: Agenda commands-Footnote-1378205 +Ref: Agenda commands-Footnote-2378286 +Ref: Agenda commands-Footnote-3378405 +Ref: Agenda commands-Footnote-4378505 +Node: Custom agenda views378588 +Node: Storing searches379229 +Ref: Storing searches-Footnote-1382181 +Ref: Storing searches-Footnote-2382298 +Node: Block agenda382546 +Node: Setting options383784 +Node: Exporting agenda views387373 +Ref: Exporting agenda views-Footnote-1392281 +Ref: Exporting agenda views-Footnote-2392398 +Ref: Exporting agenda views-Footnote-3392554 +Ref: Exporting agenda views-Footnote-4392741 +Node: Agenda column view392823 +Node: Markup395895 +Node: Paragraphs396882 +Node: Emphasis and monospace398048 +Node: Horizontal rules398890 +Node: Images and tables399141 +Node: Literal examples400848 +Ref: Literal examples-Footnote-1405357 +Ref: Literal examples-Footnote-2405885 +Ref: Literal examples-Footnote-3406054 +Ref: Literal examples-Footnote-4406233 +Ref: Literal examples-Footnote-5406483 +Node: Special symbols406577 +Ref: Special symbols-Footnote-1408507 +Ref: Special symbols-Footnote-2408662 +Node: Subscripts and superscripts408752 +Node: Embedded LaTeX409856 +Ref: Embedded LaTeX-Footnote-1410670 +Node: LaTeX fragments410860 +Ref: LaTeX fragments-Footnote-1412940 +Node: Previewing LaTeX fragments413163 +Ref: Previewing LaTeX fragments-Footnote-1414592 +Node: CDLaTeX mode414838 +Ref: CDLaTeX mode-Footnote-1417338 +Node: Exporting417486 +Node: The export dispatcher420106 +Node: Export settings422676 +Ref: Export settings-Footnote-1430276 +Ref: Export settings-Footnote-2430374 +Node: Table of contents430476 +Node: Include files432320 +Ref: Include files-Footnote-1435109 +Node: Macro replacement435275 +Ref: Macro replacement-Footnote-1438041 +Node: Comment lines438258 +Ref: Comment lines-Footnote-1439064 +Node: ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export439164 +Node: Beamer export442140 +Node: Beamer export commands442910 +Node: Beamer specific export settings443582 +Node: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer445407 +Ref: Sectioning Frames and Blocks in Beamer-Footnote-1448590 +Node: Beamer specific syntax448743 +Node: Editing support450661 +Node: A Beamer example451135 +Node: HTML export452402 +Node: HTML Export commands453409 +Node: HTML Specific export settings453920 +Node: HTML doctypes455903 +Node: HTML preamble and postamble457954 +Node: Quoting HTML tags459088 +Node: Links in HTML export459750 +Node: Tables in HTML export461159 +Node: Images in HTML export462562 +Node: Math formatting in HTML export464007 +Ref: Math formatting in HTML export-Footnote-1465398 +Node: Text areas in HTML export465522 +Node: CSS support466637 +Ref: CSS support-Footnote-1470066 +Node: JavaScript support470238 +Node: LaTeX export473488 +Node: LaTeX export commands475206 +Ref: LaTeX export commands-Footnote-1476477 +Node: LaTeX specific export settings476677 +Node: LaTeX header and sectioning479405 +Node: Quoting LaTeX code481480 +Node: Tables in LaTeX export482264 +Node: Images in LaTeX export486557 +Ref: Images in LaTeX export-Footnote-1488962 +Node: Plain lists in LaTeX export489009 +Node: Source blocks in LaTeX export490014 +Node: Example blocks in LaTeX export491400 +Node: Special blocks in LaTeX export492100 +Node: Horizontal rules in LaTeX export493336 +Node: Markdown export493723 +Node: OpenDocument Text export495021 +Ref: OpenDocument Text export-Footnote-1496110 +Node: Pre-requisites for ODT export496254 +Node: ODT export commands496628 +Ref: x-export-to-odt496832 +Node: ODT specific export settings497961 +Node: Extending ODT export498968 +Ref: x-export-to-other-formats499827 +Ref: x-convert-to-other-formats500232 +Node: Applying custom styles500701 +Node: Links in ODT export502462 +Node: Tables in ODT export503112 +Node: Images in ODT export505082 +Node: Math formatting in ODT export507876 +Node: Working with LaTeX math snippets508337 +Ref: Working with LaTeX math snippets-Footnote-1510573 +Ref: Working with LaTeX math snippets-Footnote-2510649 +Node: Working with MathML or OpenDocument formula files510694 +Node: Labels and captions in ODT export511221 +Node: Literal examples in ODT export512481 +Node: Advanced topics in ODT export513299 +Node: Configuring a document converter513953 +Ref: x-odt-converter-capabilities514631 +Node: Working with OpenDocument style files515030 +Ref: x-factory-styles515435 +Ref: x-orgodtstyles-xml515673 +Ref: x-orgodtcontenttemplate-xml516000 +Ref: x-overriding-factory-styles516649 +Ref: x-org-odt-styles-file516920 +Ref: x-org-odt-content-template-file517828 +Node: Creating one-off styles517969 +Node: Customizing tables in ODT export520117 +Ref: Customizing tables in ODT export-Footnote-1524970 +Ref: Customizing tables in ODT export-Footnote-2525074 +Ref: Customizing tables in ODT export-Footnote-3525162 +Node: Validating OpenDocument XML525477 +Node: Org export526353 +Node: Texinfo export527086 +Node: Texinfo export commands528102 +Node: Texinfo specific export settings528700 +Node: Texinfo file header529783 +Node: Texinfo title and copyright page530725 +Node: Info directory file532047 +Node: Headings and sectioning structure532750 +Node: Indices534716 +Node: Quoting Texinfo code535700 +Node: Plain lists in Texinfo export536189 +Node: Tables in Texinfo export537516 +Node: Images in Texinfo export538003 +Node: Special blocks in Texinfo export538628 +Node: A Texinfo example539218 +Node: iCalendar export541342 +Node: Other built-in back-ends544935 +Node: Advanced configuration545533 +Node: Export in foreign buffers552271 +Node: Publishing553308 +Node: Configuration554176 +Node: Project alist554939 +Node: Sources and destinations556080 +Node: Selecting files557603 +Node: Publishing action558604 +Ref: Publishing action-Footnote-1560433 +Node: Publishing options560590 +Node: Publishing links573744 +Node: Sitemap575096 +Node: Generating an index578824 +Node: Uploading files579606 +Node: Sample configuration581370 +Node: Simple example581859 +Node: Complex example582566 +Node: Triggering publication584617 +Node: Working with source code585613 +Node: Structure of code blocks590063 +Node: Editing source code592550 +Node: Exporting code blocks595309 +Node: Extracting source code597604 +Node: Evaluating code blocks600046 +Ref: Evaluating code blocks-Footnote-1603167 +Ref: Evaluating code blocks-Footnote-2603293 +Node: Library of Babel603479 +Node: Languages604155 +Node: Header arguments606610 +Node: Using header arguments606967 +Node: System-wide header arguments607773 +Node: Language-specific header arguments608468 +Node: Header arguments in Org mode properties608988 +Node: Language-specific mode properties610431 +Node: Code block specific header arguments611251 +Node: Arguments in function calls612902 +Node: Specific header arguments613662 +Node: var616344 +Node: results622926 +Node: file626825 +Node: file-desc627490 +Node: file-ext627888 +Node: output-dir628305 +Node: dir628703 +Node: exports630825 +Node: tangle631697 +Node: mkdirp632542 +Node: comments632856 +Node: padline633812 +Node: no-expand634203 +Node: session634913 +Node: noweb635990 +Node: noweb-ref638602 +Node: noweb-sep639706 +Node: cache640010 +Node: sep642606 +Node: hlines642997 +Node: colnames644479 +Node: rownames645883 +Node: shebang647072 +Node: tangle-mode647550 +Node: eval648334 +Node: wrap649318 +Node: post649625 +Node: prologue651360 +Node: epilogue651856 +Node: Results of evaluation652114 +Node: Noweb reference syntax655835 +Node: Key bindings and useful functions658106 +Node: Batch execution660145 +Node: Miscellaneous660917 +Node: Completion661756 +Node: Easy templates663799 +Node: Speed keys665019 +Node: Code evaluation security666188 +Node: Customization668992 +Node: In-buffer settings669418 +Node: The very busy C-c C-c key678851 +Node: Clean view680816 +Ref: Clean view-Footnote-1684215 +Ref: Clean view-Footnote-2684438 +Ref: Clean view-Footnote-3684493 +Node: TTY keys684565 +Node: Interaction685990 +Node: Cooperation686387 +Node: Conflicts689106 +Node: org-crypt693615 +Node: Hacking694867 +Node: Hooks695853 +Node: Add-on packages696171 +Node: Adding hyperlink types696699 +Node: Adding export back-ends700060 +Node: Context-sensitive commands701280 +Node: Tables in arbitrary syntax701961 +Node: Radio tables703624 +Node: A LaTeX example705697 +Ref: A LaTeX example-Footnote-1709410 +Ref: A LaTeX example-Footnote-2709576 +Node: Translator functions710011 +Node: Radio lists712118 +Node: Dynamic blocks713268 +Node: Special agenda views715314 +Ref: x-agenda-skip-entry-regexp718139 +Ref: Special agenda views-Footnote-1718904 +Ref: Special agenda views-Footnote-2719099 +Node: Speeding up your agendas719227 +Node: Extracting agenda information720271 +Node: Using the property API724095 +Node: Using the mapping API727420 +Node: MobileOrg731387 +Node: Setting up the staging area732947 +Ref: Setting up the staging area-Footnote-1734149 +Ref: Setting up the staging area-Footnote-2734318 +Node: Pushing to MobileOrg734525 +Ref: Pushing to MobileOrg-Footnote-1735404 +Ref: Pushing to MobileOrg-Footnote-2735490 +Ref: Pushing to MobileOrg-Footnote-3735849 +Node: Pulling from MobileOrg735921 +Ref: Pulling from MobileOrg-Footnote-1737941 +Node: History and acknowledgments738001 +Node: GNU Free Documentation License753186 +Node: Main Index778376 +Node: Key Index875806 +Node: Command and Function Index928394 +Node: Variable Index963690 + +End Tag Table + + +Local Variables: +coding: utf-8 +End: |
